SERVICE
NOTES
Lotus Cars Ltd. Hethel, Norwich, Norfolk, NR14 8EZ, England.
Tel: +44 (0)1953 608000 Fax: +44 (0)1953 608300 www.LotusCars.co.uk
Part number B132T0327D/09/01
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
© Lotus Cars Ltd.2009
Publication Part Number A132T0327J
© Lotus Cars Ltd. July 2009.
This publication has been designed for use by Lotus Dealers familiar with general workshop safety procedures and practices. Take all appropriate action to guard against injury to persons or damage to property.
Lotus policy is one of continuous product improvement, and the right is reserved to alter specifications at
any time without notice.
Whilst every care has been taken to ensure correctness of information, it is impossible to guarantee complete freedom from errors or omissions, or to accept liability arising from such errors or omissions, but nothing
herein contained shall affect your statutory rights.
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Introduction
CONTENTS
LOTUS EVORA
Section
Technical Data - Engine
- Vehicle
TDT
TDU
Chassis
AJ
Bodycare & Repair
BU
Body Fittings
BV
Front Suspension
CK
Rear Suspension
DJ
Engine & Engine Management - Lotus supplement
- Toyota engine repair manual
EJ
*
EMR
Engine Management
Transmission
- Lotus supplement
- Toyota transmission manual
FL
#
Wheels & Tyres
GJ
Steering
HI
Brakes
JL
Engine Cooling
KJ
Fuel System
Electrics
LN
Maintenance & Lubrication
OK
Air Conditioning, Heating & Ventilation
PN
Clutch
QJ
Interior Trim
VE
Passive Restraint
WF
* see separate CD: T000T1516F
# see separate CD: T000T1517F
MR
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Introduction
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER & ENGINE NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (V.I.N.) is a unique 17-digit number used to identify the car for licencing,
warranty, spares ordering and administrative purposes.
The chassis frame is stamped with the V.I.N. on the crossmember beneath the driver’s seat, accessible
inside the cabin with the seat slid fully rearwards. Pull back a flap in the carpet to view. The number is also
printed on a label stuck to the vertical face of the fuel tank bay, below the front edge of the right hand rear seat
cushion or luggage shelf. Pull back a flap in the carpet to view.
It is essential that the complete V.I.N. is quoted in any correspondence concerning the car, or when order
ing spare parts.
intro25
3#
#1
#
(
#
0564901
2GR
ohe40
ENGINE NUMBER
V.I.N. LABEL
V.I.N. ON CHASSIS
intro24
Engine Number
The 6-digit engine serial number is stamped on the LH rear flange of the cylinder block, alongside the
clutch housing jointface, and is viewable only from beneath after removal of the engine undertray. The number
is repeated on a bar code label applied to the front face of the left hand cylinder head, which may be viewed
from above using a mirror.
The full V.I.N. should always be quoted with any vehicle enquiries, together with the engine number if the
query is engine related. Factory records are filed against V.I.N., and specification change points are identified
by V.I.N. or engine number.
The V.I.N. comprises 17 characters, coded in accordance with European Economic Community (EEC)
directives, or, for the USA, with those of the National Highway Traffic Safety Association (NHTSA). For change
point identification in Service Notes, Service Bulletins and Service Parts Lists, typically, only characters 10
(model year), and 14 to 17 (serial number) will be quoted.
Assembly
Plant
H = Hethel
Manufacturer
Vehicle Type Check
B = Shah Model
Identifier Code
122 = Evora Digit
Alam 4 = Evora
S C C
1 2 3 4
5
6 7 8
9
Engine Type Restraint
T = 2GR-FE C = Dual S.I.R.
+ active
front belts
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
10
11
12
13
14 15 16 17
Model Year Chassis/Body Serial
9 = 2009 N = RHD a.c. Number
A = 2010 P = LHD a.c.
B = 2011
120U0113
Lotus Service Notes
Introduction
MODEL HISTORY
Evora Introduction:
First deliveries commence June 2009 at '09 VIN serial number 0721.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Introduction
LIFTING POINTS
When using a lifting jack or hoist, care must be taken to position the device only beneath the areas shown
in the illustration. Each designated point uses a ribbed alloy reinforcement pad integral with the main chassis
structure. Use a suitable rubber pad to provide additional protection from surface damage:
A;
Identified by a blue sticker. Beneath the front ends of the chassis main siderails, just behind the rear edge
of the front undertray.
B;
Identified by a blue sticker. Beneath each end of the fuel tank bay rear crossmember, just ahead of the
front edge of the engine bay undertray.
If using a single jack for wheel changing purposes, a single rear lifting point (B) may be used to raise both
wheels on that side of the car. With the limited vision available under these circumstances, extra care must be
taken to position the jack correctly.
Note that in order fully to exploit the benefits of light weight, and to maximise stowage space, the Evora
has no provision for spare wheel carriage or lifting jack. A temporary puncture recovery facility is provided in
the form of a tyre inflator aerosol stowed in the right hand side of the boot.
B B
A
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
A
ohe52
Lotus Service Notes
Section AJ
CHASSIS
SECTION AJ
Sub-Section
Page
General Description
AJ.1
3
Chassis Straightness Check
AJ.2
4
Rear Subframe
AJ.3
5
Front Subframe
AJ.4
6
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Gusset panel
Main siderail
Mounting face for
front subframe
Door hinge post
a31
Steering column
Hinge post
cut-out
reinforcement
Seat mounting
crossmember
Mounting face for
rear subframe
Lotus Service Notes
Pedal box
apeture
Scuttle
beam
EAGLE MAIN CHASSIS TUB
Upper gusset
Section AJ
Lotus Service Notes
Section AJ
AJ.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The chassis frame of the Lotus Eagle is constructed primarily from aluminium alloy extrusions and formed
alloy sheet, with the various sections bonded together using an epoxy adhesive with secondary drive-in fasteners. The main chassis unit includes the passenger cell, footwells, front bulkhead, front scuttle with door hinge
posts and the fuel tank bay. At the rear, the main chassis siderails extend rearwards beyond the fuel tank bay
and alongside the engine bay, to terminate in mounting faces for the galvanised steel rear subframe. Similarly,
the front bulkhead/toe board provides mountings for the alloy front subframe. A large diameter tubular steel
seat belt mounting frame is bolted to the top face of the chassis side members, and incorporates a roof hoop
with backstays for additional occupant protection.
The cabin rear bulkhead, body sills (inc. 'B' posts), roof panel, and windscreen mounting frame, are all
constructed from glass fibre composite and are bonded to the chassis structure using an elastomeric adhesive.
The front and rear outer body clamshells are each constructed from glass fibre composite mouldings, fixed to
the body and chassis structure with threaded fasteners to facilitate service access and economic repair.
Two main chassis siderail extrusions, 226mm wide and 80mm deep, each comprising three box sections,
run along each side of the passenger compartment between the front and rear subframe mountings. Each
member incorporates two bends to allow the siderails to angle inwards afore and behind the seating area in
order to accommodate the wheel wells. Each bend is formed by notching the extrusion, bending the outer wall
and restoring the three cut faces with bonded and riveted patches. The front joint is reinforced by an inboard
gusset panel, and the rear joint by the fuel tank crossmember. At the rear, each siderail is raised above the
lower wishbone front pivot by having the siderail lowermost section machined away, and adding a folded upper gusset to the siderail top surface, to reinforce a vertical end face used for attachment of the rear subframe
supension tower.
Five crossmembers link the bottom of the two siderails; one at the toe-board, two bonded together at the
seat front mountings, one for the seat rear mountings, and one across the front of the fuel tank bay. Two single
skin sheet sections are used to complete the cabin floor.
Behind the passenger cell, the siderails are linked by a pair of transverse crossmembers which are used
in conjunction with a folded sheet upper panel to form an open bottomed fuel tank cell with a detachable, screw
fixed, lower closing panel. Note that this closing panel contributes to the structural integrity of the chassis, such
that the vehicle should not be operated without it properly fitted.
The front scuttle structure comprises a scuttle beam, the two door hinge posts and the foowells. A vertical extrusion is used to form each door hinge post, which is secured to the end of the scuttle beam, and, by a
rearwards leading tapering channel section, to the chassis siderail. Perforated flat plates are also used to tie
the lower ends of the hinge posts to the siderails. The folded sheet footbox links the front of the scuttle beam to
the siderails, the toe-board and to vertical strongpoints which are used to terminate the front end of the siderails
and provide mounting points for the front subframe.
A galvanised, sheet steel, fabricated rear subframe, provides mountings for the rear suspension, powertrain
and exhaust muffler, and is bolted to the rear ends of the chassis siderails. The subframe also serves as a deformable crash structure to provide the necessary energy dissipation in the event of a rear impact. This feature
also facilitates accident repair by separating the suspension mounting points from the main chassis structure.
At the front of the car, a front subframe uses the same construction techniques as the main chassis tub,
with aluminium alloy extrusions bonded and riveted together to provide mounting points for the front suspension,
front body clamshell and cooling radiators, and also houses the heating/a.c. system. The structure consists
primarily of a box section extrusion at each side, continuing forwards from the front of the chassis tub to which
each side is fixed by a 6 bolt flange. These two longerons, house the mounting points for the top wishbone
pivots and carry drop towers down to the lower wishbone pivots. The foremost of these are linked by a lower
crossmember which also carries the power steering rack, with the whole area reinforced by a bolted upper
crossmember/bulkead panel forming the front of the HVAC chamber. The front ends of the longerons are linked
by another crossmember secured at each side by two M8 fixings. The construction of the subframe also serves
to dissipate energy and control the rate of deceleration sustained by the occupants in a frontal collision. As
at the rear, this feature also facilitates accident repair by separating the suspension mounting points from the
main chassis structure.
Note that the whole of the chassis structure as so far described, is machined to allow assembly into right
or left hand drive configuration.
The bonded and rivetted main chassis tub described above is considered a non-serviceable single unit,
jig built to fine tolerances, to which no structural repairs are approved. Superficial, cosmetic, or non-structural
localised damage may be cosmetically repaired as necessary, but in the case of accident damage resulting
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section AJ
in significant bending, tearing or distortion of the aluminium structure, especially in respect of the attachment
points for the front and rear subframes, the recommended repair is to renew the partial body assembly, which
comprises the main chassis tub, with jig bonded composite rear bulkhead, body sills and windscreen frame.
Also included are the pipes and cables routed through the body sill mouldings.
AJ.2 - CHASSIS STRAiGHTNESS CHECK
In the absence of visual damage, the chassis may be checked for twist or distortion by utilising the machined
tooling indents in the underside of the main side rails. If computer processed laser measuring equipment is not
available, manual checks can be made with reference to a completely level ground plane, e.g. an accurately
set and maintained suspension geometry ramp/lift. Position the car on the lift, and proceed as follows:
1.
Identify the tooling indents in the lower surface of each chassis main side rail. At the front end, just behind
the front crossmember, and at the rear, just ahead of the fuel tank bay rear crossmember. Note that three
of the machined oval areas are drilled, but not at the left hand rear.
2.
Measure the height of each tooling indent above the reference plane and use jacks to adjust the height of
the chassis in order to equalise any three of these dimensions.
3.
Measure the deviation of the fourth dimension from the other three.
Maximum service deviation = ± 2.0 mm.
4.
Repeat operations (2) and (3) for each combination of corners to result in four values for the 'fourth' dimension deviation. If any one of these exceeds the service specification, the chassis should be considered
damaged and replaced by a partial body assembly.
Illustration to follow
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section AJ
AJ.3 - REAR SUBFRAME
The rear ends of the chassis siderails are linked by a fabricated sheet steel subframe which provides
mountings for the powertrain, rear suspension, rear body, exhaust muffler and seat belt mounting frame struts.
The subframe is aligned to each of the siderails by an 8mm roll pin, and secured by seven M10 x 30, 8.8 grade
bolts. It is possible to remove the subframe from the chassis complete with powertrain and suspension attached,
although access to some fixing bolts will be restricted, and alignment on refitment may be difficult.
To remove/refit rear subframe
1. Remove rear body and disconnect all pipes, hoses, harnesses and cables.
2.
Remove the seat belt mounting frame rear struts.
3.
Support the rear subframe before progressively and evenly removing the seven fixing bolts from each side
of the frame:
At each side;
- Two bolts from beneath into threaded inserts in the chassis rail lower surface;
- Three bolts into captive nuts in the chassis rail side face;
- Two bolts from within the engine bay using loose nuts ahead of the siderail closing plate.
4.
Withdraw the subframe taking note of the shim plates fitted at each side between the bottom of the siderail
and the subframe.
5.
On re-assembly, first trial fit the subframe to the chassis, using no shim plates. Locate the subframe by
engaging the roll pins into the dowel holes in the chassis rail rear closing plates and secure at each side
by temporarily fitting the two bolts and nuts through the closing plates. Measure the gap between the
bottom of each chassis siderail and the subframe horizontal surface, and select the appropriate number
of 1mm shim plates.
Front subframe (alloy)
Main chassis tub (alloy)
Rear subframe (steel)
Tie plate
Shim plate
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
a32
6.
Lotus Service Notes
Section AJ
Re-assemble the subframe to the chassis using Duralac MSDS anti-corrosion compound (A111C6017S)
between the mating faces and inserting the appropriate shim stacks. Fit all fixing bolts and tighten evenly
and progressively to a final torque of 45 Nm.
AJ.4 - FRONT SUBFRAME
The front subframe uses the same construction techniques as the main chassis tub, with aluminium alloy
extrusions bonded and riveted together to provide mounting points for the front suspension, front body clamshell and cooling radiators, and also houses the heating/a.c. system. The subframe legs are secured at each
side to the front face of the chassis tub by three bolts, and reinforced by a tie plate on the outer surface which
uses six bolts.
To remove/refit front subframe
Before removing the front subframe, it is recommended to remove all front bodywork, the front suspension
assembly and the HVAC equipment in order to allow easier handling of the subframe and to minimise potential
component damage.
1. Remove the front clamshell, 'A' panels and front bumper.
2.
Recover the a.c. refrigerant and drain the engine cooling radiator. Remove the HVAC unit (see section
PN) and disconnect all hoses, pipes, harnesses and cables.
3.
Disconnect the steering column from the rack pinion shaft.
4.
Provide support for the subframe before releasing the six bolts securing the tie plate to each subframe
leg. Then progressively and evenly release the three bolts securing the inboard side of each subframe
leg to the chassis. Withdraw the subframe.
5.
On re-assembly, mate the subframe to the chassis and locate with the three bolts and each side. Fit the
tie plates to the outboard faces and locate the six bolts at each side. Progressively and evenly tighten all
18 off M10x30 bolts to a final torque of 45 Nm.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section AJ
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
BODYCARE & REPAIR
SECTION BU
Sub-Section Page
General Description
BU.1
3
Lotus Composite Body Features
BU.2
3
Bodycare
BU.3
4
Accident Damage Assessment
BU.4
5
Body Panel Bonding Materials
BU.5
6
Replacement of Bonded-On Panels - General
BU.6
9
Roof Panel
BU.7
9
Windscreen Frame
BU.8
10
Body Side Panels
BU.9
11
Rear Bulkhead
BU.10
12
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Front clamshell
Windscreen frame*
Roof panel*
Rear bulkhead*
Ventilation panel
Tailgate
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
'A' panel
Body side panel*
Rear clamshell
Rear bumper
b357
Lotus Service Notes
* denotes panels bonded with elastomeric adhesive
Door
Front bumper
Reservoir access hatch Rear
spoiler
Evora Composite Body Panels
Section BU
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
BU.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The body panels of the Lotus Evora are constructed of composite materials, and contribute to the overall
stiffness of the body/chassis structure. The panels are attached to the aluminium chassis and/or other body
panels either by elastomeric polyurethane adhesive, where maximum structural integrity is required, or by
threaded fasteners, where ease of service access and repair is the greater priority. The windscreen frame
incorporates foam cores to create closed box sections for optimum strength and lightness.
BU.2 - Lotus COMPOSITE BODY FEATURES
Composite structures have the ability to absorb high impact loads by progressive collapse, with impact
damage being localised. In vehicle accidents this feature protects the occupants from injurious shock loads and
greatly reduces the danger of entrapment by deformation of steel body panels. This behaviour also facilitates
repair either by replacing the damaged bonded or bolt on panels, and/or integrating a replacement section
with the undamaged area, using recognised approved methods which restore the panel to its original condition
without residual strain or distortion.
The manufacturing process enables the thickness of composite mouldings to be varied in order to provide
efficient structures of high strength and low weight. Composites will not corrode, so the strength of composite components is retained regardless of age, unless physical damage is sustained. On the Evora, the body
construction features a safety cell around the cabin, comprising an assembly of body panels bonded to the
chassis and to each other to provide maximum occupant protection combined with light weight. Both ahead of,
and behind the cabin, body panels are screw fixed to permit easy removal for access to chassis or powertrain
components, or to allow simple and economic accident repair.
A composite panel may return to its original shape after deflection, but beyond a certain level of flexibility,
such treatment may result in the formation of surface cracks which may not be immediately apparent due to
the masking effect of the paint film. A steel panel similarly treated would become dented or deformed. The
cracking may be confined to the surface layer with no reduction in panel strength, but if the damage is more
severe the composite structure below the surface may be weakened. Localised repairs can be made in either
case. Possible causes of surface cracking include:
-
Vehicle collision;
Inappropriately sitting, leaning heavily or pushing on the body or any composite panel;
Knocking doors against obstructions when opening;
Dropping or striking objects against a panel, including footballs and other wayward missiles;
Unrestrained items in the luggage compartment striking the inside of the rear body;
Attempting to close the tailgate onto projecting luggage or tools
Applying excessive force to parts attached to composite panels e.g. mirrors, handles and locks (inc. action
by vandals).
Incorrect jacking, or panel removal procedures.
The composite body panels of the Evora are manufactured by one of several processes dependent on
the requirements of the panel concerned:
All visible external panels, where surface quality is a priority, are produced by Injection Compression System
Resin Transfer Moulding (ICSRTM), whereby glass fibre mat cut to shape and preformed when necessary,
is placed in a heated, chrome steel surfaced, closed mould, into which polyester resin is injected. After
filling, the gap between the two halves of the mould is then reduced in order to compress the moulding
and ensure complete material flow and consistent structural quality. Panel thickness varies according to
strength/weight requirement. The special 'low profile' resin used ensures minimum shrinkage during the
curing process, in order to provide the optimum surface finish.
For less visible components, including the rear bulkhead, battery box, boot box and some reinforcement
panels, a Resin Transfer Moulding process is used with standard polyester resin injected at low pressure
into a double sided closed tool containing dry and preformed composite material.
For panels with a relatively simple shape and a low structural requirement, a Sheet Moulding Compound
(SMC) process is used, whereby a pad of material impregnated with resin is placed in a closed tool which
applies heat and a low compression to the moulding. A panel of high surface quality is produced, requiring
only a minimum of fettling operations.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
-
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
The front and rear bumpers are produced by a Reinforced Reaction Injection Moulding (RRIM) process,
whereby a mixture of polyurethane resin and milled glass is injected into a closed mould to result in panels
with good surface finish and high flexibility.
Whichever production process applies, if repairs can be determined as being more economic than panel
replacement, repair methods using either conventional composite techniques, or proprietary plastic component
repair systems, can be used to rectify surface or structural damage.
ICS components
Front clamshell outer
Rear clamshell outer
Bodysides
Tailgate inner
Roof
Door inners
Windscreen frame
RTM components
Rear bulkhead
Battery and boot boxes
Clamshell reinforcement panels
SMC components
Tailgate outer
Door outers
'A' post panels
Reservoir access hatch
RRIM components
Front and rear bumpers
BU.3 - BODYCARE
The acrylic enamel paint finish of the Evora is extremely resistant to all normal forms of atmospheric attack.
Following the simple maintenance procedure summarised below will help retain the gloss, colour and protective
properties of the paint throughout the life of the vehicle. However, car finishes are not immune to damage, and
amongst the more common causes of deterioration are:
‑
‑
‑
‑
‑
-
Atmospheric contaminants; dust, soot, ash, and acidic or alkaline aerosol mist can chemically attack
paint.
Abrasion; blowing sand and dust, or a dirty washing cloth.
Tree sap and insect fluids; can form a water‑insoluble polymer that adheres to the paint.
Bird excrement; highly acidic or alkaline, they can chemically etch the paint. Wash off immediately.
Leaves; contain tannic acid which can stain light finishes.
Impact damage; granite chippings thrown up from poor or recently dressed road surfaces can subject
the body to severe localised impact, and result in paint chips, especially around the vulnerable frontal
panels.
Moisture entrapment; Long term use of a non-breathable car cover can trap moisture and/or induce condensation and promote water penetration of the paint film.
Washing
Lotus recommends hand washing of the painted bodywork. The car is a speciality sports vehicle not
intended to be subjected to an automatic car wash. Automatic car washing machines may have a detrimental
effect on the paint film and their use will invalidate the terms of the Vehicle Warranty.
Many contaminants are water soluble and can be removed before any harm occurs by thorough washing
with plenty of lukewarm water, together with a proprietary car wash additive (household detergent and washing
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
up liquid can contain corrosive salts, and will remove wax and accelerate oxidation). Frequent washing is the
best safeguard against both seen and invisible contaminants. Wash in the shade, and use a cotton chenille
wash mitt or a sponge rinsed frequently to minimise entrapment of dirt particles. Use a straight back and forth
washing motion to avoid swirled micro scratches, and rinse thoroughly.
In order to minimise degradation from road salt, the underside of the chassis should be rinsed with clean
water as soon as possible after driving on treated roads. Many fuel filling stations offer pressure washing facilities ideal for this purpose, but to not use on the painted bodywork or vulnerable powertrain components or
delicate radiator finning.
Paintwork Polishing
Eventually some loss of gloss, and an accumulation of traffic film, will occur. At this stage, after normal
washing, the application of a good quality liquid polish will restore the original lustre of the paint film. Higher
gloss of the paint finish, and added protection against contamination, can be obtained by the use of a wax
polish; however, this can only be used successfully on a clean surface, from which the previous application has
been removed with white spirit or a liquid polish cleaner.
Ventilation
Water lying on the paint surface for a lengthy period will eventually penetrate the paint film. Although the
effects will not be visible immediately, a deterioration in the protective properties of the paint film will ultimately
result. It is not recommended to store a wet car in a poorly ventilated garage. If good ventilation cannot be
provided, storage outside on a hard standing or under a carport is to be preferred.
BU.4 - ACCIDENT DAMAGE ASSESSMENT
The repair method to be employed in the rectification of accident damage to composite panels, is to be
assessed reletive to the particular panel and its method of attachment:
Bolt-on Panels: - Front Clamshell & Reservoir Hatch;
- Front Bumper;
- 'A' Panels;
- Door Shells;
- Rear Clamshell;
- Rear Bumper;
- Tailgate;
- Ventilation Panel;
- Reservoir Hatch.
These panels are secured by threaded fasteners and are easily removed for access to the back of any
damaged area for repair by conventional composite techniques. Instructions for the removal and refitment of
these panels are contained in section BV.
Bonded-on Panels: - Windscreen Frame;
- LH & RH Body Side Panels;
- Rear Bulkhead;
- Roof Panel.
These panels are bonded to the chassis or to other panels using a flexible polyurethane adhesive which
must be cut before the panel may be removed. In some cases, it may be necessary to partially remove another
panel before the subject panel can be released. It is not generally economic to attempt to remove a bonded
panel intact for later re-fitment.
The shape, positioning and structure of the windscreen frame is crucial to the fit of the windscreen and
adjacent body panels, in addition to its behaviour in a vehicle collision. The only repairs which should be considered for this panel are cosmetic and superficial; any structural damage should be addressed by windscreen
frame replacement.
The body side panels include the ‘A’ posts, ‘B’ posts and cantrails, and involve much labour time to replace. Localised repairs should be performed whenever possible, if necessary using a partial section cut from
a replacement body side panel. Access to the inner surface should be considered when assessing cut lines.
Note that if damage is such as to require replacement of the chassis, a service replacement chassis is
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
provided only as a 'partial body assembly' which includes jig bonded windscreen frame, body side panels, rear
bulkhead and roof. Also included, are the pipes, hoses and cables routed through the sills.
BU.5 - BODY PANEL BONDING MATERIALS
The materials used for bonding the body panels are manufactured by Dow Chemical, and in order to
maintain the structural integrity of the vehicle, and in the case of the front crash structure, the safety, it is most
important to use only the specified materials. The surface preparation and cleaning and priming operations are
crucial to the performance of the adhesive, and must be followed in detail. The products to be used depend on
the surface (substrate) onto which they are applied, and the following list identifies each application:
Anodised aluminium (e.g. chassis and components)
Cleaner: Betawipe VP 04604 Lotus part no. A082B6150V
Primer: Betapnme 5404 Lotus part no. A082B6337V
Adhesive: Betaseal 1701 Lotus part no. A082B6281F
Unpainted or painted composite
Cleaner: Betaclean 3900 Lotus part no. A100B6008V
Primer: Betaprime 5404 Lotus part no. A082B6337V
Adhesive: Betaseal 1701 Lotus part no. A082B6281F
Zinc plated and passivated steel
Cleaner: Betaclean 3900 Lotus part no. A100B6008V
Primer: Betaprime 1707 (A+B) Lotus part no. A111B6374V
Adhesive: Betaseal 1701 Lotus part no. A082B6281F
Glass
Cleaner: Betabrade F1 Lotus part no. A120B6043V
or Betaclean 3300 Lotus part no. A120B6042V
or Betaclean 3900 Lotus part no. A100B6008V
Primer: Betaprime 5500 Lotus part no. A120B6041V
Adhesive: Betaseal 1701 Lotus part no. A082B6281F
Uncoated Lexan/Perspex
Cleaner: Abrasion & dry wipe
Primer: Betaprime 5404 Lotus part no. A082B6337V
Adhesive: Betaseal 1701 Lotus part no. A082B6281F
Residual adhesive (i.e. rebonding to surface after cutting off old panel)
Cleaner, primer
& re-activator: Betawipe 4000 Lotus part no. A082B6355V
Adhesive: Betaseal 1701 Lotus part no. A082B6281 F
Applicator Bottle
An applicator bottle is available for use with some cleaners and primers, and has a disposable felt pad
which should be changed regularly to minimise surface contamination:
Applicator bottle: A000Z1071F
Cap: A082B6353S
Felt pad: A082B6354S
Product Usage
BETAWIPE VP 04604 (A082B6150V):
Description: Activator and cleaning agent used to promote adhesion to the substrate surface. Supplied in
a 250ml aluminium container with a YELLOW coloured cap.
Application: - Wipe on/wipe off type.
- Pour Betawipe VP 04604 into applicator bottle, and immediately refit the yellow cap onto the
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Notes:
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
container.
- Push the applicator head onto the bottle, and fit the felt pad.
- Wet out the felt pan by inverting the applicator bottle and gently squeezing the sides.
- Wipe the pad over the substrate surface using minimal pressure to wet the surface.
- Immediately wipe off the activated/cleaned surface using a clean fibre free cloth, and dis
card.
- If the substrate is very dirty, first wipe off the surface with a clean fibre free cloth and discard.
- Do not leave the caps off Betawipe containers. A milky colour indicates moisture absorption,
and the material should be discarded.
- Only decant a sufficient quantity of Betawipe for the job concerned, and never pour material
back into the container from the applicator bottle.
- Change the felt pad at regular intervals to reduce surface contamination.
BETACLEAN 3900 (A100B6008V)
Description: Degreaser and cleaning agent used for the removal of contamination from the substrate surface.
Supplied in 1 litre aluminium container with a BLACK coloured cap.
Application: - Wipe on/wipe off type.
- When substrate is very dirty, first wipe off the surface with a clean fibre-free cloth and dis
card.
- Dampen a fibre-free cloth with Betaclean 3900, and immediately replace the black cap.
- Thoroughly clean the substrate surface with Betaclean and discard the cloth.
- Wipe off the substrate with a clean fibre-free cloth and discard.
BETABRADE F1 (A120B6043V)
Description: Liquid for removing contaminants from glass surface without scratching.
Application: Betabrade F1 may be applied to either (i) the glass surface, or (ii) a fibre free cloth.
i) Glass surface: Apply small beads of material, approx 3mm dia. x 50mm to the ceramic surface of the glass. Use a fibre free cloth to thoroughly clean the ceramic surface of the glass to
be bonded and then wipe off all residual amounts. (A wipe on/wipe off process)
ii) Fibre free cloth: Apply material to the fibre free cloth and thoroughly clean the ceramic
surface of the glass to be bonded and then wipe off all residual amounts. (A wipe on/wipe off
process)
BETACLEAN 3300 (A120B6042V)
Description: Cleaner for glass and ceramic frit (coating).
Application: Betaclean 3300 may be applied to either (i) the glass surface, or (ii) a fibre free cloth.
i) Glass surface: Spray the material onto the ceramic frit (coating) of the glass around the
periphery and then using a fibre free cloth thoroughly clean the surface.
ii) Fibre free cloth: Apply the cleaner to the fibre free cloth and then thoroughly clean the ceramic frit (coating). In both (i) and (ii) above the method is a wipe on/wipe off process.
BETAWIPE 4000 (A082B6355V)
Description: Cleaning agent which acitvates the old adhesive layer to accept new adhesive. Supplied in
15ml aluminium containers with a BLUE cap.
Application: - The residual adhesive bead should be cut with a scalpal to leave an even thickness of approximately 1 to 2 mm.
- Dampen a fibre-free cloth with Betawipe 4000 and immediately replace the blue cap.
- Thoroughly clean the substrate surface with Betawipe and discard the cloth. Do not wipe
off.
- Allow 2 - 3 minutes flash off time before applying adhesive.
BETAPRIME 5500 (A120B6041V)
Description: Adhesion promotor used to maximise the performance of the bonding between the cleaned
and/or activated surface and the adhesive compound. Supplied in 250 ml aluminium container
with GREEN coloured cap.
Application: - Two steel balls inside the container are provided to assist mixing of the contents when shaken.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Notes:
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
Prior to decanting Betaprime 5500, shake the container for at least 60 seconds to disperse the
solid content of the material into suspension.
- Pour the primer into the applicator bottle and immediately replace the green cap.
- Wet out the felt pan by inverting the applicator bottle and gently squeezing the sides.
- Wipe the pad over the activated/cleaned substrate surface to apply a continuous film of
primer.
- Allow to dry for a minimum of 15 minutes before applying adhesive. If adhesive is not applied
with 72 hours, wipe on/wipe off with Betawipe VP 04604.
- The appearance of the primed areas should be deep black in colour with no streaks or
voids.
To achieve this appearance, apply in smooth continuous uni-directional movement, not short
backward and forward movements. The latter technique results in inconsistent film build.
Rework any poor areas after 5 minutes (tack time), applying in the same direction.
- Replace the felt pad if moisture absorption results in hardening.
- Never return unused Betaprime back into the aluminium container.
BETAPRIME 5404 (A082B6337V)
Description: Adhesion promotor used to maximise the performance of the bonding between the cleaned
and/or activated surface and the adhesive compound. Supplied in 250 ml aluminium container
with RED coloured cap.
Application: - Two steel balls inside the container are provided to assist mixing of the contents when shaken.
Prior to decanting Betaprime 5404, shake the container for at least 60 seconds to disperse the
solid content of the material into suspension.
- Pour the primer into the applicator bottle and immediately replace the green cap.
- Wet out the felt pan by inverting the applicator bottle and gently squeezing the sides.
- Wipe the pad over the activated/cleaned substrate surface to apply a continuous film of
primer.
- Allow to dry for a minimum of 15 minutes before applying adhesive. If adhesive is not applied
with 24 hours, re-activate by applying a further coat of Betaprime 5404.
Notes: - The appearance of the primed areas should be deep black in colour with no streaks or
voids.
To achieve this appearance, apply in smooth continuous uni-directional movement, not short
backward and forward movements. The latter technique results in inconsistent film build.
Rework any poor areas after 5 minutes (tack time), applying in the same direction.
- Replace the felt pad if moisture absorption results in hardening.
- Never return unused Betaprime back into the aluminium container.
BETAPRIME 1707 A+B (A111B6374V)
Description: Adhesion promotor used to maximise the performance of the bonding between the cleaned
and/or activated surface and the adhesive compound. Supplied in 250 ml aluminium containers
of component A and component B.
Application: - Thoroughly shake component A container to disperse solid material. Remove the lid from the
component A container and scrape any sediment from the botton of the container. Replace the
container lid and thoroughly shake again to disperse the solid content.
- Pour the required amount of component A into a clean container, and add the same volume
of component B. Replace lids immediately. Thoroughly mix the two components for 45 seconds
minimum.
- Leave the mixed components to stand for 30 MINUTES. (Discard if unused after 8 hours)
- Pour the pnmer into the applicator bottle and wet out the felt pan by inverting the bottle and
gently squeezing the sides.
- Wipe the pad over the cleaned substrate surface to apply a continuous THIN film of primer:
A thin, almost transparent film is all that is required. No attempt should be made to attain a
completely opaque covering.
- Allow to dry for a minimum of 4 HOURS, before applying adhesive.
Notes: - To achieve a continuous thin film of Betaprime 1707, apply in a smooth continuous uni-directional movement, not short backward and forward movements. The latter technique results in
inconsistent film build.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
- Replace the felt pad if moisture absorption results in hardening.
- Never return unused Betaprime back into the aluminium container.
Section BU
BETASEAL 1701 (A082B6281F)
Description: One component moisture curing adhesive, providing high strength, permanently elastic bonds
between various substrates. Supplied in 300 ml aluminium cartridge.
Application: - Remove the cartridge end ensuring there is no damage to the reinforcing sleeve.
- Pierce the neck of the cartridge and screw on the applicator nozzle. Cut the nozzle end to the
required diameter and shape.
- Fit the cartridge into an air assisted gun, and extrude a smooth, even and continuous bead
of Betaseal to the previously prepared substrate.
- Assemble the joint within 5 MINUTES.
Notes: - If the adhesive has to be touched or manipulated for any reason, use only wetted fingers.
Plastic Panel Repair System
For repairs of cracked or damaged panels 'in-situ', plastic panel repair systems may be used such as Wurth
Replast, available under Lotus part number T000T1469F. Full instructions are supplied with the kit.
BU.6 - REPLACEMENT OF BONDED-ON PANELS - GENERAL
Bonded body panels are secured using Dow Chemicals products ‘Betaseal’ or ‘Betamate’, which are flexible
polyurethane adhesives which must be cut in order for a panel to be removed. The recommended method of
adhesive cutting is with the use of a pneumatic tool such as are widely available from specialist tool suppliers,
and which use a range of differently shaped cutting knives operating with a rapidly oscillating action. These
tools may also be used to remove windscreens.
An applicator gun for dispensing Betaseal 1701 adhesive may be obtained directly from PC Cox Ltd,
Turnpike Lane, Newbury, Berks. RG14 2LR Tel; +44 (0)1635 264500.
With some panels, it may not be practicable to attempt to removal intact for later refitment; damage to the
bonding flange is likely to occur. Consequently, when expedient, the panel can be cut away for better access
to the bonded joint. It is not necessary to remove all traces of sealant from the joint faces on the remaining
panels or chassis, but any remaining sealant must be securely bonded and no thicker than 1 mm or the fit and
joint gaps will be upset. It is essential always to follow the cleaning/priming/bonding operations meticulously if
sufficiently strong and durable bonds are to be achieved. Always use the specified materials.
Preferred practice is to paint the body panels prior to bonding into position (as factory build), firstly masking off all bonding surfaces on the panel.
BU.7 - roof panel
The composite roof panel is an ICS moulding which is last to be assembled, and generally the first panel
which needs to be removed. The panel is bonded to the top of the windscreen header rail, cabin rear bulkhead
panel, top flanges of the body side panels and seat belt mounting frame.
To replace roof panel
1. Remove the 'A' post covers and the roof lining if this is to be re-used.
2.
Remove rear clamshell (see sub-section BV.5).
3.
Using a pneumatic knife or cutting wire, cut the adhesive between the roof and header rail, body side
panels, rear bulkhead and seat belt frame, and remove the roof.
4.
Remove excess sealant from all the bonding areas on the header rail, body side panels, rear bulkhead
and seat belt frame. It is not necessary to remove all traces of old adhesive, but any remaining adhesive
must be securely bonded and be cut with a scalpal blade to leave an even thickness of 1 - 2 mm.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
5.
Prepare the bonding surface of the new roof panel with Betaclean 3900 and Betaprime 5404 (see sub
section BU.5). Prepare the surface of the residual adhesive on the body panels and seat belt frame using
Betawipe 4000 (see sub-section BU.5).
6.
Apply a bead of Betaseal adhesive (see sub-section BU.5) to the bonding surface on the header rail, rear
bulkhead, body side panels and seat belt frame, and fit the roof into position. Press all around the whole
length of the joint to ensure sufficient spread of adhesive, if necessary using a spatula to smooth or remove
any extruded adhesive, and to neaten any visual areas. Where necessary, add adhesive to the jointline
to ensure complete weathersealing and neat appearance, and smooth with a spatula.
7.
Clamp the panel into position until the adhesive has cured (see sub-section BU.5).
8.
Refit displaced parts as necessary.
BU.8 - WINDSCREEN FRAME
The windscreen frame is an assembly of ICSRTM mouldings featuring hollow, foam filled sections, and
including a screen bottom landing panel, the two windscreen pillars and the windscreen header rail. The landing panel is bonded to the chassis scuttle, the pillars to the body sides, and the roof panel bonds to the header
rail.
Localised damage to the frame should be repaired in situ using recognised techniques, but it is unlikely
that the complete frame will require replacement without the body sides and/or roof panel also being damaged.
Replacement of the windscreen frame will in any case require that the roof panel be removed, and the front
section of both body sides be released from the chassis.
The elastomeric adhesive bonding the frame to the scuttle and other body panels requires cutting with a
reciprocating knife, if necessary cutting the frame itself to allow improved access to the joint. It is unlikely to
be economic to attempt to remove a windscreen frame for re-fitment.
To replace windscreen frame
1. Remove the front clamshell (see sub-section BV.4) and wiper mechanism.
1.
Remove the front clamshell, windscreen pillar trims, fascia top panel and headlining.
2.
Remove the wiper mechanism and cut out the windscreen (see sub-section BV13).
3.
Remove the roof panel (see sub-section BU.10).
4.
Cut the adhesive securing both body sides to the chassis 'A' posts.
5.
Remove the bracket securing the frame to the pedal box.
6.
Cut the adhesive bond securing the frame to the chassis and to the body side panels, and remove the
frame from the car.
7.
Prepare the old adhesive bead on the chassis and any existing body panels for fitment of the new windscreen frame by removing excess sealant from all the bonding areas to leave a consistent and level bonding
surface for the new frame. It is not necessary to remove all traces of old adhesive, but a uniform surface
must be available for the new adhesive bead. Any remaining adhesive must be securely bonded and be
cut with a scalpal blade to leave an even thickness of 1 - 2 mm.
8.
If necessary, replace the foam sealing blocks between scuttle and frame using Betaseal products to clean,
prime and bond new blocks into position on the chassis.
9.
- Prepare and re-activate the old adhesive bead on the chassis and other components using Betawipe
4000 (see BU.5).
- Clean and prime the bonding area on the new windscreen frame with Betaclean 3900 and Betaprime
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
5404 (see sub-section BU.5).
- Apply a bead of Betaseal 1701 adhesive (see sub-section BU.5) to the whole of the chassis bonding
flange on the windscreen frame, and to the body side panel flanges.
- Spring the body sides apart sufficiently to allow careful positioning of the windscreen frame onto the
chassis and locate with the tie bracket to the pedal box.
- Mate the body sides to the 'A' posts and windscreen frame.
- Press around all bonded joints to ensure adequate adhesive compression. Ensure the windscreen frame
is positioned correctly by measuring from the underside of each top rear end of the frame to the top surface of the chassis siderail. Specification = 744mm. Compare diagonal dimensions to verify squareness.
Support the header rail in this position to prevent drooping until the adhesive cures.
- Ensure complete bonding between the frame and scuttle/foam blocks/other body panels, with no gaps,
if necessary extruding more adhesive into the joint.
- Use a spatula to smooth out or remove any excess adhesive, leaving a neat appearance, especially
where the joint will be visible.
10. Do not disturb the frame until the adhesive has fully cured (see sub-section BU.5).
11. Fit the windscreen (see sub-section BV.13), dash panel (BV.12), front clamshell (BV.4), and other components as necessary.
BU.9 - Body side PANELS
Each body side panel incorporates the complete sill section, lower rear quarter panel ahead of the rear
wheelarch, ‘A’ and ‘B’ posts, door aperture and rear quarter window aperture. The panel is bonded to the chassis, windscreen frame, rear bulkhead panel and roof.
The sill bottom flange is bonded into a groove in the chassis main side rail and it is necessary to cut the
panel to effect its removal: it is not practical to attempt to remove a body side panel intact for later refitment. If
damage occurs to the panel which is not repairable ‘in situ’, the body side panel should be renewed. However,
in view of the extensive amount of labour required to replace a body side, localised repairs or integrated sections should be considered wherever possible.
To replace body side panel
1. Remove front and rear clamshells (see sub-sections BV.4, BV.5), doors (BV.8) and roof panel (BU.10).
2.
Remove electrical equipment fixed to the inside of the body side in the rear quarter area.
3.
Remove the door weatherstrip seal and door latch striker plate.
4.
Use a sealant cutting knife to cut the adhesive bead between body side and chassis, windscreen frame
and rear bulkhead. Also cut the adhesive around the door hinge faces, the striker plate face and the seat
belt mounting frame.
Note:
- The bottom edge of the sill locates in a groove in the chassis side frame, and may not readily be cut out
with the sill intact. Cut the sill as necessary to release the panel, and then remove the remaining edges
of the panel from the chassis using a suitable cutting knife.
5.
Remove excess sealant from all the bonding areas on the chassis and body panels. It is not necessary to
remove all traces of old adhesive, but any remaining adhesive must be securely bonded and be cut with
a scalpal blade to leave an even thickness of 1 - 2 mm.
6.
Dry fit the body side panel and fettle if necessary to achieve a good fit.
7.
Before preparing the surfaces for bonding, ensure that the necessary pipes and cables are fitted to the
chassis side rails and are in good condition:
Page 11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
RH side:
LH side:
- Engine radiator return pipe
- A.C. feed and return pipes
- PAS feed and return pipes
- Right hand rear brake pipe
- Engine radiator feed pipe
- Heater feed and return pipes
- Clutch pipe
- Brake servo vacuum pipe
- Positive battery cable to front post.
Section BU
Check also, by comparison with the displaced part, that the 'B' post reinforcement panel, and all necessary bonded brackets and captive fixings, are correctly attached to the new sill panel.
8.
Prepare the bonding surface of the new body side panel with Betaclean 3900 and Betaprime 5404 (see
subsection BU.5). Prepare surface of the old adhesive bead on the chassis and body panels Using Betawipe 4000 (see sub-section BU.5).
9.
Apply a bead of Betaseal adhesive (see sub-section BU.5) to the bonding surface on the chassis, windscreen
frame and rear bulkhead, and fit the body side panel into position, first locating the sill bottom edge into
its chassis slot. Press all around the joint and ensure sufficient spread of adhesive, if necessary using a
spatula to smooth or remove any extruded adhesive, and to neaten any visual areas. Where necessary,
add adhesive to the jointline to ensure complete weathersealing and neat appearance, especially around
the door hinge post apertures, and smooth with a spatula.
10.
Clamp the panel into position until the adhesive has cured (see sub-section BU.5).
11.
Refit the dash panel, front and rear clamshells, doors, both wheelarch liners and other components as
necessary.
bU.10 - rear bulkhead
The rear bulkhead is a Resin Transfer Moulded (RTM) panel and is bonded to the chassis and seat belt
mounting frame. The roof panel is bonded to its top flange, and the body side panels to each side flange.
A heat formed polyester fibre heat/acoustic insulator panel is bonded to the rear side of the panel. The
cabin rear window is bonded directly to the bulkhead using the same materials and procedure as is used for
the windscreen. A screw fixed panel is provided on the right hand side to allow access from the cabin to the
alternator, compressor and adjacent engine components.
Replacement of the complete bulkhead panel is unlikely to be required without a complete body rebuild.
In the case of localised damage, the panel should be repaired in situ using conventional hand lay techniques,
if necessary integrating a new section cut from a new bulkhead panel. The position of th e rear bulkhead is
critical to the fit of the tailgate and rear body section. If building up a new chassis tub, a jig assembled bulkhead
and rear seat belt mounting frame should be used, as a 3 - 5 mm standoff is required between the panel and
frame.
Rear Window: In order to minimise noise and heat transmission into the cabin, the rear bulkhead window is a
double glazed unit comprising two 4mm, toughened, clear, flat glass panes, separated by a 6mm void filled with
Argon gas. An obscuration band is applied to the rear face of both panes, with identification data read from
the engine bay side. The unit is bonded to the front face of the rear bulkhead panel using materials supplied
by Dow Chemical.
To replace the glass, remove the rear bulkhead trim and use a reciprocating knife to cut the bonding
medium. Clean the whole of the bonding surface on the new glass with Betawipe VP 04604 (yellow cap), and
prime with Betaprime 5500 (green cap). Clean the corresponding surface on the bulkhead with Betaclean 3900
(black cap) and prime with Betaprime 5404 (red cap). Apply a bead of Betaseal 1701 to the periphery of the
glass, and press into position on the bulkhead to ensure sufficient and uniform compression of the adhesive.
Use a spatula to remove excess extruded adhesive and smooth any visual areas. Support the glass in place
as necessary until the adhesive has cured suffiently.
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BU
Bonding of rear bulkhead: The rear bulkhead panel is positioned by reference to the rear seat belt mounting
frame, and should be fitted only as a jig built assembly of bulkhead and frame.
Clean the mating surface on the bulkhead with Betaclean 3900 (black cap) and prime with Betaprime 5404
(red cap) or, where applicable, use Betawipe 4000 to re-activate old adhesive (refer to sub-section BU.5). Clean
the mating surface on the chassis with Betawipe VP 04604 (yellow cap), and prime with Betaprime 5404 (red
cap), or with Betawipe 4000 to re-activate old adhesive. Apply a bead of Betaseal 1701 to the bonding path on
the chassis, and fit the bulkhead/frame assembly into position by securing the frame with its four bolts to the
extruded brackets which form part of the chassis tub. If necessary, apply additional adhesive into the joint and
use a spatula to remove any excess extruded adhesive and to smooth any visual areas.
The rear bracing struts should then be shimmed as necessary to avoid corrupting this position. The stays
connecting to the front seat belt mounting frame should then be similarly shimmed.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
BODY FITTINGS
SECTION BV
Sub-Section Page
General Overview
-
2
Reservoir Access Hatch
BV.1
3
Tailgate
BV.2
3
'A' Panels
BV.3
4
Front Clamshell
BV.4
5
Front Bumper
BV.5
5
Rear Clamshell
BV.6
6
Rear Bumper
BV.7
8
Door Mirrors
BV.8
9
Door Shell, Beam & Hinges
BV.9
10
Door Weatherstrip Seals
BV.10
11
Door Window, Guide Rails & Lift Mechanism
BV.11
12
Door Latch Mechanism
BV.12
14
Windscreen Removal/Replacement
BV.13
15
Tailgate Glass
BV.14
17
Cabin Rear Window
BV.15
18
Rear Quarter Light Window
BV.16
18
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Front clamshell
Windscreen frame
Roof panel
Rear bulkhead
Ventilation panel
Tailgate
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
'A' panel
Body side panel
Rear clamshell
Main chassis tub
GENERAL OVERVIEW Seat belt mounting frame
Rear subframe
Rear bumper
b357
Lotus Service Notes
Front subframe
Door
Front bumper
Reservoir access hatch Rear
spoiler
Section BV
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
BV.1 - RESERVOIR ACCESS HATCH
The Lotus Evora is fitted with a front hinged,
composite, access hatch in the front body to
provide ready access to the brake/clutch master cylinder reservoir and windscreen washer
reservoir filler neck. Incoming air to the interior
climate pollen filter is also routed through this
area from the high pressure zone at the base of
the windscreen.
To open the hatch, from the inboard side of
either footwell, press down the release lever; the
hatch may then be raised fully by hand.
Before closing, check that the reservoir caps
are secure, lower the lid, and press firmly over
the latch.
To open
HATCH RELEASE LEVER
ohe20
Access panel adjustment
The hinge stator is secured by two M6 nuts to a captive studplate on the clamshell, with sufficient hole
tolerance to allow some adjustment of panel height. Similarly, the hinge rotor is secured by 2 M6 nuts to a
studplate in the cover, with allowance made for adjustment of shutlines.
BV.2 - Tailgate
The composite tailgate panel is hinged at its leading edge to the rear bulkhead, and uses a single latch
mounted centrally at its rear end. The latch is released by an electric solenoid activated by the transmitter key
fob, but note that unlatching is inhibited with the ignition switched on. An emergency release is provided in the
form of a mechanical cable from a handle concealed beneath the rear seat cushion (or carpet). Opening of the
tailgate is assisted by a pair of gas pressurised struts. The tailgate incorporates a heated window glass, and,
to the rear of the glass, an outlet grille for hot air from around the rearmost catalytic converter.
The extruded alloy hinge arms are bolted to the tailgate with two M8 screws and reach beneath the ventilation panel to the cabin rear bulkhead, to which the hinge stators are secured with two M8 screws. The steel
hinge pin is an interference fit into the stator, and supports two top hat synthetic bushes pressed into the bore
of the hinge rotor, with an 'E' clip used for retention. Oversize hinge fixing holes allow for the adjustment of
tailgate panel shutlines.
Pivot ball pins for the twin gas struts are screwed into captive nuts in the tailgate inner panel, with the lower
end of each strut anchored to a steel bracket secured to the clamshell aperture. A spring steel clip secures
each strut pivot socket onto its ball pin.
The latch mechanism is secured to the tailgate, and the striker hoop to the clamshell, with a security
system sensing switch incorporated into the latch. The latch release solenoid is mounted to the right of the
striker, and uses a short link to pull a bellcrank lever pivoted on the striker, and interacting with a release lever
on the latch mechanism. The manual release cable activates the same bellcrank lever, and is routed over the
RH wheelarch and through the cabin bulkhead. An adjustable height downstop buffer is provided at each rear
corner of the tailgate for panel height alignment and stability.
The rear aerofoil is secured to the tailgate with 2 x M6 button head screws at each side, and houses the
CHMSL, which comprises 12 red LEDs behind a white diffuser. The CHMSL wiring combined with the latch
sensing switch and HRS wiring, form a tailgate harness which exits the tailgate inner skin near the RH hinge,
to which it is clipped before penetrating the cabin bulkhead.
The heated, toughened glass screen with pre-applied obscuration band, is bonded to the tailgate with an
elastomeric adhesive (see sub-section BV.14).
Tailgate remove/refit
To remove the tailgate:
1. Disconnect the tailgate harness at the RH hinge area.
2.
Release the spring clip securing each gas strut to the tailgate and disengage the struts.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
3.
Scribe around the hinge blade on the tailgate to aid refit alignment (if applicable) before supporting the
tailgate and removing the hinge blade fixing bolts.
4.
Refit in reverse order to removal, adjusting panel shutlines and height as necessary. Check latch engagement and release, and adjust striker position if necessary.
BV.3 - 'a' PANELS
Each 'A' panel constitutes the body surface below the waistline between the front wheelarch and the door
aperture, with each panel screw fixed to the front clamshell and body sill.
'A' panel removal/replacement
1. Slacken or remove the front wheelarch liner and release the two screws securing the 'A' panel to the rear
lower flange of the front clamshell.
2.
Slacken or remove the two screws securing the bottom edge of the panel to the body sill and withdraw
the panel.
3.
Replace in reverse order to removal.
Clamshell to wiper bracket
Front clamshell
Fixing beneath
nose badge
Clamshell to
mounting
rail
Chassis mounted bracket
Single fixing to clamshell
Clamshell to bumper
Two fixings to clamshell
'A' panel
b358
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
'A' panel to sill
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
bV.4 - front clamshell
The front clamshell comprises a composite moulding forming the front upper bodywork between the base
of the windscreen and the front bumper. Incorporated into the panel are apertures for the radiator air outlet
grilles, and a recess for the hydraulic fluid and windscreen washer reservoirs. The panel is secured by threaded
fasteners for ease of access to the HVAC and engine cooling radiator, and to allow economical panel repair or
replacement. The panel is secured to the front subframe via mounting brackets, and to the front bumper and
'A' panels, with provision being made for height and shutline adjustment.
Front clamshell removal/replacement
The clamshell with front access panel may be removed whilst leaving the front bumper in position:
1.
Remove both front wheels and wheelarch liners.
2.
Open the reservoir access hatch, remove the three screws securing the latch, and disconnect the release
cable. Feed the cable through the clamshell grommet. Release the two fixings securing the hydraulic
fluid reservoir to the clamshell, and the two screws securing the washer reservoir filler neck. Release the
washer tube and harness connector from the washer jet.
3.
From within each wheelarch, disconnect the headlamp harness and headlamp washer tubing. Release
the two fixings securing the headlamp front mounting bracket to the subframe, and the two fixings securing
the headlamp rear bracket to the bumper support bracket. Withdraw the headlamp.
4.
From within the front of each wheelarch, release the three fixings securing the clamshell to the top edge
of the bumper.
5.
From within the back of each wheelarch, release the two fixings securing the clamshell to the top of the
'A' panel, and the single screw to the chassis bracket. Disconnect the side repeater lamp.
6.
From the headlamp apertures, release the two nuts at each side, securing the front edge of the clamshell
to the mounting rail.
7.
Prise out the nose badge taking suitable precautions to avoid paint damage. From the access hole revealed, remove the single fixing securing the clam to the mounting rail.
8.
Carefully lift the clamshell from the car and place on a protected surface.
9.
Refit in reverse order to removal, noting that all fixing points incorporate provision for adjustment of panel
height and alignment via slotted holes or shim washers. The height of the clamshell front fixing rail is
adjustable against the subframe at the three slotted fixing points on the rear face, accessible via the headlamp apertures. Clamshell adjustments must be completed before the headlamps are fitted and adjusted
to seal correctly against the clamshell apertures.
10. Check headlamp beam alignment.
BV.5 - front bumper
The front bumper may be removed with the clamshell in place, but the headlamps must be removed to
provide access to the upper fixings.
1.
Remove both front wheels and wheelarch liners. At each side, disconnect the headlamp harness and
headlamp washer tubing. Release the two fixings securing the headlamp front mounting bracket to the
subframe, and the two fixings securing the headlamp rear bracket to the bumper support bracket. Withdraw the headlamp.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
Front bumper
Adjustable support rail
Bumper/headlamp
support bracket
Diffuser spat
b359
2.
From each headlamp aperture, release the three fixings clamping the bumper top flange to the clamshell
and to the support bracket.
3.
From each headlamp aperture, slacken the two nuts securing the front edge of the clamshell and bumper
top flange to the support rail. Prise out the nose badge taking suitable precautions to protect the surrounding paintwork, and slacken the single nut securing the centre of the clamshell and bumper.
4.
From beneath the car, release the fixings securing the front undertray to the lower edge of the bumper,
and the two screws securing each lower rear corner of the bumper to the support bracket.
5.
Withdraw the bumper.
6.
Ensure the bumper foam is fitted to the subframe before replacing the bumper in reverse order to removal,
inserting the top flange between the clamshell and support rail.
BV.6 - rear clamshell
The rear clamshell comprises the principal body moulding aft of the doors and includes the integral boot
box. The separate rear bumper panel is screw fixed to the rear face of the clamshell. The front of the clamshell
is secured to the body side mouldings and the back edge of the roof panel, with the back end supported via
the boot floor to the rear subframe. The tailgate hinges reach beneath the top edge of the clamshell to fix onto
the rear bulkhead, such that the tailgate needs to be removed before the clamshell may be released. The rear
bumper may remain fitted to the clamshell. Two people are required to lift the clamshell from the vehicle, and
sufficient space provided to store the panel without paint damage.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
Boot floor to subframe
Clam to roof rear flange
Acess from interior
Clam to body side
b358
Rear clamshell removal/replacement
1. Tailgate: Remove the tailgate (see BV.2), both rear wheels, and wheelarch liners.
2.
Ventilation panel: The engine bay outlet ventilation panel around the top edge of the tailgate aperture
needs to be removed to provide access the clamshell to roof fixings.
- From beneath the clamshell aperture, release the 2 fixings securing the vent panel to the roof rear flange,
and one at each side fixing to the body side panel.
- Draw the panel rearwards and lift to release from the keyhole slot at each front corner.
3.
From the access provided by op. 2, remove the two nuts securing the clam to the roof rear flange, and the
single nut to each body side panel.
4.
Battery: Remove the battery cover, battery and tray, and feed the two battery cables out through the clamshell grommets.
5.
Boot box: From inside the boot, release the 8 fixings securing the boot floor to the subframe, and the 4
fixings in the boot front wall securing the heatshield. Release the single screw securing the header tank
bracket to the boot wall.
6.
Wheelarch: From within the front of each rear wheelarch, release the fixing securing the clamshell to the
body side top flange. Reach further forward with an M10 socket and short ratchet handle to release the
similar fixing at the front of this flange.
7.
Remove the fuel cap and pull the grommet over the filler neck. Re-seal the neck. Unplug the flap release
solenoid connection.
8.
At the back of each wheelarch, release the two fixings securing the clamshell to the subframe bracket,
and the 2 fixings to the diffuser panel.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
9.
Section BV
At each side, release the front seat belt upper anchorage from the 'B' post, and pull off the 'B' post top
trim. Pull the weatherstrip seal off the body vertical flange at the rear of the door aperture. Pull the rear
quarter trim panel away at its top edge to release the two spring fasteners beneath the quarter window.
This should allow sufficient access to the single M8 headed screw securing the topshell to the body side
just below the front end of the rear quarter window.
10. Unplug the rear harness at the RH side of the boot and feed the harness through the panel. Unplug the
cable to the reversing camera and withdraw the cable through the clamshell. At the left hand side of the
boot, disconnect the parking sensor module and tyre pressure monitoring harnesses and feed through
the clamshell.
11. Carefully lift the clamshell from the body and lay aside on a protected surface. Note and retain any shim
washers or plates used at each fixing point.
12. Refit the clamshell in reverse order to removal, taking appropriate precautions to protect surfaces from
damage during the installation process. Refit any shim washers or plates noted on disassembly. Assess
shutlines and panel heights as early as possible and amend shim stacks as necessary.
BV.7 - rear bumper
The rear bumper moulding is screw fixed to the rear face of the rear clamshell, and covers the impact foam
secured to the rear subframe. It also incorporates the rear transom panel, houses the licence plate lamps and
rear fog and reverse lamps, and mounts the diffuser finisher.
Rear bumper moulding
Single screw outboard
of tail lamp
Nuts in tailgate aperture
Accessed via grommet
hole in boot
Support bracket
to subframe
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
b359
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
To remove/refit rear bumper
1. From inside the boot, remove the trim panel from around the latch mechanism, and disconnect the harnesses to the rear fog and reverse lamps, parking sensors and reverse camera.
2.
From within each rear wheelarch, release the single fixing securing the lower edge of the bumper to the
subframe bracket, and the two fixings at each side securing the diffuser finisher to the diffuser. Also release
the single fixing securing the top edge of the bumper to the clamshell flange.
3.
From within each side of the boot, remove the two grommets, and release the two fixings securing the
bumper top edge to the clamshell. Also remove the single screw just outboard of the tail lamp.
4.
Remove the 5 fixings along the rear edge of the boot aperture, clamping the bumper to the clamshell.
5.
Carefully withdraw the bumper from the clamshell.
6.
Refit the bumper in reverse order to removal, adjusting the panel heights and gaps as necessary.
BV.8 - DOOR MIRRORS
The two door mirrors are electrically adjustable, and, only when the engine is running, are heated on demand in conjunction with the HRS for a maximum period of 10 minutes. An optional specification includes an
electric fold facility for use when parking or negotiating narrow gaps.
Each mirror comprises a cast alloy bracket carrying a black textured plastic housing, and a gimbal mounted
glass carrier driven by a pair of electric motors, and to which is attached the mirror glass. A third motor provides
the fold function. A sprung attachment of the mirror housing to the plinth allows the mirror to move forwards
or backwards on accidental contact, in order to reduce the potential for personal injury or vehicle damage. A
body colour painted moulding is clipped to the front of the mirror housing.
This mirror assembly is mounted via a cast alloy plinth to the door cheater panel, with upper and lower
black plastic mouldings used for cosmetic enhancement.
Mirror cover Mirror body
Plinth upper
moulding
Harness connector
Cast alloy
plinth
Plinth lower
moulding
b360
Replacement of mirror glass and cover
The mirror glass is contained in a plastic carrier which includes the heating element and terminals. To
remove the glass, press the glass so as to expose the outer edge, and carefully ease the outboard end from
its carrier clip. Then unhook the inboard end, unplug the two heater cables, and remove the glass. Check that
the adjustment racks have not become detached from the gimble during disassembly.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
To refit, connect the cables (either way round), hook on the inboard end of the glass carrier, and press the
outboard end until the clip is engaged.
Note that convex glass is normally fitted to both sides in order to provide the widest field of vision, but
certain markets use flat glass on one or both sides. Be aware that objects viewed in convex mirrors appear
more distant than when viewed with flat glass.
The painted cover is secured to the mirror body by integrally moulded clips. To remove a cover, first remove
the glass to allow the lower clips to be eased, whilst the lower edge of the cover is carefully prised away.
Replacement of mirror assembly
To remove the complete mirror, the assembly of mirror, plinth and covers must be released from the
door:
1. Remove the door trim panel (see sub-section VE.2).
2. Unplug the mirror harness connector, remove the split grommet and back feed the harness into the door
shell. Use the harness hole to access and remove the mirror plinth lower fixing screw.
3.
Remove the Rokut plastic rivets securing the plinth upper finisher and cheater panel seal to the door. Pull
back the cheater seal to access and remove the plinth upper fixing screw.
4.
Withdraw the mirror assembly whilst feeding the harness through the door shell.
5.
Remove the plinth lower cover by releasing the two retaining screws.
6.
To allow the mirror to be removed from the plinth, the connector block must first be removed. Record the
cable colour against connector cavity before using a suitable terminal extractor tool to depress the retaining barb, and withdraw each terminal from the connector. Remove the three screws around the pivot
mechanism and withdraw the mirror from the plinth.
Note that the plinth upper finisher is heat bonded to the plinth. If necessary, new parts can be mated using
a soldering iron or similar to secure.
7.
New mirror assemblies may be supplied with an unsuitable connector block. Use an appropriate terminal
extractor tool to withdraw each cable from the connector, which may then be discarded. Feed the harness
through the mirror plinth before inserting the terminals into the replacement or original connector block in
the following manner.
Connector cavity
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
8.
Cable colour Function
Not used Not used
Brown Up/down
Orange Mirror common
Pink Left/right
Red Fold in
Blue Fold out
Black Mirror heater
Black Mirror heater ground
Continue re-assembly in reverse order to removal.
BV.9 - DOOR SHELL, BEAM & HINGES
The door comprises an inner and outer composite moulding, bonded together around the periphery, and
enclosing a hollow section, extruded alloy, door beam with internal siffening webs, to provide side intrusion protection. A fabricated steel hinge post is bonded to the inside of the door shell front face, and provides a 2-bolt
mounting for the front end of the door beam. Similarly, another fabricated steel bracket is bonded to the inside
of the door shell rear face, and provides a 2-bolt mounting for the rear end of the door beam. The components
so far described, are available only as a jig-built, door shell assembly.
Each door uses two identical hinges, each comprising two steel forgings, one with a single eye for bolting
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
to the door shell, and one with a double eye for bolting to the chassis hinge post, the oversize holes providing
sufficient positional tolerance for door shutline adjustments to be made. Synthetic bushes and a steel tube
provide the maintenance free pivot mechanism, with the two hinge halves being mated by a pivot bolt to allow
door removal without losing the alignment settings. The hinges also feature open limiting stops, although this
function is subsumed to the check strap.
A check strap is fitted to limit door opening and also to provide a mid-point detent position for convenience
in restricted space. The check strap unit is secured to the inside front face of the door shell with two screws, and
uses spring loaded Nylon jaws to embrace a profiled steel link fixed by a single bolt to the chassis 'A' post.
To remove/refit door assembly
The complete door assembly may be removed from the car by the following procedure:
1. Remove the door hinge post trim panel and unplug the door harness connector. Feed the connector
through the hinge post aperture.
2.
Release the check strap from the 'A' post.
3.
To preserve the shutline settings, support the door, remove the pivot bolt from each of the two hinges, and
lift the door off the hinge pivot tubes.
4.
Refit in reverse order to removal. If shutline adjustment is required, slacken the bolts securing the hinges
to the door and 'A' post, move the door as required, and re-tighten.
Check strap
The check strap is secured from inside the door shell by two M6 screws. To remove the strap, remove the
door trim panel and membrane, fully raise the window, and release the two screws securing the check strap
assembly. Remove the single fixing securing the strap to the 'A' post, and withdraw the strap.
bv.10 - door weatherstrip seals
Drop glass waist seal
The door drop glass uses flocked EPDM wipe seals on the inner and outer top edges of the door shell to
minimise water ingress into the door. Each main length of seal is bonded to an aluminium 'U' section barbed
carrier, which is pressed on to the appropriate door top flange. These two seals are linked around the back
of the door shell glass slot, by an integrated moulded capping section secured to the door by two push button
fixings. The seal should be removed from the door before attempting to remove the door glass or guide rails.
To remove the seal, lower the door glass fully. Press in the centre pin of the two button fixings to allow
them to be withdrawn, and carefully pull the two seals from the door shell flanges.
Door cheater seal
The extension to the top front of the door moulding, designed to provide increased support to the door
glass, and also to mount the door mirror, is referred to as the door 'cheater' panel. A moulded rubber seal is
fitted around the cheater and secured by Rokut rivets and adhesive strips.
Door weatherstrip
Each door weatherstrip seal comprises several extruded rubber sections and a right angle corner moulding, all bonded together to form a single service unit. The top, front and rear sections of the seal incorporate
a gripper channel which is pressed onto the body flange. The bottom section is bonded to the sill via a self
adhesive strip pre-applied to the seal. Before fitting the seal, thoroughly clean the bonding area on the sill using Betaclean 3900 (A100B6008V).
Start fitting the seal from the top rear corner, and ensure that the whole length of the 'U' section is pressed
fully on to the body flange. Remove the backing tape and position the lower section against the sill. Use a
roller wheel to ensure full adhesion.
Secondary door seal
In order to minimise wind noise transmitted into the cabin, a secondary seal is fitted along the cant rail and
down the 'A' post. This self adhesive, hollow section rubber extrusion, should be contacted by the door glass
in its fully raised position (see BV.11).
Page 11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
bv.11 - door window, guide rails & lift mechanism
WARNING: To ease door closure, and optimise the sealing of the frameless door glass against the
weatherstrips, the control mechanism will automatically drop a fully closed window a small distance
when the door is opened (preparatory to closing), and raise it again after the door is shut. This function may be triggered, with ignition on or off, by door latching signals. Whenever working on or near
the window mechanism, disconnect the window motor to prevent injury from unexpected operation.
Each door uses a single, 4mm thick, green tinted, tempered glass, curved door window, with a frameless
configuration, and an electrically operated lift mechanism. The glass is guided by a pair of curved steel 'L' section channels, to which it is constrained by two pairs of point contact Nylon guide blocks bonded to the front and
rear edges of the glass. The lower end of each of the guide rails is adjustable in/out via a screw mechanism,
to enable the correct weatherstrip seal loading to be achieved, whilst the glass upward travel is limited by an
adjustable stop on the lift mechanism.
The lift mechanism uses a top hat section steel lift channel, curved to match the window guide rails, and
attached to the door shell. An alloy carriage plate, clamped to the bottom of the glass, uses a plastic shoe to
slide along one edge of the lift channel. A multistrand steel cable is attached to the carriage plate and is routed
around a pulley at the top and bottom of the lift channel and then around a drum driven by an electric motor.
The assembly thus described is secured at 3 points to the door shell.
A micro-switch mounted on the lift mechanism closes when the glass is fully raised, and triggers the window
automatic drop function when the door is opened.
Viewed From Outboard
Glass
Guide rail
Upstop adjuster
Plastic shoe
Guide rail
upper fixing
Glass clamp
Carriage plate
Cable winder
drum
b361
Window lift Lift channel
motor assembly
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Guide rail
adjuster
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
Door glass adjustment
To provide optimum weather sealing, several adjustments are available to position the glass correctly, with
sufficient weatherstrip seal loading.
Glass top edge alignment: When fully raised, the glass top edge needs to be aligned to the roof and cant rail
seal. If adjustment is required, the door trim panel and membrane must first be removed for access (see subsection VE.2). The glass is secured to the carriage plate by two rubber lined clamps; release the two clamp
nuts, re-position the glass as necessary and re-tighten.
Glass height adjustment: An adjustable upstop buffer screw is mouted on the carriage plate, which abuts against
a flange at the top of the window lift channel to limit upward travel of the glass. Complete but light contact
between the fully raised glass and cant rail seal is required.
Glass inward tilt: The inward tilt of the glass may be adjusted by screw theaded anchorages for the bottom
ends of the two guide rails. These are accessible with the trim panel fitted. Light contact with the weatherstrip
seals is required.
Door glass removal
1. Remove the door trim panel and membrane (see sub-section VE.2).
2.
Remove the door glass waist seal (see sub-section BV.10).
3.
Release the two clamps securing the glass to the lift channel, and slide the glass out of the door.
4.
New door glasses are supplied with the slider blocks pre-fitted. If a slider block should become detached,
the old adhesive should be cleaned off, the bonding surfaces cleaned with Betaclean 3900 (A100B6008V),
and the following products used to rebond the slider block using the adhesive manufacturer's instructions:
Permabond Initiator INI 5 A000Z0043F
Permabond Flexon F246 B089B6125V
Guide rail removal
1. Remove the door glass (see above).
2.
Release the single screw securing the top of the rail to the bonded bracket or mirror mounting bracket,
noting any shim washers fitted.
3.
Release the 2 screws securing the bottom end of the rail to the adjuster screw block, and withdraw the
rail from the door.
Window lift mechanism
The lift mechanism is available only as a complete assembly and is secured to the door shell by three
fixings. The mechanism may be removed whilst leaving the glass and guide channels in place, but access will
be improved if the glass can be fully raised.
1. Release the two clamps securing the glass to the carriage plate.
2.
Disconnect the harness from the lift motor and micro switch.
3.
Release the three retaining screws and withdraw the lift mechanism from the door.
4.
When re-fitting, adjust the glass height and alignment as detailed above.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
BV.12 - door latch mechanism
The door latch mechanism is fitted inside the rear face of the door, which is reinforced by a steel plate
bonded to the composite door shell, and which is also used to secure the rear end of the door beam. The
latch engages with a striker hoop which is secured to a bracket integral with the seat belt mounting frame. The
external key lock (fitted only on the LH door) is connected to the latch mechanism by control rod, as are the
door sill buttons, and exterior release handles. The interior release handle is connected via a control cable.
The latch contains a microswitch to detect when the door is closed, and which is used to operate the courtesy
lamp, alarm system, door glass drop functions, and others. The electrical locking actuator is mounted on a
bracket integral with the latch mechanism with which it interacts via a rotary link.
A plastic security shield is fitted around the latch mechanism to inhibit illicit interference with the locking
system.
Normal operation of the locking functions is performed electronically via the transmitter fob (see Section
MR), but if necessary, the doors can be locked mechanically. The LH door can be locked by using the key in
the exterior lock barrel. Both doors can also be locked individually by lifting the exterior release handle (with
door open), pressing down the door sill button, and keeping the handle lifted, shutting the door. This action will
also disable the interior release handle. Once locked in this way, the RH door can be unlocked only by using
the transmitter fob or by raising the door sill button after opening the LH door via the mechanical key.
WARNING: The window control mechanism includes an automatic window drop and raise logic to aid
door closing and weathersealing. This function may be triggered, with ignition on or off, by door latching signals. Whenever working on or near the window mechanism, disconnect the window motor to
prevent injury from unintended operation.
Sill button
Security shield
Exterior handle
LH lock barrel
Interior release
handle
Latch mechanism
Striker
Interior hoop
release
cable
b362
CDL motor
Tapping plate
Page 14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
Exterior release handle
The exterior release handle is secured to the door shell by two studs. To remove the handle, remove the
door trim panel and membrane (see section VE.2), fully raise the window, and unclip the control rod from the
handle. Release the two retaining nuts, and withdraw the handle.
LH door exterior lock
An exterior key lock is provided only on the LH door. To remove the lock assembly, remove the door
trim panel and membrane (see section VE.2), fully raise the window, and unclip the control rod from the latch
mechanism. Release the three nuts securing the lock mounting plate to the door, and withdraw the plate and
lock assembly. A spring clip secures the lock to the mounting plate.
Latch mechanism
To remove the latch mechanism:
1. Remove the door trim panel and membrane (see section VE.2).
2.
Fully raise the window and unclip the exterior lock rod from the latch (LH door only).
3. Unlip the control rod from the exterior release handle.
4. Unclip the interior handle release cable from the latch.
5. Unplug the door harness from the latch actuator, and the microswitch.
6.
Release the three screws from the door shut face securing the latch mechanism, and withdraw the unit
together with the sill button control rod from the door.
7.
On re-assembly, remember to fit the sill button control rod to the latch mechanism before installing the
mechanism into the door.
bv.13 - windscreen removal/replacement
The Evora windscreen is constructed from two layers of glass, the inside component of which is green
tinted, sandwiching a synthetic solar reflecting interlay, to form a 5mm thick laminate. A black ceramic obscuration band with graduated fade out, is applied to the inner surface periphery. The windscreen is bonded to the
composite body frame using an elastomeric polyurethane adhesive, and contributes to the structural integrity
of the body assembly. The screen uses rubber extrusions along the top and bottom edges for visual enhancement, and black finished alloy finishers over each 'A' pillar. Screen replacement will require new top and bottom
filler strips, but the side finishers may be salvaged if carefully removed.
Parts required:
Windscreen.
Betaseal Kit A075B6158F.
Plinth, interior mirror mounting (supplied with new windscreen).
Plinth Adhesive Kit A116U0194F.
Top and bottom filler strips.
1.
Pull the door weatherstrip off the windscreen frame flange along both 'A' pillars. Remove the 'A' pillar
finisher fixing nuts; one at the lower end beneath the corner of the clamshell; three along the 'A' pillar shut
face. Use a knife blade or similar between the glass and the finisher to gently ease the finisher away from
the double sided tape fixing. Withdraw the finisher with the secondary door seal still attached and secure
aside with tape.
2.
If a cutting wire is to be used to release the windscreen bonding, it may not be necessary to disturb the
front clamshell. If a vibrating knife is to be used, it is likely that the rearmost fixings for the clamshell will
need to be removed to allow tool access to the bottom corners of the screen.
Page 15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
3.
Slide the interior mirror stem from the windscreen plinth. Remove the sun visor retaining screws to allow
the front of the head lining to drop. Pull each 'A' pillar trim panel out from its three captive 'fir tree' fasteners
(a fourth fir tree button at its lower end is inaccessible), to protect from adhesive cutting tool damage.
4.
Remove the windscreen wiper arm and attach suction handles to the glass. Using a cutting wire or dedicated vibrating knife of suitable form, cut the adhesive bead around the entire periphery of the screen,
taking precautions as necessary to prevent paint or body damage. Note that the top and bottom rubber
finisher strips are likely to be cut through during this operation and will require replacement. With assistance, lift the glass from the car.
5.
Remove old adhesive from the windscreen frame sufficiently to leave a consistent and flat surface for the
new bonding medium.
6.
Clean the whole of the windscreen periphery bonding surface, including the mirror plinth area with the
wipe cleaner supplied in the Betaseal Kit, or with Betaclean 3900 (A100B6008V). Allow to dry.
7.
Prime the bonding surface of the new mirror plinth and the corresponding glass area with Dymax 500E
activator A111B6187. Use Dymax 840 adhesive to bond the plinth to the glass following the supplier's
directions. Position the plinth centrally and with the bottom, closed end, 7mm from the bottom edge of
the obscuration patch.
8.
Prime the bonding area on the glass to a width of 25mm with Betaprime 5500 (green cap) A120B6041V,
avoiding the VIN window. Allow the primer fully to dry.
9.
Fit the new self adhesive filler strip A132U0266F to the inside top edge of the glass, and the longer strip
A132U0402F to the bottom edge.
10. Prime and re-activate the prepared surface of the old adhesive on the windscreen frame with Betawipe
4000 (A082B6355V). If the windscreen frame surface is new or without adhesive, prime the frame with
Betaprime 5404 (red cap) A082B6337V. Allow a minimum of 5 minutes for the primer to dry. If the screen
is not fitted within 48 hours, the primer should be re-applied.
11. Around the windscreen landing path, check the joints between windscreen frame and screen lower landing, and between the roof and body side 'A' pillars, for correct sealing and joint path integrity. If necessary,
prepare these gullies for bonding as described above, and fill with adhesive sealant prior to windscreen
fitment.
8 mm
12. Cut the nozzle of the adhesive cartridge to
the dimensions shown to produce a triangular
section bead. Holding the cartridge perpendicular to the glass, extrude a bead of Betaseal 1701 adhesive (A082B6281F) around
the screen using the inner edge of the top and
bottom filler strips as a guide, and following
the centre of the primer band along each side.
12 mm
60 mm
Page 16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
b264
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
13. Insert three 6mm spacer blocks A132U0346F into the inside edge of each 'A' pillar bead.
14. Apply suction handles to the glass, and with assistance, carefully fit the glass onto the frame, taking care
to position it centrally (compare dimensions at each side between glass and body edges) and with the
upper filler strip in uniform contact with the roof edge. Press down on the glass around the periphery to
compress the joint onto the spacer blocks and then secure in position using duct tape or other methods
to support the screen until the adhesive has cured. This will take around 4 hours, with a longer period
required in dry atmospheric conditions.
15. Before curing, examine the whole length of the joint for integrity, and if necessary, extrude additional adhesive locally into the joint to ensure complete sealing. Use a spatula or similar tool if required to force
the adhesive into the appropriate area. Use a spatula or whetted gloved finger to smooth out or remove
any excess extrunded material to leave a neat appearance. Alternatively, cut away after curing using a
scalpel knife.
16. Check the fitted condition of the lower rubber finisher, and if necessary, adjust the height of the windscreen
bottom gutter to align correctly with the screen bottom edge.
17. After adhesive cure, continue re-assembly in reverse order to disassembly, applying fresh double sided
tape to the 'A' pillar finishers.
Spillage of material
a)
Any spillage of Betaseal onto unprimed glass can be readily peeled off after it has cured.
b)
Any spillage onto the bldy can be removed with either Wipe Cleaner No.4, or white spirit.
Shelf life
a)
Betaseal primer has a useful life of about 24 hrs. after exposure to the air, after which it starts to become
spongy. If the material is spongy, DO NOT USE. Always use glass primer immediately on opening, and
replace the lid after use.
b)
Betaseal has a shelf life of over 6 months at ambient temperature in the original unopened package.
BV.14 - TAILGATE GLASS
The grey tinted, 5mm thick, tempered glass screen, incorporates an electrical heating element and is bonded
to the composite tailgate panel using Betaseal flexible polyurethane adhesive. A black ceramic obscuration
band with graduated fade out, is applied to the inner surface periphery.
To Replace Tailgate Glass
Parts required:
Tailgate Glass.
Screen adhesive cutting equipment.
Betaseal Kit A075B6158F.
1.
Apply suction handles to the outside surface of the glass, and disconnect the two HRS cables from the
inside.
2. Using a dedicated vibrating cutting knife of suitable form, cut the adhesive bead around the entire periphery
of the screen, taking precautions as necessary to prevent damage to paintwork or body flange.
3.
After cutting out the glass, remove old adhesive from the tailgate aperture sufficiently to leave a consistent
and flat surface for the new bonding medium.
4.
Clean the whole of the bonding surface on the new glass, and the bonding surface on the tailgate aperture,
with the wipe cleaner supplied in the Betaseal Kit (or Betaclean 3900 A100B6008V).
5.
Prime the bonding area on the glass to a width of 25mm with the primer in the kit, or with Betaprime 5500
Page 17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
(green cap) A120B6041V.
6.
Prime and re-activate the prepared surface of the old adhesive on the tailgate with Betawipe 4000
(A082B6355V). If the tailgate bonding surface is new or without adhesive, prime the tailgate with Betaprime
5404 (red cap) A082B6337V.
7.
Allow a minimum of 5 minutes for the primer to dry. If the glass is not fitted within 48 hours, the primer
should be re-applied.
8.
Cut the nozzle of the Betaseal cartridge as shown in sub-section BV.13, and holding the cartridge vertically, extrude a bead of adhesive around the glass periphery using a finger against the glass edge as a
guide. Manipulate the two ends of the bead together for a consistent joint.
9.
Cut six 4mm spacer blocks from the material supplied in the Betaseal kit (or use 6 off A124U0069F), and
position in the inside edge of the adhesive bead, two along the top bead, two along the bottom, and one
centrally in each side bead. These spacers are used to control the fitted height of the glass.
10. Using suction handles, carefully lower the glass onto the tailgate, and position centrally in its aperture.
Press around the periphery of the glass to compress the adhesive until contact with the spacer blocks is
felt. Carefully examine the integrity of the whole length of the joint, if necessary using a spatula to force
extra adhesive into any depleted areas. Wipe off any excess adhesive extruded from the joint, or alternatively, allow the adhesive fully to cure and cut away any excess using a scalpel blade.
11.
Position the tailgate horizontally and use duct tape to hold the glass in position until the Betaseal is fully
cured. This will take approximately 4 hours dependent on atmospheric conditions, with a longer period
required in dry atmospheres. Reconnect the HRS cables.
Refer to sub-section BV.13 for spillage of material and shelf life advice.
BV.15 - CABIN REAR Window
The cabin rear window is a double glazed unit to enhance insulation from engine bay heat and noise, and
consists of two clear, 4mm thick, tempered glass panes, bonded around the periphery to a 6mm thick synthetic
spacer, with the sealed space filled with argon gas. A black ceramic obscuration band with graduated fade
out, is applied to the forward face of each glass pane. The window is bonded to the cabin rear bulkhead using
Betaseal flexible polyurethane adhesive.
BV.16 - rear quarter Light window
Each rear quarter light window comprises a green tinted, 4mm thick, tempered glass pane, bonded to the
body side panel with Betaseal flexible polyurethane adhesive. A black ceramic obscuration band with graduated fade out, is applied to the inside periphery of the glass, and an extruded rubber finisher is bonded along
the top edge. It is unlikely that the top finisher will be re-usable after glass removal.
To Replace Rear Quarter Light Glass
1. Remove the rear clamshell (see sub-section BV.6).
2.
Pull off the top rear section of the door weatherstrip seal, and peel off the rubber finisher moulding from
the front edge of the quarter light glass.
3.
Remove the rear quarter trim panel and 'B' post upper trim (see section VE.11).
4.
From inside the car, and using a dedicated vibrating cutting knife of suitable form, cut the adhesive bead
around the periphery of the window, taking care to avoid damage to paintwork or body flange.
Page 18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section BV
5.
After cutting out the glass, remove old adhesive from body flange sufficiently to leave a consistent and
flat surface for the new bonding medium.
6.
Clean the whole of the bonding surface on the new glass, and the bonding surface on the tailgate aperture,
with the wipe cleaner supplied in the Betaseal Kit (or Betaclean 3900 A100B6008V).
7.
Peel off the backing tape, and apply a new finisher strip to the inside top edge of the glass, aligning the
cut back feature on the extrusion with the front edge of the glass.
8.
Prime the bonding area on the glass to a width of 25mm with the primer in the kit, or with Betaprime 5500
(green cap) A120B6041V.
9.
Prime and re-activate the prepared surface of the old adhesive on the body with Betawipe 4000
(A082B6355V). If the body side panel is new or without adhesive, prime the flange with Betaprime 5404
(red cap) A082B6337V.
10. Allow a minimum of 5 minutes for the primer to dry. If the glass is not fitted within 48 hours, the primer
should be re-applied.
11.
Cut the nozzle of the Betaseal cartridge as shown in sub-section BV.13, and holding the cartridge vertically,
extrude a bead of adhesive around the glass periphery. Manipulate the two ends of the bead together to
form an unbroken ring.
12.
As shown in the illustration, insert into the top run of adhesive two 5mm spacer blocks A124U0069F, and
into the bottom run, two 4mm spacers A075U0588F.
13. Using a suction cup, carefully position the glass onto its aperture, with the finisher strip consistently abuting the roof panel, and the front edge aligned with the door shut rebate.
Press around the periphery of the glass to compress the adhesive until contact with the spacer blocks is
felt. Carefully examine the integrity of the whole length of the joint, if necessary using a spatula to force
extra adhesive into any depleted areas. Wipe off any excess adhesive extruded from the joint, or alternatively, allow the adhesive fully to cure and cut away any excess using a scalpel blade. Use duct tape to
hold the glass in position until the Betaseal is fully cured. This will take approximately 4 hours dependent
on atmospheric conditions, with a longer period required in dry atmospheres.
14.
Refit front edge finisher, interior trim panels and rear clamshell.
Refer to sub-section BV.13 for spillage of material and shelf life advice.
Page 19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
FRONT SUSPENSION
SECTION CK
Sub-Section
Page
General Description
CK.1
3
Geometry & Adjustments
CK.2
3
Wishbone Pivot Bushes & Swivel Joints
CK.3
6
Anti-Roll Bar
CK.4
7
Suspension Disassembly/Assembly
CK.5
8
Front Wheel Bearings
CK.6
10
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
General Arrangement
Damper mounting bracket
Top wishbone
Upper steering
swivel joint
Hub carrier
Steering arm
Track rod end
ball joint
Hub bearing unit
Lower steering
swivel joint
Anti-roll bar
Spring/damper
unit
Bottom wishbone
Anti-roll bar drop link
Brake calliper
lower boss
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
c49
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
CK.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The independent front suspension comprises, on each side of the car, upper and lower forged aluminium
wishbones, a concentric coil spring/telescopic damper unit, and a tubular anti-roll bar. A forged steel hub carrier, provides a mounting for the hub bearing unit to which the 5-bolt road wheel and brake disc are attached,
and also features an integral steering arm and mounting bosses for the brake caliper.
The primary, vehicle weight bearing, lower wishbone, is braced by two integral struts and features an integrated steering swivel lower ball joint, a pair of press fit bonded rubber pivot bushes, and attachment points
for a fabricated steel bracket carrying the damper lower end, and a forged steel bracket for the anti-roll bar
drop link. The upper wishbone is a simple open 'A' frame, into the apex of which the upper steering swivel ball
joint is integrated.
The inboard ends of both wishbones use replaceable bonded rubber pivot bushes for maintenance free
articulation, with a compliance profile tuned to provide the vehicle with accurate and responsive dynamic characteristics. Eccentric cams incorporated at the front and rear pivot points for the lower wishbone, provide for
the adjustment of both camber and castor.
The bottom of the Bilstein monotube telescopic damper fixes to the lower wishbone via a folded steel
cradle bolted to both arms of the wishbone, with the damper top end fixing to the subframe via a substantial
alloy casting bolted to the subframe longeron. The damper uses a bonded rubber bush in the top eye for noise
suppression, and a through bolted spherical steel joint in the lower eye for optimum dynamic response, and is
orientated with the damper rod uppermost. The dual rate concentric coil spring abuts against a lower seat on
the damper body, and a rubber cushioned upper seat incorporated in the damper top mounting bracket, thus
relieving the damper top bush from vehicle weight to the benefit of noise and ride refinement. The dual rate
coil spring is mounted with the close coiled end lowermost.
A 28mm o.d. tubular steel anti-roll bar is mounted in rubber bushes to the underside of the subframe and
projects through the lower wishbone before connecting to the wishbone rear leg via a short ball jointed drop
link and a forged steel bracket.
The hub bearing unit, which is common to all four wheels, is fixed to the hub carrier by 4 bolts, and incorporates a double row ball bearing with the inner race of the outboard bearing formed directly in the hub
forging, and the inner race of the inboard bearing retained by a swaging operation on the hub flange. Inboard
and outboard grease seals are included in the assembly, with a vehicle speed sensor ring integrated into the
inboard seal, whose 48 pole signal is picked up by a sensor mounted in the rear of the hub carrier. This data
is used for the anti-lock brake, vehicle stability, engine management and speedometer functions.
CK.2 - GEOMETRY & ADJUSTMENTS
Provision is made for the adjustment of wheel alignment, camber and castor. Under normal service conditions, no periodic scheduled check of the geometry is necessary, although a front wheel alignment check is
recommended when the front tyres are replaced. A full geometry check is required only after front suspension
component replacement, or if excessive tyre wear is evident, or if steering difficulties are manifest. Before
any measurements or adjustments are made it is essential first to set the vehicle to its ‘mid‑laden’ ride height,
approximating to driver and passenger and a full tank of fuel. This will require the vehicle to be ballasted, or
pulled down on a ramp:
Type Independent. Upper and lower wishbone; co-
axial coil spring/telescopic damper; anti-roll bar.
Mid-laden ride height (2x75 kg occupants + full fuel tank) - set car to this height before measuring geometry:
- front 125 mm below front end of chassis siderail
- rear 147 mm below rear end of chassis siderail
Castor - optimum + 5.2°
- tolerance range + 5.0° to + 5.5°; max. side/side 0.3°
Camber - optimum - 0.3°
- tolerance range - 0.5° to - 0.2°; max. side/side 0.2°
Alignment - optimum Zero
- tolerance range 0.5 mm toe-out, to 0.5mm toe-in overall
Steering axis inclination 9.4° nominal
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
Alignment
Wheel alignment refers to the parallelism of the wheels when viewed from above and is crucial to vehicle
stability, handling and tyre wear.
Difference between
rim measurements
= overall toe out
FRONT
Individual
toe out
angle
c26
Alignment is measured either by the angle a wheel makes with the vehicle centre line, or the difference in
dimension between the wheel rim to wheel rim measurement at the front and rear of the wheel at hub centre
height. The wheels are said to 'toe-in' when the wheel paths converge ahead of the vehicle, and 'toe-out' when
they diverge. Wheel alignment is designed to vary with both steering angle (Ackerman) and suspension travel
(bump steer) and should be measured only 'straight ahead' at the specified ride height.
Front wheel alignment is adjusted be screwing the rack tie rods into or out of the track rods. In order to
preserve the required bump steer characteristic and steering symmetry, the effective length of each track rod
must remain equal - adjust each tie rod by a similar amount.
To be revised
Track rod end flats
Steering rack gaiter
Track rod end
Steering arm
Steering track rod flats
Track rod end locknut
c28a
-
Hold the track rod using the flats provided, and slacken the locknut. Repeat for the opposite side.
Turn each tie rod a similar amount. As a guide, turning both tie rods by one quarter of a turn will alter
overall toe-out by approx. 2.0 mm.
When adjustment is correct, hold each track rod and tighten the locknuts to 80 - 82 Nm (58 - 60 lbf.ft).
When slackening or tightening the track rod locknuts, it is important that the torque reaction is resisted
using the track rod flats, and that the outer ball joint is not allowed to be stressed.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
Camber Adjustment
Camber is the angle from vertical of the wheel when viewed from the front, and is said to be negative when
the wheel leans inwards at the top (positive when leaning outwards). The primary purpose of camber is to
achieve the maximum efficiency of the tyre under cornering loads and body roll, with the specification closely
allied to a particular wheel/tyre combination. The camber angle changes with suspension travel, becoming
more negative on bump, and should be measured only at the specified ride height. Incorrect camber can result
in handling deficiencies and excessive tyre wear.
c29
Vertical
Camber angle
Wheel centreline
Eccentric cams at the inboard pivots of the lower wishbone provide a means of camber adjustment. The
front pivot bolt is inserted from the rear, and the rear pivot bolt from the front, with each bolt head featuring an
integral eccentric cam. A corresponding eccentric camplate is clamped beneath the nut, and is keyed to the
bolt via a tongue and groove feature to ensure alignment between the two cams. Each cam is constrained
by vertical guides integral with the subframe structure, whereas the pivot bolt hole in the subframe is slotted
horizontally. Thus by turning the bolt (and eccentric cams) the wishbone pivot point may be moved inboard or
outboard.
When adjusting camber, the front and rear pivot bolts should be moved by a similar horizontal distance to
minimise the effect on castor (see below) but be aware that the horizontal movement produced by turning the
cambolts accords with simple harmonic motion, and is not linear. After adjustment, ensure that the nuts are
tightened to 86 Nm (only at ride height).
Cambolt Effects
From a midpoint position (i.e. centres of bolt and eccentric on common vertical axis, stamped arrow pointing
vertically upwards or downwards);
Foreward cambolt; 90° cambolt rotation moves pivot horizontally by 5mm, and
- changes camber angle by 0.25°
- changes castor angle by 1°
Rearward cambolt; 90° cambolt rotation moves pivot horizontally by 5mm, and
- changes camber angle by 0.7°
- changes castor angle by 1°
Note:
Forward cambolt; Moving pivot axis INboard;
- reduces negative camber
- increases castor
Rearward cambolt; Moving pivot axis INboard;
- reduces negative camber
- reduces castor
Total adjustment range - camber 4°
- castor 0.8°
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
Cambolt illustration
Castor Adjustment
Castor is the angle from vertical of the steering axis of the wheel when viewed from the side. Its primary
purpose is to provide a natural straight running tendency of the steered wheels with forward vehicle motion.
Castor angles have a complex interaction with other steering geometries and if unbalanced or outside of specification, can result in various stability and handling deficiencies.
FRONT
Top & bottom
steering swivels
Vertical
Castor angle
c27
The eccentric cams fitted at both front and rear inboard pivots of the lower wishbone (see 'Camber Adjustment above) are also used to adjust camber. By moving the rear pivot axis outwards, and the front pivot
inwards, the lower swivel joint is moved forwards to result in an increase in castor angle. To reduce the effect
of this adjustment on camber angle, the front pivot point will need to be moved laterally about three times the
distance, and in the opposite direction, to the rear pivot point movement.
After adjustment, ensure that the nuts are tightened to 86 Nm (only at ride height).
CK.3 - wishbone pivot bushes & swivel joints
Pivot Bushes
The upper and lower wishbone pivot bushes are bonded rubber type with a plastic flanged outer sleeve,
an alloy inner sleeve, and an aluminium interleaf sleeve within the rubber bush to control the flexing characteristic. The rubber material specification has been selected to optimise the handling/refinement balance. The
flanged end of the bush incorporates a snubbing feature to limit the axial distortion of the bush, with each bush
arranged to resist braking forces transmitted through the suspension; Both top wishbone bushes are inserted
from the front, and both bottom wishbone bushes from the rear. A chamfer is provided in the wishbone bore
for this purpose.
The bushes may be pressed out of the wishbone eyes, and new bushes fitted using suitable press tool
dollies. Smear the outer surface of the new bush with IPC 'P-80' rubber lubricant emulsion (A082C6042V) to
ease fitment, and assemble in the direction detailed above.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
To be revised
Steering Swivel Joints
The steering swivel joint housed in the outboard end of both the top and bottom wishbones, uses a steel
ball pin located in a synthetic spherical bearing cup pressed into the wishbone and retained by a swaging operation. The joint requires no maintenance other than a visual inspection of the dust gaiter, and is replaceable
only as an integral part of the wishbone assembly.
Damper Pivots
The lower eye of the damper is fitted with a zero compliance, through bolted, spherical joint which may
be replaced using suitable press tools. The upper eye houses a bonded rubber bush, with a steel outer sleeve
and an alloy inner sleeve. The bush may be replaced using suitable press tools.
CK.4 - ANTI-ROLL BAR
The tubular steel anti-roll bar is mounted beneath the front subframe in rubber bushes retained by extruded
alloy clamps. One clamp secures the bar at each side to a bolt fixed, alloy extrusion, bridging the chassis drop
towers for the lower wishbone front and rear pivots. Each end of the bar loops upwards through the lower
wishbone and uses a short ball jointed drop link and forged steel bracket to connect to the rear leg of the lower
wishbone. At each side, a washer crimped to the bar, bears against the inboard end of the chassis mounting
bush to provide lateral location of the bar.
The drop link ball joints require no maintenance, and are replaceable only as part of the drop link assembly. The chassis mounted bushes are lubricated with rubber grease on assembly, but require no routine
maintenance.
ARB illustration
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
CK.5 - SUSPENSION DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY
The suspension may be disassembled without the use of any special tools other than spring compressor
clamps if the spring and damper are to be separated. With the car on a wheel free lift and with the front wheels
removed:
1. Remove the wheelarch liner(s) as appropriate.
2.
Hub Unit
Remove the two bolts securing the brake calliper to the hub carrier, release the flexible hose from the top
wishbone, and support the calliper aside without straining the brake hose. Release the single countersunk
screw, and remove the brake disc.
3.
Release the harness connector from the wheel speed sensor, release the harness from any suspension
components, and secure the harness aside. Release the single screw securing the wheel speed sensor,
and withdraw the sensor from the hub carrier.
4.
Release the four hex. head securing bolts and withdraw the hub unit from the hub carrier. Note that this
unit is common to all four wheels.
5.
Hub Carrier
Remove the nut securing the track rod ball joint into the steering arm, and use a ball joint splitter to separate the joint from the arm.
6.
Remove the nut securing the top swivel joint to the hub carrier, and use a ball joint splitter to separate the
joint.
7.
Remove the nut securing the lower swivel joint to the hub carrier, and use a ball joint splitter to separate
the ball pin from the carrier. Lift the carrier and hub unit from the car.
8.
9.
Damper and Spring
If the damper and spring are to be separated, it is recommended to remove the complete assembly of
spring/damper/top mounting bracket from the car in order that spring compression may be carried out in
the safest manner.
Remove the 4 bolts securing the top mounting bracket to the subframe, and the single bolt securing the
lower end of the damper to the bottom wishbone bracket. Withdraw the assembly to a workbench.
Using spring compressor clamps and taking all suitable safety precautions, unload the spring seats and
remove the bolt securing the top end of the damper to the mounting bracket.
10. Separate the spring, damper and top bracket, noting the spring top seat cushion, and unload the spring
clamps.
Upper Wishbone
11. Release the 'P' clip securing the brake hose to the wishbone, and the front and rear pivot bolts, and withdraw the wishbone from the subframe. The captive nuts for the pivot bolts are retained in channels in the
chassis extrusions, replacement of the nutplate for the rear pivot requiring removal of the crash structure
joining plate.
Note that the steering swivel ball joint is retained in the wishbone by a swaging operation, and is serviced
only as part of the upper wishbone assembly. For pivot bush replacement, see CK.3.
Lower Wishbone
12. To aid re-assembly, match mark the eccentric cam adjuster positions at both pivot points for the lower
wishbone. Release the anti-roll bar drop link from the wishbone, noting that a 5mm hexagonal socket is
provided in the end of the ball pin stud to aid this process. Remove both pivot bolts and eccentric cam
adjusters, and withdraw the wishbone.
Note that the steering swivel ball joint is retained in the wishbone by a swaging operation, and is serviced
only as part of the lower wishbone assembly. For pivot bush replacement, see CK.3.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section CK
13. If necessary, release the four bolts and remove the damper lower fixing bracket from the lower wishbone,
and the remaining bolt securing the anti-roll bar drop link bracket.
Anti-Roll Bar
14. At least one of the lower wishbones must be removed before the ARB may be withdrawn.
Release the anti-roll bar drop links from the ARB noting that the link assembly is symmetrical end to end.
Note that the drop link ball pin self locking nuts should be discarded and renewed for re-assembly. Release the two bolts securing each of the two ARB pivot clamps to the chassis brackets and withdraw the
anti-roll bar.
Reassembly
Re-assemble the suspension in reverse order to disassembly with the following notes:
If the car suffers a suspension impact sufficient to damage a wheel rim, careful attention should be paid
to all related suspension components, and replacement parts fitted in any cases of doubt.
Smear the shank of each pivot bolt with PBC grease to inhibit corrosion and facilitate subsequent servicing, but do not allow grease contamination of the threads.
Where bolts are threaded into captive nuts with no secondary locking mechanism, apply a suitable threadlocking compound. If separate self-locking nuts are used, assess the locking torque and renew the nuts
in any case of doubt. The ARB drop link ball pin self locking nuts should always be renewed.
Take care to match mark and refit the eccentric cam adjusters on the lower wishbone pivots in their original
settings to facilitate subsequent geometry checking and adjustment.
Lubricate the rubber type anti-roll bar mountings with rubber grease on assembly.
Refit the plastic bung into the steering arm counterbore to prevent corrosion of the ball joint fixing.
The damper body is provided with three location grooves for the circlip retaining the spring lower seat.
Use the middle position for standard ride height setting. Use spring compressor clamps to assemble the
spring/damper/top mounting bracket (spring close coils lowermost), before fitting the complete assembly
to the car. Do not omit the spring top seat cushion.
Pump the brake pedal to reposition the pads before driving the car.
The Service Schedule specifies that the security of the front and rear suspension is checked at each service.
For cars used on race tracks, or in similar conditions, suspension components and torque checks should be
carried out between sessions. This operation requires that all the principal suspension pivot bolts are torque
checked, noting the following points:
Where a bolt is tapped into a housing or weldnut, and relies on a thread locking compound for security, it
is important to appreciate that if the bolt is disturbed, the locking compound must be re-applied. The following
procedure should be adopted for all such fixings:
Check the torque of the fixing.
If the specified torque is attained without the fixing being disturbed (moving), take no further action.
If the bolt moves, the locking action of the thread adhesive will have been compromised. Remove the
bolt completely, clean off all old adhesive using a wire brush and acetone, and apply new adhesive as
specified.
Refit the bolt and tighten to the specified torque.
If for any reason a bolt is found to have become loose, and the car has been operated for any period in
this condition, the bolt should be renewed as a standard precaution and related components carefully
inspected for hole ovality, undue stress or wear.
Torque Settings:
Upper and lower wishbone pivot bolts
Upper and lower swivel joints to hub carrier
Track rod end to steering arm
Damper to lower wishbone bracket
Damper to top anchor bracket
Damper bracket to lower wishbone
Spring/damper upper anchor bracket to chassis
Hub bearing unit to hub carrier
Brake calliper to hub carrier
Anti-roll bar alloy mounting clamps to chassis
Nm
86
86
45
135
86
45
45
70
86
45
+ Permabond A130
+ Permabond A130
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Anti-roll bar drop links
Wheel bolts
Speed sensor to hub carrier
Brake disc retaining screw
Section CK
38
105
5
10
CK.6 - FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS
The hub bearing unit, which is common to all four wheels, is fixed to the hub carrier by 4 hex. head bolts,
and incorporates a double row ball bearing with the inner race of the outboard bearing formed directly in the hub
forging, and the inner race of the inboard bearing retained by a swaging operation on the hub flange. Inboard
and outboard grease seals are included in the assembly, with a vehicle speed sensor ring integrated into the
inboard seal, whose signal is picked up by a sensor mounted in the rear of the hub carrier.
If there is found to be any discernible free play in the hub bearing, or any roughness or tight spots can be
felt, or any untoward noise heard, or any signs of lubricant expulsion are evident, the hub assembly should be
replaced - there is no provision for adjustment or replacement of individual bearings.
To Replace Hub Bearing Assembly
1. With the wheel removed, release the two fixing bolts, and remove the brake calliper from the hub carrier.
Support clear of the brake disc without straining the flexible hose. Release the single countersunk screw
and withdraw the brake disc from the hub.
2.
Release the four bolts securing the hub bearing unit to the hub carrier.
3.
Fit the new hub bearing unit to the hub carrier, apply Permabond A130 (A912E7033) to the threads of the
four bolts, and torque tighten to 70 Nm.
4.
Refit the brake disc and calliper, using Permabond A130 (A912E7033) on the threads of the calliper fixing
bolts and torque tighten to 86 Nm. Pump the brake pedal to re-position the pads before driving the car.
Hub carrier
Hub bearing unit
Hub unit fixing bolt
Retaining swage
Wheel bolt thread
Double row ball bearing
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
c50
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
REAR SUSPENSION
SECTION DJ
Sub-Section
Page
General Description
DJ.1
3
Geometry & Adjustments
DJ.2
3
Wishbone Pivot Bushes & Spherical Joints
DJ.3
6
Anti-Roll Bar
DJ.4
6
Suspension Disassembly/Assembly
DJ.5
7
Rear Wheel Bearings
DJ.6
9
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
Rear Suspension Layout
Spherical joint
Spring/damper unit
Top wishbone
Damper top
mounting
bracket
Calliper
mounting ARB Turnbuckle
lug drop
link Anti-roll bar
Lower wishbone Toe control link
ARB chassis
Hub unit mounting bush
Hub carrier
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
d51
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
DJ.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The independent rear suspension comprises, on each side of the car, upper and lower forged aluminium
wishbones, a forged steel toe control link, a concentric coil spring/telescopic damper unit, and a tubular steel
anti-roll bar, all being attached to the galvanised steel rear subframe. A forged steel hub carrier, provides a
mounting for the hub bearing unit to which the 5-bolt road wheel and brake disc are attached, and also carries
bosses for the cross-axis fixing bolts for the brake calliper.
The primary, vehicle weight bearing, lower wishbone, is widely based and substantially cross braced, and
incorporates separate double shear mounting points for the hub carrier and damper lower eye, and a single lug
for the anti-roll bar drop link. The outboard end of the wishbone is through bolted to a spherical joint pressed
into the lower eye of the hub carrier. The upper wishbone is of simple 'A' form, and houses a replaceable
through-bolted spherical joint at its outboard end to connect to the hub carrier. The inboard ends of both upper
and lower wishbones use replaceable bonded rubber pivot bushes for maintenance free articulation, with the
bush compliance profile tuned to provide the vehicle with accurate and responsive dynamic characteristics. The
toe control link is a two part steel forging incorporating an adjustment turnbuckle, and by connecting a rearward
extension on the hub carrier to the chassis subframe, a 'toe-in on compression' bump steer characteristic is
produced. Through bolted spherical joints are used in each end of the link, and the threaded turnbuckle allows
for adjustment of rear wheel alignment. An eccentric cam incorporated at the rear pivot point for the lower
wishbone, provides a means of camber adjustment.
The bottom of the Bilstein monotube telescopic damper fixes to the lower wishbone in a double shear
arrangement, with the damper top end secured to the subframe via a steel bracket bolted inside the subframe
tower. The damper uses a rubber bush in the top eye for noise suppression, and a through bolted spherical
steel joint in the lower eye for optimum dynamic response, and is orientated with the damper rod uppermost.
The dual rate, concentric coil spring abuts against a lower seat fixed to the damper body, and an upper seat
secured to the damper top eye, but also bolted to the subframe, thus relieving the damper top bush of vehicle
weight to the benefit of noise and ride refinement. The close coiled end of the spring is mounted lowermost,
on the damper body.
A 21mm o.d. tubular steel anti-roll bar is mounted in rubber bushes to the underside of the subframe
rearward of the axle line, and curves over each toe-link before connecting to the lower wishbone rear leg via
a short ball jointed drop link.
The hub bearing unit, which is common to all four wheels, is fixed to the hub carrier by 4 bolts, and incorporates a wide spaced double row ball bearing and a vehicle speed sensor ring integrated into the inboard
seal, whose 48 pole signal is picked up by a sensor mounted in the rear of the hub carrier. This data is used
for the anti-lock brake, vehicle stability, engine management and speedometer functions.
DJ.2 - GEOMETRY & ADJUSTMENTS
Provision is made for the adjustment of wheel alignment and camber. Under normal service conditions, no
periodic scheduled check of the geometry is necessary, with a full geometry check required only after suspension
repair, or if excessive tyre wear is evident, or handling deficiencies encountered. Before any measurements or
adjustments are made, it is essential first to set the vehicle to its ‘mid‑laden’ ride height, approximating to driver
and passenger and a half/full tank of fuel. This will require the vehicle to be ballasted or tied down:
Type
Mid-laden ride height (2 x 75 kg occupants + full fuel tank)
etry: - front
- rear
Camber - optimum
- tolerance range
Alignment - optimum
- tolerance range
Thrust angle - optimum
- tolerance
Independent. Upper and lower wishbone; co-
axial coil spring/telescopic damper; toe-link;
anti-roll bar
- set car to this height before measuring geom125 mm below front end of chassis siderail
147 mm below rear end of chassis siderail
- 1.6°
- 1.8° to - 1.5° max. side/side 0.2°
1.5 mm toe-in each side
1.4 to 1.8 mm toe-in each side
max. side/side 0.3 mm
Zero
0.05°
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
Alignment
Wheel alignment refers to the parallelism of the wheels when viewed from above and is crucial to vehicle
stability, handling and tyre wear. It is measured either by the angle a wheel makes with the vehicle centre
line, or the difference in dimension between the wheel rim to wheel rim measurement at the front and rear of
the wheel at hub centre height. The wheels are said to 'toe-in' when the wheel paths converge ahead of the
vehicle, and 'toe-out' when they diverge. Rear wheel alignment should be measured only using equipment
which measures individual rear wheel alignment relative to the car centreline. Wheel alignment is designed
to vary with suspension travel ('bump steer') and the base setting should be measured only at the specified
mid laden ride height.
It is possible to accurately measure individual wheel alignment using a pair of long straight bars or round
section elastic in conjunction with 4 axle stands or similar. Any bars used must be longer than the length of the
car, and be suitably stiff and straight.
Set up the bars or elastic on each side of the car at wheel centre height as shown an the diagram, so that
A = A, B = B and C = C.
Straight
edge
FRONT
d21
Measure the distance from the bar to the rim of the wheel concerned at the front and rear of the centre line
of the wheel (D1, D2). If the front dimension, D1, is greater than the rear dimension, D2, the wheel has TOE-IN.
If the rear dimension is greater than the front dimension, the wheel has TOE-OUT. The difference between the
two measurements is the amount the wheel has toe-in or toe-out.
Wheel alignment is adjusted via the toe control link which is equipped with a turnbuckle at its centre.
Slacken both locknuts, and turn the buckle as necessary to increase or decrease the effective length of the
link. As a guide, lengthening the link rod by a turn of one 'flat' (one sixth of a turn) will increase toe-in by approximately 1.6 mm.
After adjustment, hold each section of the toe-link in turn using the flats provided, whilst tightening each
of the two locknuts to 45 Nm. Ensure that the axes of the toe-link pivot bearings are parallel.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
Camber Adjustment
Camber is the angle from vertical of the wheel when viewed from the rear, and is said to be negative when
the wheel leans inwards at the top (positive when leaning outwards).
Vertical
Camber angle
Wheel centreline
c29
The primary purpose of camber is to achieve the maximum efficiency of the tyre under cornering loads and
body roll, with the specification closely allied to a particular wheel/tyre combination. The camber angle changes
with suspension travel, becoming more negative on bump, and should be measured only at the specified ride
height. Incorrect camber can result in handling deficiencies and excessive tyre wear.
Illustration TBA
An eccentric cam at the rear inboard pivot of each lower wishbone provides a means of camber adjustment. The pivot bolt is inserted from the rear, with the bolt head featuring an integral eccentric cam, and with
a corresponding eccentric camplate clamped beneath the nut on the front side of the rear pivot. The camplate
is keyed to the bolt via a tongue and groove feature to ensure alignment between the two cams. Each cam is
constrained by vertical guides in a riveted insert in the subframe, whereas the pivot bolt hole in the subframe
is slotted horizontally. Thus by turning the bolt (and eccentric cams) the wishbone pivot axis may be moved
inboard or outboard.
When adjusting camber, note that the horizontal movement produced is not linear, but accords with simple
harmonic motion. After adjustment, ensure that the pivot bolt is tightened to 86 Nm. Be aware that any camber
adjustment will also affect wheel alignment, which must subsequently be checked and/or reset (see above).
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
DJ.3 - wishbone pivot bushes & SPHERICAL joints
Pivot Bushes
The upper and lower wishbone pivot bushes are bonded rubber type with a plastic flanged outer sleeve,
an alloy inner sleeve, and an aluminium interleaf sleeve within the rubber bush to control the flexing characteristic. The rubber material specification has been selected to optimise the handling/refinement balance. The
flanged end of the bush incorporates a snubbing feature to limit the axial distortion of the bush, with each bush
arranged to resist braking forces transmitted through the suspension; Both top wishbone bushes are inserted
from the front, and both bottom wishbone bushes from the rear. A chamfer is provided in the wishbone bore
for this purpose.
The bushes may be pressed out of the wishbone eyes, and new bushes fitted using suitable press tool
dollies. Smear the outer surface of the new bush with IPC 'P-80' rubber lubricant emulsion (A082C6042V) to
ease fitment, and assemble in the direction detailed above.
To be revised
Damper Upper Bush
The upper eye of the damper houses a bonded rubber bush, with a steel outer sleeve and an alloy inner
sleeve. The bush may be replaced using suitable press tools.
Spherical Joints
Through bolted spherical joints are used at the outboard ends of the upper and lower wishbones, both ends
of the toe control links, and in the lower eye of the dampers. All joints have an outside diameter of 40mm apart
from the lower wishbone joint (pressed into the hub carrier) which is 47mm. Spherical joints are maintenance
free, but may be replaced using suitable press tools.
DJ.4 - ANTI-ROLL BAR
A 21mm o.d. tubular steel anti-roll bar is mounted beneath the rear subframe behind the axle line, in rubber
bushes retained by extruded alloy clamps. One clamp secures the bar at each side to the bottom surface of
the subframe longeron via two bolts tapping into a steel nutplate riveted inside the longeron. Each end of the
bar curves over the toe-link before connecting to a lug on the lower wishbone rear leg via a short ball jointed
drop link. A pair of washers crimped to the bar, bear against the outboard sides of the mounting bushes to
provide lateral location of the bar.
The drop link ball joints require no maintenance, and are replaceable only as part of the handed drop link
assembly. The chassis mounted bushes are lubricated with rubber grease on assembly, but require no routine
maintenance.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
ARB illustration
DJ.5 - SUSPENSION DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY
The suspension may be disassembled without the use of any special tools other than spring compressor
clamps if the sping and damper are to be separated. If the hub carrier is to be removed, necessitating withdrawal of the driveshaft, it is recommended first to release the driveshaft nut before dismantling the brakes, in
order that the brakes may be used to react against the release torque.
With the car on a wheel free lift and with the rear wheels and engine undertray removed:
1.
Hub Unit
With the parking and footbrakes firmly applied, remove the driveshaft nut (both RH thread).
2.
Release the two bolts securing the brake calliper to the hub carrier, release the flexible hose from the top
wishbone, and support the calliper aside without straining the brake hose.
3.
Check that the parking brake is released, back off the brake shoe adjuster, remove the two countersunk
retaining screws and withdraw the brake disc/drum from the hub.
4.
Release the single screw securing the wheel speed sensor, and withdraw the sensor from the hub carrier.
5.
Release the four hex. head securing bolts and withdraw the hub unit from the hub carrier and driveshaft.
Note that this unit is common to all four wheels.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Parking Brake Backplate
Release the parking brake cable from the backplate actuating lever. Remove the three bolts securing the
backplate to the hub carrier and withdraw the backplate complete with brake shoes.
Hub Carrier
Remove the bolt securing the toe-link to the hub carrier, and separate from the clevis.
Remove the bolt securing the top wishbone to the hub carrier, and that securing the lower wishbone to
the hub carrier, and withdraw the carrier from the car.
Damper and Spring
Remove the bolt securing the lower end of the damper to the lower wishbone, noting and retaining the
steel washers fitted between the spherical joint and wishbone.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
10. Release the two bolts securing the spring top abutment plate to the inside of the subframe tower, and the
single bolt (captive nut) securing a leg on the plate to the front face of the tower. Withdraw the complete
spring/damper/abutment plate assembly.
11. Using spring compressor clamps and taking all suitable safety precautions, unload the spring seats and
remove the bolt securing the damper top eye to the spring top abutment plate and separate the three
components, noting the spring top seat cushion. Unload the spring compressor clamps.
Anti-Roll Bar
12. Release the drop link from each lower wishbone and/or the anti-roll bar.
13. Remove the two bolts securing each of the two alloy clamps to the subframe (riveted nut plates), and
withdraw the ARB.
Upper and Lower Wishbones
14. Remove the two pivot bolts securing the top wishbone, and withdraw the wishbone. Note that the top
wishbone is not handed, so should be marked accordingly if both sides are removed and are to be refitted.
15. Before releasing the lower wishbone rear pivot, match mark the eccentric cam to aid re-assembly. Remove
the cam bolt and cam, release the front pivot bolt and withdraw the lower wishbone.
16. Release the inboard pivot bolt and withdraw the toe-link. Note that the toe-link is not handed, so should
be marked accordingly if both sides are removed and are to be refitted. The shorter toe-link tube is fitted
outboard.
Reassembly
Re-assemble the suspension in reverse order to disassembly with the following notes:
Take care to assemble each pivot bolt with the correct washers/snubbers/spacers as noted on removal.
Smear the shank of each pivot bolt with PBC grease to inhibit corrosion and facilitate subsequent servicing, but do not allow grease contamination of the threads.
Where bolts are threaded into captive nuts with no secondary locking mechanism, apply a suitable threadlocking compound. If separate self-locking nuts are used, assess the locking torque and renew the nuts
in any case of doubt. The ARB drop link ball pin self locking nuts should always be renewed.
Take care to match mark and refit the eccentric cam adjusters on the lower wishbone rear pivot to facilitate
subsequent geometry checking and adjustment.
Lubricate the rubber type anti-roll bar mountings with rubber grease on assembly.
Adjust the brake shoes and pump the brake pedal to re-position the pads before driving the car.
If the car suffers a suspension impact sufficient to damage a wheel rim, careful attention should be paid
to all related suspension components, and replacement parts fitted in any cases of doubt.
The Service Schedule specifies that the security of the front and rear suspension is checked at each service.
For cars used on race tracks, or in similar conditions, suspension components and torque checks should be
carried out between sessions. This operation requires that all the principal suspension pivot bolts are torque
checked, noting the following points:
Where a bolt is tapped into a housing or weldnut, and relies on a thread locking compound for security, be
aware that if the bolt is disturbed, the locking compound must be re-applied. The following procedure should
be adopted for all such fixings:
Check the torque of the fixing.
If the specified torque is attained without the fixing being disturbed (moving), take no further action.
If the bolt moves, the locking action of the thread adhesive will have been compromised. Remove the
bolt completely, clean off all old adhesive using a wire brush and acetone, and apply new adhesive as
specified.
Refit the bolt and tighten to the specified torque.
If for any reason a bolt is found to have become loose, and the car has been operated for any period in
this condition, the bolt should be renewed as a standard precaution and related components carefully
inspected for hole ovality or wear.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Torque Settings:
Upper and lower wishbone pivot bolts
Upper wishbone to hub carrier
Lower wishbone to hub carrier
Toe-link outer ball joint to hub carrier
Toe-link inner ball joint to subframe
Toe-link turnbuckle locknuts
Damper to lower wishbone
Damper to upper abutment bracket
Spring top abutment bracket to subframe - upper
- lower
Anti-roll bar drop link ball joints
Anti-roll bar clamps to subframe
- Hub bearing unit to hub carrier
Brake calliper to hub carrier
Speed sensor to hub carrier
Driveshaft nut to hub
Parking brake backplate to hub carrier
Brake disc retaining screw
Wheel bolts
Section DJ
Nm
86
135
135
135
135
45
135
86
24
45
38
45
70 Use Permabond A130
86 Use Permabond A130
5
300
45
10
105
DJ.6 - Rear WHEEL BEARINGS
The hub bearing unit, which is common to all four wheels, is fixed to the hub carrier by 4 hex. head bolts,
and incorporates a double row ball bearing with the inner race of the outboard bearing formed directly in the hub
forging, and the inner race of the inboard bearing retained by a swaging operation on the hub flange. Inboard
and outboard grease seals are included in the assembly, with a 48 pole vehicle speed sensor ring integrated
into the inboard seal, whose signal is picked up by a sensor mounted in the rear of the hub carrier.
If there is found to be any discernible free play in the hub bearing, or any roughness, or if tight spots can
be felt, or any untoward noise heard, or any signs of lubricant expulsion are evident, the hub assembly should
be replaced - there is no provision for adjustment or replacement of the bearings.
Hub carrier
Hub unit fixing bolt
Hub bearing unit
Driveshaft nut
Driveshaft outboard C.V. joint
Double row ball bearing
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
d52
Lotus Service Notes
Section DJ
To Replace Hub Bearing Assembly
With the car on a wheel free lift and with the rear wheel and engine undertray removed:
1. Firmly apply the parking and footbrakes, and remove the driveshaft nut (both RH thread).
2.
Release the two fixing bolts, and remove the brake calliper from the hub carrier. Support clear of the brake
disc without straining the flexible hose. Check that the parking brake is released, back off the brake shoe
adjuster, remove the two countersunk retaining screws and withdraw the brake disc/drum from the hub.
3.
Using a Torx socket, release the four bolts securing the hub bearing unit to the hub carrier, and withdraw.
4.
Fit the new hub bearing unit to the hub carrier and driveshaft, apply Permabond A130 (A912E7033) to the
threads and retain the unit with the four Torx bolts tightened to 70 Nm.
5.
Refit the brake disc and calliper, using Permabond A130 (A912E7033) on the threads of the calliper fixing
bolts and torque tightening to 86 Nm.
6.
Adjust the parking brake shoes and pump the brake pedal to reposition the pads before driving the car.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
ENGINE
SECTION EJ
Sub-Section
Page
Introduction
EJ.1
3
Air Cleaner Element Inspection/Replacement
EJ.2
3
Engine Oil & Filter Change
EJ.3
4
Auxiliary Drive Belt
EJ.4
5
Engine Removal/Replacement
EJ.5
5
Engine Special Tools
EJ.6
7
Engine Repair (CD T000T1506)
EJ.7
7
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
g
ved enVVT-i
proDual
(Variable Valve Timing-intelligent) system, DIS (Direct Ignition System), ACIS
mthe
ustic Control Induction System), and ETCS-i (Electronic Throttle Control System-intelligent). These
ol functions achieve
improved
engine performance, fuel economy, and reduced
exhaust emissions.
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
EJ.1 - INTRODUCTION
General Layout
Throttle body
Variable Valve
Timing (VVT)
sprocket hub
Coolant outlet
housing
Water pump
Oil pump
1
285EG0
Oil filter
Acoustic Control
Induction System
(ACIS) butterfly
valve
285EG01
Hydraulic
tappet
finger
post
Primary catalytic
converter
Cross bolted main
bearing cap
Cartridge oil filter
1Y
1MEG1
0
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
e237
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
EJ.1 - INTRODUCTION
Terminology
The powertrain of the Eagle is mounted transversely, with the crankshaft of the engine running parallel
to the rear axle line. The front of the engine is to the right of the engine bay and the rear to the left. When
refering to powertrain components, this logic will be used, e.g. the left hand side of the engine is towards the
front of the engine bay.
General Description
The 2GR-FE engine fitted to the Eagle is supplied by Toyota, and comprises a 3.5 litre 60° V6 unit mounted
transversely (front of the engine towards the right) in the 'mid engine' position between the cabin and rear wheel
axis. The cylinder block/crankcase and cylinder heads are cast in aluminium alloy with the block featuring an
open deck construction and integral cast-in iron liners. The forged steel crankshaft runs in 4 main bearings,
with each of the 3 crankpins accommodating two forged steel connecting rods, those of the RH cylinder bank
foremost. Each cylinder head houses twin overhead camshafts operating two inlet and two exhaust valves
per cylinder, via roller followers mounted in steel fingers, the pivot posts of which provide for zero valve clearances by hydraulic means. The bifurcated ports are arranged with the inlets positioned inside the 'V' and the
exhaust ports outboard. The inlet camshafts are driven by a single roller chain from the crankshaft nose, with
each exhaust cam driven by a short, link chain from its neighbouring inlet camshaft.
In order to optimise power, economy, emissions and noise, the engine control system includes; dual VVT-i
(Variable Valve Timing - intelligent) to provide phase shifting of both inlet and exhaust valve timing; ACIS (Acoustic Control Induction System) to vary the effective intake tract length to the benefit of both high and low speed
power output; ETCS - i (Electronic Throttle Control System - intelligent) to facilitate traction control, skid control
and cruise control; AICS (Air Intake Control System) to reduce intake noise in the low to mid range of engine
speed without sacrificing efficiency at high engine speed. The engine management system is programmed by
Lotus using the T4e controller.
The engine is mated to a type EA60 6-speed manual transmission supplied by Toyota, and installed in
the engine bay with transmission on the left hand side. Primary mountings for the power unit pick up off the
front of the engine and to the top rear of the transmission case, and connect with the suspension towers on the
rear subframe via voided elastic isolators. Secondary engine steady mountings are used to control powertrain
roll under drive torque and inertia effects, and are fitted low down on either side of the block, attaching to the
chassis rear crossmember and to the subframe via elastic isolators.
ej.2 - AIR CLEANER ELEMENT INSPECTION/REPLACEMENT
To inspect the air cleaner element, the airbox cover complete with resonance chamber, may be removed
from the throttle body and air cleaner base unit without disturbing the clamshell.
1.
Remove the LHR wheel.
2.
Release the clamp securing the convoluted intake hose from the airbox to the throttle body.
3.
Release the rear bank cam cover breather hose from the convoluted intake hose.
4.
Release two vacuum hoses from the airbox reservoir, one from an intake tract), the other to the intake flap
valve solenoid.
5.
Unplug the harness connector from the airflow sensor.
6.
From within the LHR wheelarch, remove the access panel in the wheelarch liner and release the two
overcentre clips on the airbox. Unhook the airbox cover from the base and withdraw. Thoroughly clean
the cover.
7.
Clean all around the airbox base before removing the cleaner element, taking care to avoid contaminating
the base unit with dust or dirt. Fit the new element into the base, and refit the cleaned cover, ensuring
that the moulded tongues are fully engaged in the base unit. Fasten the two overcentre clips, and check
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
again for correct mating.
8.
Continue re-assembly in reverse order to removal.
EJ.3 - ENGINE OIL & FILTER CHANGE
The engine oil hex. head drain plug is located in the base of the pressed steel sump. Remove the plug to
drain the sump immediately after a run when the oil is warm and the impurities are still held in suspension.
•
•
•
•
•
WARNING
Engine oil is hazardous to your health and may be fatal if swallowed.
Take all suitable precautions to guard against scalding from the hot oil.
Prolonged and repeated contact with used engine oil may cause serious skin disorders, including dermatitis
and cancer.
Use protective gloves to avoid contact with skin as far as possible and wash skin thoroughly after
any contact.
Keep out of reach of children.
Allow the oil to drain completely before cleaning the drain plug, fitting a new sealing ring, and tightening
securely. Refill with the recommended lubricant (see section OK) via the oil filler on the camshaft cover, to the
top mark on the dipstick, allowing several minutes for the oil to drain through to the sump before checking the
level. Take care not to overfill. Refit the oil filler cap securely, and check the oil level again when the engine
is fully warm.
Oil Filter
The cartridge type oil filter is mounted at the right hand front of the engine, and is accessible only from
beneath. The filter should be renewed along with the engine oil, at intervals specified in the Maintenance
Schedule.
The oil filter housing incorporates a drain plug to minimise potential oil spillage;
Unscrew the drain plug (square socket) from the filter housing cap and collect the small amount of oil
released.
-
Connect a length of 15mm i.d. hose to the drain pipe supplied with the new filter. Insert the pipe into the
base of the filter housing with the ‘O’ ring on the top side of the tube flange, and push upwards until it clicks
into position and opens the spring loaded drain valve. Collect the draining oil.
Remove the drain tube by pulling sideways and down.
Using special tool T000T1511, unscrew the cap from the filter housing. Discard the filter element and filter
cap ‘O’ ring.
Thoroughly clean the filter cap, filter housing and drain plug.
Fit the new ‘O’ ring supplied with the new filter element into the cap groove, and lubricate with engine oil.
Fit the new filter element into the cap, and install the filter and cap into the housing, ensuring that the ‘O’
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
-
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
ring does not become displaced.
Using special tool T000T1511, torque tighten the cap to 25 Nm. Check that there is no clearance between
cap and housing.
Lubricate the small ‘O’ ring supplied with the new filter with engine oil, and fit into the groove in the filter
housing. Fit the filter drain plug and tighten to 13 Nm.
Check the oil level (see above) before starting the engine and restricting to idle speed until the oil pressure
tell tale is extinguished. Check for oil leaks with the engine running. Stop the engine when fully warm
and re-check oil level.
ej.4 - AUXILIARY DRIVE BELT
A single serpentine multi-rib auxiliary belt is used to transfer drive from the crankshaft nose pulley to the
power steering pump, water pump, alternator and a.c. compressor. An automatic type belt tensioner is provided
in the form of an idler pulley mounted on a spring loaded arm. At each service interval, the whole length of belt,
on both the inside and outside surfaces, should be examined for any evidence of perishing,cracking, chafing,
splitting, tearing, delamination, contamination or other indications of undue wear or deterioration. In any cases
of doubt, the belt should be renewed.
Auxiliary Belt Replacement
Remove the RH rear wheel and wheelarch liner.
If the original belt is to be refitted (renewal is recommended), mark the direction of rotation on the belt
before removal.
Using a 14 mm hexagonal socket and long bar, rotate the tensioner pulley counterclockwise to relieve the
tension on the belt.
Align the hole in the arm with the corresponding drilling in the baseplate and insert a 5mm rod or hex. key
to hold the tensioner in the released position.
Slide the belt off the pulleys.
When reinstalling the belt, retain the original direction of rotation, and ensure that the belt ribs are correctly
located on each drive pulley, before finally fitting over the tensioner pulley. Rotate the tensioner counterclockwise to relieve tension and remove the locking pin.
EJ.5 - ENGINE REMOVAL/REPLACEMENT
The engine and/or transmission can be removed only as a combined unit, and should be lifted out from
above after removing the rear clamshell:
1. Preparation: Remove both rear wheels, the diffuser and engine undertray. Remove the rear clamshell
(see sub-section BV.6).
2.
Drain fluids: Drain the transmission oil and the cooling system. De-pressurise fuel system (see sub-section
LN.3). Recover refrigerant gas.
3.
Driveshafts and hub carriers:
At each side:
- Remove the rear brake calliper and support aside without straining the hydraulic hose.
- Disconnect the parking brake cable from the brake backplate.
- Disconnect the wheel speed sensor cable.
- On the RH driveshaft, release the two bolts securing the extension shaft bearing to the engine mounted
bracket.
- Release the fixings securing the top and bottom wishbones and toe-link to the hub carrier.
- Withdraw the complete RH hub carrier and driveshaft assembly, taking care not to damage the transmission output shaft oil seal.
The left hand driveshaft is retained in the transmission by a round section circlip. Use a suitable slide
hammer with a forked adaptor or use pry bar to apply a shock force to the body of the inboard CV joint
to release the driveshaft. DO NOT apply a pulling or extension force to the driveshaft assembly, or the
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
CV joints will be damaged and require replacement. Apply pressure only to the body of the inboard
joint. Withdraw the complete LH hub carrier and driveshaft assembly, taking care not to damage the
transmission output shaft oil seal.
4.
Heat shields: Remove the boot box and battery box heatshields from the subframe.
5.
SBMF struts: Remove both LH and RH struts bracing the Seat Belt Mounting Frame to the subframe to
provide better accesss to the powertrain.
6.
Airbox: Remove the complete intake airbox together with trunking.
7.
Header tank: Release the header tank bracket from the subframe, release the recirc. pump bracket and
hose, heater return hose, radiator return hose and brake servo vacuum hose from the engine, and secure
all plumbing aside.
8.
Purge pipe: Release the purge pipe from the charcoal canister.
9.
Fuel pipe: After checking that the fuel system is de-pressurised, and taking suitable precautions to absorb
residual fuel, disconnect the fuel feed pipe from the fuel rail.
10. Engine harness: From the LH rear corner of the cabin, disconnect the engine harness from the ECU and
release the adjacent earth braid. Feed the cables and grommet through the rear bulkhead.
11. Gearchange cables: Release the gearchange cables from the transmission levers and abutment brackets.
Release any cable guides and restraints.
12. Clutch release: Release the clutch slave cylinder and the bracket securing the flexible hose to the transmission, and place aside without disturbing the hydraulic line.
13. Earth braid: Release the earth braid from the transmission case.
14. Exhaust: Release the exhaust downpipe from the catalytic converter.
15. PAS: Release the feed and return pipes from the PAS pump and collect the draining fluid.
16. A.C.: Disconnect the high and low pressure a.c. pipes from the compressor hoses and plug all ports.
17. Rad. hose: Release the radiator feed hose from the thermostat housing.
18. Hooks: Fit lifting hooks A132E6182S and A132E6183S to the RH front and LH rear of the engine and
support the powertrain on a hoist.
19. Steady mountings: At the left hand side of the engine, remove the connecting clevis bolt. At the right hand
side of the engine, release the isolator mounting bracket from the engine clevis and subframe.
20. Engine mounts: At the transmission end of the powertrain, release the four fixings securing the engine
mounting plate to the subframe LH tower, and the isolator clevis bolt. At the front of the engine, release
the three fixings securing the engine mounting to the subframe RH tower.
21. Hoist: Carefully hoist the powertrain from the chassis, constantly checking for any remaining attachments
or snagging. Place the unit on a flat surface and support securely using wooden chocks as necessary.
Powertrain Replacement
To refit the powertrain, reverse the removal procedure, with the following notes:
Refer to the following torque listing.
Torque tighten the engine isolator bolts only when all four mountings are secured and the hoist is released.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
-
Lotus Service Notes
Section EJ
Re-charge the air conditioning system (see section PN), refill the power steering and cooling systems,
and transmission and engine lubrication.
After re-assembly of the rear suspension, check camber and wheel alignment.
eJ.6 - ENGINE SPECIAL TOOLS
Engine Lifting Hook, RH
Engine Lifting Hook, LH
Wrench Adaptor, oil filter cap
A132E6182S
A132E6183S
T000T1511S
EJ.7 - ENGINE REPAIR
Engine repair information is contained on CD T000T1506 (Toyota SC03T0U) and by following the links:
Insert disc 'XML'
Service Information Directory will automatically open up. If not, open the CD and select:
- rm03t0u
- index HTML
Then;
- Technical Description; New car features
- NM01M0U
- ENGINE
- 2GR-FE ENGINE
Then select from the menu for an overview of the engine features.
Insert disc 'HTML'
Global Service Information Centre will open up. Select:
- ENGINE
From menu section relating to the 2GR-FE engine, select topic required. Be aware of installation differences for the Lotus application.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
ENGINE MANAGEMENT
SECTION EMR
Sub-Section Page
Diagnostic Trouble Code List
EMR.1
3
CAN Bus Diagnostics; Lotus TechCentre
EMR.2
80
Page 1
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Notes
Cylinder Numbering - viewed from above:
LH cylinder bank (2)
6 4 2
Rear of engine
(flywheel end)
5
1
RH cylinder bank (1)
Page 2
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
3
Front of engine
(auxiliary drive
belt end)
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
EMR.1 - DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE (DTC) LIST
DTC Fault description Page
P0011 A Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance - Bank 1 11
P0012 A Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Retarded - Bank 1 11
P0014 B Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance - Bank 1 11
P0015 B Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Retarded - Bank 1 11
P0016 Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation - Bank 1 Sensor A 12
P0017 Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation - Bank 1 Sensor B 12
P0018 Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation - Bank 2 Sensor A 12
P0019 Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation - Bank 2 Sensor B 12
P0021 A Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance - Bank 2 11
P0022 A Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Retarded - Bank 2 11
P0024 B Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance - Bank 2 11
P0025 B Camshaft Position - Timing Over-Retarded - Bank 2 11
P0076 Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low - Bank 1 13
P0077 Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High - Bank 1 13
P0079 Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low - Bank 1 13
P0080 Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High - Bank 1 13
P0082 Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low - Bank 2 13
P0083 Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High - Bank 2 13
P0085 Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low - Bank 2 13
P0086 Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High - Bank 2 13
P0101 Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Range/Performance 14
P0102 Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Low Input 14
P0103 Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit High Input 14
P0106 Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance -
P0107 Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Low Input 16
P0108 Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit High Input 16
P0111 Intake Air Temperature Sensor 1 Circuit Range/Performance P0112 Intake Air Temperature Sensor 1 Circuit Low 17
P0113 Intake Air Temperature Sensor 1 Circuit High 17
P0116 Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range/Performance 19
P0117 Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low 19
P0118 Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High 19
P0122 Throttle Position Sensor 'A' Circuit Low 21
P0123 Throttle Position Sensor 'A' Circuit High 21
P0128 Coolant Thermostat (Coolant Temperature Below Thermostat Regulating Temperature) P0131 O2 Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Pre Catalyst) - Bank1 25
P0132 O2 Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Pre Catalyst) - Bank1 25
P0133 O2 Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Pre Catalyst) - Bank1 25
P0134 O2 Sensor Circuit No Activity Detected (Pre Catalyst) - Bank1 25
P0135 O2 Sensor Heater Circuit (Pre Catalyst) - Bank1 25
P0137 O2 Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Post Catalyst) - Bank1 28
P0138 O2 Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Post Catalyst) - Bank1 28
P0139 O2 Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Post Catalyst) -
P0140 O2 Sensor Circuit No Activity Detected (Post Catalyst) - Bank1 28
P0141 O2 Sensor Heater Circuit (Post Catalyst) - Bank1 28
P0151 O2 Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Pre Catalyst) – Bank2 25
P0152 O2 Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Pre Catalyst) – Bank2 25
P0153 O2 Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Pre Catalyst) – Bank2 25
P0154 O2 Sensor Circuit No Activity Detected (Pre Catalyst) – Bank2 25
P0155 O2 Sensor Heater Circuit (Pre Catalyst) – Bank2 25
P0157 O2 Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Post Catalyst) – Bank2 28
P0158 O2 Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Post Catalyst) – Bank2 28
P0159 O2 sensor Circuit Slow Response (Post Catalyst) Continued........................
Page 3
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
.............Continued
DTC Fault description Page
P0160 O2 Sensor Circuit No Activity Detected (Post Catalyst) – Bank2 28
P0161 O2 Sensor Heater Circuit (post Catalyst) – Bank2 28
P0171 System Too Lean – Bank1 31
P0172 System Too Rich – Bank1 31
P0174 System Too Lean – Bank2 31
P0175 System Too Rich – Bank2 31
P0222 Throttle Position Sensor 'B' Circuit Low 21
P0223 Throttle Position Sensor 'B' Circuit High 21
P0261 Cylinder 1 Injector Circuit Low 33
P0262 Cylinder 1 Injector Circuit High 33
P0264 Cylinder 2 Injector Circuit Low 33
P0265 Cylinder 2 Injector Circuit High 33
P0267 Cylinder 3 Injector Circuit Low 33
P0268 Cylinder 3 Injector Circuit High 33
P0270 Cylinder 4 Injector Circuit Low 33
P0271 Cylinder 4 Injector Circuit High 33
P0273 Cylinder 5 Injector Circuit Low 33
P0274 Cylinder 5 Injector Circuit High 33
P0276 Cylinder 6 Injector Circuit Low 33
P0277 Cylinder 6 Injector Circuit High 33
P0300 Random/Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected 34
P0301 Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected 34
P0302 Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected 34
P0303 Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected 34
P0304 Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected 34
P0305 Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected 34
P0306 Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected 34
P0327 Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low 36
P0328 Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High 36
P0332 Knock Sensor 2 Circuit Low 36
P0333 Knock Sensor 2 Circuit High 36
P0335 Crankshaft Position Sensor “A” Circuit Range/Performance 37
P0341 Camshaft Position Sensor “A” Circuit Range/Performance (Bank 1) 38
P0346 Camshaft Position Sensor “A” Circuit Range/Performance (Bank 2) 38
P0351 Ignition Coil “A” Primary/Secondary Circuit 39
P0352 Ignition Coil “B” Primary/Secondary Circuit 39
P0353 Ignition Coil “C” Primary/Secondary Circuit 39
P0354 Ignition Coil “D” Primary/Secondary Circuit 39
P0355 Ignition Coil “E” Primary/Secondary Circuit 39
P0356 Ignition Coil “F” Primary/Secondary Circuit 39
P0366 Camshaft Position Sensor “B” Circuit Range/Performance (Bank 1) 38
P0391 Camshaft Position Sensor “B” Circuit Range/Performance (Bank 2) 38
P0420 Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 1) 40
P0430 Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 2) 40
P0441 Evaporative Emission System Incorrect Purge Flow P0442 Evaporative Emission System Leak Detected (small leak) P0444 Evaporative Emission System Purge Control Valve Circuit Open 45
P0445 Evaporative Emission System Purge Control Valve Circuit Shorted 45
P0446 Evaporative Emission System Vent Control Circuit P0447 Evaporative Emission System Vent Control Circuit Open P0448 Evaporative Emission System Vent Control Circuit Shorted P0451 Evaporative Emission System Pressure Sensor/Switch Range/Performance P0452 Evaporative Emission System Pressure Sensor/Switch Low Continued........................
Page 4
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
.............Continued
DTC
P0453
P0455
P0456
P0461
P0462
P0463
P0500
P0506
P0507
P0562
P0563
P0601
P0606
P0610
P0628
P0629
P0630
P0638
P0661
P0662
P1301
P1302
P2100
P2102
P2103
P2104
P2105
P2106
P2107
P2108
P2122
P2123
P2127
P2128
P2135
P2138
P2173
Fault description
Evaporative Emission System Pressure Sensor/Switch High
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detected (large leak)
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detected (very small leak)
Fuel Level Sensor “A” Circuit Range/Performance
Fuel Level Sensor “A” Circuit Low
Fuel Level Sensor “A” Circuit High
Vehicle Speed Sensor “A”
Idle Air Control System RPM Lower Than Expected
Idle Air Control System RPM Higher Than Expected
System Voltage Low
System Voltage High
Watchdog
Checksum
Variant Code not Programmed
Fuel Pump Control Circuit Low
Fuel Pump Control Circuit High
VIN not Programmed or Incompatible
Throttle Control Error
Intake Manifold Tuning Valve Control Circuit Low
Intake Manifold Tuning Valve Control Circuit High
Misfire level causing emissions increase
Misfire level causing catalyst system damage
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit/Open
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit Low
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit High
Throttle Actuator Control System – Forced Idle
Throttle Actuator Control System – Forced Engine Shutdown
Throttle Actuator Control System – Forced Limited Power
Throttle Actuator Control Module Processor
Throttle Actuator Control Module Performance
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch "D" Circuit Low
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch "D" Circuit High
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch "E" Circuit Low
Throttle/Pedal Position Sensor/Switch "E" Circuit High
Voltage Correlation Error (Sensors “A” & “B”).
Voltage Correlation Error (Sensors “D” & “E”).
Throttle Actuator Control System – High Airflow Detected
Page
47
47
47
50
51
51
53
53
56
56
57
59
59
60
61
63
63
67
67
69
69
69
70
70
71
71
72
72
73
73
74
74
75
75
Non-MIL Fault codes
P0480 Fan 1 Control Circuit 49
P0481 Fan 2 Control Circuit 49
P0537 A/C Evaporator Temperature Sensor Circuit Low 52
P0538 A/C Evaporator Temperature Sensor Circuit High 52
P0564 Cruise Control Multi-function Input Signal 54
P0571 Brake Switch “A” Circuit 54
P0578 Cruise Control Multi-Function Input “A” Circuit Stuck 54
P0616 Starter Relay Circuit Low 58
P0617 Starter Relay Circuit High 58
P0646 A/C Clutch Relay Control Circuit Low 62
P0647 A/C Clutch Relay Control Circuit High 62
P0806 Clutch Position Sensor Circuit Range/Performance 64
P0807 Clutch Position Sensor Circuit Low 64
P0808 Clutch Position Sensor Circuit High 64
Continued........................
Page 5
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
.............Continued
DTC
P1113
P2602
P2603
P2612
P2613
Fault description
Air Intake Control Valve Circuit
Coolant Pump Control Circuit Low
Coolant Pump Control Circuit High
A/C Refrigerant Distribution Valve Control Circuit Low
A/C Refrigerant Distribution Valve Control Circuit High
Page
66
68
68
76
76
B1422
U0101
U0122
U0127
U0316
A/C Compressor Lock Sensor Circuit
Lost Communications with TCM
Lost Communications with VDCM
Lost Communications with TPMS
Software Incompatible with VDCM
77
78
78
78
79
When applicable, reference may be made under the 'Notes' heading to a page in the Toyota service manual.
This information should be used only for diagnosis and connection detail of the sensor. The Evora uses a
Lotus ECU, the connections for which may be found in circuit diagrams in Section MR. Diagnostic Trouble
Codes should be read using the Lotus TechCentre.
Page 6
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
MR.2 - COMPONENT FUNCTION
Component
Function
Mass Air Flow Meter
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor
Pedal Position Sensor
Barometric Pressure Sensor
O2 Sensor (Front) – Bank 1
O2 Sensor (Front) – Bank 2
O2 Sensor (Rear) – Bank 1
O2 Sensor (Rear) – Bank 2
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Camshaft Position Sensor (Inlet) – Bank 1
Camshaft Position Sensor (Inlet) – Bank 2
Camshaft Position Sensor (Exhaust) – Bank 1
Camshaft Position Sensor (Exhaust) – Bank 2
Knock Sensor – Bank1
Knock Sensor – Bank2
Fuel Level Sensor
Air Conditioning Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Clutch Pedal Position Sensor
Brake Pedal Position Switch
Cruise Control Multi-function Input
Electronic Throttle Control Motor
Injector Circuit – Cylinder 1
Injector Circuit – Cylinder 2
Injector Circuit – Cylinder 3
Injector Circuit – Cylinder 4
Injector Circuit – Cylinder 5
Injector Circuit – Cylinder 6
Ignition Circuit – Cylinder 1
Ignition Circuit – Cylinder 2
Ignition Circuit – Cylinder 3
Ignition Circuit – Cylinder 4
Ignition Circuit – Cylinder 5
Ignition Circuit – Cylinder 6
Variable Valve Timing Actuator (Inlet) – Bank 1
Variable Valve Timing Actuator (Inlet) – Bank 2
Variable Valve Timing Actuator (Exhaust) – Bank 1
Variable Valve Timing Actuator (Exhaust) – Bank 2
Variable Intake Manifold Actuator
Primary Catalyst – Bank 1
Primary Catalyst – Bank 2
Secondary Catalyst
Evaporative Emission Control System Purge Control Valve
Fuel Pump Relay
Starter Relay
Engine load detection
Air temperature detection
Engine coolant temperature detection
Determines engine throttle position
Determines pedal position requested by driver
Barometric pressure detection
Measures oxygen content in exhaust before
bank 1 primary catalyst
Measures oxygen content in exhaust before
bank 1 primary catalyst
Measures oxygen content in exhaust after bank
1 primary catalyst
Measures oxygen content in exhaust after bank
2 primary catalyst
Determines crankshaft position
Determines bank1 inlet camshaft position
Determines bank 2 inlet camshaft position
Determines bank 1 exhaust camshaft position
Determines bank 2 exhaust camshaft position
Determines bank 1 engine detonation
Determines bank 2 engine detonation
Determines fuel tank level
Evaporator temperature detection
Determines clutch pedal position
Determines brake pedal position
Determines driver request for cruise control
Actuates engine throttle
Regulates fuel injected into cylinder 1
Regulates fuel injected into cylinder 2
Regulates fuel injected into cylinder 3
Regulates fuel injected into cylinder 4
Regulates fuel injected into cylinder 5
Regulates fuel injected into cylinder 6
Actuates spark plug in cylinder 1
Actuates spark plug in cylinder 2
Actuates spark plug in cylinder 3
Actuates spark plug in cylinder 4
Actuates spark plug in cylinder 5
Actuates spark plug in cylinder 6
Actuates bank 1 inlet camshaft timing control
Actuates bank 2 inlet camshaft timing control
Actuates bank 1 exhaust camshaft timing
control
Actuates bank 2 exhaust camshaft timing
control
Actuates variable intake manifold
Removes pollutants from exhaust
Removes pollutants from exhaust
Removes pollutants from exhaust
Regulates fuel tank vapour flow into inlet
manifold
Actuates fuel pump
Actuates engine starter motor
Page 7
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Component
Function
Cooling Fan 1 Relay
Cooling Fan 2 Relay
Air Conditioning Control Relay
Air Conditioning Control Valve
Coolant Recirculation Pump
Noise Flap Solenoid
ABS
Battery
Actuates cooling fan 1
Actuates cooling fan 2
Actuates air conditioning compressor
Regulates air conditioning compressor load
Actuates coolant recirculation pump
Actuates air intake flap vacuum control
Provides vehicle wheel speed information
Provides electrical power
Page 8
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
EMR.3 - COMPONENT LOCATION
(O2)
em239
(O2)
(O2)
(O2)
Page 9
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
em240
Page 10
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
emr.4 - Diagnostic guide
Camshaft Timing Control (VVT)
P0011
P0012
P0014
P0015
P0021
P0022
P0024
P0025
Camshaft Position – Inlet Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance (Bank 1)
Camshaft Position – Inlet Timing Over-Retarded (Bank 1)
Camshaft Position – Exhaust Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance (Bank 1)
Camshaft Position – Exhaust Timing Over Retarded (Bank 1)
Camshaft Position – Inlet Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance (Bank 2)
Camshaft Position – Inlet Timing Over-Retarded (Bank 2)
Camshaft Position – Exhaust Timing Over-Advanced or System Performance (Bank 2)
Camshaft Position – Exhaust Timing Over-Retarded (Bank 2)
Description
The Variable Valve Timing system (VVT) on the intake camshafts and the exhaust camshafts can vary the
timing by approximately 35°. The camshaft relative position is varied by a system of vanes mounted on the
drive end of the camshaft. Each VVT oil control valve modulates a spool valve position in accordance with the
drive signal duty cycle, this in turns controls the oil pressure applied to the vanes. A 50% duty cycle applied to
the valve will hold the valve current timing by preventing oil flow from the VVT controller housing, a duty cycle
less than 50% will retard the valve timing, a duty cycle greater then 50% will advance the valve timing. The
ECM regulates this duty cycle based on the feedback signal from the respective camshaft position sensor to
optimise the camshaft timing.
Component connections
Sensor Connector Description
1 Battery Voltage
2 VVT Control Valve Inlet (Bank 1)
1
2
ECU Pin ECU Connector
- B2
48 Way (Centre)
Battery Voltage
VVT Control Valve Exhaust (Bank 1)
- A2
48 Way (Centre)
1 Battery Voltage -
2
VVT Control Valve Inlet (Bank 2)
A3
48 Way (Centre)
1 Battery Voltage -
2
VVT Control Valve Exhaust (Bank 2)
A4
48 Way (Centre)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running > 30 secs
• Coolant temperature > 60°C (140°F)
Disable Criteria:
• P0116, P0117, P0118 – Coolant temperature fault codes
Malfunction Criteria:
• VVT error > 5 degrees for time > 2.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Static valve timing is incorrect
• VVT camshaft actuator failure
• VVT control valve stuck open / closed
• VVT control valve filter
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
Page 11
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Crankshaft Position–Camshaft Position Correlation Error
P0016
P0017
P0018
P0019
Crankshaft position – camshaft position correlation – bank 1 sensor A (Inlet)
Crankshaft position – camshaft position correlation – bank 1 sensor B (Exhaust)
Crankshaft position – camshaft position correlation – bank 2 sensor A (Inlet)
Crankshaft position – camshaft position correlation – bank 2 sensor B (Exhaust)
Description
The crankshaft position sensor is used to identify engine position and speed via a pole wheel mounted on the
front end of the crankshaft. The camshaft position sensor is used to determine camshaft position from a three
vane reluctor on the rear end of the inlet and exhaust camshaft. Fault codes P0016, P0017, P0018, P0019
indicate a mechanical timing error such as incorrectly set, or 'jumped' cam timing.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running (from cranking up to 4 seconds)
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Camshaft out of phase with crankshaft > 16 degrees
Potential failure modes:
• Static valve timing is incorrect
• VVT camshaft actuator failure
• VVT control valve stuck open / closed
• VVT control valve filter
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
Page 12
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Camshaft Timing Control (VVT)
P0076
P0077
P0079
P0080
P0082
P0083
P0085
P0086
Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low (Bank1)
Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High (Bank1)
Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low (Bank1)
Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High (Bank1)
Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low (Bank2)
Intake Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High (Bank2)
Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit Low (Bank2)
Exhaust Valve Control Solenoid Circuit High (Bank2)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P0076, P0079, P0082, P0085 - VVT control valve open circuit or short to ground
• P0077, P0080, P0083, P0086 - VVT control valve circuit short to battery voltage
• ECU output circuit failure
• VVT control valve
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
Page 13
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
-Intake Air Flow
P0101
P0102
P0103
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Range/Performance
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Low Input
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit High Input
Description
The Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor is incorporated into the airbox, and measures both intake air flow rate and
Intake Air Temperature (IAT). The MAF sensor uses a hot wire exposed to the airflow, which is maintained at a
constant temperature by a constant current flow. This is achieved within the sensor unit by varying the voltage
applied to the hot wire. This voltage is the output signal from the MAF sensor.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1
2
3
4
5
Description ECU Pin ECU Connector
IAT Signal J3 48 Way (Centre)
IAT Ground E3 48 Way (Centre)
Battery Voltage - MAF Ground J4 48 Way (Centre)
MAF Signal G1 48 Way (Centre)
Sensor characteristics
0 – 330 g/sec
Typical values: 1.5 – 5.0 g/sec (idle), 5.0 – 15.0 g/sec (2500rpm elevated idle no load)
P0101
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
• Engine speed >1500rpm
• Engine speed < 3510rpm
• Fuel Learns enabled
Disable Criteria:
• P0122, P0123, P0222, P0223 – Throttle/Pedal position fault codes
Malfunction Criteria:
• Measured MAF is compared to a predicted MAF based on current engine conditions.
• Error > 40% for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• MAF meter
• Air induction system
• Air intake hose connections
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
P0102
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Page 14
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Voltage at ECU < 0.52V for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• MAF sensor circuit open
• MAF sensor circuit short to ground
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
P0103
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Voltage at ECU > 4.86V for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• MAF sensor circuit short to ECU supply voltage
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
Page 15
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Barometric Pressure
P0106
P0107
P0108
Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Range/Performance
Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit Low Input
Manifold Absolute Pressure/Barometric Pressure Circuit High Input
Description
The barometric pressure sensor is located internally within the ECU, and measures atmospheric pressure. This
parameter is required to compensate the mass air flow when the vehicle is operated at higher altitudes.
P0106
P0107, P0108
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0107: Voltage at ECU < 1.08V for time > 1.5 secs
• P0108: Voltage at ECU > 4.98V for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if the faults are present for 2 consecutive trips
Page 16
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Intake Air Temperature
P0111 Intake Air Temperature Sensor 1 Circuit Range/Performance
P0112Intake Air Temperature Sensor 1 Circuit Low
P0113Intake Air Temperature Sensor 1 Circuit High
Description
The combined sensor which measures both Mass Air Flow (MAF) and Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is incorporated into the air box. The IAT sensor is a thermistor device which changes resistance with temperature. As
air intake temperature decreases the thermistor resistance value increases, and conversely as air temperature
increases so the thermistor resistance value decreases.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1
2
3
4
5
Description ECU Pin ECU Connector
IAT Signal J3 48 Way (Centre)
IAT Ground E3 48 Way (Centre)
Battery Voltage - MAF Ground J4 48 Way (Centre)
MAF Signal G1 48 Way (Centre)
Sensor characteristics
IAT -20°C (-4°F) 13.6 – 18.4 kΩ
IAT 20°C (68°F) 2.21 – 2.69 kΩ
IAT 60°C (140°F) 0.50 – 0.67 kΩ
P0111
Page 17
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
P0112
Monitor:
• Continuous
Disable Criteria:
• None
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• Inlet air temperature > 119°C (246°F) for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Signal short circuit
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0113
Monitor:
• Continuous
Disable Criteria:
• None
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• Inlet air temperature < –40°C (–104°F) for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Signal open circuit
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Page 18
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section EMR
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Engine Coolant Temperature
P0116
P0117
P0118
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range/Performance
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High
Description
The engine coolant temperature sensor is a thermistor device which changes resistance with temperature. As
coolant temperature decreases the thermistor resistance value increases, and conversely as coolant temperature increases so the thermistor resistance value decreases.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1
2
Description
Ground
Signal
ECU Pin
C3
G2
ECU Connector
48 Way (Centre)
48 Way (Centre)
Sensor characteristics
-20°C (-4°F)
= 13.84 – 16.33 KΩ
20°C (68°F)
= 2.31 – 2.58 KΩ
80°C (176°F)
= 0.310 – 0.326 KΩ
110°C (230°F)
= 0.1399 – 0.1435 KΩ
P0116
Monitor:
• Continuous
Disable Criteria:
• None
Enable Criteria 1:
• Engine running > 1000 seconds
Malfunction Criteria 1:
• Engine coolant temperature < 40°C (104°F)
Enable Criteria 2:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria 2:
• Engine coolant temperature erratic by more than 30°C (54°F)
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor wiring
• Sensor failure
• Thermostat failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0117
Monitor:
• Continuous
Disable Criteria:
• None
Page 19
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• Coolant temperature > 119°C (246°F) for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Signal short circuit
• Sensor failure
• Thermostat failure
• Cooling system problem
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0118
Monitor:
• Continuous
Disable Criteria:
• None
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• Coolant temperature > -38°C (-36°F) for time > 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Signal open circuit
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Page 20
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section EMR
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Throttle Position
P0122
P0123
P0222
P0223
Throttle Position Sensor 'A' Circuit Low
Throttle Position Sensor 'A' Circuit High
Throttle Position Sensor ‘B’ Circuit Low
Throttle Position Sensor ‘B’ Circuit High
Description
The throttle position sensor (TPS) is mounted on the throttle body, and detects the opening angle of the throttle valve. The TPS has 2 sensor circuits, each of which transmits a signal, VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to
detect the throttle valve angle and VTA2 is used to detect malfunctions in VTA1. The sensor signal voltages
vary between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the throttle valve opening angle, and are transmitted to the VTA
terminals of the ECU.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1
2
3
4
5
6
Description ECU Pin ECU Connector
ETB -ve M1 48 Way (Centre)
ETB +ve L2 48 Way (Centre)
Ground
C4 48 Way (Centre)
TPS 1B Signal F3
48 Way (Centre)
TPS 1A/B V Ref E4
48 Way (Centre)
TPS 1A Signal F2 48 Way (Centre)
Sensor characteristics
0% = 0.595 V ± 5%
100% = 4.148 V ± 5%
P0122
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Signal voltage < 0.635V
Potential failure modes:
• Signal short circuit
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
P0123
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Page 21
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Signal voltage > 4.765V
Potential failure modes:
• Signal open circuit
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
P0222
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Signal voltage < 2.146V
Potential failure modes:
• Signal short circuit
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed due to this single code. In the case of multiple
codes, a mechanically sprung 7% opening may be applied.
P0223
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Signal voltage > 4.985V
Page 22
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Potential failure modes:
• Signal open circuit
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed due to this single code. In the case of multiple
codes, a mechanically sprung 7% opening may be applied.
Page 23
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Coolant Thermostat (USA only)
P0128
Coolant Thermostat (Coolant Temperature Below Thermostat Regulating Temperature)
Page 24
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
O2 Sensor (Pre Catalyst)
P0131
P0132
P0133
P0134
P0135
P0151
P0152
P0153
P0154
P0155
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit No Activity Detected (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor 1 Heater Circuit (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit High Voltage (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit Slow Response (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor 1 Circuit No Activity Detected (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor 1 Heater Circuit (Bank 2)
Description
The oxygen sensors separately monitor the oxygen content in the exhaust gases of each bank of the engine.
Each sensor is electrically heated to improve response after start.
The sensor consists of a zirconia electrode between two platinum plates. When zirconia comes into contact with
oxygen, it becomes an electrical conductor. The exhaust gases pass through louvers in the sensor. One plate
is in contact with the outside air and the other plate is in contact with the exhaust gases. The platinum plate in
contact with the air is electrically negative due to the oxygen in the atmosphere and the plate in contact with
the exhaust gases is electrically positive. This will cause a difference in electrical potential to develop between
the two plates. Thus the voltage across the platinum plates ranges approximately from 100 millivolts to 900
millivolts, depending on the oxygen content of the exhaust gases. Thus when the air/fuel mixture is rich, the
oxygen sensor output will be high. If the air/fuel mixture is lean, the oxygen sensor output will be low.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1 Bank 1
2 Bank 1
3 Bank 1
4 Bank 1
Description
Signal
Ground
Heater
Battery Voltage
1 Bank 2
2 Bank 2
3 Bank 2
4 Bank 2
Signal
Ground
Heater
Battery Voltage
ECU Pin ECU Connector
G3 48 Way (Centre)
J2 48 Way (Centre)
H3 48 Way (Centre)
-
G4 48 Way (Centre)
J2 48 Way (Centre)
H4 48 Way (Centre)
- -
Sensor characteristics
Normal operating range is 0 – 1000mV
P0131 (Bank1) or P0151 (Bank2)
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Disable Criteria:
• DFCO (Deceleration Fuel Cut Off)
• AE DE (Acceleration Enrichment Deceleration Enleanment)
• Misfire
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Failure Criteria:
• Sensor voltage < 15mV for more than 1.5 seconds consecutively for a specified number of times.
Page 25
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Potential failure modes:
• Low fuel pressure (Lean mixture)
• Malfunctioning sensor
• External water on sensor
• Sensor wire shorted to ground
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0132 (Bank1) or P0152 (Bank2)
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Disable Criteria:
• None
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• Sensor voltage > 1200V for more than 1.5 seconds consecutively for a specified number of times.
Potential failure modes:
• High fuel pressure (Rich mixture)
• Leaking or shorted injector
• Purge valve fault
• Oxygen sensor contamination
• Engine oil contamination
• Sensor wire shorted to heater voltage
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0133 (Bank1) or P0153 (Bank2)
Monitor:
• Continuous.
Disable Criteria:
• P0116, P0117, P0118
– Coolant temperature sensor faults
• P0101, P0102, P0103
– MAF sensor faults
• P0335, P0500
– Crank or vehicle speed faults
• P0131, P0132, P0134, P0135 – Pre catalyst oxygen sensor faults for Bank1 checks
• P0151, P0152, P0154, P0155 – Pre catalyst oxygen sensor faults for Bank2 checks
Enable Criteria:
• Vehicle speed between 0 – 255 km/h (158.5 mph)
• MAF per stroke between 15 – 48 mg
• Engine speed between 1285 – 1818rpm
• Engine run time > 200 seconds
• Coolant temperature > 60°C (140°F)
• Closed loop fuelling enabled
Monitor:
• Monitored until the required amount of switches (30) in both directions has been achieved or 130 seconds
has elapsed.
Page 26
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the sensor fails to switch from a Lean to a Rich condition or switch from a Rich to a Lean condition
in a sufficiently timely manner. A selection of switches is used to determine the average times.
“highlighted section removed”
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor connector and wiring should be checked for corrosion and loose connections
• Sensor contaminated, possibly from fuel, improper use of RTV, engine oil or coolant
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0134 (Bank1) or P0154 (Bank2)
Monitor:
• Until either passed or failed.
Enable Criteria:
• Engine run time > 30 seconds
• Engine is not at idle
• Engine is in closed loop fuel control
• O2 sensor ready
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the sensor fails to switch above 673mV and below 400mV within a 60 second period.
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor connector and wiring should be checked for corrosion and loose connections.
• Gas leak in exhaust system
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0135, P0155
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine run time > 20 seconds
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the heater output is greater than 1900mA or less than 250mA for 1.5 seconds, for 40 consecutive
checks.
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor connector and wiring should be checked for corrosion and loose connections.
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Page 27
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
O2 Sensor (Post Catalyst)
P0137
P0138
P0139
P0140
P0141
P0157
P0158
P0159
P0160
P0161
O2 Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor Circuit No Activity Detected (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor Heater Circuit (Bank 1)
O2 Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor Circuit No Activity Detected (Bank 2)
O2 Sensor Heater Circuit (Bank 2)
Description
The oxygen sensors separately monitor the oxygen content in the exhaust gases of each bank of the engine.
Each sensor is electrically heated to improve response from start.
The sensor consists of a zirconia electrode between two platinum plates. When zirconia comes into contact with
oxygen, it becomes an electrical conductor. The exhaust gases passes through louvers in the sensor. One plate
is in contact with the outside air and the other plate is in contact with the exhaust gases. The platinum plate in
contact with the air is electrically negative due to the oxygen in the atmosphere and the plate in contact with
the exhaust gases is electrically positive. This will cause a difference in electrical potential to develop between
the two plates. Thus the voltage across the platinum plates ranges approximately from 100 millivolts to 900
millivolts, depending on the oxygen content of the exhaust gases. Thus when the air/fuel mixture is rich, the
oxygen sensor output will be high. If the air/fuel mixture is lean, the oxygen sensor output will be low. The post
catalyst oxygen sensor performance is a good indicator of catalyst efficiency.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1 Bank 1
2 Bank 1
3 Bank 1
4 Bank 1
Description
Signal
Ground
Heater
Battery Voltage
1 Bank 2
2 Bank 2
3 Bank 2
4 Bank 2
Signal
Ground
Heater
Battery Voltage
ECU Pin ECU Connector
H1 48 Way (Centre)
K4 48 Way (Centre)
K1
48 Way (Centre)
-
H2 48 Way (Centre)
K4 48 Way (Centre)
K2 48 Way (Centre)
- -
Sensor characteristics
Normal operating range is 0 – 1000mV
P0137, P0157
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• DFCO (Deceleration Fuel Cut Off)
• AE DE (Acceleration Enrichment or Deceleration Enleanment)
• Misfire
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the sensor operates below 15mV for more than 1.5 seconds consecutively for a specified number
of times.
Page 28
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Potential failure modes:
• Check and rectify any pre catalyst sensor fault code, as they may be causing the fault code to be set
• Sensor wire shorted to ground
• Catalyst
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0138, P0158
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the sensor operates above 1200mV for more than 1.5 seconds consecutively for a specified
number of times.
Potential failure modes:
• Check and rectify any front sensor fault code, as they may be causing the fault code to be set
• Catalyst
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0139, P0159
Page 29
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
P0140, P0160
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine run time > 30 seconds
• Engine is not at idle
• Engine is in closed loop fuel control
• Oxygen sensors ready
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the sensor fails to switch above 673mV and below 400mV within 60 seconds.
Potential failure modes:
• Check and rectify any front sensor fault code, as they may be causing the fault code to be set
• Sensor connector and wiring should be checked for corrosion and loose connections
• Catalyst
• Gas leak in exhaust system
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0141, P0161
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine run time > 20 seconds
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Set when the heater output is greater than 1900mA or less than 250mA for 1.5 seconds, for 40 consecutive
checks.
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor connector and wiring should be checked for corrosion and loose connections
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 30
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Fuel Control System Too Lean Or Rich
P0171
P0172
P0174
P0175
System Too Lean (Bank 1)
System Too Rich (Bank 1)
System Too Lean (Bank 2)
System Too Rich (Bank 2)
Description
The oxygen sensor sends a signal to the ECU corresponding to the exhaust gas oxygen content enabling the
ECU to maintain a 14.7:1 air/fuel ratio under normal driving conditions. The ECU can make fuel corrections of
± 30% to the calculated fuel demand. This value is then learned by the ECU over time. If the ECU determines
a rich condition exists (oxygen sensor above 450mV), it will decrease the calculated fuel demand to maintain
a 14.7:1 ratio. If the ECU determines a lean condition exists (oxygen sensor below 450mV), it will increase the
calculated fuel demand to maintain a 14.7:1 ratio.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Fuel Trim condition enabled
• Closed loop fuelling enabled
• MAF < 28 g/sec
• Altitude < 8000 ft (2438 m), Baro > 756 mbar
Disable Criteria P0171 & P0172:
• P0106, P0107, P0108
• P0131, P0135
• P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303
• P0111, P0112, P0113
– Baro sensor faults
– Oxygen sensor faults
– Misfire faults
– Intake air temperature faults
Disable Criteria P0174 & P0175:
• P0106, P0107, P0108
• P0151, P0155
• P0300, P0304, P0305, P0306
• P0111, P0112, P0113
– Baro sensor faults
– Oxygen sensor faults
– Misfire faults
– Intake air temperature faults
Malfunction Criteria P0171 & P0174:
• These codes will set when the relevant engine bank learned fuel correction has been increased to its maximum
limit of 25% and the system still cannot maintain an air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 under normal driving conditions.
• These codes will also be set if the relevant bank fuel learn injector dead time is greater than 450 micro
seconds.
Potential failure modes:
• Fuel Pressure too low (restriction in fuel line)
• Air leak in induction system
• Water in fuel
• Exhaust leak / crack before front oxygen sensor
• Injector fault
• Sensor connector and wiring for signs of corrosion or loose connections
• MAF fault
• Vehicle has previously run out of fuel
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 31
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Malfunction Criteria P0172, P0175:
• These codes will be set when the relevant bank learned fuel correction has been decreased to its minimum
limit of -25% and the system still cannot maintain an air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 under normal driving conditions.
• These codes will also be set if the relevant bank fuel learn injector dead time is less than -450 micro seconds.
Potential failure modes:
• Fuel pressure too high
• Leaking fuel injector
• Restriction in the exhaust system or air intake / filter
• Erratic throttle position sensor
• MAF fault
• O2 sensor fault
• Ignition fault
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 32
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Fuel Injection System
P0261
P0262
P0264
P0265
P0267
P0268
P0270
P0271
P0273
P0274
P0276
P0277
Injector Circuit low voltage – Cylinder 1
Injector Circuit high voltage – Cylinder 1
Injector Circuit low voltage – Cylinder 2
Injector Circuit high voltage – Cylinder 2
Injector Circuit low voltage – Cylinder 3
Injector Circuit high voltage – Cylinder 3
Injector Circuit low voltage – Cylinder 4
Injector Circuit high voltage – Cylinder 4
Injector Circuit low voltage – Cylinder 5
Injector Circuit high voltage – Cylinder 5
Injector Circuit low voltage – Cylinder 6
Injector Circuit high voltage – Cylinder 6
Description
The ECU has six injector driver circuits, each of which controls an injector. When the engine is running the
ECU continuously monitors the injector circuit feedback signals. The monitored feedback signal should be low
voltage when the injector is ON and high voltage when the injector is OFF.
Component connections
Injector ECU Pin
1
H4
2
H3
3
H2
4
H1
5
G4
6
G3
ECU Connector
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor connector or wiring corroded or loose connections
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Limp home:
• Limit maximum engine speed to 4000rpm
• Return the fuel system of the affected bank to open loop fuel control
Notes:
If an injector goes short circuit it is likely that the ECU injector driver will be damaged.
Page 33
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Misfire
P0300
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
P0305
P0306
Random/Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
Cylinder 5 Misfire Detected
Cylinder 6 Misfire Detected
Description
A misfiring cylinder can be detected by analysing crank speed variation. As a result of a combustion event there
will be a net acceleration of the crankshaft. Subsequent to a misfire event the engine will decelerate over the
period following the missed cylinder event.
Speed changes can be characterised by observing changes in the time period for a fixed angle of rotation after
firing events. A significant change in this period, assessed by comparison to previous periods, may be attributed
to misfire on a known cylinder.
Component connections
Connector Description ECU Pin
1 Supply Voltage Coil 1 Coil 2 Coil 3 Coil 4 Coil 5 Coil 6
2 Ignition Coil Feedback
D2
D2
D2
D2
D2
D2
3 Coil Output (Logic)
F4
F3
F2
F1
E4
E3
4 Ground
ECU Connector
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
Malfunction Criteria
The operation of all the misfire codes is the same, the last digit relates to the misfire involved i.e. a code P0303
indicates there is a problem with cylinder number 3.
P0300 indicates the misfire is random and not linked to one particular cylinder.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Battery voltage between 10 – 16 V
• Coolant temperature between -10 – 120°C (14 – 248°F)
• Engine speed between 480 – 8010rpm
• Engine speed transient > 15rpm
• Altitude < 8000 ft (2438 m) / Baro > 756mbar
• Fuel level > 5 litres (1.3 US gallons)
• Engine load greater than 14 – 25% depending on engine speed
Disable Criteria:
• DFCO enabled (Deceleration Fuel Cut Off)
• Rough road
• MAF faults
Malfunction Criteria:
• Individual cylinder misfire in excess of 10% of total engine misfire
• P300 set when more than one cylinder misfiring or when CAM error MIL requested
Limp home (depends on severity and number of cylinders affected):
• Throttle limited and engine continues to run on all cylinders
• Fuel system set to open loop control
• Affected bank shut down and engine speed limited to 4000 rpm
Page 34
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Potential failure modes:
• Injectors or related codes
• VVT system (clearance or timing) or related codes
• MAF meter or related codes
• Connectors and wiring for signs of corrosion or loose connections
• Spark plug / coil / cylinder compression
• PCV system / hoses
• Fuel pressure
• Coolant temperature sensor
• Vacuum hoses
• ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 35
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Knock Control System
P0327
P0328
P0332
P0333
Knock Sensor Circuit Low (Bank 1)
Knock Sensor Circuit High (Bank 1)
Knock Sensor Circuit Low (Bank 2)
Knock Sensor Circuit High (Bank 2)
Description
The knock sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it becomes deformed. The
piezoelectric element sends continuously sends a signal to the ECU, when the cylinder block vibrates due to
engine knocking this signal increases. The ECU is able to identify each cylinder. If knock is detected then the
ECU will retard the ignition of the relevant cylinder to suppress it.
The knock control sensor cannot differentiate between spark knock and other similar sounding noises.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1 Bank 1
2 Bank 1
Description
Sensor input
Ground
3 Bank 2
4 Bank 2
Sensor input
Ground
ECU Pin
D1
C1
D2
C2
ECU Connector
48 Way (Centre)
48 Way (Centre)
48 Way (Centre)
48 Way (Centre)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0327 – This code is set when the bank 1 knock sensor signal is < 0.586 V
• P0328 – This code is set when the bank 1 knock sensor signal is > 2.932 V
• P0332 – This code is set when the bank 2 knock sensor signal is < 0.586 V
• P0333 – This code is set when the bank 2 knock sensor signal is > 2.932 V
Potential failure modes:
• Abnormal engine noise, i.e. damaged engine or exhaust system contacting vehicle
• Knock sensor fixing too tight
• Sensor connector / wiring corroded or loose connections
• ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 36
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Engine Speed / Position Sensors
P0335 Crankshaft Position Sensor “A” Circuit Range/Performance
Description
Engine speed is calculated by measuring the time between the ‘teeth’ of the crankshaft sensor trigger disc. The
disc has 34 ‘teeth’ and 2 missing ‘teeth’, spaced at 10 degree intervals around the disc. The 2 missing ‘teeth’
are positioned at 225 degrees before cylinder No.1 and 4 TDC. The crankshaft sensor signal is also used to
determine misfires events.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1
2
Description
Sensor input
Ground
ECU Pin
A4
B2
ECU Connector
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• 15 crank errors in succession. This can occur due to no crank signal occurring whilst the cams continue to
count or if there is a measured consecutive crank error.
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor signal open circuit or short to ground
• Sensor ground open circuit
• Sensor failure
• Crankshaft sensor plate
• ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if this fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Notes:
If a sensor or sensor circuit failure occurs, the engine will not fire or start.
Page 37
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Engine Speed / Position Sensors
P0341
P0346
P0366
P0391
Camshaft Position Sensor “A” Circuit (Bank 1)
Camshaft Position Sensor “A” Circuit (Bank 2)
Camshaft Position Sensor “B” Circuit (Bank 2)
Camshaft Position Sensor “B” Circuit (Bank 2)
Description
The camshaft position input to the ECU is used to determine engine phase, enable sequential fuel injection
control and to determine camshaft position for VVT control. The inlet camshaft has three ‘teeth’ spaced 90°
apart, which are detected by the electromagnetic sensor. The valve timing setting is measured in the ECU by
measuring time from a (fixed position) crankshaft tooth to a (variable position) camshaft tooth. As the engine
speed and the position is known from the crankshaft sensor signal, the camshaft position can be calculated.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector
1 Inlet Bank 1
2 Inlet Bank 1
3 Supply voltage
1 Exhaust Bank 1
2 Exhaust Bank 1
3 Supply voltage
1 Inlet Bank 2
2 Inlet Bank 2
3 Supply voltage
1 Exhaust Bank 2
2 Exhaust Bank 2
3 Supply voltage
Description ECU Pin
Signal
A3
Ground
B3
5V
D1
Signal D4
Ground C3
5V
D1
Signal A2
Ground C2
5V
D1
Signal D3
Ground C4
5V
D1
ECU Connector
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
• Engine speed > 600rpm
• Engine runtime > 4 secs
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• 15 revolutions of crankshaft without receiving camshaft signal
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor signal open circuit or short to ground
• Sensor ground open circuit
• Sensor failure
• Cam failure
• Camshaft position plate
• ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Notes:
Fault code P0341 will also be generated if the vehicle fails security checks on start up.
Page 38
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Ignition System
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
P0355
P0356
Ignition Coil “A” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition Coil “B” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition Coil “C” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition Coil “D” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition Coil “E” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Ignition Coil “F” Primary/Secondary Circuit
Description
A Direct Ignition System (DIS) is used on the engine. The DIS improves the ignition accuracy, reduces highvoltage loss, and enhances the reliability of the ignition system. The DIS is a 1-cylinder system that ignites one
cylinder with one ignition coil. The ECU determines the ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGT) for
each cylinder. Based on IGT signals, the power transistors in the igniter cuts off the current to the primary coil,
which induces a spark at the spark plug connected to the secondary coil. The igniter will also send an ignition
confirmation signal (IGF) as a fail-safe measure to the ECU.
Component connections
Connector Pin Description ECU Pin
1 Supply Voltage Coil 1 Coil 2 Coil 3 Coil 4 Coil 5 Coil 6
2 Ignition Coil Feedback
D2 D2
D2 D2 D2
D2
3 Coil Output (Logic)
F4 F3
F2 F1 E4
E3
4 Ground
ECU Connector
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Malfunction Criteria:
• No IGF signal to ECM while engine is running
Potential failure modes:
• Open or short in IGF1 – IGF6 circuits from ignition coil to ECU
• Coil failure
• ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 39
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Catalyst System Efficiency
P0420
P0430
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 1)
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold (Bank 2)
Description
The ECU compares the waveform of the oxygen sensors located before and after the catalyst to determine
whether or not the catalyst has deteriorated. If the catalyst is functioning normally the front oxygen sensor will
be switching between rich and lean whilst the rear oxygen sensor should also be switching between rich and
lean but more slowly. When both the oxygen sensor waveforms change at a similar rate, it indicates that the
catalyst performance has deteriorated. The ECU counts the number of pre and post catalyst oxygen sensor
switches and divides one by the other to determine a ratio. If this ratio is too high a fault will be indicated.
Sensor connections
Pre catalyst oxygen sensor
Sensor Connector Description
1 Bank 1 Signal
2 Bank 1 Ground
3 Bank 1 Heater Supply
4 Bank 1 Battery Voltage
1 Bank 2
2 Bank 2
3 Bank 2
4 Bank 2
Signal
Ground
Heater Supply
Battery Voltage
Post catalyst oxygen sensor
Sensor Connector Description
1 Bank 1 Signal
2 Bank 1 Ground
3 Bank 1 Heater Supply
4 Bank 1 Battery Voltage
1 Bank 2
2 Bank 2
3 Bank 2
4 Bank 2
ECU Pin ECU Connector
G3 48 Way (Centre)
J2 48 Way (Centre)
H3 48 Way (Centre)
-
G4
J2
H4
-
48 Way (Centre)
48 Way (Centre)
48 Way (Centre)
-
ECU Pin ECU Connector
H1 48 Way (Centre)
K4 48 Way (Centre)
K1 48 Way (Centre)
-
-
Signal
Ground
Heater Supply
Battery Voltage
H2 48 Way (Centre)
K4 48 Way (Centre)
K2 48 Way (Centre)
-
-
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Closed loop fuel control enabled
• Coolant temperature > 60 °C (140 °F)
• Baro > 756 mbar
• Vehicle speed < 130 km/h (81 mph)
• MAF < 48 g/sec & MAF > 2 g/sec
• Air inlet temp > -10°C (14°F)
• Accumulated Mass Air > 2000-4080 grams depending on coolant temperature
Page 40
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Disable Criteria:
• P0101, P0102, P0103
– MAF faults
• P0107, P0108
– MAP / Baro Faults
• P0116, P0117, P0118
– Coolant temperature faults
• P0131, P0132, P0133, P0134, P0135, P0137, P0138, P0139, P0140, P0141 – Oxygen sensor faults B1
• P0151, P0152, P0153, P0154, P0155, P0157, P0158, P0159, P0160, P0161 – Oxygen sensor faults B2
• P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175
– Fuelling faults B1 / B2
• P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306
– Misfire faults
• P0500
– Speed sensor fault
Malfunction Criteria:
• Switch ratio between Pre & Post catalytic converter O2 sensors > 0.6
Potential failure modes:
• Exhaust system leak
• Oxygen sensor faults
• Oxygen sensor heater failure
• Catalyst failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Page 41
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Evaporative Emission Control – Leak Detection System
P0441
P0442
P0455
P0456
Evaporative Emission System Incorrect Purge Flow
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detected (small leak)
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detected (large leak)
Evaporative Emission System Leak Detected (very small leak)
Page 42
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section EMR
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Page 43
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 44
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section EMR
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Evaporative Emission Control – Purge, Open / Closed Circuit
P0444
P0445
P0446
P0447
P0448
P0451
P0452
P0453
Evaporative Emission System Purge Control Valve Circuit Open
Evaporative Emission System Purge Control Valve Circuit Closed
Evaporative Emission System Vent Control Circuit
Evaporative Emission System Vent Control Circuit Open
Evaporative Emission System Vent Control Circuit Closed
Evaporative Emission System Pressure Sensor/Switch Range/Performance
Evaporative Emission System Pressure Sensor/Switch Low
Evaporative Emission System Pressure Sensor/Switch High
Description
When the engine is running the ECU continuously monitors the status of the evaporative emission components
for open circuit or short. The feedback signal should be low when turned ON and high when turned OFF. The
following codes will be set if the above conditions are not met.
P0444, P0445
Sensor / component connections
Purge Solenoid
Connector Pins Description
1 Battery Voltage
2 Solenoid Output
ECU Pin
-
B3
ECU Connector
48 Way (Centre)
Potential failure modes:
• P0444 Purge valve/wiring open circuit
• P0445 Purge valve short circuit
Diagnostic mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Page 45
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 46
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section EMR
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Fuel Level Sensor
P0461
P0462
P0463
Fuel Level Sensor “A” Circuit Range/Performance
Fuel Level Sensor “A” Circuit Low
Fuel Level Sensor “A” Circuit High
Description
When the engine is running the ECU continuously monitors the fuel level sensor feedback signals. The feedback
signal should be low when turned ON and high when turned OFF. The following codes will be set if the above
conditions are not meet.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector Description
1
2 Fuel level sensor
3 Fuel level sensor ground.
ECU Pin
ECU Connector
A2
K3
48 Way (Right)
48 Way (Right)
P0462, P0463
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine Running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0462 – Voltage < 0.020V, P0463 – Voltage > 0.684V for 1.5 secs
Potential failure modes:
• Sensor open or short circuit
• Fuel level sensor
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
P0461
The ECU calculates the fuel usage and determines whether the fuel level sensor has responded correctly to
this usage. The ECU also monitors the filtered and unfiltered signal at idle after a 20 second de-slosh period
and compares the differences.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria 1:
• Vehicle Idling
• Vehicle stationary for 20 seconds
Disable Criteria 1:
• Fuel level < 3.3 litres (0.9 US gallons)
Malfunction Criteria 1:
• Signal fluctuation > 10 litres, 35 times over 7 second period
Page 47
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Enable Criteria 2:
• 12 litres fuel usage in upper region
• 10 litres fuel usage in lower region
• 5 litres fuel usage in mid region
Disable Criteria:
• Vehicle stopped for 30 secs
Malfunction Criteria:
• Checks for three conditions, stuck when full, stuck when empty or stuck midway. The ECU determines if the
sensor is stuck by calculating the amount of fuel used during the test period. If the fuel level does not move by
more than 1 litre a fault is flagged.
Potential failure modes:
• Fuel level sensor wiring or connector corroded
• Fuel level sensor stuck
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if these faults are present for 2 consecutive trips.
Page 48
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Engine Cooling Fan Control
P0480
P0481
Fan 1 Control Circuit
Fan 2 Control Circuit
Component connections
Sensor Connector Description
Fan Relay 3
Fan Relay 2
ECU Pin
F1
E2
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
48 Way (Right)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Wiring harness problem
• Relay
• ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 49
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Vehicle Speed Sensor
P0500 Vehicle Speed Sensor “A”
Description
This input to the ECU is from the ABS module via CAN.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Following conditions must occur for 5 seconds
• Engine speed > 1800rpm and < 5010rpm
• Baro > 756 mbar
• Engine in a mode that indicates that the vehicle must be moving.
Malfunction Criteria:
• KMH < 5 kmh
Potential failure modes:
• ABS module failure
• CAN bus communication error to ABS controller
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 50
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Idle Speed Control
P0506 Idle Air Control System RPM Lower Than Expected
P0507 Idle Air Control System RPM Higher Than Expected
Description
The ECM controls the engine idle speed using a combination of spark advance and throttle blade adjustment.
If this control cannot attain the desired idle speed a fault is diagnosed.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine at idle speed
• Battery voltage between 10 V and 16 V
Malfunction Criteria 1:
• Idle air learn value on upper limit of +1.8g/s
• Idle speed more than 200 rpm above desired idle speed for more than 5 seconds.
Malfunction Criteria 2:
• Idle air learn value on lower limit of -1.8g/s
• Idle speed more than 100 rpm below desired idle speed for more than 5 seconds.
Potential failure modes:
• Induction system air leak
• Excessive engine load from front end accessory drive system, water pump, power steering, alternator
• Electronic Throttle Control
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for 2 consecutive trips.
Notes:
There will be a different learn value for AC on and AC off. Either could trigger fault
Page 51
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
A/C Evaporator temperature sensor
P0537
P0538
A/C Evaporator temperature sensor circuit low
A/C Evaporator temperature sensor circuit high
Description
The A/C system incorporates an evaporator temperature sensor for system control. This is a thermistor device
that changes resistance with temperature. As the evaporator temperature decreases the thermistor resistance
value increases, and conversely as the evaporator temperature increases so the thermistor resistance value
decreases.
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector Description ECU Pin
1 Sensor signal A3
1 Sensor ground K3
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
48 Way (Right)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Vehicle Running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0537 – Signal voltage < 0.049V for 1.5 seconds
• P0538 – Signal voltage > 4.399V for 1.5 seconds
Potential failure modes:
• Thermistor wiring open circuit or shorted
• Thermistor fault
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 52
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Battery Voltage
P0562
P0563
System Voltage Low
System Voltage High
Description
With a battery and alternator functioning as normal the system voltage for a running engine should be around
14V. The ECM monitors this and will diagnose if the voltage is too high or too low.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0562 – Voltage Too Low < 10V for 10 seconds
• P0563 – Voltage Too High > 16V for 25.5 seconds
Potential failure modes:
• Alternator fault
• Battery fault
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 53
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Cruise Control
P0564
P0578
P0571
Cruise control multi-function input signal
Cruise control multi-function input “A” circuit stuck
Brake switch “A” circuit
Description
Cruise control requests are made using a multi-function switch input. Each cruise control function switch selects
a different resistive network to a single ECM input. From this input the ECM determines the driver request.
In addition cruise control is cancelled by the application of either the brake pedal or the clutch pedal (see also
P0806, P0807 and P0808).
Sensor connections
Sensor Connector Description
1 Cruise control switch input
2 Cruise control ground
ECU Pin
E3
K3
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
48 Way (Right)
1
2
-
C4
48 Way (Right)
Brake Switch Ground
Brake Switch Input
P0564, P0578
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0564 – Cruise control multifunction switch open circuit or short circuit
• P0578 – Input other than OFF received for more than 100 seconds
Potential failure modes:
• Cruise switch wiring open circuit or shorted
• Cruise switch fault
• ECU input circuit fault
Notes:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
P0571
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria 1:
• KMH > 10 kmh
• PPS > 0.488%
Enable Criteria 2:
• ABS communications working
Disable Criteria:
• None
Page 54
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Malfunction Criteria 1:
• Brake switch on for greater than 25.5 seconds
Malfunction Criteria 2:
• ABS indicating brakes are on but brake switch off for greater than 0.5 seconds
Potential failure modes:
• Brake switch wiring open circuit or shorted
• Brake switch fault
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 55
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
ECU Integrity
P0601
P0606
Checksum
Watchdog
Description
These codes are used by the ECU to check the integrity of the software and calibration data.
P0601 checks that on power up the checksum for calibration data is the same as checksum saved on the
previous power down.
P0606 checks the watchdog timer after a defined period to see if it has reset. If the watchdog timer has not
reset then the code has entered an unplanned loop or condition stopping it resetting the timer.
Monitor
• P0601 at ECU power up
• P0606 continuously while the engine running
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present.
Page 56
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Variant Code Not Programmed
P0610
Variant code not programmed
Description
The ECM programming process includes the Vehicle Variant Code. If a new ECM has been fitted, the relevant
variant code needs to be programmed using the Lotus TechCentre tool.
Monitor
• During start up
Disable criteria
• None
Potential failure modes
• Variant code not programmed
Diagnostic mask
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
Page 57
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Crank Relay
P0616
P0617
Starter relay voltage low
Starter relay voltage high
Description
When the ignition key is in the crank position battery voltage is applied to the start request input of the ECM.
The ECM will then energise the crank relay, via the immobiliser, to allow the starter motor to be engaged.
ECM diagnosis is only carried out on the crank relay.
Component connections
Relay Connector Description ECU Pin
2 Main relay via fuse R1 -
4 Crank relay control G1
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P0616 – Crank relay wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P0616 – Fuse R1
• P0617 – Crank relay wiring shorted to 12V
• Crank relay failure
• Immobiliser failure
• ECU output circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 58
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Fuel Pump Relay
P0628
P0629
Fuel Pump “A” Control Circuit Low Voltage
Fuel Pump “A” Control Circuit High Voltage
Description
The fuel system is of the non-return type. The fuel pump is incorporated into the fuel tank module, which also
contains the level sensor, fuel pressure regulator and vapour pressure sensor. The ECM controls the fuel pump
operation via a relay, because of this the only fault diagnosis is of the fuel pump relay.
Component connections
Relay connector Description
1 Rear ignition relay (fuse R7)
2 Fuel pump relay control
ECU Pin
-
H2
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Ignition on
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P0628 fuel pump relay wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P0628 fuse R7
• P0629 fuel pump relay wiring shorted to 12V
• Fuel pump relay failure
• ECU output circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated immediately if a fault is present.
Page 59
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
VIN Not Programmed or Incompatible – ECU/PCM
P0630
Vin not programmed or incompatible
Description
The ECM programming process includes the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). If a new ECM has been fitted
this operation is performed using the Lotus TechCentre tool.
Monitor:
• During start up
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running (for up to 4 seconds)
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• VIN not programmed
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
Page 60
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Throttle Actuator Control Range/Performance
P0638
Throttle actuator control range/performance
Description
The single throttle butterfly valve mounted at the inlet to the intake plenum is operated by a stepper motor under
the command of the engine ECU. The valve moves through a range of nearly 90° and should display 100% at
full throttle and around 2% at idle.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria 1:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria 1:
• Electronic throttle fault P2135, P0122, P0122, P0222 or P0223 present
• Throttle demand transient condition
Malfunction Criteria 1:
• TPS error > 3% for 7.5 secs
Enable Criteria 2:
• Ignition on
Disable Criteria 2:
• Electronic throttle fault P2135, P0122, P0122, P0222 or P0223 present
Malfunction Criteria 2:
• Throttle not able to find closed position during boot
Potential failure modes:
• Blocked throttle body
• Damage to throttle actuator
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if fault is present.
Notes: A mechanically sprung 7% throttle opening may be imposed.
Page 61
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Air Conditioning System
P0646
P0647
A/C Clutch Relay Control Circuit Low
A/C Clutch Relay Control Circuit High
Description
The ECM controls the A/C clutch relay in response to the A/C driver request and ECM control logic.
Component connections
Relay Connector Description
1 Ignition supply (fuse R11)
2 AC clutch relay control
ECU Pin
ECU Connector
F2
48 Way (Right)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P0646 – A/C compressor relay wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P0646 – Fuse R11
• P0647 – A/C compressor relay circuit shorted to 12V
• A/C compressor relay failure
• ECU output circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 62
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Variable intake manifold circuit
P0661
P0662
Variable intake manifold circuit voltage low
Variable intake manifold circuit voltage high
Description
This circuit opens and closes the variable intake manifold (VIM) in response to changes in the engine speed
and load in order to increase the intake efficiency.
When the engine speed is less than 4200 rpm and the engine load is greater than 52%, the ECM turns on the
VIM control valve to close the VIM. Under all other conditions, the VIM control valve is usually off and the VIM
is open.
Component connections
Connector Description
1 Ignition supply (fuse R8)
2 VIM control valve control
ECU Pin
-
L4
ECU Connector
48 Way (Central)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P0661 – VIM wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P0661 – Fuse R8
• P0662 – VIM circuit, ECM side, shorted to battery voltage
• VIM control valve failure
• ECU output circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The MIL will be illuminated if a fault is present for two consecutive trips.
Page 63
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Clutch position sensor circuit
P0806
P0807
P0808
Clutch position sensor circuit range/performance
Clutch position sensor circuit low
Clutch position sensor circuit high
Description
The clutch position sensor is used to identify the position of the clutch (engaged, disengaged or slipping). This
information is used to control features such as fuel cut during gear changes, cruise control deactivation and
ensuring any torque increase requests from the ESP system only occur with the clutch engaged.
The ECM continuously monitors the clutch position sensor input for malfunctions.
Component connections
Connector Description
A Ground
B Clutch position sensor signal
C Reference voltage
ECU Pin
K3
B1
F4
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
48 Way (Right)
48 Way (Right)
P0806
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Maximum and minimum clutch position measured over 15 gear changes
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• Voltage difference between maximum and minimum of less than 2.101V
Potential failure modes:
• Clutch sensor failure
• Clutch pedal failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
P0807, P0808
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Malfunction Criteria:
• P0807 – Sensor voltage < 0.098V
• P0808 – Sensor voltage > 4.790V
Page 64
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Potential failure modes:
• P0807 – Clutch sensor wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P0808 – Clutch sensor ECU input circuit shorted to 5V or 12V
• Clutch sensor failure
• Clutch pedal failure
• ECU input circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 65
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Air intake control valve circuit
P1113
Air intake control valve circuit
Description:
The air cleaner is equipped with 2 inlets, one of which is opened or closed by the Air Intake Control Valve (AICV).
This system reduces intake noise and increases engine power.
When the engine is operating in the low-to-mid speed range, the ECM deactivates the Vacuum Solenoid Valve
(VSV) and allows the AICV to close one of the air cleaner inlets. When the engine speed is greater than a
specified value the ECM activates the VSV and the applied vacuum activates the AICV to open both of the air
cleaner inlets.
Component connections
Connector Description
1 Ignition supply (fuse R8)
2 VSV control
ECU Pin
-
B1
ECU Connector
48 Way (Central)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• VSV open circuit or short to ground
• VSV circuit short to ECU
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 66
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Misfire
P1301
P1302
Misfire level causing emissions increase
Misfire level causing catalyst system damage
Description
When the engine misfire reaches a high enough percentage the engine emission output levels can exceed the
allowed limits, this will produce the fault code P1301.
If the misfire percentage is high enough and there is a possibility that the catalyst may be damaged then code
P1302 will be set. To prevent catalyst damage the ECM may take action to either shut down the engine bank
containing the misfiring cylinder and limit the engine speed to 4000rpm, or limit the throttle opening if there is
more than one cylinder misfiring.
See misfire faults P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304, P0305, P0306
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Battery voltage between 10 – 16 V
• Coolant temperature between -10 – 120°C (14 – 248°F)
• Engine speed between 480 – 8010rpm
• Engine speed transient > 15rpm
• Altitude < 8000 ft (2438 m) / Baro > 756mbar
• Fuel level > 5 litres (1.3 US gallons)
• Engine load greater than 14 – 25% depending on engine speed
Disable Criteria:
• DFCO enabled (Deceleration Fuel Cut Off)
• Rough road
• MAF faults
Malfunction Criteria:
• P1301 Emissions Failure – Misfire percentage > 7% measured over 1000 engine revolutions.
• P1302 Catalyst Damage Failure – Misfire percentage > 16.6% - 40% depending on engine speed and load,
measured over 200 engine revolutions.
Potential failure modes:
• Injector related codes, as these can cause misfire codes to be set.
• VVT codes set
• Sensor connector and wiring for signs of corrosion or loose connections
• Spark plug / cylinder compression
• Cam timing / damage to rocker arm assembly
• Fuel pressure
Diagnostic Masks:
• For a P1301 fault code the MIL will be illuminated immediately.
• For a P1302 fault code the MIL will be illuminated immediately and the ECM will take action to prevent
catalyst damage.
Notes:
• Misfire learns are calculated during DFCO (Deceleration Fuel Cut Off)
Page 67
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Coolant Recirculation Pump
P2602
P2603
Coolant Pump Control Circuit Low
Coolant Pump Control Circuit High
Description
During a hot shutdown of the engine, the recirculation pump can continue to pump coolant around the engine.
The recirculation pump will run after the engine has been turned off if the enable criteria are matched.
The recirculation pump will also run after a short period of idle to aid heater performance.
Component connections
Connector Description
1 Recirc pump driver
2 Main relay via fuse R4
ECU Pin
M1
-
ECU Connector
48 Way (Right)
-
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• P2602 - continuous
• P2603 - engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P2602 – pump wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P2602 – fuse R4
• P2603 – pump circuit, ECM side, shorted to battery voltage
• Pump failure
• ECU output circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 68
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit/Open
P2100
Throttle actuator control motor circuit open
Description
The throttle actuator stepper motor operates on 12 volts.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Throttle actuator control motor open circuit
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit/Low
P2102
Throttle actuator control motor circuit low
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Throttle actuator control motor short to ground
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit/High
P2103
Throttle actuator control motor circuit high
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Throttle actuator control motor short to supply voltage
Page 69
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Throttle Actuator Control System – Forced Idle
P2104
Throttle actuator control system – forced idle
Description
If a problem is detected which could result in faster engine speed than commanded by the pedal, the actuator
is switched out, allowing the throttle valve to default to a 6% mechanically sprung setting. This provides a fast
idle speed which may be used to effect a 'limp home' mechanism.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Electronic throttle fault
Note: This code indicates action taken by the ECU, and will always be accompanied by another code which
has caused this action.
Throttle Actuator Control System – Forced Engine Shutdown
P2105
Throttle actuator control system – forced engine shutdown
Description
If a problem is detected which could result in engine speed runaway, or if sufficient control of engine speed is
lost, the ECU switches off the fuel injectors in order to stop the engine.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Electronic throttle fault
Note: This code indicates action taken by the ECU, and will always be accompanied by another code which
has caused this action.
Page 70
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Throttle Actuator Control System – Forced Limited Power
P2106
Throttle actuator control system – forced limited power
Description
If a problem is detected which could result in engine speed control difficulties, the ECU will limit throttle opening
to a maximum of 15%.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Electronic throttle fault
Note: This code indicates action taken by the ECU, and will always be accompanied by another code which
has caused this action.
Throttle Actuator Control Module Processor
P2107
Throttle actuator control module processor
Description
The ECU contains two processors dedicated to the throttle pedal and throttle valve potentiometers.
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• ECU internal fault
• Incorrect ECU programming
Page 71
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Throttle Actuator Control Module Performance
P2108
Throttle actuator control module performance
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• ECU internal failure
• Short circuit to throttle actuator
Pedal Position Sensor 'D' Circuit Low
P2122
Pedal position sensor ‘D’ circuit low
Description
Two potentiometers are built into the throttle pedal unit in order to provide a throttle demand signal to the ECU.
Note that the potentiometers operate on 5 volts.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Signal short circuit (< 0.283 V)
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed due to this single code. In the case of multiple
codes, a mechanically sprung 7% opening may be applied.
Page 72
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Pedal Position Sensor 'D' Circuit High
P2123
Pedal position sensor ‘D’ circuit high
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Signal open circuit (> 4.487 V)
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed due to this single code. In the case of multiple
codes, a mechanically sprung 7% opening may be applied.
Pedal Position Sensor 'E' Circuit Low
P2127
Pedal position sensor ‘E’ circuit low
Description
Two potentiometers are built into the throttle pedal unit in order to provide a throttle demand signal to the ECU.
Note that the potentiometers operate on 5 volts.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Signal short circuit (< 0.283 V)
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed due to this single code. In the case of multiple
codes, a mechanically sprung 7% opening may be applied.
Page 73
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Pedal Position Sensor 'E' Circuit High
P2128
Pedal position sensor ‘E’ circuit high
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• Signal open circuit (> 4.487 V)
• Reference voltage open circuit
• Reference voltage short to ground
• Sensor failure
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed due to this single code. In the case of multiple
codes, a mechanically sprung 7% opening may be applied.
Throttle Position Sensor 'A'/'B' Voltage Correlation
P2135
Throttle position sensor ‘A/B’ voltage correlation
Description
Two potentiometers are built into the throttle actuator unit in order to provide a throttle position signal to the
ECU. Two processors within the ECU compare the two output signals, which should match within a defined
tolerance. Note that the potentiometers operate on 5 volts.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• Throttle position greater than 60%
Potential failure modes:
• TPS1 reading incorrectly
• TPS2 reading incorrectly
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed.
Page 74
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Pedal Position Sensor/Switch 'D'/'E' Voltage Correlation
P2138
Pedal position sensor/switch ‘D/E’ voltage correlation
Description
Two potentiometers are built into the throttle pedal unit in order to provide a throttle demand signal to the ECU.
Two processors within the ECU compare the two output signals, which should match within a defined tolerance.
Note that the potentiometers operate on 5 volts.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• PPS1 reading incorrectly
• PPS2 reading incorrectly
Notes: A maximum throttle opening of 15% may be imposed.
Throttle Actuator Control System – High Airflow Detected
P2173
Throttle actuator control system – high airflow detected
Description
The mass air flow is compared with the throttle position to determine whether an incorrect correlation exists.
Enable Criteria:
• None
Disable Criteria:
• MAF fault(s) present
Potential failure modes:
• Throttle plate damage
• Air leak in intake system
Notes: A mechanically sprung 7% throttle opening may be imposed, or the injectors may be shut off to stop
the engine.
Page 75
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
A/C Refrigerant Distribution Valve
P2612
P2613
A/C Refrigerant Distribution Valve Control Circuit Low
A/C Refrigerant Distribution Valve Control Circuit High
Description:
The A/C refrigerant flow is regulated by the ECM using the distribution valve to control the evaporator to the
required temperature and prevent freezing.
Component connections:
Connector Description
1 Control valve driver
2 Ignition via rear ign relay
ECM Pin
K3
-
ECM Connector
48 Way (Centre)
-
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• None
Potential failure modes:
• P2612 – valve wiring open circuit or shorted to ground
• P2612 – loss of power from rear ignition relay
• P2613 – valve circuit, ECM side, shorted to battery voltage
• Valve failure
• ECM output circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 76
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
A/C Compressor Lock Sensor Circuit
B1422
A/C Compressor Lock Sensor Circuit
Description:
The ECM monitors the A/C compressor speed. If this speed is lower than the engine speed the ECM will turn
off the A/C compressor clutch. This is to prevent belt damage due to slippage.
Component connections:
Connector Description
1 Lock sensor +ve
2 Lock sensor -ve
ECM Pin
C1
B1
ECM Connector
32 Way (Left)
32 Way (Left)
Monitor:
• Continuous
Enable Criteria:
• Engine running
Disable Criteria:
• P0646, P0647 A/C compressor clutch fault
Malfunction Criteria:
• A/C compressor speed error greater than 20%
Potential failure modes:
• A/C compressor clutch mechanism slipping or seized
• A/C compressor drive belt slipping
• Lock sensor wiring
• Lock sensor failure
• ECM input circuit failure
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault has been present for the
previous two trips.
Page 77
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Lost Communications with TCM
U0101
Lost Communications with TCM
Description:
The ECM communicates with the Transmission Control Module (TCM) via the CAN bus.
If these CAN bus communications have been interrupted the ECM will register a diagnostic code.
Potential failure modes:
• CAN wiring
• TCM control module failure
• CAN bus corruption by another module on bus
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault was present on the previous
trip.
Lost Communications with VDCM
U0122
Lost Communications with VDCM
Description:
The ECM communicates with the Vehicle Dynamic Control Module (VDCM) via the CAN bus.
If these CAN bus communications have been interrupted the ECM will register a diagnostic code.
Potential failure modes:
• CAN wiring
• VDCM control module failure
• CAN bus corruption by another module on bus
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault was present on the previous
trip.
Lost Communications with TPMS
U0127
Lost Communications with TPMS
Description:
The ECM communicates with the Tyre Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) via the CAN bus.
If these CAN bus communications have been interrupted the ECM will register a diagnostic code.
Potential failure modes:
• CAN wiring
• TPMS control module failure
• CAN bus corruption by another module on bus
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault was present on the previous
trip.
Page 78
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
Software Incompatible with VDCM
U0316
Software Incompatible with VDCM
Description:
The ECM checks that the Vehicle Dynamic Control Module (VDCM) matches the vehicle variant code. If not
the above code will be set and the ECM will not respond to torque requests from the VDCM.
Potential failure modes:
• The ECM has been programmed with an incorrect variant code which does not match vehicle VDCM
level.
• VDCM error.
Diagnostic Mask:
• The service light will be illuminated for 30 seconds after engine start if the fault was present on the previous
trip.
Page 79
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section EMR
EMR.2 - CAN BUS DIAGNOSTICS; LOTUS TECHCENTRE
Controller Area Network (CAN) is an electronic standard to allow high speed communication between modules and controllers, via a serial data bus. The bus is a circuit linking the modules to the controller, consisting
of a pair of cables, twisted together to reduce electromagnetic interference, and carrying a square wave voltage
signal corresponding to '0's and '1's, coded in such a way as to identify and prioritise the individual messages.
On the Evora, CAN based systems include; engine management, safety restraint, anti-lock braking and related
features, instrument pack, and onboard diagnostics.
A 'stand alone' lap top PC loaded with 'Lotus Techcentre' software allows the CAN based serial data to
be read. A Vehicle Communication Device (T000T1472F) introduced for the Europa model is used to connect
the vehicle to the laptop Lotus Techcentre. Engine programming, live data display, diagnostics of engine, ABS
and airbag systems, are all carried out via the Lotus Techcentre.
The minimum specification of the laptop computer for installation of the Lotus Techcentre is as follows:
Processer 1.70 Ghz;
1 GB RAM;
40 GB HDD;
CDRW DVD ROM;
WIN XP PRO;
USB interface;
Ethernet or Wireless LAN
Note that this laptop should be dedicated totally to the Lotus Techcentre, with no other software installed.
Page 80
2009/02
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
TRANSMISSION
SECTION FL
Sub-Section
Page
Introduction
FL.1
3
Gearchange Mechanism
FL.2
3
Lubrication
FL.3
6
Driveshafts
FL.4
6
Transmission Removal/Replacement
FL.5
10
Transmission Overhaul
FL.6
10
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
3EA60 AND EA61 MANUAL TRANSAXLE
1. General
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
EA60/EA61 manual transaxles are newly developed 6-speed manual transaxles. These transaxles realize a
compact construction and excellent shift feeling due to the following items.
GENERAL LAYOUT
Feature
Compact Construction
Item
Twin (No.1 and No.2) output shafts are used.
The 4th & 5th and 1st & reverse drive gears share.
Multi-cone type (for 1st to 4th) and lever type (for reverse) synchromesh
View rotated for clarity
mechanisms are used.
This gear also This output gear also
Excellent
Shift Feeling
Constant mesh type reverse gear is used.
mates with mates with differential
Slide ball bearings
areon
used for the shift
fork shafts and shift & select
1st gear
crownwheel
Rolling type rock
shaftball
1 is used for shift & select lever shaft.
Reverse
Output Shaft
lever shaft.
5th
6th
No. 2
Input Shaft
Double-cone
1st
Synchromesh
Mechanism
Output Shaft No. 1
4th
3rd
2nd
Triple-cone
Synchromesh
Mechanisms
Crownwheel
Differential
288NF03Y
A
Sliding Ball Bearings
Sliding Ball
Bearing
Shift Fork Shafts
Shift & Select
Lever Shaft
Sliding Ball
Bearings
Rolling Type
Rock Ball Page 2
Sliding Ball Bearing
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
View from A Side
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
FL.1 - General Description
The 6-speed transmission assembly is an 'end on' type, positioned at the left hand side of the powertrain,
and is supplied by the Toyota Motor Corporation under the designation EA60. The unit is fully described on
CD Lotus part number T000T1507 (Toyota ref. SC02J1EA).
Insert the disc into a personal computer, and it will automatically open up to an Avensis menu page. Select:
New Car Features Supplement.
2005.04 Update.
New Features.
Manual Transaxle.
EA60 and EA61 Manual Transaxle (disregard shift lever description).
Note that the EA60 transmission is not used by Toyota in combination with the 2GR-FE V6 engine. For
the Evora application, a fully machined, cast alloy adaptor plate is interposed between the engine and transmission, the clutch housing of which is machined to accept the mounting of the starter motor via a further adaptor
block.
The transmission serial number is engraved on the top surface of the transmission front case, alongside
the jointline with the rear case. Typical example: A7H05232
FL.2 - GEARCHANGE MECHANISM
Two control cables run along the centre of the cabin and beneath the fuel tank and power unit, and transmit
the movement of the gearchange lever to the transmission selector housing.
The gear lever is spring biased towards
the 3rd/4th gear plane, by springs at both the
lever end, and within the transmission. The
lever must be moved against light spring pressure to the left before selecting first or second
gear, or against similar pressure to the right
before selecting 5th or 6th speed.
Engaging Reverse Gear:
With the vehicle at a complete standstill, pause for a moment with the clutch pedal
fully depressed before moving the lever to the
left, raising the lift collar beneath the knob, and
then further to the left over a spring detent
before finally pushing forwards to engage the
gear.
LIFT
COLLAR
6-SPEED CHANGE PATTERN
ohs15a
A two cable mechanism is used to connect the gearchange lever with the transmission, one cable ('shift')
to transmit the fore/aft movement of the lever, and a second ('crossgate') cable for the sideways movement.
The gearchange lever is pivotted at its base and operates the shift cable directly via a ball joint half way up the
lever. The base of the lever has an extended ball pin on the right hand side which engages with a crossgate
bellcrank lever, the other leg of which operates the crossgate cable.
An inhibit mechanism prevents the gear lever being moved into the reverse gear plane unless a collar
beneath the gear knob is lifted. This action raises a boss at the base of the lever above a curved inhibitor block,
allowing the lever full leftward movement.
The front end of both inner cables are equipped with socket joints which engage with ball pins fitted on
the gearchange mechanism. The outer cables are retained by a forked plastic block bolted into the gearlever/
handbrake mounting frame.
At the transmission end, each outer cable is located in an abutment bracket by a spring 'C' clip, with the
eye of the inner cable retained in its selector lever by a washer and 'R' pin. The shift cable connects directly to a
lever on the cross-shaft to cause its rotation, the action smoothed by an extension to the lever carrying a damper
mass. The crossgate cable connects to a bellcrank lever which imparts an axial motion to the cross-shaft.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
Crossgate cable Shift cable to
to transmission transmission
Lift collar
Abutment bracket
on transmission
Shift cable
Crossgate cable
pl4705eg
Gear lever/parking brake mounting bracket
Gearchange Cable Adjustment
In order to ensure smooth selection of 1st/2nd gears, it is important to set the crossgate cable adjustment
in relation to the fixed position reverse inhibitor block.
Push the lever to the left to abut against the reverse inhibitor block, and check selection of 1st and 2nd
gears. There should be no obstruction to fore/aft movement of the lever.
If fore/aft baulking occurs, determine whether the 1st/2nd unobstructed plane is too far left or right of where
it needs to be (i.e. adjacent to the inhibitor block). For example, if smooth operation can be achieved only
when the lever is moved slightly away from the inhibitor, the plane needs to be moved leftwards.
Remove the gear lever shroud. Release the ball pin from the crossgate bellcrank lever, loosen the locknut
and to move the plane to the left, screw the ball joint socket further onto the cable by one turn clockwise.To
move the plane to the right, turn counter-clockwise before re-attaching to the bellcrank and testing. Once
a setting is found which allows smooth fore/aft lever movement whilst abuting against the inhibitor block,
secure the ball joint socket with the locknut. Note that adjustment is available also at the transmission
end of the cable.
Raise the reverse inhibit gear lever collar and check that reverse gear can be engaged.
Refit the shroud and check that all gears can be selected without the lever fouling the shroud aperture. If
necessary, fit shim washers behind the reverse inhibitor block to move the lever away from the LH side of
the aperture and re-adjust the crossgate cable as necessary.
If other adjustments have been made, check the alignment of the 3rd/4th lever plane. From the spring
loaded neutral position, it should be possible to smoothly engage 3rd and 4th gears without moving the
lever across the gate. If necessary, the ends of the centralising hairpin spring may be reprofiled to reset
the neutral plane.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
Hairpin spring
Bellcrank lever
Grease these areas
Pivot stud
Fixing to floor channel
Gearchange Cable Replacement
For access to the gear cables, the gear lever shroud and parking brake lever trim panel must be removed,
and the gear lever/parking brake support channel released from the chassis tub floor:
Remove centre console: See sub-section VE.5.
Remove the engine bay undertray.
Release cables, front: Disconnect the front end of each cable by prising off the end socket from its gear
lever or crossgate lever ball pin. Release the outer cable abutment clamp from the mounting frame. Also
release the parking brake cable from the lever and disconnect the parking brake tell tale switch.
Mounting frame: Release the gear lever mounting frame from the support channel, and withdraw.
Release the support channel: Remove the 12 screws securing the support channel to the floor of the
chassis tub to allow the gear cables to be released from the 'P' clips inside the support channel.
Release cables, rear: Release the cables from the transmission levers and abutment bracket by removing
the 'R' clips and 'C' clips respectively. Release all cable retaining clips and ties, and remove the cables
from the car.
Refit the cables in reverse order to removal, and check adjustment as detailed above.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
FL.3 - LUBRICATION
The engine and transmission should be inspected for evidence of oil leaks at every service, and the transmission oil renewed at intervals specified in the Maintenance Schedule.
The transmission should be drained after a run when the oil is warm, flows more readily, and the impurities
are still held in suspension. A hex. head drain plug is provided in the bottom of the transmission crownwheel
housing. After allowing a sufficient drain period, thoroughly clean the drain plug before applying PTFE tape
around the thread, fitting a new sealing washer and tightening to 39 Nm.
A level/filler plug is located in the left hand side of the transmission case. With the vehicle at normal ride
attitude, the oil level should be within 5mm of this filler plug hole. For oil specification refer to Section OK. After
refilling, re-check the oil level at normal running temperature after a run. Finally use a new sealing washer and
tighten to 39 Nm.
FL.4 - DRIVE SHAFTS
Each of the two driveshaft assemblies comprises a steel shaft with a constant velocity (CV) joint at each
end, and is used to transmit the drive from each differential output gear to the rear wheel hub. The longer right
hand driveshaft assembly features an outrigger bearing bolted to the right hand side of the cylinder block, with
a shaft extending from the inboard CV joint into the transmission housing.
The inboard joints are of a plunging tripod design to accommodate driveshaft length variation with suspension travel, whereas the outboard joints are high efficiency 6-ball fixed length type. Replacement outboard
joints include the main driveshaft, outboard C.V. joint and gaiter. Replacement inboard joints include the inner
C.V. joint and gaiter kit, with the extended stub shaft of the RH joint also including the support bearing and
mounting bracket.
The joints themselves are packed with grease on initial assembly, and are maintenance free. It is however
vitally important that the protective gaiters are carefully inspected at service intervals, to check for splits, tears
or punctures, since the joint will deteriorate very quickly once contaminated with dirt or water. Damaged gaiters
should be renewed immediately, once the servicibility of the joint has been established.
CAUTION: The outboard C.V. joint gaiter can suffer 'pinch' damage if the joint is subjected to extreme articulation off the car, or during driveshaft removal/refitment.
LH Driveshaft Assembly
Outboard joint
Inboard plunging joint
f140
RH Driveshaft Assembly
Extension shaft
Inboard plunging joint
Outboard joint
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
f141
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
Clicking noises, torque reversal 'clonks', or shudder and vibration when accelerating are all possible
symptoms of worn C.V. joints. It should not be possible to discern any free play in a joint by manual manipulation, but care must be taken not to confuse this with transmission backlash, which may be considerable. Any
symptoms that could be due to worn driveshaft joint assemblies, should be investigated and rectified without
delay, since safety considerations are always of paramount importance.
The inboard C.V. joint is equipped with a male splined spigot shaft which engages with the female splines
of the differential output sun gear, with the LH shaft retained by a round section spring circlip on its end, and the
RH shaft retained by the extension shaft support bearing. Each of the two transmission output oil seals runs
on a machined shoulder on the C.V. joint spigot shaft, onto which is pressed a dust shield. The stub shaft of
each outboard joint is splined into the wheel hub, and retained by a nut on the threaded end of the shaft.
Driveshaft Assembly Replacement
Removing a driveshaft assembly from the transmission will result in some loss of transmission lubricant. It
may be preferred to drain off some oil via the transmission drain plug beforehand. At no time during this process
should an extension force be applied to the shaft assembly, as the plunging inner joint could be damaged.
1. Hub Nut: With the parking brake and footbrake firmly applied, remove the wheel centre cap and release
the driveshaft hub nut (RH thread at both sides).
2.
Road Wheel: Remove the appropriate road wheel and the engine bay undertray.
3.
Hub Carrier: To allow the withdrawal of the driveshaft from the hub, release from the hub carrier the lower
wishbone, toe-link, and anti-roll bar drop link. If necessary, release the brake hose 'P' clip and the wheel
speed sensor harness to allow the hub carrier to be swung upwards to release the driveshaft.
4.
Lubricant: Remove transmission drain plug and drain off approx. 1 litre of oil into a clean container for
re-use.
5.
LH Driveshaft: The left hand driveshaft inboard joint is retained in the transmission by a round section
circlip. The joint may be removed by applying a shock pull to the C.V. joint body using a slide hammer
with a forked end.
CAUTION: Any attempt to withdraw the inboard joint by pulling on the driveshaft is likely to damage the
joint and require its replacement. Apply pressure only to the outer body of the joint.
RH Driveshaft: The right hand driveshaft assembly incorporates a bearing for the extension shaft and it
is this which retains the shaft in the transmission. Remove the two bolts securing the bearing housing to
the engine, and withdraw the complete shaft assembly.
When withdrawing either driveshaft from the transmission, take care not to damage the output oil seal.
6.
Re-assembly: Before re-fitting a driveshaft, first renew the round section circlip on the end of the left hand
inboard joint spigot shaft, and lubricate the circlip with grease. Also, check the condition of the transmission output seal, and renew if necessary. Lubricate the lip of the seal with transmission oil, and grease
the corresponding shoulder on the driveshaft (C.V. joint) to reduce the danger of damaging the seal on
assembly.
7.
Driveshaft: Carefully insert the driveshaft into the transmission, with, on the left hand shaft, the two ends
of the circlip positioned lowermost, and rotate the shaft if necessary to engage the splines. Press the
inboard joint outer until a click indicates the engagement of the retaining circlip, if necessary tapping the
joint outer body using a brass drift and hammer. Pull on the joint body to confirm its security. On the right
hand shaft, fit the bolts securing the extension shaft bearing to the engine mounted bracket, and torque
to 64 Nm.
8.
Suspension: Fit the outer end of the shaft into the hub, and re-assemble the suspension links.
Torque settings: Lower wishbone to hub carrier; 135 Nm. Toe-link to hub carrier; 135 Nm. ARB drop link;
38 Nm.
9.
Hub Nut: Fit the hub nut and road wheel, apply the parking and footbrake, and tighten the hub nut to 300
Nm.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
10. Lubricant: With the car on the level, top up the transmission oil to the filler/level plug hole (see above).
11. Wheel and Undertray: Refit the road wheel and undertray.
Driveshaft C.V. Joint and/or Gaiter Replacement
The outboard C.V. joint is supplied complete with main driveshaft to which it is fixed by a spline with a small
helix angle to eliminate any potential backlash. Separation of the shaft from the joint should not be attempted.
Replacement of the outboard joint gaiter entails removal of the complete driveshaft assembly from the car, and
separation of the inboard joint from the shaft.
1.
Remove the driveshaft assembly from the car (see above).
2.
Remove the clips securing the inboard joint gaiter without damaging the gaiter if it is to be re-used. Pull the
gaiter off the joint outer body and match mark the body to the joint spider before disengaging the joint.
3.
Match mark the inboard joint spider to the shaft before removing the snap ring from the end of the shaft,
and withdrawing the spider assembly.
4.
Slide the inboard gaiter off the shaft, remove the outboard gaiter clips and slide off the outboard gaiter.
5.
Inspection & Cleaning: Complete disassembly of either joint is NOT recommended. The separate components are a precision fit and develop their own individual wear patterns, such that any interchanging or
re-orientation of parts is likely to result in premature failure.
If the grease in the joint is contaminated with dirt or water, it is likely that the joint is damaged, and should
be replaced. If the grease is not contaminated, the joint should be degreased by soaking in a suitable
solvent (NOT petrol), and then carefully inspected. Tilt the ball type inner race or spider rollers to one
side to expose each driving surface. Severe pitting, galling, play between ball and its cage window, any
cracking or damage to the cage, or pitting, galling or chips in raceways, call for joint replacement.
If the joint is found to be serviceable, it must be repacked with the special grease provided. Pack the
grease into the joint itself and also into the inside of the new gaiter.
NOTE: The grease provided in the kits is specially formulated for wear resistance and durability. DO NOT
use substitutes or mix with other lubricants. The grease specification and quantity also differs for inboard
and outboard joints:
Inboard: 180g NKG302
Outboard: 180g NTG2218-M (inboard grease is also supplied in outboard kits, as the inboard joint must
be removed before fitting outboard gaiter)
6.
Slide the new outboard gaiter and smaller retaining clip onto the shaft. Fit the gaiter into the grooves on
the outboard joint body and the driveshaft, and secure with the clips provided.
7.
Slide the new inboard gaiter and retaining clips onto the driveshaft. Press the spider onto the driveshaft
splines with the match marks aligned, and retain with a new snap ring.
8.
Fit the spider into the inboard joint body with the match marks aligned, position the gaiter in the loctation
grooves, and retain with the new clips.
9.
Refit the driveshaft to the car (see above).
Extension Shaft Support Bearing
The ball bearing supporting the RH driveshaft extension shaft to the engine block is mounted in a housing
which is bolted to a bracket on the engine block. The bearing is sealed and maintenance free, and is included
as part of the inboard C.V. joint assembly, but may if necessary be renewed by the following procedure:
1.
Remove the RH driveshaft assembly (see above).
2.
Using a press, remove the dust shield from the inboard end of the shaft.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
3.
Remove the circlip from the outboard face of the bearing housing, and press or pull the housing from the
bearing.
4.
Prise or pull the bearing dust shield off the shaft.
5.
Remove the circlip retaining the bearing and press or pull the bearing from the shaft.
6.
Press a new bearing into the housing,
and retain with a new circlip. Then use
special press tool T000T1438F to press
the inner race of the bearing up to the
shoulder on the shaft, and retain with a
new circlip.
f125
7.
Use special press tool T000T1439F to
press the bearing dust shield onto the
shaft and position as shown in the illustration.
f126
8.
Press the inboard dust shield onto the
end of the shaft to the dimension shown
in the illustration.
9.
Refit the driveshaft to the car (see
above).
86.5 ± 0.5mm
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
f127
Lotus Service Notes
Section FL
FL.5 - TRANSMISSION Removal/REPLACEMENT
The transmission may be separated from the engine only after removal of the complete powertrain from
the car. See sub-section EJ.5.
To separate the engine/transmission assembly
In order to mate the 2GR-FE engine to the EA60 manual transmission for use in the Evora, a Lotus specific
fully machined cast alloy adaptor plate is used between the two units. Space to mount the starter motor in the
position ordained by the clutch housing, is not available with the 2GR-FE engine, so a special machined casting is used to mount an opposite rotation starter motor alongside the clutch, the housing for which is machined
to provide suitable clearance.
After removal of the complete powertrain assembly:
1. Remove the clamp bracket supporting the end of the starter motor body.
2.
Release the two bolts securing the starter motor flange to the adaptor bracket, and withdraw the motor.
3.
Remove the two bolts securing the motor adaptor bracket to the transmission adaptor plate, and remove
the bracket.
4.
Ensure suitable independent support of the engine and transmission units before releasing the clutch
housing from the engine:
- From beneath, remove the two bolts securing the dirt shield in the clutch housing aperture.
- Remove the 3 bolts from the engine side of the lower section of the adaptor plate.
- Remove the 5 bolts from the transmission side securing the clutch housing to the engine/adaptor
plate.
- Withdraw the transmission from the engine.
5.
If necessary, release the 3 x M12 bolts from the transmission side securing the adaptor plate to the engine,
and the single M10 bolt from the engine side of the plate. Remove the plate.
On re-assembly, torque all M12 fixings to 65 Nm, and M10 fixings to 45 Nm. Re-seal around the starter
motor to reduce the ingress of water into the clutch housing.
FL.6 - TRANSMISSION OVERHAUL
For transmission repair and overhaul procedures, refer to Lotus CD part number T000T1507F (Toyota
ref. SC02J1EA). Insert the disc into a personal computer, and it will automatically open up to an Avensis menu
page. Select:
Repair Manual Supplement.
2005.4 Transmission.
EA60 / EA61 MANUAL TRANSAXLE
Select the operation required.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section GJ
WHEELS & TYRES
SECTION GJ
Sub-Section Page
General Description
GJ.1
2
Tyre Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
GJ.2
2
Wheels
GJ.3
3
Wheel Bolts
GJ.4
4
Tyres
GJ.5
4
Winter Tyres & Snow Chains
GJ.6
5
Punctured Tyre Emergency Inflator
GJ.7
6
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section GJ
GJ.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The single piece, light alloy roadwheels are factory fitted with tyres engineered to provide the optimum
balance of ride and handling characteristics. In order fully to exploit the dynamic qualities and packaging opportunities, the wheel and tyre sizes are different front and rear, so that interchanging of wheels and tyres between axles is not permissible. Note that the tyre tread pattern is asymetric across the width, with the sidewalls
marked 'side facing inwards' or 'side facing outwards', but the tyre may rotate in either direction.
The tyres should be inspected frequently by the vehicle user, and also at every service, for signs of cuts,
abrasions or other damage, and for any uneven tread wear patterns. Uneven treadwear may indicate that the
suspension geometry or dampers require attention. Care should be taken when parking to avoid tyre contact
with high or sharp edged kerbs, as mistreatment of this nature can cause internal damage to the tyre structure
which may not readily be apparent. The alloy wheel rims may also be distorted or damaged by careless parking, and result in wheel imbalance or loss of tyre pressure. Safety considerations should always be paramount
when assessing tyre condition and serviceability, and the tyres replaced if any doubt exists, or if the legal tread
depth limits are approached.
The cold tyre pressures should be checked every week, or every 1,000 miles (1,700 km), whichever is the
sooner, and corrections made as necessary. Under‑inflation will cause excessive wear, rapid deterioration of
the tyre sidewalls and heavy steering, whereas overinflation results in a hard ride and increased susceptibility
to tyre damage. Both conditions will cause a degradation in the vehicle handling qualities. It is important that
the tyre pressures are adjusted only when the tyres are cold (driven less than one mile), as the pressures may
increase by 0.3 ‑ 0.5 bar (4 ‑ 8 lb/in²) when the tyres are warmed to normal running temperature. The tyre
valve dust cap should always be replaced in order to prevent the ingress of dirt and moisture into the valve,
which could cause leakage.
When balancing the wheel and tyre assemblies, the wheels should be located by the centre spigot ‑ NOT
by the wheel bolt holes. In order to maintain the correct handling feel and minimum steering wheel shake, it is
very important that the radial and lateral run out of the tyres are to the high standard required by Lotus Cars.
If any difficulty is experienced with replacement tyres, refer to the tyre manufacturer.
The Yokohama Advan Sport tyres fitted to the Evora are suitable for all normal weather conditions. The
tyre characteristics include good feedback (‘feel’) from the road surface to the steering wheel, a high level of
steering linearity and response, and little performance degradation with the high temperatures which may be
reached in sports use. However, tyre performance will decrease at low ambient temperatures, resulting in
reduced levels of grip and an increased susceptibility to damage from impacts. In these conditions, especially
below -7°C, it is recommended to fit a car set of the recommended winter tyres (see below).
GJ.2 - TYRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (tpms) - Where fitted
A sensor incorporated into each of the tyre valves, monitors the air pressure inside the tyre, and supplies
an onboard control module located on the LH rear wheelarch with this data by radio transmission. Tyre pressure information is displayed in the instrument cluster right hand screen. A silhouette of the vehicle showing
each wheel, will display all four tyre pressures for one minute following ignition switch on.
If any tyre pressure should fall below 75% of the recommended value, an alert message is sent to the
instrument panel, and the tyre pressure tell tale
will light up amber. The corresponding tyre on the silhouette will be highlighted and the pressure displayed.
If this warning should occur, the car should be stopped as soon as it is safely possible, and the affected
tyre examined. If there is no visible damage and a tyre pump is available, the pressure should be corrected
(see below), before proceeding with caution to a tyre repair/replacement facility. Note that the tell tale will
automatically be extinguished when the correct pressure is restored. If the tyre is punctured, or no inflation
equipment is available, use of the emergency tyre inflator aerosol (see below) should be considered, whilst
being aware that the TPMS sensor in the tyre would be disabled by the sealing fluid, and would subsequently
require replacement.
The TPMS incorporates self-malfunction recognition, and if a fault is detected, the low tyre pressure
tell tale in the instrument panel will flash for one minute, and then remain constantly lit, this sequence being
repeated for subsequent ignition cycles; with the tell tale flashing or lit, there may be no detection of low
tyre pressure.
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section GJ
When removing or replacing a tyre, be aware that the tyre valve includes a pressure transducer and should
not be discarded. Take care not to damage the sensor with the tyre bead or tools. If a fault is indicated after
wheel or tyre replacement, it is likely that a sensor has been incorrectly fitted or damaged. If a tyre valve/sensor
is renewed, or is moved to a different wheel position, the TPMS will automatically identify the new configuration
by interpreting signal strength as distance from sensor to receiver.
Note that the pressure sensors are powered by integral batteries, with an average service life of 10 years.
It is recommended to renew all pressure sensors at this time interval.
TPMS fault codes
On detection of a fault, the TPMS integrated diagnostics will set an appropriate code which may be read
using the Lotus Techcentre:
C0550
C0551
C0558
C075A
C075B
C075C
C075D
C0777
C0800
U2103
TPMS ECU Failure
TPMS Module not programmed with Vehicle Configuration
TPMS Vehicle Sensor ID's not programmed
TPMS Pressure Sensor LF Malfunction / Battery Low / Broken Shock Sensor
TPMS Pressure Sensor RF Malfunction / Battery Low / Broken Shock Sensor
TPMS Pressure Sensor LR Malfunction / Battery Low / Broken Shock Sensor
TPMS Pressure Sensor RR Malfunction / Battery Low / Broken Shock Sensor
TPMS Sensor Autolocation Failed
TPMS Module Supply Voltage Below 9V / Above 18V
TPMS Communications Malfunction
In the first instance, the car should be driven gently at 40 mph in order to optimise conditions for sensor
recognition. If the fault persists, the following action should be considered:
550/551/558 – most likely a TPMS module problem; renew
75A/B/C/D – most likely a pressure sensor; renew
777 – Most likely the module but could be a rogue sensor
800 – Check supply voltage and ground connection
U2103 – Could be module, CAN cable connection or engine T4e controller
GJ.3 - WHEELS
Standard wheels on the Lotus Evora are Lotus styled, cast alloy, 10-spoke arranged in pairs, silver or grey
painted, in sizes of 8.0J x 18 front, and 9.5J x19 rear. Optional forged alloy wheels are Lotus styled with 10
equally spaced radial spokes, but are otherwise similar. Each wheel is located by a central spigot and secured
by five bolts, four of which have a spline socket head, and one with a security coded head. A splined extension
tool and a coded adaptor are supplied with the vehicle and require a 17mm hex. socket, square drive extension
and a torque wrench.
Type - std
- optional
Size - front
- rear
Inset - front
- rear
PCD
Wheel bolts - thread
- torque
- seat
Centre spigot hole diameter
Radial run-out at bead seat
Lateral run-out at bead seat
Cast alloy, 10 spokes in pairs, silver or grey, 5-bolt fixing.
Forged alloy, 10 radial spokes, silver or grey, 5-bolt fixing.
8.0J x 18H2
9.5J x 19H2
+ 52 mm
+ 69 mm
114.3 mm
M12 x 1.5 x 26 mm
105 Nm
60° taper
68 mm
0.3 mm max.
0.3 mm max.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Note that the inset figure is the displacement of the wheelrim centreline relative to the
wheel/hub mounting face. A positive inset
indicates that the wheelrim centreline lies inboard of the wheel mounting face, whereas a
negative inset means the wheelrim centreline
is outboard of the mounting face.
Section GJ
INSIDE
face of
wheel
Wheelrim centreline
OUTSIDE
face of
wheel
Wheel mounting face
Inset (positive shown)
g02
GJ.4 - wheel bolts
The wheel bolts used are of a special
design to suit the small diameter fixing tunnels
in the wheel centres. The bolts have an M12
x1.5 thread, 60° conical seat, and a 10 spline
socket head for which a special extension tool
is supplied with the car.
A 17 mm a/f deep socket and 1/2 inch
square drive torque wrench should be applied
to the extension tool, with a tightening torque
of 105 Nm required.
Standard wheelbolt
Splined
extension tool
Coded wheelbolt Coded adaptor
17mm socket, extension & torque wrench
ohs114d
To protect against wheel theft, one of the five bolts securing each wheel is key coded, and requires a
correspondingly coded adaptor tool. Fit the adaptor tool onto a 1/2 inch square drive extension, and rotate the
adaptor until until full engagement into the bolt head is assured before applying torque. Note that an alignment
mark is provided on the coded bolt head and adaptor tool to aid refitting. The spline drive extension and the
coded adaptor tool are stowed in the vehicle tool pouch, and should remain with the car at all times to allow
servicing or repairs to be performed.
GJ.5 - TYRES
The Pirelli P-Zero tyres fitted to the Evora are suitable for all normal weather conditions. The tyre char
acteristics include good feedback (‘feel’) from the road surface to the steering wheel, a high level of steering
linearity and response, and little performance degradation with the raised temperatures which may be reached
in high speed use.
However, tyre performance will decrease at low ambient temperatures, resulting in reduced levels of
grip and an increased susceptibility to damage from impacts. In these conditions, especially where average
temperatures are below 0°C (32°F), or where snow may be expected, it is recommended to fit a car set of the
recommended winter tyres (see below).
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Note that the Pirelli P-Zero tread pattern
is asymetrical, so that when fitting tyres, attention must be paid to the sidewall marking, and
the side of the car for which the wheel and tyre
is intended. Wear indicators are moulded into
the bottom of the tread grooves at intervals
around the tyre, indicated by small pointers on
the outer tread blocks. The tyres should be
replaced before being worn to this minimum
legal tread depth.
Section GJ
Outboard tread
pattern
Inboard tread
pattern
g23
Tyre type Pirelli P-Zero
Size - front 225/40 ZR18
- rear 255/35 ZR19
Pressure (cold) - normal driving conditions
- front 2.3 bar (33.5 psi)
- rear 2.5 bar (36 psi)
- high loads and/or speed
- front 2.8 bar (40.5 psi)
- rear 3.0 bar (43.5 psi)
GJ.6 - WINTER TYRES & SNOW CHAINS
If the car is to be used in very cold climates, or driven on snow covered roads, it is recommended to fit a
complete vehicle set of winter tyres developed specifically for such conditions. For the Evora, Lotus recommends the use of Yokohama W.drive V-902 winter tyres in sizes specified below.
Wear indicators are moulded into the bottom of the tread grooves at intervals around the tyre, indicated
by small pointers on the outer tread blocks. In order that these tyres maintain their design performance on
snow covered roads, the minimum tread depth is designated as 4 mm, which is reflected in the height of a
secondary set of wear indicators.
Note that the W.drive tread pattern is asymetrical, so that when fitting tyres, attention must be paid to the
sidewall marking, and the side of the car for which the wheel and tyre is intended.
Winter Tyres - type
- size - front
- rear
Pressure (cold) - front
- rear
Yokohama W.drive V-902
215/40 R18
245/35 R19
2.3 bar (33.5 lb/in²)
2.5 bar (36 lb/in²)
WARNING:
When winter tyres are fitted, a maximum speed of 118 mph (190 km/h) must be observed.
The tyres are NOT suitable for studding.
Snow Chains
In extreme weather conditions, Lotus approves the fitment of RUD-matic DISC snow chains (Lotus part
number A132G6004F), used only in conjunction with winter tyres (see above) and fitted only on the rear wheels.
Close attention should be paid to the fitting and tensioning instructions supplied with the chains. The chains
should be removed as soon as road conditions allow.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section GJ
GJ.7 - PUNCTURED TYRE EMERGENCY INFLATOR (If fitted)
In order fully to exploit the benefits of
light weight, and to maximise stowage space,
the Evora has no provision for spare wheel
carriage or lifting jack. A temporary puncture
sealing facility is provided in the form of an
emergency tyre inflator aerosol mounted in a
spring clip at the extreme right hand side of
the boot. If possible, avoid driving on a deflated tyre, or irreparable damage to the tyre
structure may be caused.
When the aerosol is connected to the
tyre valve, and the button pressed, a mixture
of liquid latex and propellant is injected into the
tyre, such that the solidifying latex is forced into
the puncture site at the same time as the tyre
is inflated, effecting a temporary repair and
enabling the car to be driven at low speed to
the nearest tyre depot.
TYRE EMERGENCY
INFLATOR AEROSOL
ohe42
WARNING:
Use of the aerosol does not constitute a permanent repair, but is designed to allow the car to be
driven to the nearest tyre depot. At the earliest opportunity, the tyre should be professionally
repaired or replaced dependent on the severity of the damage.
Until the tyre is repaired or replaced, the car should be driven only in a moderate manner, not
exceeding 30 mph (45 km/h).
Do not use the aerosol for large holes or repairs, or when the tyre sidewall has been damaged, or
if the tyre has been displaced from the rim.
For safety reasons, the aerosol should be carried at all times in the designated stowage position.
Never carry in the passenger compartment.
As soon as a puncture is suspected, the car should be stopped at the first safe opportunity. Continued
driving on a deflated tyre will cause irreparable damage to the tyre.
Directions for use of the aerosol: Before using, carefully read all the instructions on the canister, or on any
literature accompanying the product. The following instructions apply to the use of Holts Tyreweld:
1.
Remove the object causing the puncture, and position the wheel with the puncture site lowermost. Deflate
tyre fully.
2.
Shake the can vigorously. In cold conditions, warm the can using the car's heater outlets, or by body
warmth.
3.
Screw the aerosol tube onto the tyre valve, remove the cap, hold the can upright and press the button until
the tyre is firmly inflated.
4.
Immediately drive for 6 - 12 miles (10 - 20 km) (or to the tyre depot if nearer) in a moderate manner and not
exceeding 30 mph (45 km/h), to allow the sealant to spread. Then check and adjust the tyre pressure.
5.
Have the tyre professionally repaired or replaced at the earliest opportunity, and until such time, limit
speed to 30 mph (45 km/h) with a moderate driving manner. Note that some tyre repairers may make an
additional charge for cleaning the sealant off the tyre before repair, and that any subsequent repairs may
not be guaranteed. Be aware that the electronic pressure sensor mounted inside the tyre and integral
with the tyre valve, could be obstructed by the sealant, and should be renewed.
6.
Renew the puncture repair aerosol.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
STEERING
SECTION HI
Sub-Section Page
General Description
HI.1
2
Power Steering Rack Operation
HI.2
3
PAS Fluid Check & Refill Procedure
HI.3
6
Steering Wheel
HI.4
6
Steering Column Assembly
HI.5
7
Intermediate Column
HI.4
8
Track Rod Ends & Rack Gaiters
HI.5
9
Front Wheel Alignment & Rack Gaiters
HI.5
8
Rack & Pinion Assembly Removal/Replacement
HI.6
10
PAS Pump & Testing Procedure
HI.7
11
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
Column and Rack Assembly
Upper column assembly
Intermediate column
Lower column
Upper universal joint
Collapsible joint
Lower universal joint
Pinion shaft
Pinion end solid mountings
Rack and pinion assembly
Rubber sleeve
Non-pinion end clamp
Mounting bracket to chassis
Alloy insert
Tie rod
Shim plate
Track rod
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
h62
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
HI.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The power assisted steering system of the Evora comprises a column assembly, adjustable for height and
reach, connected via two universal joints and an intermediate shaft, to a rack and pinion steering gear mounted
on the chassis front subframe ahead of the front axle line. Power assistance is provided by an hydraulic pump
mounted on the LH side of the engine, driven by the auxiliary belt, with an hydraulic reservoir located at the RH
side of the engine bay. The pipes connecting the pump and reservoir to the rack assembly, are routed along
the outside of the RH main chassis rail, within the body sill.
The column assembly comprises three sections, upper, intermediate and lower, articulated with two
universal joints. The upper section is bolted to the chassis scuttle structure and provides for a steering wheel
reach variation of 40 mm, and a vertical adjustment range of 43 mm. A clamping lever is positioned below the
column, which is lowered to allow an adjustment to be made, and should be pushed fully upwards to clamp
the setting before the car is driven. The intermediate column, like the upper, is telescopic, and in this instance
allows for length compression of the column in the event of rack displacement in a vehicle collision. The short
lower column connects to the steering rack pinion shaft.
The steering rack assembly consists of an alloy pinion housing/valve body, and a steel tube through which
the rack is guided. The pinion housing features two lugs with solid alloy inserts, which bolt to an extruded alloy
bracket, itself bolted to the subframe. The non-pinion end of the rack tube is clamped via a split rubber sleeve
around the rack housing, to a second extruded bracket, again bolted to the subframe. Short ball jointed tie-rods
from each end of the rack connect via length adjustable track rods, to forward facing steering arms integral
with the forged steel front hub carriers, with outer pivot points positioned laterally to provide a 32% Ackermann
effect, and vertically for a toe-out on bump characteristic. The rack and pinion assembly is geared to provide
47.4mm rack travel for one steering wheel revolution, with 2.86 turns needed from lock to lock.
Steering power assistance is sourced from a belt driven, vane type hydraulic pump, mounted at the right
hand front of the engine. Pipework to and from the power rack assembly is routed within the RH body sill, with
a fluid reservoir mounted at the RH rear of the engine bay. Some cars destined for hot climates are equipped
with a befinned oil pipe cooler loop incorporated into the return line from rack to reservoir, and mounted ahead
of, and at the base of the engine coolant radiator.
HI.2 - POWER STEERING RACK OPERATION
-
The steering rack assembly comprises the following major components:
a round section steel bar with rack teeth machined at one end.
an alloy pinion housing to support and contain the pinion shaft and hydraulic valve body assembly, and
also support the pinion end of the rack bar.
a steel tube pressed into the pinion housing to support the non-pinion end of the rack bar, and provide an
hydraulic cylinder for power operation of the rack.
The rack housing contains two seals, between which a piston on the rack bar operates to form two hydraulic cylinders, each of which is linked to the valve body by a steel pipe. By using a pumped oil supply and a
mechanism for creating a pressure differential between the two cylinders, a force can be applied to the piston
and rack bar to provide steering assistance in either direction.
The valve body, which is integral with the pinion gear housing, contains three main elements:
an input shaft/valve rotor connected to the steering column;
a valve sleeve fixed to the pinion gear.
a torsion bar connecting the two;
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
Splines to
intermediate
shaft
Connection pin
Input shaft/valve rotor
Torsion bar
Hydraulic seal
Roller bearing
Valve body
Outlet to reservoir
To/from rack cylinder 1
Sealing rings
Inlet from pump
Valve sleeve
Ball bearing/seal
Torsion bar splined
to sleeve/pinion
To/from rack cylinder 2
Pinion gear
h61
The steering column is clamped to splines on the top end of the rack input shaft, the lower end of which
is machined to form a valve rotor, turning within the valve sleeve. The valve sleeve is fixed to the pinion gear
and contains hydraulic ports which are controlled by the position of the rotor relative to the sleeve. The rotor
and sleeve are connected by the torsion bar, the top end of which is secured inside the top end of the hollow
input shaft (rotor), and the bottom end splined into the pinion gear (sleeve). The degree of twist of the torsion
bar is determined by the force applied at the steering wheel, and is proportional to the loading at the front tyres.
These forces tend to be highest when manoeuvering at low speed (e.g. parking) and result in the greatest
angular displacement between valve rotor and sleeve.
-
The valve body incorporates 4 ports:
inlet from the engine driven pump;
outlet (return) to the reservoir;
connection to the right hand rack cylinder;
connection to the left hand rack cylinder.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
Power Steering Schematic (RHD shown)
PAS reservoir
Low pressure line from reservoir to pump
Engine driven pump
Supply line to valve body
Low pressure return line to reservoir
Supply/return to RH cylinder
Valve body
Supply/return to LH cylinder
Hydraulic seal
Track rod
Rack & pinion gear RH rack cylinder LH rack cylinder
Sealed
piston
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
h62
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
The schematic diagram below shows the principle of valve control, although in practice, six pockets are
machined in the rotor and sleeve, and the valve system is repeated three times. The valve sleeve is provided
with four sealing rings in order to divide the inlet and outlet feeds and connect with ports in the valve body,
whilst allowing 360°rotation of the valve assembly.
RHD steering being Pressurised oil to
turned to left Restricted return RH rack cylinder
path causes supply
side pressure increase
Return to
reservoir
Valve sleeve - fixed to pinion
Angular position to rotor
displaced due to flex in
torsion bar
Oil supply
from pump
Valve rotor/input shaft
Torsion bar (connects
(fixed to column)
valve sleeve to rotor)
Restricted return path
causes supply side
Oil returning from pressure increase h40a
LH rack cylinder
The engine driven pump supplies oil at a controlled rate. A progressive restriction of this oil flow will cause
the pressure to increase whilst the flow rate is maintained. Eventually, when the flow is completely restricted,
the pressure will rise to the relief valve setting in the pump, causing oil to flow through the relief valve and recirculate within the pump.
The hydraulic valve in the steering gear provides this restriction according to the force applied at the
steering wheel and the loading on the front tyres. The valve is configured as 'open centre' such that when no
torque is applied to the steering wheel, there is minimal restriction to the oil supply, resulting in low oil pressure
and the freedom to flow to both rack cylinders and through the outlet port back to the reservoir. The pressure
differential across the rack piston is zero.
When the steering is turned to the left against some resistance, the input shaft/rotor transmits the motion
to the pinion gear/valve sleeve via the torsion bar, which twists in proportion to the effort applied at the wheel
and the resistance at the tyres. Effort is high typically at slow vehicle speeds, or when parking. When the bar
twists, the angular position of the rotor relative to the valve sleeve alters, with the result that the ports to cylinder 1 become biased towards the pressurised supply, and the ports to cylinder 2 biased to the reservoir return
port at low pressure. Hence a pressure differential is created within the rack housing, with higher pressure in
cylinder 1 applying a force to the steering rack piston to assist the turn.
If the steering is turned hard against resistance, or the lock stop, the valve will completely close off the
return path and cause delivery pressure from the pump to rise until the pressure relief valve in the pump opens;
maximum assistance has been reached.
The ultimate degree to which the torsion bar is permitted to twist, is limited by mechanical contact between
the input shaft and the pinion gear. This mechanism prevents the torsion bar being over stressed, defines the
maximum level of assistance, and provides a safety back up in case of torsion bar failure; steering control would
be retained, albeit with a small amount of lost motion.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
HI.3 - PAS FLUID CHECK & REFILL PROCEDURE
Recommended fluid:
Capacity:
PAS or Automatic Transmission Fluid meeting Dexron III
1.5 litre
Fluid Level Check
The PAS fluid reservoir is located at the right hand rear corner of the engine bay with the fluid level visible
through the translucent material of the reservoir. The level of fluid will rise as the oil temperature warms during
normal operation, and the best time to check the level (part of each routine service) is with the engine warm,
immediately after a run. With a warm engine, the level should be close to the 'MAX' mark, and if cold, close
to the 'MIN'. Note that there are two sets of marks on the reservoir, with hot markings on the outboard side,
and cold marks in the inboard side, the hot marks being at a slightly higher level. The fluid level will also drop
slightly when the engine is running.
Under normal circumstances, the PAS fluid should not require any topping up, and a drop in level is likely
to be an indication of a leak.
If topping up is required, the air outlet grille at the RH rear corner of the engine bay must first be removed
by releasing its two retaining screws. The reservoir cap may then be removed and a suitable funnel used to
aid the addition of an approved fluid. Do not overfill. Replace the cap securely, and refit the grille.
Fluid Change & Bleeding
In the normal course of operation, it is not necessary to change the hydraulic fluid, only to check the level.
If, however, the system becomes contaminated with dirt or other fluids, all pipework connections should be
released and fluid expelled using low pressure air. Dispel fluid from the rack mechanism by turning the steering
to each full lock. Dispel fluid from the pump by cranking the engine for a few moments with ignition disabled.
After draining the fluid, or after the loss of fluid during the course of repairs or hydraulic system disconnection;
Fill the reservoir with an approved fluid.
Raise the front of the car and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock several times. Top up fluid
level if necessary.
Lower the car, start the engine and idle for a few minutes, before turning the steering to full lock and holding for 3 seconds, then repeating for the opposite lock. Repeat this sequence several times.
Stop the engine and check the reservoir level.
Any foaming or emulsification of the oil is an indication of air in the system. Repeat the above procedure.
If symptoms persist, check for air/fluid leaks.
HI.4 - STEERING WHEEL
The alloy three spoke steering wheel features a flattened lower section to facilitate driver access, a leather
trimmed rim, buttons for the cruise control (if fitted) and an airbag module which also serves as a press pad
to operate the horns. The electrical supply for the steering wheel mounted equipment utilises a rotary coil assembly surrounding the column.
The wheel comprises a cast magnesium rim and spokes, to which is bolted a machined alloy hub, with a
screw fixed alloy pressing to carry, via double sided tape, the cruise control buttons and/or trim.
To Remove Steering Wheel
WARNING: The following procedures must be followed in the order listed to temporarily disable the
airbag system whilst working in the immediate vicinity of an airbag. Failure to follow this procedure
could cause unintended airbag deployment, resulting in personal injury and unnecessary airbag system repairs.
i)
ii)
iii)
iv)
Turn off the ignition.
Before disconnecting the battery, use the Lotus TechCentre to read any stored trouble codes.
Disconnect the negative (earth) lead from the battery and tape back to ensure that no contact with the
battery negative terminal can be made.
Wait for 30 seconds.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
v)
vi)
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
Unclip the top part of the column shroud, then remove the lower part after releasing the three retaining
screws.
Locate and unplug the airbag harness from the rotary connector. Note that the connector socket is fitted
with 'shorting bars' which automatically interconnect the high and low terminals of the airbag to prevent
unschedules deployment caused by a voltage differential.
1.
On the reverse side of the steering wheel, release the two Torx head screws, accessible via holes in the
plastic shroud around the steering wheel hub.
2.
Withdraw the airbag module and disconnect the two airbag harness connectors and the two horn leads.
WARNING: When carrying a live airbag module, make sure the bag and trim cover are pointed away
from you. In case of an accidental deployment, the bag will then deploy with minimal chance of injury.
When placing a live airbag module on a bench or other surface, always face the bag and trim cover
upwards, away from the surface. This is necessary so that a free space is provided to allow the airbag
to expand in the unlikely event of accidental deployment.
3.
Unplug the cruise control harness and the airbag/horn harness from the rotary connector.
4.
Ensure the wheels are pointing straight ahead, match mark the wheel to the column, and remove the
steering wheel retaining bolt. Note that the wheel is located on a steep angle hexagonal taper on the
column.
CAUTION: If excessive force is applied to either the steering wheel or column, the break-out inserts securing the column to the fascia bracket may be disturbed, necessitating replacement of
the complete column. If necessary, use an appropriate puller.
5.
If necessary, remove the cruise control switches and trim by carefully prising away from the double sided
tape fixing. Remove the 4 screws to release the cover from the wheel reverse side.
6.
Refit in reverse order to removal, but before fitting the steering wheel, it is essential to centralise the rotary
connector, or the unit will be broken when lock is applied. Turn the connector fully clockwise until it tightens,
and then turn back just over two turns until the red marker appears in the square window. Note that this
instruction is printed on the rotary connector. Ensure the road wheels are pointing straight ahead and fit
the steering wheel with the match marks aligned. Tighten the steering wheel retaining bolt to 50 Nm.
When fitting the jump harness for the cruise controls, ensure the cable is routed through the channel
provided in the steering wheel carrier.
7.
After re-assembly, check that the airbag tell tale lights for a few seconds with ignition, and then goes
out.
Steering Wheel Alignment
Ideally, the steering wheel should align in the straight running position, with the steering rack centralised
and with equal track rod lengths. In practice, a minor compromise to track rod lengths may have to be made.
To arrive at the optimum setting, proceed as follows:
Note that only one splined joint in the steering system allows a choice of position, this being the connection of the lower column to the rack pinion shaft.
1.
Set the front wheel alignment to specification with equal track rod lengths (see sub-section CK.2).
2.
With the wheels pointing straight ahead, fit the steering wheel on the column hexagonal taper in the straight
ahead position, and secure with the retaining bolt, torque tightening to 50 Nm.
3.
Road test the car and mark the actual 'straight ahead' position of the wheel which should deviate from
the ideal position by less than 5°. If more than this, the lower column should be released from the rack
pinion shaft and re-positioned on the splines before repeating the procedure.
4.
Final steering wheel alignment is achieved by asymmetric adjustment of the track rods, retaining the
overall toe-out setting.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
HI.5 - STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
The steering column assembly includes a two-piece upper inner column, consisting of two tubes ('A' upper; 'B' lower) with a sliding splined joint to accommodate reach adjustment, articulated via a universal joint
to a similarly constructed two-piece ('C' upper; 'D' lower) intermediate column, which allows for telescoping
compression in the event of vehicle collision. A third, lower column ('E'), is articulated from the intermediate
shaft via a second universal joint, and is splined directly to the rack pinion shaft.
The upper column assembly comprises a steel mounting bracket from which is hung a pivoted alloy carrier for the ball bearing race supporting the lower end (B) of the two-piece upper column. The upper (steering
wheel) end of the column (A) is supported in a steel tube outer column fitted with synthetic plain bushes. The
outer column is fixed to the column mounting bracket via a cam operated clamp, which allows vertical and axial
movement of the upper outer/inner column assembly, the inner column (A) being free to slide over the splines
on the lower column (B). The upper end of the assembly incorporates an alloy housing to accommodate the
steering lock/ignition switch and top bearing.
The lower end of the upper column assembly is articulated via a universal joint to the intermediate column,
which itself comprises an upper tube (C) splined over a lower shaft (D) to provide a telescopic length variation
of approx. 50mm. This feature allows for steering column length compression in the event of vehicle collision
in order to reduce the potential for occupant injury. For a similar purpose, the mounting bracket for the upper
column assembly is constructed in two parts, the forward part being rigidly secured to the scuttle beam, whereas
the rearward part is retained to the beam only by open ended slots equipped with special 'break out' inserts.
In the event of a heavy forward load being applied to the steering wheel, such as may occur in an accident,
the rearward part of the bracket complete with upper column assembly is able to break free from the scuttle,
pushing the column (B) through the lower bearing and collapsing the intermediate column. After any such occurence, the complete steering column assembly should be replaced.
If, in any circumstances, an abnormal load is applied to the steering wheel or upper column assembly,
the column shrouds should be removed and the 'break out' inserts carefully checked.
To Remove Steering Column Assembly
WARNING: The driver's airbag is housed in the hub of the steering wheel. Precautions need to be
taken for personal safety when working with airbags and associated componentry. Do not attempt to
remove the airbag, steering wheel or column without first referring to section WF.
1.
Remove the steering wheel (see sub-section HI.4).
2.
Remove the rotary connector (see sub-section WF.10).
3.
Remove the fascia dash panel (see sub-section VE.7).
4.
Release all wiring harness restraints from the column.
5.
If necessary, remove the steering lock/ignition key barrel: Turn the key to position 'I', depress the spring
pin accessible via a hole in the rear of the housing, and withdraw the lock barrel.
CAUTION: Once the lock barrel has been removed from the column, it is essential NOT to turn the lock
mechanism. Failure to heed this advice will result in the mechanism being irrepairably displaced, and
a complete new column assembly being required.
When re-fitting a lock barrel, note that the key must be positioned at '1' before the locating pin may be
depressed to allow insertion. Ensure the pin is correctly engaged in the housing hole.
6.
If necessary, remove the ignition switch: Depress the two retaining barbs, and withdraw. When re-fitting,
the position of the ignition switch must be adjusted to match that of the lock spindle.
CAUTION: If the lock barrel is removed, on no account should the position of the lock mechanism be
disturbed, or irrepairable displacement of the mechanism may occur, necessitating replacement of the
complete column assembly.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
7.
Disconnect the steering angle sensor, and release its mounting bracket from the scuttle. Release the
clamp securing the sensor to the column.
8.
Remove the front undertray and remove the pinch bolt securing the lower universal joint to the rack pinion
shaft and match mark the joint. Release the gaiter from the chassis aperture.
9.
The column must be withdrawn complete with the two extruded alloy mounting brackets securing it to the
scuttle beam. For each of these two brackets, release the single front fixing into the top surface of the
scuttle beam, and the two rear fixings into the vertical face; all use threaded inserts in the chassis.
10. Withdraw the column assembly from the pinion shaft and through the fascia aperture.
To Refit Steering Column Assembly
New steering column assemblies are supplied without a steering lock barrel or ignition switch to allow
transfer of existing components. A plastic sleeve is fitted in the lock barrel bore for transit purposes.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to remove the plastic sleeve without following the procedure below. Failure
to heed this advice may result in the lock mechanism being irrepairably displaced, and a complete new
column assembly being required.
a)
b)
c)
d)
-
With the plastic sleeve still in place, and the ignition switch removed, use the lock spindle and the features
on the mechanism plate which interfaces with the lock barrel, to turn the lock mechanism to position 1 (to
match the features of the key lock barrel at this position). At this position, the column is unlocked.
As a precaution, maintain a pulling action on the lock spindle from now until the lock barrel is securely
installed.
Turn the plastic insert a quarter turn clockwise and withdraw. With the key turned to position '1', insert the
lock barrel into the lock housing and ensure that the spring loaded pin is engaged in the housing locating
hole.
The lock spindle may now be released.
Continue the assembly procedure in reverse to removal with the following notes:
Slide the steering angle sensor and toe board gaiter over the intermediate column during installation.
Torque tighten fixings as follows:
- Column 'break out' fixings; 24 Nm
- Column to forward fixing holes in extruded scuttle brackets; 24 Nm
- Extruded brackets to scuttle; 24 Nm
- Lower u/j pinch bolts; 25 Nm
HI.5 - TRACK ROD ENDS & RACK GAITERS
Front Wheel Alignment
Alignment is measured either by the angle the front wheels make with the vehicle's longitudinal axis, or
the difference in dimension between the wheel rim to wheel rim measurement at the front and rear of the wheel
at hub centre height. The wheels are said to 'toe-in' when the wheel paths converge ahead of the vehicle,
and 'toe-out' when they diverge. Wheel alignment is designed to vary with both steering angle (Ackermann; to
minimise low speed, tight turn tyre scrub) and suspension travel (bump steer; to provide consistent handling)
and should be measured only 'straight ahead' at the specified mid-laden ride height.
Provision is made for the adjustment of front wheel alignment at the joint between the track rods, which
are ball jointed to the outboard ends of the steering rack, and the outer ball joints ('track rod ends') which connect to the steering arms on the hub carriers. In this application, the track rod ends are extended to form the
major part of the track rods.
The mid-laden ride height and alignment specification is detailed in sub-section CK.2.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
Illustration of track rod adjustment
Note that in order to preserve the required bump steer characteristic and steering symmetry, the effective
length of each track rod must remain equal; compare dimensions and equalise if necessary before subsequently
adjusting each track rod by a similar amount:
-
Slacken the rack gaiter outboard clips.
Hold the track rod using the flats provided, and slacken the locknut. Repeat for the opposite side.
Turn each track rod a similar amount. As a guide, turning both track rods by one quarter of a turn will alter
overall toe-out by approx. 2.0 mm.
When adjustment is correct, hold each track rod and tighten the locknuts to 45 Nm. Tighten the rack gaiter
clips.
CAUTION: When slackening or tightening the track rod locknuts, it is important that the torque reaction is resisted using the track rod flats, and that the ball joint itself is not allowed to be stressed.
Track Rod Ends
The track rod end ball joints are sealed for life and maintenance free. If replacement is required;
Remove the ball pin nut and use a ball joint splitter tool to separate the joint from the steering arm.
Unscrew the track rod from the steering rack tie rod, using the locknut as a refitment position guide.
On re-assembly, tighten the ball joint to steering arm nut to 45 Nm, and set the front wheel alignment as
detailed in sub-section CK.2.
Steering Rack Gaiters
The convoluted gaiters sealing each end of the steering rack housing to the tie rods, should be inspected
at service intervals and replaced immediately if found to be torn, cracked or otherwise damaged. The ingress
of dirt or water into the rack housing will cause rapid deterioration of the track rod inner ball joints, rack end
bushes and rack and pinion mechanism, requiring replacement of the complete steering gear.
To replace a gaiter, remove the track rod (see above), release the gaiter clips, and slide the gaiter off the
housing and tie rod. Check for consequent damage or wear and replace the steering gear assembly if necessary. Fit the new gaiter into position, and secure with new retaining clips.
HI.6 - RACK & PINION ASSEMBLY REMOVAL/REPLACEMENT
The steering rack assembly consists of an alloy pinion housing/valve body, and a steel tube through which
the rack is guided. The pinion housing features two solid bushed lugs, which bolt to an extruded alloy bracket,
itself secured to the subframe with four bolts threading into a tapping plate. The non-pinion end is secured by
a 2-bolt clamp and rubber sleeve around the steel tube to a second extruded bracket, secured with two bolts.
Short ball jointed tie-rods from each end of the rack connect, via extended 'track rod ends' to forward facing
steering arms integral with the forged steel front hub carriers.
Note that the only approved repairs or adjustments to the steering rack assembly are the replacement of
the track rod ends, rack housing gaiters, and the pipes connecting the pinion housing to the rack body.
Page 11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
To Remove/Replace Steering Rack Assembly
The steering rack may be removed from the front subframe after first removing the front anti-roll bar with
its mounting brackets.
1.
Remove both front wheels, and the front undertray.
2.
Release the anti-roll bar from the drop link at each side.
3.
At each side, remove the six screws securing the extruded alloy mounting plate to which the ARB clamp
is fixed. Captive threaded inserts are used in the subframe. Withdraw the anti-roll bar assembly from the
car.
4.
Remove the nut securing each track rod end to the steering arm, and use a ball joint splitter to separate
the joint.
5.
Match mark the pinion shaft against the u/j yoke to aid steering wheel alignment on re-assembly, and
remove the pinch bolt.
6.
Slacken the banjo bolts securing the feed and return pipes to the pinion housing, and collect the draining
oil. Removal of the bolts may not be possible at this stage.
7.
At each end of the rack housing, remove the two bolts securing the unit to the mounting brackets. Withdraw the pinion shaft from the lower u/j and remove the two banjo bolts as the assembly is withdrawn from
below.
To Re-fit/Replace Steering Rack Assembly
Refit in the reverse order to removal, with the following notes:
Engage the pinion shaft with the column u/j (match marks aligned) as the housing is positioned. Fit and
tighten the u/j pinch bolt to 25 Nm.
Before securing the rack housing, refit the feed and return pipes to the pinion housing using new or annealed washers. Torque tighten M14 (return) to 18 - 25 Nm; M16 (feed) to 25 - 30 Nm.
Torque tighten housing fixing bolts (4 off) to 45 Nm.
Torque tighten track rod end ball pin nuts to 45 Nm.
Torque tighten the anti-roll bar clamp mounting plate to subframe bolts (8 off) to 24 Nm.
Torque tighten the anti-roll bar to drop link fixings to 38 Nm.
Refill the power steering reservoir and bleed the system as detailed in sub-section HI.3
Check and adjust the front wheel alignment as detailed in sub-section CK.2.
Note: If the rack mounting plinths are removed from the front subframe, note that there are shim plates fitted
between the plinths and the subframe top surface in order to control the height of the rack and the bump steer
characteristic. Shim plates are available in thicknesses of 5, 2 and 1mm, with the standard setting being two
2mm shim plates at each position. Torque tighten the plinth to subframe fixing bolts to 45 Nm.
hi.7 - pas pump & testing procedure
The vane type, constant displacement hydraulic pump is mounted on the right hand front of the cylinder
block, and is driven by the automatically tensioned multi-rib auxiliary belt from the crankshaft pulley. To check
for correct functionality, the steering effort may be checked with the engine running and the car stationary:
PAS Pump Test Procedure
Tools required
PAS Pressure Test Gauge Kit - use a universal kit, or Toyota part number 09640-10010
1.
Remove the rear clamshell (see Sub-Section BV.6).
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
2.
Check auxiliary drive belt condition and fluid level. With engine idling, turn the steering from lock to lock
several times to raise fluid temperature and check for foaming or emulsification; if necessary, bleed the
system (see Sub-Section HI.3).
3.
Remove the banjo bolt connecting the pressure outlet pipe to the PAS pump. Fit the adaptor pipe from
the test kit into the pump, and connect the gauge inlet pipe to the adaptor.
4.
Connect the outlet pipe on the gauge to the banjo connector using the union adaptor.
5.
Open the gauge valve, and bleed the system of air (see above).
6.
With the engine idling, turn the steering from lock to lock several times to raise fluid temperature (70 80°C).
7.
With the engine idling, close the gauge valve and observe the gauge reading - Do not keep the valve
closed for more than 10 seconds, or excessive oil heating will occur.
Minimum fluid pressure: 7800 to 8300 kPa (1100 to 1200 psi).
8.
With the engine idling, open the gauge valve fully and measure the pressure at engine speeds of 1000
and 3000 rpm.
Maximum difference: 490 kPa (70 psi).
9.
With the engine idling and the gauge valve fully open, turn the steering to full lock and measure the fluid
pressure. Repeat for the opposite lock - Do not keep on full lock for more than 10 seconds, or excessive oil heating will occur.
Minimum fluid pressure: 7800 to 8300 kPa (1100 to 1200 psi).
10. Disconnect the gauge pipes and refit the banjo union to the pump. Bleed the system of air (see above).
hi.8 - pas pump removal & inspection
The vane type, constant displacement hydraulic pump is mounted on the right hand front of the cylinder
block, and is driven by the automatically tensioned multi-rib auxiliary belt from the crankshaft pulley. The pump
is secured to the engine by two bolts, access to which requires the removal of the rear clamshell.
1.
Remove the rear clamshell (see Sub-Section BV.6).
2.
Use a syringe to empty the PAS reservoir of oil and reduce potential spillage.
3.
Using a 14mm hexagonal socket, turn the auxilary belt tensioner counterclockwise to relieve tension on
the belt, and insert a 5mm rod through the tensioner hole to secure in that position. Mark the direction of
rotation on the belt before unhooking from the PAS pump pulley.
4.
Disconnect the reservoir hose from the pump, and plug both hose and pump port.
5.
Disconnect the high pressure feed pipe from the pump, and plug both pipe and pump port.
6.
Disconnect the harness from the PAS pump pressure switch.
7.
The pump is secured to the engine by two bolts, accessible between the spokes of the pulley. Remove
the lower bolt. Unscrew the upper bolt from its threaded boss, but leave in position whilst withdrawing the
pump from the slotted upper lug.
8.
-
Flow Control Valve:
Remove the pressure port union and 'O' ring.
Remover the flow control valve and compression spring.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
9.
-
Lotus Service Notes
Section HI
With the pump port axis vertical, check that the valve (lubricated with PAS fluid) falls smoothly into the
port. If any stickiness is apparent, replace the pump.
Check the valve for leakage: Close off one of the ports in the side of the valve, and apply 450 kPa (65 psi)
of compressed air to the opposite port. No leakage from either end of the valve should be detected.
Measure the free length of the flow control valve spring with a vernier caliper: Minimum = 29.2 mm
Coat the valve with PAS fluid and instal with its spring. Fit a new 'O' ring on the pressure port union, lubricate, instal and tighten to 69 Nm (51 lbf.ft).
Vane Pump Mechanism:
Remove the 4 bolts securing the pump rear housing, and withdraw the housing.
Remove the snap ring from the pump shaft and withdraw the pulley and shaft assembly.
Remove the pump rotor with its 10 vanes, followed by the cam ring and pump front plate.
Pull out the shaft oil seal from the front of the housing, and press a new seal into position.
Measure the thickness of each rotor vane: Specification = 1.405 - 1.411 mm
Measure the side clearance between each vane and its rotor slot: Max. clearance = 0.03 mm
Measure the pump shaft diameter and housing bush diameter and determine the oil clearance:
Max. clearance = 0.07 mm
Refit the shaft and pulley assembly, taking great care not to damage the oil seal.
Fit new 'O' rings to the housing and front plate and lubricate with PAS fluid, before inserting the plate into
the housing with the notch on the rear side rim aligned with the notch in the housing.
Fit the cam ring into the housing with the inscribed mark facing rearwards, and the notch aligned with the
notch in the front plate.
Fit the vane rotor onto the shaft and lubricate before sliding the 10 vanes into their slots.
Retain the rotor by installing a new snap ring into the shaft groove.
Fit a new 'O' ring into the groove in the rear cover, and fit the cover to the housing so that the alignment
pin engages into the notches in the cam ring, front plate and pump housing. Fit the 4 retaining bolts and
tighten to 22 Nm.
Check Preload: Fit a M10 x 1.25 x 50mm bolt into the pulley end of the shaft, and apply a torque wrench
to the bolt. Check pump rotation torque; Max. = 2.8 kgf.cm (2.4 lbf.in).
10. If necessary, fit a new PAS pressure switch with lubricated 'O' ring, and tighten to 21 Nm.
11. Before installing the pump, insert the upper bolt through the top lug on the pump housing. Fit the pump
to the engine and secure with the upper and lower bolts. Tighten both fixings to 43 Nm (32 lbf.ft).
12. Plug in pressure switch connector. Fit banjo bolt with two new washers and connect high pressure pipe
to outlet union. Tighten to 50 Nm (37 lbf.ft). Connect the reservoir hose to the pump spigot and secure
the clamp.
13. Refit the auxiliary drive belt to all pulleys, ensuring that the belt ribs are correlty located on each drive
pulley. Rotate the tensioner counterclockwise to relieve tension, and remove the tensioner locking pin.
14. Refill and bleed the PAS system (see above), and check for leaks.
15. Refit rear clamshell (see sub-section BV.6).
Page 14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
BRAKING SYSTEM
SECTION JL
Sub-Section
Page
General Description
JL.1
3
Tell Tale Lamps
JL.2
4
Brake Fluid Check & Change
JL.3
4
Brake Pad Replacement (front & rear)
JL.4
5
Parking Brake Mechanism
JL.5
7
Brake Discs
JL.6
8
Brake Callipers
JL.7
9
Brake Master Cylinder
JL.8
9
Vacuum Servo Unit
JL.9
10
Pedal Box
JL.10
12
ABS Theory of Operation
JL.11
13
ABS Electro-Hydraulic Unit
JL.12
20
Wheel Speed Sensors
JL.13
21
Data Link Connector (DLC)
JL.14
21
Special Tools
JL.15
21
Lotus TechCentre Checking Procedures
JL.16
22
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
TBA
GENERAL LAYOUT
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section JL
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
JL.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The braking system of the Lotus Evora comprises a four piston calliper and brake disc at each wheel operated by a tandem master cylinder with dual diaphragm vacuum servo power assistance. The dual hydraulic
circuit is divided front/rear and modulated by a Kelsey-Hayes microprocessor based anti-lock system. A cable
actuated parking brake uses brake shoes operating in drums incorporated into the rear discs.
The brake callipers are supplied by A.P. Racing, and feature lightweight alloy bodies housing four pistons
in opposed pairs. The castings for the front and rear callipers are common, but are machined differently to
accommodate the differing piston diameters. In the front callipers, the leading pistons are 38.2 mm diameter,
and the trailing pistons 41.3 mm. The rear callipers house 38.2 mm leading pistons and 36.0 mm trailing. Each
calliper is marked on its inner, inboard face, alongside the pad aperture, with its designated fitting position;
'RF' representing Right hand Front, with others marked as LF, RR, and LR. Each calliper is secured to its hub
carrier by two bolts disposed in a plane perpendicular to the disc axis, with the front callipers mounted behind
the axle line, and the rear callipers ahead of the axle.
The front cast iron discs are 350 mm diameter, 32 mm thick, with optional cross-drilling to enhance pad
cleaning, and include internal curved vanes to draw cooling air from the centre to the periphery, with the vanes
curving backwards in relation to the normal direction of rotation. The rear cast iron discs include similar features,
but are 332 mm diameter and 26 mm thick, and incorporate integral 185 mm diameter drums for the parking
brake shoes. Each disc is sandwiched between the road wheel and hub, and is retained for convenience by
a single countersunk screw.
The Continental Teves tandem master cylinder incorporates a front section to supply both front brakes,
and a rear section to supply the rear brakes. A translucent fluid reservoir is mounted on a bracket above the
master cylinder, and is divided into front and rear chambers separated by a weir. The two chambers are connected to the front and rear master cylinder sections by flexible hose, with a third hose connecting the rear
brake reservoir chamber to the clutch master cylinder to supply that system’s needs. A fluid level sensor in the
filler cap will light a fascia tell tale lamp if the level becomes dangerously low.
The parking brake ratchet lever is mounted between the seats in a fabricated steel structure which also
houses the gearchange mechanism. The lever activates a primary cable which exits the cabin at the front of
the fuel tank bay, and turns through 90° to connect to a balancing yoke at the front of the engine bay. The yoke
forms the abutment for the primary outer cable, with the inner cable continuing through a slot in the yoke to
link to the RH secondary cable. The opposite end of the yoke connects to the LH secondary cable, with both
secondaries leading to their respective rear wheel parking brake backplates. The interaction of the yoke with
the three separate cables results in an automatically balanced force being applied to each of the secondary
cables.
At the each brake backplate the secondary cable connects to a lever mechanism which provides a balanced expanding force to the lower ends of the parking brake shoes. The upper ends of the shoes pivot against
opposite ends of an adjustable length abutment, with access to the toothed adjuster screw available via a hole
in the brake backplate.
The parking brake should be applied by pulling up the lever with high effort, and engaging the highest
ratchet setting attainable. When parking the car on a slope, the additional precaution should be taken of leaving the transmission in first or reverse gear and steering the wheels towards the kerb.
The braking system is designed to enhance brake performance during high speed driving, with good fade
and pad wear characteristics, with the pads offering a higher friction level when heated to normal working temperature than when cold. Required pedal effort will reduce as cold brakes become heated to normal working
temperature, and the braking efficiency will increase significantly as new discs or pads become ‘bedded in’.
After fitting new brake components, maximum braking efficiency will be achieved if, for the first few hundred
miles, needless heavy braking is avoided, and the brake pads are allowed to ‘bed in’ fully before being used
to their full potential.
A Bosch Antilock Brake System (ABS) is used to optimise brake performance in extreme conditions and
reduce the tendency of any wheel to lock up. Under most conditions, the maximum braking force is provided
by a wheel which is rotating at about 90% of road speed. Apart from the likelihood of increasing the stopping
distance, a locked wheel provides no steering force, such that with both front wheels locked, movement of the
steering wheel has almost no effect on vehicle direction. With the antilock system, even panic braking results
in controlled deceleration and the retention of steering response and is especially advantageous when braking
on slippery road surfaces and in bad driving conditions. The ABS control system is self monitoring and has
the capability of switching itself off if a fault is detected, allowing the base brake system to operate without
anti-lock control.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Under normal circumstances, the hydraulic power brake system of the vehicle operates without input from
the ABS, with brake pressures governed by the force applied to the brake pedal in conjunction with vacuum
servo assistance. The ABS microprocessor receives signals from wheel speed sensors at each of the four
wheel hubs, and interprets this data to determine if any wheel is tending to lock up. If imminent lock up is
determined, the microprocessor commands solenoid valves in an electro-hydraulic unit to reduce the pressure
in that particular brake circuit in order to restore wheel speed to that providing the maximum braking force
consistent with continued wheel rotation.
When the ABS is operating, indication to the driver is provided by a ‘pulsing’ sensation felt at the brake
pedal as fluid is pumped between the master cylinder and hydraulic control unit, and also by audible clicking of
the relays and switches. These signals indicate to the driver that maximum retardation is being approached,
and that driving style should be modified to suit the conditions. The minimum stopping distance is achieved
by applying the brakes firmly and steadily, and allowing the ABS to modulate hydraulic pressure. The driver
should not attempt to emulate this process by ‘pumping’ the brake pedal, as modulation at the pedal will treat
all four wheel brakes similarly, rather than the individual wheel control governed by the electronics.
During ABS operation, the wheels may appear to lock momentarily as the wheel speed changes rapidly,
and some tyre noise (intermittent screeching) may be heard. This noise is normal and will vary with road and
tyre conditions. However, a wheel that completely locks and stays locked for more than one or two seconds
is not normal, and indicates that the vehicle should be serviced as soon as possible. The ABS cannot operate
properly if the base brake system is faulty, and will also be affected by dragging brakes, faulty wheel bearings
or other related faults.
The ABS controller constantly monitors the anti-lock system for faults, and lights a fascia tell tale if a problem is detected. Information stored in the computer’s memory may be accessed via the Lotus TechCentre in
order to facilitate diagnosis of system faults (see later).
JL.2 - TELL TALE LAMPS
Two tell tale lamps are provided in the instrument cluster to warn of problems in the brake system.
LOTUS
OFF
Brakes Tell Tale
As a bulb check function, this tell tale will glow red for about 3 seconds after ignition switch on, and then
go out unless one of the following conditions applies:
i)
The parking brake is applied.
ii) The brake fluid level in the master cylinder reservoir is low.
Under normal circumstances, the tell tale should light when the ignition is switced on, and go out when
the parking brake is released. If the lamp stays on, or comes on whilst driving, the car should be stopped
immediately, as this may be an indication of low brake fluid level caused by a hydraulic leak. A button on the
reservoir cap allows the tell tale circuit to be tested.
LOTUS
ABS Tell Tale
The ABS tell tale warns the driver of problems in the anti-lock system. The lamp should light for about
3seconds following ignition switch on, and then go out. If the lamp remains lit, or comes on whilst driving, a fault
in the ABS is indicated. The base brake system will continue to operate normally, but without ABS regulation.
The car can be driven but should be checked and repaired at the earliest opportunity.
OFF
JL.3 - BRAKE FLUID CHECK & CHANGE
Before checking the brake fluid level, ensure that the car is parked on a level surface, and open the front
body access panel. The level of fluid in the reservoir may be inspected without disturbing the filler cap, and
should be level with the top of the ‘MAX’ mark moulded on the transluscent reservoir body. The level will fall
progressively as the brake pads wear in service, and should be checked at each service interval. A sensor
incorporated into the filler cap will light a tell tale lamp in the instrument cluster if the level drops significantly.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Non-mineral type brake fluid symbol
(yellow & black)
j146
BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR
ohe21
As a bulb check, the tell tale should light for about 3 seconds when the ignition is first turned on, but may
also be tested by pressing the button on the filler cap, which action should light the tell tale with the ignition
switched on.
The reservoir is mounted on a bracket fixed to the wiper spindle support, and is connected to the master
cylinder by flexible hoses. An internal baffle divides the reservoir into two compartments, with one section supplying the front brake circuit, and a second section supplying the rear brakes in addition to, via another flexible
hose, the clutch master cylinder. Service wear of the clutch friction plate will cause fluid to be displaced from
the self adjusting clutch slave cylinder, back to the reservoir, and will counteract to some extent the dropping
of the level due to brake pad wear.
If the reservoir needs topping up, first clean around the cap to reduce the possibility of contamination before unscrewing the cap; it is not necessary to disconnect the level sensor cables. Take suitable precautions
to guard against damage to paintwork caused by brake fluid dripping from the level sensor.
Use only a fresh supply of DOT 4 non-mineral type fluid,identified by a yellow and black symbol. Do NOT
use DOT 5 silicone fluid, or any fluid which has been exposed to the atmosphere for more than a brief period,
or any fluid suspected of being wet, dirty or contaminated. Do not overfill. Replace the filler cap securely.
Some service operations, such as replacing brake pads, will result in the displacement of fluid from the
hydraulic circuit back into the reservoir. In order to prevent fluid overflowing from the reservoir, it may be necessary to remove some fluid using a syringe.
Renewal of Brake Fluid
Brake fluid absorbs water from the atmosphere over a period of time (i.e. is hygroscopic), resulting in a
lowering of the boiling point of the fluid, and corrosion of the hydraulic system. For optimum safety and brake
performance, the brake fluid should be renewed every twelve months (including clutch release system).
Brake Bleeding Procedure
If the brake fluid is to be renewed, or an hydraulic component replaced, the system should be bled of air
using the following procedure:
1. Using conventional manual techniques, or low air pressure applied to the reservoir, bleed the system from
each calliper bleed nipple in turn until no air bubbles can be seen.
2. Connect the Lotus Techcentre to the diagnostic link, select ABS and follow the brake bleeding instructions.
Whilst this automatic process is taking place (with all 4 calliper nipples open), gently cycle the brake pedal
up and down whilst keeping the reservoir topped up, to move any air bubbles displaced from the ABS unit
down the hydraulic lines. Finish by closing each nipple with the pedal down.
3. Repeat step (1) to purge each calliper feed line in turn.
JL.4 - BRAKE PAD REPLACEMENT (front and rear)
Pad thickness may be checked with the wheel removed without disturbing the calliper.
Standard pad thickness (excluding backplate); 12.0 mm
Minimum pad thickness (excluding backplate); 2.5 mm
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
If the thickness of any pad is below the specified minimum, the axle set of pads should be renewed.
1.
To remove the brake pads; Use a pin punch to tap one of the pad retaining pins towards the inboard
side. Unhook and remove the anti-rattle spring plate, and tap out the second retaining pin. Use pliers
on the backplate lugs to withdraw the pads from the calliper, noting each pad's position if they are to be
refitted.
Measure the lining thickness and renew the axle set of pads if any lining is below 2.5 mm.
2.
Before replacing the pads, inspect the calliper for any signs of fluid leakage from a piston seal or joint,
and replace the calliper if any such signs are evident. Clean the pad recess in the calliper taking suitable
precautions to protect from dust inhalation. Inspect the brake disc surface condition and thickness (see
below) and replace if necessary.
3.
If refitting the existing brake pads, refit in their original position.
Front Brake Shown
Brake disc
Pad retaining pin
Brake pad
Calliper
Anti-rattle
spring plate
-0564
j164b
4.
If fitting new pads, the pistons must be pushed back into the calliper using suitable calliper pliers, to provide
the necessary space. This action will return fluid to the master cylinder such that some fluid may need
to be removed by syringe in order to prevent overflowing. Do not lever between the disc and piston, or
damage to both components may be caused. Note that new pads are supplied with an anti-squeal overlay
applied to the backplate, and the edge of the pad material should be marked 'FER 4212 FF'.
5.
Position the pads in the calliper, and insert the upper pad retaining pin from the inboard side. Tap fully
into position using a pin punch, and verify the security of the pin. Renew the pin if in any doubt.
6.
Fit the anti-rattle spring plate into position with the top end tucked under the upper pin and the arrow pointing upwards on a front calliper, or downwards on a rear calliper. Insert the second pin, pressing down the
bottom of the spring plate so as to be captured by the lower pin. Verify pin security.
7.
Before driving the car, press the brake pedal several times to bring the pads to their correct running position. Top up the master cylinder reservoir (see above) if necessary, to bring the level to the top of the
‘MAX’ mark.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
8.
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Ensure the customer is made aware that maximum braking efficiency will be achieved if, for the first few
hundred miles, needless heavy braking is avoided, and the brake pads are allowed to ‘bed in’ fully before
being used to their full potential.
JL.5 - PARKING BRAKE MECHANISM
The parking brake ratchet lever is mounted between the seats in a fabricated steel structure which also
houses the gearchange mechanism. The lever activates a primary cable which exits the cabin at the front of
the fuel tank bay, and turns through 90° to connect to an equalising yoke at the front of the engine bay. The
yoke forms the abutment for the primary outer cable, with the inner cable continuing through a slot in the yoke
to link to the RH secondary cable. The opposite end of the yoke connects to the LH secondary cable, with
both secondaries penetrating the rear subframe and routing through the lower wishbone to their respective
rear wheel parking brake backplates. The interaction of the yoke with the three separate cables results in an
automatically balanced force being applied to each of the secondary cables.
At the each brake backplate the secondary cable connects to a lever mechanism which provides a balanced expanding force to the lower ends of the parking brake shoes which operate within brake drums formed
integrally with the rear brake discs. The upper ends of the shoes pivot against opposite ends of an adjustable
length abutment, with access to the toothed adjuster screw available via a hole in the brake backplate.
Parking brake lever
Primary cable
Micro-switch
RH secondary cable
Equalising yoke
LH secondary cable
pl3305eg
The parking brake should be applied by pulling up the lever with high effort, and engaging the highest
ratchet setting attainable. When parking the car on a slope, the additional precaution should be taken of leaving the transmission in first or reverse gear and steering the wheels towards the kerb.
Adjustment
At each service interval, the parking brake should be fully applied, and lever movement assessed by the
number or ratchet 'clicks' attainable. The adjustment is satisfactory when 4 or 5 clicks are achieved.
To make an adjustment;
1. Ensure that the parking brake lever is fully off, and the adjuster in the LH secondary cable is fully slackened
(shortened).
2.
Remove both rear wheels. Using the access hole in the brake drum and hub flange, turn the adjuster
downwards to expand the shoes until the brake drum cannot be turned by hand. Then back off the adjuster
the minimum amount necessary to allow free rotation of the drum without rubbing, and then repeat for the
opposite side.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
3.
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
The cable adjuster may then be tightened to remove slack until the 'click' specification is achieved. Check
that there is no brake drag with the lever fully off.
Parking Brake Shoes
Unless the parking brake shoes are mal-adjusted, the shoe material should suffer little wear. To remove
the shoes, remove the road wheel, fully slacken the brake shoe adjuster, and remove the brake disc (see below).
Mark the shoes with their fitting position before removing the steady pin and spring from each shoe by turning
the pin 1/4 turn. Allow the shoes to fold outboard and release from the adjuster. Remove the upper retraction
spring, and lever the shoes from the adjuster mechanism slots.
Refit in reverse order.
Parking Brake Lever
The parking brake lever is mounted in a steel bracket which also houses the gearchange lever. The
mounting bracket is bolted to an alloy support channel running down the centre of the cabin floor, to which it
is secured by 12 setscrews. The brake lever ratchet pawl operates a micro switch to light the ‘brakes’ tell tale
lamp in the instrument panel whenever the ignition is switched on and the parking brake is applied. The short
front cable is connected to the lever assembly by a clevis pin with spring retaining clip. When carrying out any
work in this area, take care not to damage or misroute the electrical main harness.
The two secondary cables are routed through the lower wishbones and into the brake backplates where
the cable nipples connect to the actuation levers by a 1/4 turn.
JL.6 - BRAKE DISCS
All four wheel brakes use a cast iron brake disc which is sandwiched between the wheel and its hub flange,
being centralised by the hub spigot, and transmitting torque via the clamping force of the road wheel bolts. A
countersunk screw is used to retain the discs for convenience when servicing. The 350 x 32 mm front discs
and the 332 x 26 mm rear discs are all internally ventilated with directionally curved cooling vanes, and have
cross-drilling to aid pad scouring available as an option. The rear discs also incorporate a 185 mm inner drum
to accommodate the parking brake function.
The condition of the brake disc friction surface is a major factor in brake performance and feel, with a good
surface quality and minimal run-out and thickness variation being required. After an extended lay up, some
surface corrosion may develop on the discs which will cause a degradation in braking quality until the surfaces
are cleaned up by normal brake action. Excessive run-out or thickness variation as a result of overheating
or extended wear, may cause brake judder and/or extended pedal travel due to pad ‘knock off’. Scoring and
ridging of the braking surfaces will be exacerbated by operation in dusty or unmetalled road environments, and
will degrade braking performance.
No skimming or re-surfacing of the brake discs is recommended. If the disc becomes badly scored, or
is out of specification in any way, it should be renewed. NOTE: Ensure that there is no discernible free play
in the wheel bearings before attempting to measure brake disc run-out. If disc run-out exceeds the service
maximum, check the hub face run-out before replacing the disc.
Brake disc thickness
New - front
- rear
Service minimum - front
- rear
Runout
New maximum
Service maximum
Hub
Disc mounting face run-out max.
Front Disc Replacement
1. Remove the road wheel.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
32 mm
26 mm
30 mm
24 mm
0.06 mm
0.10 mm
0.05 mm
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
2.
Remove the two bolts securing the brake calliper to the hub carrier, and withdraw the calliper from the
disc. Secure clear without straining the flexible hose.
3.
Remove the single countersunk screw, and withdraw the disc from the hub.
4.
Before re-fitting a disc, ensure that the mating face between disc and hub is scrupulously clean. Mount
the correctly handed disc (with the curved vanes trailing in normal direction of rotation) onto the hub spigot,
align the fixing screw hole, and secure the disc with the screw, tightening to 10 Nm.
5.
Apply Permabond A130 (Blue - A912E7033) to the threads of the calliper fixing bolts. Fit the calliper with
pads over the disc and secure to the hub carrier with the two bolts. Tighten to 86 Nm.
Refit the road wheel and when all brakes are assembled, pump the brake pedal to restore brake pad position before driving the car.
6.
Rear Disc Replacement
Replacement of the rear discs is similar to that for the front discs, except that the adjuster for the parking
brake shoes should first be slackened to allow easy withdrawal of the disc/drum. Re-adjust after re-assembly.
JL.7 - BRAKE CALLIPERS
The brake callipers are supplied by A.P. Racing, and feature lightweight alloy bodies housing four pistons
in opposed pairs. The castings for the front and rear callipers are common, but are machined differently to
accommodate the differing piston diameters. In the front callipers, the leading pistons are 38.1 mm diameter,
and the trailing pistons 41.3 mm. The rear callipers house 38.2 mm leading pistons and 36.0 mm trailing. Each
calliper is marked on its inner, inboard face, alongside the pad aperture, with its designated fitting position; 'RF'
representing Right hand Front, with others marked as LF, RR, and LR.
Each calliper is secured to its hub carrier by two bolts disposed in a plane perpendicular to the disc axis,
with the front callipers mounted behind the axle line, and the rear callipers ahead of the axle.
The brake callipers are to be dismantled or overhauled only A.P. Racing at Wheeler Road, Seven Stars
Industrial Estate, Coventry, CV3 4LB.
Front calliper fixing bolt torque; 86 Nm using Permabond A130.
Banjo bolt, flexi hose to calliper; 20 Nm.
Flexi hose to subframe bracket; 16 Nm.
JL.8 - BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
The Continental Teves tandem master cylinder incorporates a rear section to supply both front brakes,
and a front section to supply the rear brakes. A translucent fluid reservoir is mounted on a bracket above the
master cylinder, and is divided into front and rear chambers separated by a weir. The two chambers are connected to the front and rear master cylinder sections by flexible hose, with a third hose connecting the rear
brake reservoir chamber to the clutch master cylinder to supply that system’s needs. A fluid level sensor in the
filler cap will light a fascia tell tale lamp if the level becomes dangerously low.
The master cylinder is secured to the front face of the brake servo which itself is bolted to the front of the
pedal box. Access is available only after removal of the front clamshell. The master cylinder manufacturer
does not recommend any dismantling of the unit, and supplies no replacement parts or internal components.
If the cylinder is faulty it should be renewed as a complete assembly.
To remove the unit, proceed as follows:
1. Remove the front clamshell (see Sub-section BV.4) and radiator air outlet duct.
2.
Syphon fluid from the reservoir to reduce spillage. Release the two hoses connecting the master cylinder
to the fluid reservoir, and plug the hoses. Disconnect the electrical cables from the reservoir cap.
3.
Release the two brake pipes from the master cylinder, and plug the pipes and ports.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
4.
Release the two nuts securing the master cylinder to the brake servo and remove the cylinder.
5.
Refit the master cylinder in reverse order to removal, using new locknuts and tightening to the following
torques:
- Master cylinder fixing nuts; 25 Nm
- Brake pipes to cylinder; 16 Nm
6.
Fill the reservoir with DOT 4 non-mineral type brake fluid, and bleed the complete brake system of air
using the procedure in Sub-section JL.3.
JL.9 - VACUUM SERVO UNIT
The vacuum brake servo is secured to the front face of the pedal box via a machined alloy spacer, and is
operationally interposed between the brake pedal and master cylinder. Engine generated vacuum is used to
provide pneumatic assistance to the effort applied at the pedal. The unit is supplied by Continental Teves and
is a dual diaphragm unit combining a 178mm (7 in) and 203mm (8 in) diameter vacuum chamber into a single
compact unit to provide a 5:1 assistance ratio. With the exception of the air filter and vacuum elbow/non return
valve, the unit is a non-servicable sealed unit which if found to be faulty, must be replaced as an assembly.
The air filter (surrounds the input push rod) should be replaced whenever the brake system is overhauled, and
cleaned or replaced more frequently if the vehicle is operated in dusty conditions. A non-return valve is incorporated into the vacuum hose elbow connector in the front case of the servo unit. The elbow connector valve
is a push fit into a grommet in the servo shell, and is supplied complete with the grommet.
The servo is of the ‘suspended in vacuum’ type, wherein two flexible diaphragms divide each of two sections within the steel shell into two chambers. One pair of chambers, towards the front side of each diaphragm,
is connected via a non-return valve, to the vacuum produced in the engine’s inlet plenum chamber. The second
pair of chambers, towards the rear side of each diaphragm, connect either to the front chambers, or to atmosphere, under the control of a double acting face valve.
Brakes Off
When the brake pedal is released, the diaphragms and driving piston are pushed fully rearwards by the
main spring, and the input rod (connected to the brake pedal) is also pushed rearwards by its own spring, causing the face valve to close the atmospheric connection. Engine vacuum admitted to front of the diaphragms is
also communicated to rear of the diaphragms via the face valve. The unit is in stable equilibrium.
Initial Movement
Initial movement of the brake pedal causes the input rod, input piston and face valve to move forwards,
closing off the front/rear communication.
Pressure Balance
Further pressure on the brake pedal pushes the input piston further forwards and opens the face valve to
bleed atmospheric pressure into the rear chambers. The resultant pressure imbalance across the diaphragms
acts to apply a force to the driving piston to assist pedal effort. When the combined input force from foot pressure
and servo pneaumatic pressure balances the reaction force of the main spring and master cylinder, movement
of the driving piston ceases, and both face valve ports close. The system is once again in equilibrium.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Tandem Servo Section (brakes off)
Vacuum supply
Atmospheric Driving piston
chambers
Pliant reaction disc
Atmospheric Communication
Atmospheric
valve face
Input
rod
Air filter
Front/rear
communication
Input piston
Main spring
Vacuum communication
Vacuum chambers
Atmospheric communication
j194
From this position of equilibrium, further pressure on the pedal will tend to open the atmospheric valve
face and allow pressure in the rearward chambers to increase, and move the driving piston forwards before
again stabilising. Any reduction in pedal pressure will tend to open the front/rear valve face and allow the higher
pressure in the rearward chambers to bleed off into the frontal chambers, whose depression is kept low by
connection to the intake plenum. The pressure imbalance allows the driving piston to move rearwards under
the action of the main spring and master cylinder, until equilibrium is regained.
Maximum Assistance
At around 900N of input rod pressure, the atmospheric port will be held open, so that the rearward chambers will be subject to full atmospheric pressure. This constitutes maximum servo assistance which will, with
0.8 bar of vacuum available from the engine, increase the force applied to the master cylinder pushrod by a
factor of five.
The pliant reaction disc fitted between the input and output rods ensures a graduated application of servo
assistance and provides pedal feedback and ‘feel’ to the driver.
Operational Check
As a quick check of servo operation proceed as follows: With the engine stopped, press the brake pedal
several times to exhaust the servo unit of vacuum. Keeping the pedal pressed (which should be ‘hard’ and
‘high’), start the engine; The pedal should drop slightly as the servo vacuum builds up, and extra force is produced. If the pedal does not drop, it is most likely that there is a fault in the vacuum supply line. Check the
vacuum hose, all connections and the non-return valve. If the vacuum supply is not defective, the servo unit
should be replaced.
Page 11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Setting brake pedal: It is essential that the servo piston (and master cylinder piston) is allowed to return fully
when the brakes are released, and is not pre-loaded by mal-adjustment of the input pushrod. See (4) below.
Stop light switch: The stop switch is mounted in a right angle bracket fixed to the underside of the scuttle, and
abuts directly against the pedal. The switch is retained in the bracket by a quarter turn mechanism, with no
adjustment provided or required.
To Replace Brake Servo Unit
1. Remove the brake master cylinder (see sub-section JL.7).
2.
From within the footwell, disconnect the servo pushrod from the brake pedal.
3.
Disconnect the brake servo vacuum hose, and release the four nuts securing the servo to the pedal box
extension plinth. Withdraw the servo assembly.
4.
Before replacing a servo unit, first check the adjustment of the clevis on the input pushrod (i.e. the effective
length of the pushrod). With a new rubber gasket fitted over the four servo mounting studs, the perpendicular distance from the surface of the gasket to the axis of the clevis pin hole should be 133mm.
5.
Replace the servo in reverse order to the above, tightening the servo mounting nuts to 25 Nm, and the
master cylinder new fixing nuts to 25 Nm. Check pushrod adjustment (see sub-section JL.9) and bleed
the hydraulic system (see sub-section JL.3)
JL.10 - PEDAL BOX
The pedal box is fabricated from alloy sheet, and rivetted, bolted and bonded to an aperture in the chassis
scuttle. A hollow steel pivot shaft serving the brake and clutch pedals is bolted to a steel mounting plate, itself
bolted to the inside of the pedal box. The brake and clutch pedals are fabricated from steel plate, and feature
synthetic bushes for maintenance free articulation on the steel pivot shaft, and serrated alloy footpads. The
brake pedal uses a coil pull off spring, and the clutch pedal is equipped with an overcentring coil spring linkage,
in order to reduce the pedal effort required to maintain full clutch disengagement. A clutch pedal potentiometer
is also fitted in order to provide data for Cruise Control operation, and for the start inhibit function on Canadian
market cars.
The 'drive by wire' throttle actuation uses a steel rod fabricated pedal to operate an electronic module and
provide a signal to the engine ECU, which then actuates the throttle valve stepper motor within programming
constraints. The throttle pedal module is secured to a mounting bracket by three bolts, with a further three bolts
fixing the bracket to the pedal box.
Pedal Removal
To remove the throttle pedal assembly complete with mounting bracket, disconnect the harness plug from
the module, and remove the three bolts securing the bracket to the pedal box.
To remove a brake or clutch pedal from the pivot shaft, the pedal shaft mounting plate must be removed
from the pedal box complete with the brake and clutch pedals:
1. Unplug and remove the throttle pedal assembly complete with mounting bracket by releasing the three
screws securing the bracket to the pedal box.
2.
Disconnect the brake and clutch pedals from their pushrods, and unhook the brake pedal return spring.
3.
Unplug and remove the clutch pedal position switch with mounting bracket, by releasing the two bolts
securing the bracket to the pedal box.
4.
Release the clutch pedal assistor spring anchor bracket from the pedal box side (3 bolts).
5.
Remove the two bolts securing the clutch master cylinder assembly to the pedal box and support the
cylinder aside.
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
6.
Remove the 4 remaining fixings securing the pedal shaft bracket to the pedal box, and manoeuvre the
pedal assembly from the car.
7.
Release the three Torx head screws securing the pedal shaft and withdraw the shaft and pedals
8.
Refit the pedals in reverse order to removal, noting that the pivot bushes of the brake and clutch pedals
should be lubricated with Syntheso GLK1 or equivalent.
Torque Settings
Brake servo to alloy spacer
Pedal shaft bracket to pedal box
Throttle pedal mounting bracket to pedal box - M6
- M8
Nm
25
16
16
25
JL.11 - ABS THEORY OF OPERATION
The Bosch antilock brake system is an ‘add on’ type used to supplement the dual circuit, tandem master
cylinder, vacuum servo assisted brakes fitted to the Evora. A single electro-hydraulic unit comprising a hydraulic
modulator, hydraulic pump, microprocessor and solenoid valve bank, is flexibly mounted on the forward side of
the driver's toebox, and plumbed into the front and rear brake circuit lines from the tandem master cylinder.
The microprocessor receives signals from magnetic wheel speed sensors integrated into each of the four
road wheel hubs, and interprets the individual wheel acceleration, deceleration, and comparative wheel speeds.
From this data, the processor is able to determine if any wheel is tending to lock up, and if imminent lock up
is sensed, the unit commands the relevant solenoid valves firstly to reduce pressure in that particular brake
circuit in order to restore wheel speed, and then to modulate pressure to that providing the maximum braking
force consistent with continued wheel rotation. The system is able to monitor and independently control each
of the four wheel brakes, and is referred to a 4-channel system.
In order to achieve the required pressure modulation, three basic modes are used:
Pressure hold;
Pressure reduction;
Pressure increase;
In order to maintain the safety provision of two entirely independent hydraulic circuits, one for the front
brakes, and one for the rear, the hydraulic elements of the control unit are doubled up, with no part of the system shared between the two circuits. For the pressure hold function, four isolation solenoid valves are used,
one in the hydraulic circuit for each wheel brake. The pressure reduction function is achieved by a separate
dump solenoid valve in each of the four wheel brake circuits, and the pressure increase provided for by a single
electric motor operating two hydraulic pumps, one serving the front, and on the rear brake circuit. Separate
low pressure accumulators are used for the front and rear circuits.
Electro-Hydraulic Control Unit
The electro-hydaulic control unit comprises an alloy valve block containing the four isolation valves, four
dump valves, two hydraulic pumps and two accumulators, with the single pump motor screwed to the housing,
and with a solenoid block and ECM unit attached. The complete assembly is flexibly mounted via a bottom
spigot and two threaded studs, each of which engage with a rubber grommet in a mounting bracket secured by
4 bolts to the front side of the driver's toebox. A protective alloy shield is secured by two nuts.
The isolation and dump valves share a similar construction, but the spring loaded isolation valves are
normally open, and the dump valves normally closed.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Anti-Lock Braking
Maximum braking force is provided from a tyre when there is around 15% slippage, dependent on road
surface conditions and tyre characteristics. The function of the ABS is to limit tyre slippage when braking to
around this figure in order to provide optimum grip, and also, by preventing wheel lock, to ensure that steering
control of the vehicle is retained.
A high brake pedal pressure (or low road surface friction) may initiate the locking of one or more wheels.
In the diagram below, a typical control strategy is shown:
1.
Normal braking occurs until, as the applied pressure increases, the wheel speed signals received by the
ECM indicate that the left hand front wheel (for example) is tending to lock. i.e. its deceleration is too rapid,
with too great a speed differential with the other wheels.
2.
The connection between the master cylinder and the LH front brake circuit is interrupted (by the isolation
valve), and the rate of slip increase is reduced.
3.
If the wheel speed continues to depart significantly from vehicle speed, the dump valve is energised to
reduce pressure in the LH front circuit until wheel speed begins to increase. The dump valve is then
closed, as is the isolation valve.
4.
As wheel speed approaches that providing optimum grip, the isolation valve is pulsed open to allow a
stepped pressure increase.
5.
As wheel speed begins to drop off and depart from vehicle speed again, a new cycle starts, repeating
steps (1) to (4).
6.
When wheel speed increases sufficiently to meet vehicle speed, ABS intervention ceases, although monitoring is continued throughout each braking event.
j186
Page 14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Sequence of Operation
In the following diagrams, one half of the hydraulic modulator is shown schematically, representing the
front brake control circuit, with the sequence of operation described for the left hand front wheel brake. This
sequence would be similar for any of the other three wheel brakes. A typical emergency braking event is
described where, in this example, the left hand front wheel tends to lock. Note that the complete system is
duplicated for the rear brake circuit, which remains completely independent of the front circuit.
Normal Braking
During normal braking, when the wheel speed sensors indicate no imminent wheel locking, the ABS is
inactive. The solenoids are unenergised, so that the isolation valves are sprung open, and the dump valves
sprung closed.
Hydraulic fluid from the master cylinder enters the modulator via the inlet port, by-passes the attenuator
orifice, passes through the open isolation valve and out to the LH front wheel brake.
LHF
Isolation
valve
LHF
Dump
valve
RHF
Dump
valve
RHF
Isolation
valve
To LHF
circuit
To RHF
circuit
Inlet from
master
cylinder
Pump
Pump motor
Low pressure
accumulator
Page 15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
j149a
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Pressure Isolation (Pressure Maintain)
If signals received from the wheel speed sensors indicate imminent lock up of the LH front wheel, the first
step in the anti-lock sequence is to isolate that wheel brake circuit from the master cylinder. The ECM energises
the isolator valve solenoid, which closes the valve against spring pressure and maintains existing pressure in
the left hand front brake circuit regardless of any increase in pedal pressure.
Isolation valve
energised and
closed
Pressure
trapped
in LHF
brake
line
Inlet from
master
cylinder
j149b
Page 16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Pressure Reduction
Once the LH front wheel brake circuit has been isolated from the master cylinder, the pressure must be
reduced in order to allow wheel speed to be restored. This pressure reduction is achieved by the ECM energising the dump valve solenoid, which then opens against spring pressure and bleeds off some of the fluid into the
low pressure accumulator shared with the RH front circuit. Very short activation pulses are used to maintain
close control of the pressure reduction, and to limit the reduction to that required to restore wheel speed. Fluid
displaced from the wheel brake circuit is stored in the front brake accumulator against spring pressure, and is
also used to prime the hydraulic pump.
Isolation valve
energised and
closed
Dump valve
energised and
open
Fluid
bleeds
off from
LHF circuit
Inlet from
master
cylinder
Pump is
primed
Low pressure
accumulator
charged
j149c
Page 17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Pressure Increase (Re-apply)
As soon as imminent wheel lock is detected by the ECM, and the ABS control system is activated, the
pump motor is energised. When the dump valve is opened, and fluid is allowed to bleed off from the wheel
brake circuit into the low pressure accumulator, this fluid is scavenged by the pump and returned back into the
input circuit through an attenuator orifice. This action is the origin of the ‘pedal pushing back’ sensation felt by
the driver, with the pressure pulsations from the pump damped and quietened by the restriction of the orifice.
When wheel speed has been restored and the brake pressure is required to increase, the isolation valve is
momentarily opened, to allow master cylinder/pump pressure to raise the pressure in the wheel brake circuit
in increments. If imminent locking is again sensed, the isolation valve closes, the dump valve opens and the
cycle repeats, with the whole process occuring several times a second.
Isolation valve
pulsed open
Increasing
pressure
to LHF
brake
Inlet from
master
cylinder
Attenuator
Pump orifice
operating
Accumulator
discharges into
pump
Page 18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
j149d
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Brake Release
When no further wheel locking is sensed by the ECM, the ABS becomes inactive with the isolation valve
open (solenoid de-energised) to allow direct communication between the master cylinder and wheel brake
circuit, and the dump valve closed (solenoid de-energised) to seal off the pressure relief circuit. The pump will
remain running for a short time to help drain any fluid from the accumulator, whose piston is returned to its start
position under the action of the spring, and return the fluid to the master cylinder reservoir.
Isolation valve
de-energised
and open
Output
to LHF
brake
Inlet from
master
cylinder
Pump runs
for short
period
Fluid scavenged from
low pressure accumulator
j149e
Page 19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
JL.12 - ELECTRO-HYDRAULIC UNIT
The electro-hydraulic unit is located on the front side of the driver's toebox, and is accessible from below
after removal of the front undertray. The protective cover may be removed after slackening the two retaining
nuts. The unit is secured to the mounting bracket via two studs and a bottom spigot, all supported in flexible
grommets. The mounting bracket is fixed to the chassis by four bolts. A single 38 pin connector plug with a
cam lever is provided to connect the vehicle harness to the control module.
CAUTION: Do not disconnect or connect the main connector plug with the ignition switched on. Switch
off the ignition and disconnect the harness before carrying out any electrical welding operations on
the car.
Hydraulic pipe connections to the unit comprise two input pipes from the master cylinder (one for the front
circuit, one for the rear) and four output pipes, one for each of the wheel brakes. Note that all hydraulic connections are identified by engraved markings on the unit:
Input:
MC1 From master cylinder rear port (front brake circuit)
MC2 From master cylinder front port (rear brake circuit)
Output:
FL Front left
FR Front right
RR Rear right
RL Rear left
To Remove Electro-Hydraulic Unit
When removing the unit, beware of dripping brake fluid and take appropriate precautions to prevent damage to paintwork.
1. Raise the vehicle and remove the front undertray. Remove the module protective cover.
2.
Switch off the ignition before pressing the release tab and folding back the cam lever to disconnect the
harness plug.
3.
Label each of the hydraulic pipes before disconnecting from the unit and immediately capping the pipes
and plugging the ports to reduce the spillage of brake fluid, and to prevent the ingress of dirt.
4.
Release the four bolts securing the mounting bracket to the chassis and withdraw the bracket with ABS
unit.
5.
To remove the unit from the bracket, release the two retaining nuts from the studs and slide the unit from
its three grommets.
6.
To refit, reverse the removal procedure, taking care to connect the brake pipes correctly:
Mounting bracket to chassis; 24 Nm
Modulator inlet pipes; 18 Nm
Modulator outlet pipes; 16 Nm
7.
Bleed the unit of air (see Sub-section JL.3).
8.
Verify correct connection by using the ‘Lotus Techcentre’ tool in actuator tests with the car on a wheel free
lift. Check that operation of each solenoid valve affects the appropriate wheel.
Note that the ABS controller is calibrated specifically for the Evora. Do not use parts from other
sources.
Page 20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
JL.13 - WHEEL SPEED SENSORS
A 48 pole vehicle speed sensor ring is integrated into the hub inboard grease seal, the signal from which is
read by a sensor inserted into the rear of the hub carrier and retained by a single button head socket screw.
Wheel speed data is supplied to the ABS control module, which uses the information to modulate brake
system pressures, and also outputs a road speed signal to the engine ECM, and to the instrument pack for
speedometer operation. Output from each wheelspeed sensor can be checked using the Lotus TechCentre.
JL.14 - DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
The Data Link Connector (DLC) is a 16 terminal electrical connector plug, complying with SAE J 1962,
which provides a means of communication with the ABS and engine management electronic control units. The
connector is used in service to connect electronic diagnostic equipment such as the ‘Lotus TechCentre’ tool
which allows system interrogation including the reading of trouble codes.
The DLC is located on the back of the scuttle crossbeam above the outboard side of the driver's
footwell.
JL.15 - SPECIAL TOOLS
Lotus TechCentre
Can Bus Diagnostics
Controller Area Network (CAN) is an electronic standard to allow high speed communication between modules
and controllers, via a serial data bus. The bus is a circuit linking the modules to the controller, consisting of a
pair of cables, twisted together to reduce electromagnetic interference, and carrying a square wave voltage
signal corresponding to '0's and '1's, coded in such a way as to identify and prioritise the individual messages.
On the Evora, CAN based systems include; engine management, anti-lock braking, safety restraint, instrument
pack and tyre pressure monitoring (where fitted).
A 'stand alone' lap top PC loaded with 'Lotus TechCentre' software allows the CAN based serial data to be
read. Updates and support are accessed via an internet connection.
A Vehicle Communication Device (VCD), part number T000T1476F, is used to connect the vehicle to the laptop Lotus TechCentre. Engine programming, live data display, diagnostics of engine, ABS and airbag systems,
and service tell tale lamp resetting (where applicable) are all carried out via the Lotus TechCentre.
The minimum specification of the laptop computer for installation of the Lotus Techcentre is as follows:
Processer 1.70 Ghz;
1 GB RAM;
40 GB HDD;
CDRW DVD ROM;
WIN XP PRO;
USB interface;
Ethernet or Wireless LAN
Note that it is recommended that this laptop be dedicated soley to the Lotus TechCentre, with no other software installed. A licensing/support fee will also apply, to be charged monthly or annually.
Page 21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
JL.16 - ‘LOTUS TECHCENTRE’ CHECKING PROCEDURES
1. Trouble Codes
i)
ii)
iii)
When the ABS controller detects a fault in the system, the following events occur;
The ABS tell tale is lit;
The anti-lock system is switched out;
A trouble code is stored in the non volatile random access memory i.e. memory which is retained when
the power supply is interrupted, or the battery disconnected.
Trouble codes may be either Condition Latched, or Ignition Latched:
Condition Latched; With this type of fault, which is generally low or high voltage, the ABS tell tale will light, and
the anti-lock system switch out, until such time as conditions return to normal, at which point the light will be
extinguished, and the anti-lock be reinstated. The trouble code will be stored only whilst the fault is present.
Ignition Latched; This type of fault, of which are most categories, will cause the tell tale to be lit and the antilock to be inhibited until such time as the fault is no longer detected at the moment of a subsequent switching
on of the ignition. At this point, the lamp will be extinguished, and the ABS restored, but the trouble code will
be retained in the memory for the next 20 drive cycles i.e. ignition switched on and a minimum road speed of
5 mph attained.
Access to diagnostic codes is available by using the Lotus TechCentre laptop PC connected to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC - see JL.14). This tool allows the display of any stored trouble codes and sensor
readings as well as allowing manual operation of actuators.
The facilities available include:
Viewing fault codes/wheel speeds/valve activities.
Clearing fault codes.
Generating valve/motor activities.
Reading EEPROM contents.
Reading ECM identification.
Updating ECM calibration.
Important Notes
Whenever the Lotus TechCentre tool is connected, the ABS tell tale is lit and the anti-lock function is inoperative.
Never connect or disconnect the DLC to/from diagnostic equipment with the ignition switched on.
Unless using a trickle 'battery conditioner' type charger, disconnect the vehicle battery before charging or
boost charging.
Never disconnect the battery from the vehicle electrical system with the engine running.
Never use a quick-charger for starting.
Take care when touching energised parts of the ignition system.
ECMs must be removed prior to welding operations, or subjecting to oven temperatures above 80°C.
When voltage testing, use only a high-resistance type meter.
During test steps which involve the connection of contacts from harness plugs or control units with ground
or battery voltage (+12V), exercise great care as incorrect contact can cause permanent damage to the
ECM internal circuits.
When measuring resistance from ground bearing wires to vehicle ground, the nominal value of ‘less than
2 ohms’ sometimes cannot be achieved. In this case, disconnect the negative (ground) post of the battery
and measure the resistance to the vehicle earth lead.
Always erase trouble codes from any control unit after a test is done.
Page 22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
2. Abbreviations & Definitions
BATTERY VOLTAGE
BRAKE LIGHT SW.
FL WHEEL SPEED
FR WHEEL SPEED
RL WHEEL SPEED
RR WHEEL SPEED
FRONT WHL SPEEDS
REAR WHL SPEEDS
VALVE RELAY CMD
VAVLE RELAY FDBK
RETURN PUMP CMD
RETURN PUMP FDBK
FL HOLD SOL. CMD
FL HOLD SOL. FDBK
FL REL. SOL. CMD
FL REL. SOL. FDBK
FR HOLD SOL. CMD
FR HOLD SOL. FDBK
FR REL. SOL. CMD
FR REL. SOL. FDBK
RL HOLD SOL. CMD
RL HOLD SOL. FDBK
RL REL. SOL. CMD
RL REL. SOL. FDBK
RR HOLD SOL. CMD
RR HOLD SOL. FDBK
RR REL. SOL. CMD
RR REL. SOL. FDBK
System voltage
Brake light switch
Front left wheel speed
Front right wheel speed
Rear right wheel speed
Rear right wheel speed
Front wheel speed
Rear wheel speed
Valve relay command
Valve relay feedback
Return pump command
Return pump feedback
Front left solenoid hold command
Front left solenoid hold feedback
Front left solenoid release command
Front left solenoid release feedback
Front right solenoid hold command
Front right solenoid hold feedback
Front right solenoid release command
Front right solenoid release feedback
Rear left solenoid hold command
Rear left solenoid hold feedback
Rear left solenoid release command
Rear left solenoid release feedback
Rear right solenoid hold command
Rear right solenoid hold feedback
Rear right solenoid release command
Rear right solenoid release feedback
3. ECU Identification
Lotus Electro-Hydraulic Unit part number: C132J0007J
Bosch Electro-Hydraulic Unit part number: 0 265 236 143
Bosch ECU Software reference: 6209306030000
Page 23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
5. Diagnostic Trouble Codes
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code Storage Condition
C0035 Front left wheel speed sensor: Short circuit or circuit open;
No signal;
Incorrect signal;
C0040 Front right wheel speed sensor: Short circuit or circuit open;
No signal;
Incorrect signal;
C0045 Rear left wheel speed sensor: Short circuit or circuit open;
No signal;
Incorrect signal;
C0050 Rear right wheel speed sensor: Short circuit or circuit open;
No signal;
Incorrect signal;
C0060 Front left outlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0065 Front left inlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0070 Front right outlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0075 Front right inlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0080 Rear left outlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0085 Rear left inlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0090 Rear right outlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0095 Rear right inlet solenoid valve circuit malfunction;
C0110 Return pump: circuit open or shorted;
locked or shorted;
C0121 Valve relay circuit malfunction;
C0161 Brake light switch fault;
C0232 Brake system telltale voltage: high or open circuit;
low;
C0245 Wheel speed: sensor erratic signal;
C0245 error;
C0252 Replace electronic control unit;
C0550 Replace electronic control unit;
C0550 Brake system or electronic control unit malfunction;
C0556 Replace electronic control unit;
C0561 Replace electronic control unit;
C0563 Replace electronic control unit;
C0564 Replace electronic control unit;
C0800 Switched battery voltage: high (valve relay)
low (valve relay)
For remedial procedures, see Lotus TechCentre display.
Page 24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section JL
Page 25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
ENGINE COOLING
SECTION KJ
Sub-Section Page
General Description
KJ.1
3
Maintenance
KJ.2
4
Drain/Refill Procedure
KJ.3
5
Radiator & Cooling Fan
KJ.4
6
Radiator Fan & Re-circ. Pump Control
KJ.5
7
Radiator Feed & Return Pipes
KJ.6
7
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Bleed screw
Heater matrix
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Thermostat housing
k76
Oil from pump
Heater feed
to heat exchanger
Oil/water
Heater return heat exchanger
Radiator
Recirc. pump
feed pipe
Oil flow from heat
exchanger to filter
Outlet housing
Lotus Service Notes
Header tank
Bleed screws
By-pass pipe
Heater return rail
Throttle body
Engine cooling
radiator
Thermostat Open
Section KJ
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
Thermostat Closed
Heater matrix Thermostat closed
circuit
By-pass flow
Throttle body circuit
Heat exchanger circuit
k76a
KJ.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The engine liquid cooling system comprises an engine driven water pump, flow thermostat, front mounted
radiator with two electric cooling fans, header tank, re-circulation pump, and associated plumbing.
The centrifugal water pump is mounted on the front face of the cylinder block, and is driven by the multirib, serpentine auxiliary belt. The pump discharges coolant into a separate volute chamber for each of the two
cylinder banks, where, after cooling the cylinders, flow is directed upwards into each cylinder head before exiting into an outlet housing bolted to the rear of the cylinder heads. From this housing, offtakes are provided for
the engine cooling radiator, heater matrix, throttle body, radiator by-pass pipe and, if fitted, an oil/water heat
exchanger. A thermostat housing is located on the timing cover above the water pump, and controls the flow
of returning coolant from the front mounted radiator.
Thermostat closed circuit (cold engine):
At coolant temperatures below 80°C (176°F) the dual valve thermostat is closed, shutting off the return
circuit from the radiator and opening a by-pass valve to admit coolant from a by-pass pipe connected to the
outlet housing on the rear of the engine. Coolant exiting the cylinder heads meets a closed radiator circuit and
is directed through four subsidiary circuits:
By-Pass: The greater proportion of flow is via the radiator by-pass pipe back to the engine side of the thermostat housing.
Heater: An offtake on the engine outlet housing feeds the heater matrix via a re-circulation pump (see below),
pipework running through the RH sill, and a heater by-pass valve mounted to the left of the HVAC unit. Return pipework follows a parallel route and connects to the rear end of the heater return rail. This return rail is
routed down the 'V' of the cylinder block, alongside the by-pass pipe, and connects to the engine side of the
thermostat housing.
Throttle body: A small offtake on the outlet housing supplies a flow of hot water to the throttle body to inhibit
ice formation around the valve in severe climatic conditions. An outlet hose from the throttle body connects to
heater return rail.
Oil/water heat exchanger (if fitted): On cars so fitted, an oil/water heat exchanger is fitted on the LH side of
the cylinder block and is fed with engine lubricating oil via feed and return hoses linking to the main bearing
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
panel. A hose from the engine coolant outlet housing feeds the heat exchanger, with a return hose linking to
the heater return circuit. When the engine is cold, heat is transferred from the quickly warming coolant to the
engine oil, whilst at high engine temperatures, the temperature managed coolant acts to extact heat from the
hotter lubrication system.
Thermostat open circuit (normal running temperature):
At temperatures above 84°C (183°F), the thermostat fully opens the radiator circuit, and closes the bypass valve.
From the engine outlet housing at the rear of the engine, a pipe running through the left hand sill directs
coolant to the single front radiator, rubber mounted between the two longerons of the front subframe and angled
forwards at about 45 degrees. The a.c. condenser is mounted ahead of the radiator, to which it is secured by
brackets riveted to each sideframe of the radiator. Cooling air is admitted through the front clamshell intake
aperture, and exhausted upwards through ducts in the front clamshell ahead of the windscreen, with airflow
augmented when necessary by two electric fans, each with 7 curved blades, mounted on the rear face of the
radiator. The fans are housed in a plastic shroud which incorporates 12 load relief flaps designed to blow
open under ram airflow, and be sucked closed when the fans are operating, in order to maximise fan cooling
efficiency. The aluminium radiator core uses moulded plastic top and bottom tanks, with the top tank divided in
order to direct the incoming coolant downwards through the LH side, and then upwards through the RH side to
the outlet spout. A pipe through the RH sill returns coolant to the thermostat housing on the front of the engine,
within which coolant flows through the open thermostat and back into the water pump.
The heater, throttle body and oil/water heat exchanger circuits continue to operate as described above,
with a low flowrate through the radiator by-pass circuit.
Header tank
To ensure that the cooling system remains fully filled, whilst providing expansion space for the hot coolant
and to facilitate 'topping up' of the system, a translucent header tank is mounted at the LH rear of the engine
bay. The tank is connected into the cooling system via a hose which joins into the heater return hose, whilst
an air bleed hose from the radiator feed hose near the outlet housing, connects to the air space in the header
tank. A threaded, 108 kPa (15 psi) pressure cap is fitted to the neck of the tank.
Re-circulation pump
In order to control engine temperature in conditions of 'heat soak' after stopping a hot engine, an electric
re-circulation pump is fitted in the heater take off hose between the engine outlet and heater feed pipework.
The pump is enabled for a short period after engine shut down, and is energised under engine ECU control to
pump coolant through the heater circuit and limit the potential for localised boiling within the cylinder head. For
details of the pump control strategy, refer to sub-section KJ.5
KJ.2 ‑ MAINTENANCE
The engine cooling system uses a header tank to ensure that the system remains completely filled, and
also to accommodate expansion of the coolant with increasing engine temperature. The tank is mounted at the
left hand rear of the engine bay, and is fitted with a 108 kPa (15 psi) pressure cap to raise the boiling point of
the coolant to over 120°C (250°F).
WARNING
•
Do NOT attempt to remove the pressure cap from the header tank when the engine is warm as
serious scalding could result from boiling water and/or steam.
•
Coolant is hazardous to your health and may be fatal if swallowed.
•
Keep coolant out of reach of children.
•
Coolant is hazardous to animals and may be fatal if swallowed. Clean up spilled coolant and do
not leave in open containers.
The level of coolant in the translucent header tank will rise as the engine warms up, and fall as it cools
down, and under normal circumstances it should not be necessary to add any coolant to the system between
scheduled services. If overfilled, the excess coolant will be expelled when the engine is warm. If underfilled,
overheating may result. When the engine is completely cold, and the car is standing on a completely level
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
surface, the coolant in the header tank should be close to the 'FULL' mark, represented by the horizontal seam
running around the tank. The lowest acceptable level is 25mm below the seam.
If topping up is required, wait until the engine has fully cooled before slowly unscrewing the filler cap and
allowing any remaining pressure to escape before finally removing the cap.
In order to maintain protection from freezing damage and metal corrosion, use only an approved coolant
mixture (see below) to top up the header tank to the 'FULL' mark. Refit the cap, and turn clockwise until the
tab on the cap engages a detent, at which position an abutment prevents any over-tightening.
NOTICE: If the cap is removed when the engine is warm, the coolant may boil and a small coolant loss may
occur. The completely cold header tank level should be checked at the first subsequent opportunity.
Anti‑Freeze/Corrosion Inhibitor
It is necessary that the coolant contains an anti‑freeze with corrosion inhibitor to protect the engine and
heat exchangers from both frost damage, and corrosion of the metallic elements. In order to protect against
these dangers as well as raising the boiling point of the coolant, the Evora is factory filled with a 50% concentration of Havoline XLC, which is a mono-ethylene glycol coolant using organic acid technology (OAT) to provide
increased corrosion protection compared with conventional coolant additives. A yellow label around the header
tank neck identifies the coolant type used. The corrosion inhibiting carboxylic acids in the OAT coolant tend to
remain in solution rather than being deposited on the internal surfaces of the cooling system, thus improving
heat transfer and extending service life. Havoline XLC is the only recommended coolant product, and at 50%
concentration provides freezing protection down to approximately - 40°C. Even in warm climates it is recommended that the concentration is not allowed to fall below 25%, in order to maintain full corrosion protection.
The simplest means of checking the antifreeze concentration is to measure the specific gravity (density)
of the coolant at a known temperature, using a hydrometer. The following table provides a general guide:
Concentration
25%
33%
50%
Density @
20°C
1.039
1.057
1.080
60°C
1.020
1.034
1.057
The coolant density reflects the effective level of mono‑ethylene glycol, and not the level of corrosion inhibitors present, whose effectiveness diminishes over a period of time. The coolant should therefore be renewed
every 4 years to ensure optimum corrosion protection.
In areas where the tap water is extremely hard (exceeding 250 parts per million), use of this water will
lead to 'furring up' of the system over a period of time. In such areas, distilled, de‑ionised or filtered rain water
should be used.
Radiator Fin Cleaning
At service intervals, the matrix of the engine cooling radiator and a.c. condenser should be checked for
clogging by insects, leaves and other debris. If necessary, use a water jet from both above and below to clean
the fins, taking care not to damage the fragile tubes or distort the finning. At the same time, check the integrity
of all cooling system joints, and the condition of all flexible hoses. In snowy conditions, ensure the radiator air
exit is cleared of snow before driving the car.
KJ.3 ‑ DRAIN/REFILL PROCEDURE
Due to the configuration and routing of the cooling system plumbing, there is no satisfactory low point
from which the entire cooling system may easily be self drained. A threaded plug is provided on the radiator
bottom tank, which will drain the radiator, but little more unless the car is tilted nose down to some extent. For
access to the plug, the front undertray must be removed. Each side of the cylinder block is provided with a
drain tap, that on the left being near to the back of the a.c. compressor, and on the right, towards the rear end
of the block.
If the coolant is to be renewed, draining of the pipework can be assisted by applying a low pressure airline
to the header tank filler neck. Note that with ignition off, the heater solenoid shut-off valve is open.
To refill, secure the radiator drain plug, block drain taps and pipework, and fill the system with a recomPage 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
mended coolant mixture (see above) via the header tank. An air bleed plug is located on the heater return
hose near its connection with the return rail, and a bleed nipple is incorporated on the by-pass pipe near its
joint with the thermostat housing. An additional bleed plug is provided on the radiator feed pipe accessible
via a grommet in the LHF wheelarch liner. All bleeds should be opened until a steady stream of coolant flows
from each. Start the engine and allow to idle, and periodically open the bleed plugs to allow any trapped air
to be expunged. Top up the header tank when necessary, and fit the pressure cap when required to prevent
overflow. When the cooling fans have cut in and then out, stop the engine and allow to cool. Re-check coolant
level when fully cold.
KJ.4 - RADIATOR & COOLING FANS
The engine cooling radiator, a.c. condenser and cooling fans are secured together as a package and are
mounted between the two longerons of the front subframe, angled fowards at about 45°, condenser lowermost,
radiator above and the two cooling fans on the top side of the radiator. The radiator uses an aluminium core,
with tubes running vertically between the top and bottom plastic tanks, the upper tank housing both inlet and
outlet spouts and an internal midpoint division, in order to provide a 'U' flow route for the coolant and optimise
radiator cooling performance. To protect the radiator structure from potentially damaging vibrations and road
shocks, the radiator is provided with two spigots on the bottom tank, and a spigot at the top of each sideframe,
with each spigot engaging into a rubber mounting grommet contained in a bracket bolted to the subframe.
Radiator Fans
Mounting rails for the cooling fan cowling run across the top and bottom of the rear face of the radiator,
being secured by screws to the radiator sideframes, with forward extensions to carry the a.c. condenser by a
single screw at each corner. Each of the two fan motors is secured to the moulded cowling by four screws,
but cannot be removed from the cowling without first releasing the fan from the motor shaft, which operation
requires that the cowling be removed from the radiator.
Removal of the radiator exit grilles from the front clamshell provides access to the fan harness connectors
for diagnostic purposes, but for fan motor or radiator removal, it is necessary to remove the front clamshell.
To replace:
1. Remove the front clamshell (see sub-section BV.4).
2.
Unplug both fan harness connectors.
3.
Release the six caphead screws securing the fan cowling to the radiator rails, and withdraw complete with
the two motor assemblies.
4.
Withdraw the fan from the motor shaft and release the four screws securing the fan motor to the cowling.
5.
Refit in reverse order to removal.
Radiator
To replace: If only the radiator is to be replaced or serviced, it is possible to leave the a.c. condenser in situ to
avoid the requirement to recover the refrigerant:
1.
Remove the front clamshell (see sub-section BV.4)
2.
Remove the front undertray and radiator lower duct (note; front fixings to bumper are slotted).
3.
Remove the drain plug from the radiator bottom tank, and collect coolant.
4.
Disconnect inlet and outlet hoses from the radiator top tank.
5.
Unplug the harness connector plug to each of the fan motors.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
6.
To avoid the requirement to recover the refrigerant, provide alternative support before releasing
the 4 fixings securing the a.c. condenser to the radiator; ensure that the a.c. pipes and unions are not
stressed.
7.
Release the two brackets securing the top of the radiator to the subframe and ease the spigots on the
bottom tank from its mounting grommets. Withdraw the radiator and fan motor assemblies from the car.
8.
Refit in reverse order to removal, and refill the cooling system (see sub-section KJ.3).
KJ.5 - RADIATOR FAN & RE-CIRC. PUMP CONTROL
The two cooling fans are fitted on the top side of the radiator/condenser package, and the coolant recirculation pump is mounted at the top left hand rear of the engine, plumbed into the heater feed circuit. Both
the fans and pump are controlled by the engine management ECU using data provided by the engine coolant
temperature sensor and a.c. pressure sensor.
Cooling Fans Control
The cooling fans are switched as a pair, and will operate at half speed (connected in series) when coolant temperature reaches 98°C on rise (94°C with a.c. on), and switch off at 96°C on fall (92°C with a.c. on). If
coolant temperature rises to 105°C (96°C with a.c. on), the fans will switch to full speed (connected in parallel),
reverting to half speed on fall at 98°C (94°C with a.c. on).
Note that the temperatures displayed on the instrument panel may differ from the programmed values
described above due to damping lag.
The fans are also activated by signals received from the air conditioning pressure sensor; the fans will run
at low speed for pressures between 13 - 18 bar, and at high speed for pressures over 18 bar.
Certain types of ECU detected engine fault will also cause the fans to be activated as an engine protection
measure. If the ECU receives a coolant temperature sensor signal voltage outside of the acceptable range, a
default setting equating to 60°C will be substituted, and the cooling fans will run at half speed.
Re-circulation Pump
A coolant re-circulation electric pump is mounted on a bracket fixed to the underside of the intake airbox,
and is plumbed into the heater supply line close to the coolant outlet housing at the LH end of the engine. When
energised, the pump circulates coolant through the heater system, drawing coolant from the cylinder head, and
pumping it through the heater matrix and back to the engine.
Heat Soak
After ignition switch off, the ECU remains live for a minimum period of 1 minute for coolant temperatures
below 75°C (at time of switch off), extending progressively to a maximum period of 10 minutes for temperatures
over 90°C. If, during this period, the coolant temperature exceeds 110°C, the re-circ. pump will be activated
and will run for a maximum period of 6 minutes, or until the coolant temperature falls to 50°C.
If, during the ECU live period the coolant temperature rises to 120°C, the cooling fans will run at slow speed
in addition to the re-circ. pump, for a maximum period of 2 minutes, or until the temperature falls to 70°C.
Defrost Enhancement
In order to speed windscreen defrosting/demisting, when coolant temperature is between 2°C and 60°C,
the re-circ. pump will be activated to boost coolant circulation through the heater matrix, commencing 10 seconds after engine start up. The pump will continue to run until 30 seconds after either 1400 rpm is exceeded,
or the coolant reaches 60°C.
KJ.6 - RADIATOR FEED & RETURN PIPES
For both the feed and return circuits between the engine and radiator, two alloy pipes are utilised, one
routed together with other pipework, along the outside of the chassis main siderail (feed on left, return on right),
within the composite body sill moulding, and one pipe over the wheelarch area to link the front end of the sill pipe
with the radiator. No joints are incorporated in the sill sections, where the pipes are supported in foam blocks
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section KJ
clamped to the chassis side. Access to the joints at each end of the sill pipes is available with the appropriate
wheelarch liner removed.
Replacement of a sill pipe is not possible without removing or cutting the body sill which is bonded to the
chassis. Such a pipe replacement should not however be necessary unless accident damaged together with
the body sill.
For full access to the wheelarch area pipes, the front clamshell must be removed.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
FUEL SYSTEM
SECTION LN
Sub-Section Page
General Description
Fuel Requirement & Filling
LN.1
3
LN.2
4
Precautions
LN.3
5
Fuel Pump/Sender Assembly
LN.4
6
Fuel Tank
LN.5
7
Fuel Supply Test
LN.6
8
Charcoal Canister
LN.7
8
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
Evora Fuel System Layout
Fuel pressure
Regulator valve
Push fit
Filler neck Fuel rails connector
Throttle
body
Fuel injector
Purge solenoid valve
Test port
Charcoal canister
Fuel tank
Fresh air vent/
purge air intake
Tank pressure
sensor
Tank
breather
pipe
Push fit
connector
Pump/sender unit
Fuel feed pipe
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Tank mounting cradle
L67
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
LN.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The 60 litre fabricated stainless steel fuel tank is mounted within an open bottomed chassis crossmember
ahead of the engine bay and beneath the floor of the cabin rear compartment. The fuel filler neck is connected to
the RH rear corner of the tank, with a breather connection at the LH front corner, and the pump/gauge sender unit
mounted centrally in the front upper surface, accessible via removeable panels in the body floor and chassis.
In order to meet stringent vapour emissions legislation, various components are housed within the tank,
and include the pump assembly and filter, a fill level vent valve, and two gradient vent valves. The pump assembly supplies fuel to the engine fuel rail at a controlled pressure using a non-circulation system.
Inside the tank, a spring loaded flap at the bottom of the filler pipe, allows fuel to enter the tank but inhibits
fuel surge up the pipe during cornering forces or extreme vehicle attitude changes. During the filling process,
tank ventilation is provided by a fill level vent valve (FLVV) mounted within the tank to the left of the pump.
The FLVV allows venting of fuel vapour to the charcoal canister via pipework connecting to the tank breather
spigot at the left hand front top corner of the tank. When the fuel level reaches the design maximum, a float ball
valve shuts off the vent, causing a pressure rise in the filler neck and triggering the nozzle auto-shut off. The
float valve will function in a similar manner to reduce fuel spillage in the event of a vehicle roll-over. In order
to ensure tank breathing when the car is parked on a side slope with a near-full tank, at which time the FLVV
may be closed, a gradient vent valve is fitted at each end of the tank and connected to the same tank outlet
spigot. These valves allow a slower rate of vapour escape and also include a low pressure holding valve and
roll-over shut-off functionality. Note that with the exception of the fuel pump/sender unit, none of these 'in-tank'
components are serviceable other than by fuel tank replacement.
The tank structure incorporates a system of baffles surrounding the pump assembly to ensure that the
pump inlet is kept submerged during extreme dynamic forces until the fuel level becomes near empty. The
modular fuel pump/gauge sender assembly is mounted inside the tank, clamped to the top surface by eight
studs. The pump uses an electric motor to power an integrated turbine, to draw fuel through an intake strainer
sock, and pump the fuel through the motor body and a non-return valve, to exit into a filter chamber incorporated into the housing of the pump/sender unit. After the filter, a pressure regulating valve controls the output
line pressure to around 3.2 bar, spilling excess fuel back into the tank, and supplying the pressurised fuel to
the outlet port on the top surface. A non-recirculation type of fuel feed system is employed in order to minimise
evaporative emissions. The feed pipe is routed along the LH top rear of the fuel tank bay to emerge through
the chassis beneath a plastic shroud, and thence into the engine bay. The pipe then continues without a joint
until connecting to the LH end of the engine rear bank fuel rail, to which the front bank rail is linked by a short
connector hose.
When the ignition is first switched on, the engine management ECU energises the fuel pump for a period
of about 3 seconds to prime the system before switching off. If a signal from the crankshaft sensor indicates
that the engine is being cranked or is running, the fuel pump feed will be maintained. The pump is switched
off immediately the ignition is turned off, or about 3 seconds after a stall. Note that after the ignition is turned
off, the ECU will remain live for up to 20 minutes (dependent on coolant temperature), to allow for heat soak
management (see sub-section KI.5).
A safety inertia switch is incorporated into the fuel pump electrical circuit, and operates in a severe impact
(indicative of a vehicle collision) to switch off the fuel pump feed and minimise the fire risk. The doors will also
be unlocked. The switch is mounted on the seat belt mounting frame LH backstay, accessible from the engine
bay, and is reset once tripped, by pressing the rubber button on the top of the switch.
An evaporative emissions 'charcoal' canister is mounted at the LH side of the engine bay bulkhead, beneath
the air intake duct, and is connected to the tank by a moulded tube. The plastic shroud covering the fuel pipes
in the cabin rear compartment, incorporates a removeable plate to allow access to the breather pipe connection to the tank. The purge port of the canister is connected to a solenoid valve mounted on the LH end of the
front bank cam cover, and thence to the intake plenum just downstream of the throttle body. The evaporative
emissions control system prevents untreated fuel vapour from the tank reaching the atmosphere, by absorbing
the tank vapour in a bed of activated charcoal in the canister. When the engine is running, the engine management ECU opens the purge solenoid valve by duty cycle, and allows intake manifold depression to draw fresh
air through the canister via a third port on the canister, purging absorbed fuel from the charcoal, and consuming the resultant vapour in the normal combustion process. In this way, the charcoal bed is 'cleaned' ready to
absorb more tank vapour when the engine is stopped.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
LN.2 - FUEL requirement & FILLING
Fuel Requirement
Use only premium grade UNLEADED fuel with a minimum octane rating of 95 RON. Using fuel with a
lower octane rating may cause knocking (pinking) which, if severe, can cause serious engine damage. Light
knocking may occasionally be heard for short periods when accelerating or driving up hills, and should cause
no concern, although using a lower gear would be advised. If, however, persistent heavy knocking is heard
when using the specified fuel, a fault is indicated.
If no unleaded premium grade fuel is available, 91 RON unleaded fuel may be used for short periods,
but heavy engine loads and wide throttle openings must be avoided. The use of good quality fuels containing
proper detergent additives is advised for good performance and emission control.
The Evora is fitted with ‘three way’ catalytic converters in the exhaust system in order to reduce the
noxious content of the exhaust gases and comply with emission control regulations. It is essential that ONLY
UNLEADED FUEL is used. The effectiveness of the catalytic converters decreases after as little as one tankful
of leaded fuel or LRP.
Note
•
The use of leaded fuel, or lead replacement petrol (LRP), will cause irreversible contamination of the precious metal catalysts and of the exhaust gas sensors used by the computer controlled engine management
system.
•
Fuel system damage and running problems, resulting from the use of incorrect fuels will not be covered
by your New Vehicle Warranty.
•
DO NOT push or tow start the car; or turn off the ignition at engine speeds above idle; or run the fuel tank
dry: Any of these actions may damage the catalytic converters.
Ethanol E5 & E10 - A mixture of 5% or 10% ethanol (grain alcohol) and unleaded petrol may be used in the Evora
but the lower octane rating (typically 93 - 94 RON) will result in slightly reduced performance and economy. If
driveability problems are experienced as a result of using ethanol, use 95 RON unleaded petrol. Do not use
Ethanol blends with a higher concentration than 10%.
Methanol ‑ Do not use fuels containing methanol (wood alcohol). Use of this type of alcohol can result in per
formance deterioration and damage to critical parts in the fuel system.
Fuels Containing MMT - Some fuels contain methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT), which is an
octane enhancing additive. Such fuels may damage the emission control system and should NOT be used.
Diesel ‑ The Lotus Evora will not operate on diesel fuel.
Fuel Filling
WARNING:
Be aware of the danger of explosion when dealing with petrol and its attendant fumes. Before
stopping at a filling station, switch off mobile phones, ensure that all cigarettes are extinguished
and that no naked flames or other potential ignition sources are present.
Switch off the engine before refuelling.
Remove the filler cap slowly to allow any pressure to bleed off gradually. Hasty removal may result
in a small amount of fuel spray with a possible health or fire hazard.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
ohe22
LOTUS
Section LN
Filler cap parking
tab
OFF
OFF
Fuel filler flap
release button
ohe43
Filler Cap: The fuel filler is located in the right hand rear quarter panel, concealed by a flush fitting hinged
flap. To open the flap, press the release button in the fascia panel outboard of the steering column, with or
without the ignition key in position, and the flap will spring fully open. Unscrew the filler cap. As the cap is
turned, any pressure differential between the tank and the atmosphere will be released and a brief hiss may
be heard. Allow the pressure to equalise gradually to avoid the potential for a small amount of spray. Note
that the cap is tethered to prevent its loss, and should be hooked onto a tab provided for this purpose, on the
hinge of the flap.
To refit, place the cap into the filler neck and turn clockwise until the ratchet mechanism clicks several
times. Push the flap closed.
Filling Procedure: Insert the pump nozzle fully into the neck, and fill until the auto-shut off mechanism is trig
gered. Do not attempt to ‘brim’ the tank to the top of the filler neck, as expansion of the fuel due to temperature
change (e.g. cold underground fuel storage) may cause flooding of the fuel tank breather system charcoal
canister, or spillage of fuel.
The total usable fuel capacity is 60 litres (13 imp.gal), but for re-fuelling purposes, from the time the low
fuel tell tale is triggered, approximately 50 litres can be accommodated. Note that from the point of low fuel tell
tale activation to the gauge reading empty, is around 5 litres.
Note: The remaining balance of approx. 5 litres, should be treated only as an emergency contingent, the use
of which may entail intermittent fuel starvation dependent on driving conditions, and potential engine damage.
In such a situation, driving style should be modified to minimise engine load and cornering forces.
If maximum engine or handling performance is to be exploited, or severe gradients tackled, a high fuel
level should be maintained to ensure the greatest safety margin of fuel supply.
LN.3 ‑ PRECAUTIONS
The fuel line between pump and injector rail, and the injector rail itself, contain pressurised fuel both when
the ignition is switched on, and for a period after switching off. This feature aids engine starting by reducing
the time needed to build up operating fuel pressure, and by inhibiting the formation of vapour pockets in the
supply line after switching off a hot engine.
WARNING:
i)
To minimise the risk of fire and personal injury, relieve the fuel system pressure before servicing
any part of the fuel supply circuit. See ‘Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure’ below.
ii) To reduce the possibility of sparks occurring when a fuel line is disconnected, or when fuel vapour
is present, the negative battery cable should be disconnected before work is commenced.
iii) When fuel lines are disconnected, absorb any escaping fuel in an absorbent cloth and dispose of
safely.
Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure
This procedure should be used prior to disconnecting any part of the fuel line.
‑
Remove the fuel pump fuse R19, start the engine, and run until it stops from starvation. Crank the engine
for a further few seconds.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
‑
-
‑
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
If the engine is a non-runner, pull out the fuel pump fuse, and crank the engine for 20 seconds to minimise
residual fuel pressure.
Disconnect the battery.
The hose connecting the fuel tank to the fuel rail has no joints other than the push-on connectors at each
of its ends. For access to the fuel tank connection, the cabin rear compartment floor must be removed,
followed by the body and chassis access hatches. To access the fuel rail connection with the clamshell
fitted, it is necessary to remove the airbox.
Surround the pipe joint with a shop towel to absorb fuel contained in the pipework before pressing the
release buttons and separating the joint.
WARNING: Be aware of the possibility of full pressure retention in the fuel line caused by a system
fault.
-
On re-fitting, push the joint firmly together until a click is heard. Pull on the pipe to ensure complete engagement.
LN.4 - FUEL Pump/TANK sender
The fuel pump/gauge sender unit is mounted centrally in the front upper surface of the fuel tank, accessible
via removeable panels in the cabin rear compartment body floor and chassis. The modular fuel pump/gauge
sender assembly is mounted inside the tank, clamped to the top surface by eight studs. The pump uses an
electric motor to power an integrated turbine, to draw fuel through an intake strainer sock, and pump the fuel
through the motor body and a non-return valve, to exit into a filter chamber incorporated into the housing of
the pump/sender unit. After the filter, a pressure regulating valve controls the output line pressure to around
3.2 bar, spilling excess fuel back into the tank, and supplying the pressurised fuel to the outlet port on the top
surface. A non-recirculation type of fuel feed system is employed in order to minimise evaporative emissions.
Note that for some markets, a fuel tank pressure sensor for on-board diagnostics is fitted alongside the pump/
sender in the tank top surface.
The fuel gauge sender is mounted on the side of the pump housing, and uses a float on a pivoted arm to
operate two rheostat strips supplying fuel level data to the engine ECU.
To remove/refit fuel pump assembly
1. De-pressurise the fuel system (see sub-section LN.3).
2.
Remove the cabin rear compartment floor covering, and the access panels in the body and chassis. Using an absorbent cloth to collect residual fuel, slide the yellow retaining clip aside and withdraw the pipe
from the pump spigot.
3.
Unplug the harness connector to the pump and pressure sensor (if fitted).
4.
Release the 8 fixings and withdraw the securing the clamp plate, noting the position of the earth lead.
5.
Taking suitable precautions to catch any dripping fuel, carefully withdraw the pump assembly from the
tank aperture, taking care not to damage the delicate float arm, strainer sock, or other vulnerable parts.
6.
Fuel pump: If necessary, the fuel pump may be removed from the housing by unclipping the yellow retainer,
removing the rubber cushion, unplugging the harness connector, and withdrawing the pump.
7.
Before re-fitting, ensure that the strainer sock is clean, replacing if necessary, and using a new retaining
clip. Note that the non-return valve is incorporated into the outlet spout of the pump, and is not individually
replaceable.
8.
PRV: The pressure regulator valve may be replaced after unclipping the yellow retainer from the base of
the housing, and withdrawing the valve.
9.
Level sender: The fuel level sender unit may be removed from the housing by unplugging the connector,
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
depressing the retaining barb behind the resistor block, and sliding the block downwards.
10. Before re-fitting the assembly back into the tank, ensure that all connector plugs are secure, and that the
top sealing ring is in good condition. To aid subsequent removal, apply a dab of MoS2 grease to each of
the retaining studs on the tank before fitting the pump assembly. Feed the unit through the tank aperture
and fit the retaining ring over the eight studs. Note that the cut out and dowel holes in the clamp plate
define its orientation in respect to the pump. A flat on the clamp plate must align with the front edge of the
tank.
11. Fit the earth cable onto the stud positioned at 4 O'clock as viewed from behind. Fit all fixing nuts and
nip tighten to 2 Nm in a diagonal sequence before final tightening to 5 - 6 Nm. Ensure the yellow clip is
securely engaged with the fuel supply pipe connector.
ln.5 - fuel tank
The 60 litre fabricated stainless steel fuel tank is mounted within an open bottomed chassis crossmember
ahead of the engine bay and beneath the floor of the cabin rear compartment. The fuel filler neck is connected
to the RH rear corner of the tank, with a breather connection at the LH front corner, and the pump/gauge sender
unit mounted centrally in the front upper surface. The tank is clamped into position by a pair of extruded alloy
cradles incorporating transverse restraints, bolted fore/aft across the underside of the chassis bay, with the tank
located and protected by a set of foam strips and pads interposed between the tank and chassis.
Fuel tank removal/refit
This operation is most easily and safely performed when the fuel level is lowest. If this is not possible, it
is recommended to pump out the fuel into a suitable container in order to minimise the tank weight.
1.
De-pressurise the fuel system (see sub-section LN.3).
2.
Top connections: Remove the cabin rear compartment floor trim. Remove the central access panel and
disconnect the fuel feed pipe and harness connector from the tank. Plug the fuel tank port. Remove the
access panel at the left hand side of the compartment, and disconnect the beather pipe from the tank.
Plug the tank port.
3.
Filler hose: From inside the car, remove the rear bulkhead access panel, and release the filler hose from
the filler neck, and seal the hose. Also release the fuel tank earth cable from the chassis stud at the right
hand front of the engine bay
4.
Undershield: Remove the 26 fixings and remove the fuel tank undershield.
5.
Parking brake cable: Release the parking brake primary cable from the secondary cables, and free from
any chassis fixings.
6.
Gearchange cables: Release the gearchange cables from the chassis fixings to provide sufficient slack
to allow tank withdrawal.
7.
Cradles: Provide alternative support for the tank before releasing the four screws from each of the two
tank retaining cradles. Lower the tank from the chassis.
8.
Refitting: Before refitting the tank, ensure that all the foam pads are in position and secure on either the
chassis or tank, and renew if necessary. Check that all apertures are sealed. Check that the fuel feed
pipe is in position along the front of the tank bay.
- Carefully raise the tank into position and ensure that it is firmly in contact with the front pad.
- Fit the retaining cradles using Permabond A130 (A912E7033V) on the bolt threads, and torquing to 24
Nm.
- Continue in reverse order to removal.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
ln.6 - fuel supply test
To Test Fuel Pump Output
Fuel pressure is controlled by the fuel pump and pressure regulator valve. Delivery may be checked at
the connection to the fuel rail after de-pressurising the system and using a proprietary fuel pressure gauge.
The procedure for testing fuel pressure, set by the pressure regulator valve on the end of the fuel rail,
is detailed in section EM. Base fuel pressure is 3.0 bar. If the result of this test is satisfactory, the fuel pump
delivery quantity may be checked as follows:
WARNING: Take all necessary precautions to guard against fire and explosion risk when dealing with
fuel and fuel vapour.
1.
Disconnect the fuel rail return line (e.g. at quick fit connector), and arrange for collection of return fuel into
a suitable container.
2.
Arrange for an auxiliary 12 volt feed to the fuel pump to allow continuous operation.
3.
Run the pump for one minute and measure the fuel quantity delivered.
Specification = 2.0 - 2.8 litres.
If below specification, check the fuel filter for restriction before replacing the fuel pump.
To Remove Pump/Sender Assembly
1. Remove the fuel tank (see sub-section LN.4).
2.
Release the circlip securing the pump assembly into the tank top flange, noting that the unit is lightly spring
loaded, and withdraw the unit and sealing ‘O’ ring. Take suitable precautions to catch any dripping fuel.
Cap the tank aperture to prevent dirt ingress and to reduce the fume hazard.
3.
To release the fuel gauge sender unit, unclip the black foot from the base of the canister, and disengage
the sender mounting bracket from the canister. Disconnect the electrical cables from the unit and withdraw.
Take care not to damage the float arm.
4.
For access to the pump, depress the three retaining barbs, and withdraw the reservoir canister from the
pump assembly. Unplug the pump electrical connector, and pull the pump from its outlet spigot.
5.
Thoroughly clean the fuel inlet strainer socks on the pump and canister before refitting.
Re-fitting Pump/Sender Assembly
Fit the pump assembly into the tank aperture using a new ‘O’ ring, and locate the positional tab on the
pump top plate in the tank flange slot. Retain with the circlip. Refit the fuel tank and ‘shear’ panel.
LN.7 - CHARCOAL CANISTER
In order to prevent fuel vapour venting from the fuel tank to atmosphere, the breather pipe from the tank
is routed to a canister filled with activated-charcoal, which absorbs and stores the fuel vapour when the engine
is stopped. When the engine is running, the canister is connected to the depression in the intake plenum such
that fresh air is drawn through the canister to purge the charcoal of its absorbed fuel, with the resultant gas
then consumed by the engine in the normal combustion process.
Charcoal Canister
This is mounted on the bulkhead at the left hand front of the engine bay, oriented horizontally with its
base to the left, located in a socket bracket, and its top, which houses the three pipework connections, to the
right and secured to another bracket by a single M6 screw. Access to the unit is available after removal of the
airbox intake trunking.
The right hand end of the bed is ventilated via the lowermost port marked 'AIR', to which is attached a
length of rubber hose routed down the front of the engine bay. The breather pipe from the fuel tank uses a
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section LN
press button quickfit connector to join to the mid-positioned spigot on the canister marked 'TANK', within which
the port is extended to the far end of the charcoal bed. In this way, vapour from the fuel tank is cleansed of fuel
by the charcoal bed before being vented.
A second quickfit type connector is used on the purge pipe spigot positioned uppermost and marked
'PURGE', and which also communicates with the left hand end of the bed. The external pipe from this port
incorporates a service test connector before joining the purge solenoid valve mounted on the rear end of the
LH camshaft cover. The outlet pipe from this valve connects to the engine intake plenum just downstream of
the throttle valve. The solenoid valve is opened during certain engine running conditions in order to allow intake depression to draw fresh air through the vent pipe and charcoal bed, cleansing the charcoal of fuel before
consuming the resultant vapour in the normal combustion process. In this way, the charcoal is prepared for
further vapour absorption when the engine is stopped.
Control System
The canister purge valve is controlled by the engine management ECU, which keeps the valve closed
(unenergised) when the engine is cold or idling in order to protect the catalyst and maintain idle quality. At
normal running temperatures and engine speeds above idle, the ECU monitors other parameters and sensor
data and when appropriate conditions pertain, the ECU will apply a duty cycle to the valve in order to regulate
the amount of purging allowed, so as not to corrupt the smooth running of the engine.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
ELECTRICS
SECTION MR
Sub-Section
Page
PFK 457 Vehicle Security Alarm
MR.1
2
Central Door Locking
MR.2
6
Electric Windows
MR.3
7
Door Mirrors
MR.4
8
Switches & Instruments - Driver's Information
MR.5
10
Component Location & Fuse Ratings
MR.6
23
Audio Equipment
MR.7
27
Battery, Battery Cables & Earthing Points
MR.8
28
Wiper Mechanism
MR.9
29
Harness Routing
MR.10
30
Headlamp Assemblies
MR.11
31
Bulb Replacement
MR.12
32
Instrument Panel
MR.13
33
Circuit Diagrams
MR.14
34
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
MR.1 - pfk 457 VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM
Keys
A mechanical key is used to operate the combined ignition switch/steering column lock, and the emergency
manual door locking function via the left hand door. The keyhead incorporates three push buttons by which to
operate the electronic immobiliser, alarm system and central door locking.
A duplicate key is supplied with the new car and, on receipt, should be separated and kept in a safe place
for use in an emergency. The mechanical key code and security system PIN (sPecific Identification Number)
are also supplied with the keys, and should be removed from the key ring by the owner, and noted safely with
the vehicle documents. These numbers should also be recorded by the selling dealer and kept securely with
the vehicle file in the interests of customer service. The codes will be required when ordering or programming
replacement or additional keys, and the PIN will allow the security system to be overridden in case of transmitter loss or failure (see later).
Vehicle Security Alarm
The Lotus Evora is fitted as standard with a PFK 457 immobiliser/alarm which includes the following
features:
•
U.K. approval to Thatcham category 1.
•
‘Dynamic coding’ of the transmitter keys; Each time the transmitters are used, the encrypted rolling code
is changed to guard against unauthorised code capture.
•
Passive activation of immobiliser, central locking and alarm system.
•
Ingress protection using sensing switches on the latches of both doors, and the tailgate.
•
Selectable cockpit intrusion detection using a microwave sensor.
•
Self powered siren to maintain protection if the vehicle battery is disconnected.
•
Personal protection by ‘on demand’ activation of the siren.
•
Emergency alarm override and transmitter key programming using an alarm sPecific Identification Number
(PIN).
•
Homesafe and selectable dynamic (drive away) locking.
Transmitter Keys
Two transmitter keys are provided with
the car, and combine a mechanical key blade
with a three button transmitter unit incorporated into the key head. The mechanical
key operates the ignition switch/steering lock
and emergency manual door locking. The
transmitter operates the central locking, alarm
system and electronic immobiliser. The 4-digit
code for the mechanical key, the unique serial number of the immobiliser/alarm, and the
system’s 5-digit sPecifc Identification Number
(PIN), are supplied on plastic tags attached to
the key ring of a new vehicle.
Manual siren, tailgate
Disarm, mobilise, unlock
Arm & Lock
TRANSMITTER KEY
ohs128d
Disarming the Alarm/Unlocking
When approaching the car, it is likely that the vehicle is locked and the alarm armed, as indicated by
the alarm red tell tale lamp in the speedometer face flashing once every 3 seconds. To disarm the alarm and
unlock the doors:
Press the central, unlock, button on the transmitter key. The first press will unlock the driver’s door, and
a second press, the passenger’s door.
This command will be acknowledged by a double flash of the hazard lamps.
The alarm tell tale will be extinguished.
The interior and mood lights will fade on, and remain lit for up to 2 minutes (if set to the ‘courtesy’ position).
The engine will be mobilised (see below).
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Auto Re-arm
If a door is not opened and closed within 2 minutes of a disarming command, the doors will passively relock and the alarm system re-arm.
Passive Immobilisation
In order to provide a measure of automatic vehicle security, independent of any driver initiative, the system
will automatically immobilise the engine’s cranking and fuel pump circuits after the ignition has been turned off
for 40 seconds, or a similar period has elapsed since the last mobilising command. With the ignition off, the
alarm tell tale will indicate that immobilisation is in effect by a brief flash every 1.5 seconds. With ignition on,
immobilisation is indicated by a continuously lit tell tale.
To mobilise the car (i.e. allow engine starting) with ignition on or off, press once the transmitter centre
button; the alarm tell tale will be extinguished.
Arming the Alarm/Locking the Doors
To lock the doors and arm the alarm, remove the ignition key, shut both doors, and check that the tailgate
is properly closed.
Press once the raised logo button on the transmitter key.
This command will be acknowledged by a single flash of the hazard lamps.
Both doors will be locked, and after a settling period of 40 seconds, the engine will be immobilised, and
the alarm system armed.
The alarm tell tale will flash once every 3 seconds.
The interior and mood lamps (if lit) will fade off.
Note:
i)
If the system is armed when a door is not fully shut, three triple beeps will sound as a warning and the
doors will not be locked. Opening a door will not trigger the alarm.
ii) If the system is armed when the tailgate is not fully closed, three warning double beeps will be heard, and
the doors will not be locked. Opening a door in this instance will trigger the alarm.
When fully armed, and after the settling period of 40 seconds has expired, the alarm will be triggered by
any of the following actions:
Interruption of the car battery power supply or siren cables.
Energising the ignition circuit (‘hot wiring’).
Opening a door;
Opening the tailgate;
Movement detected within the cabin (unless de-selected).
If the alarm is triggered, the hazard warning lamps will flash and the wailing siren will sound for a period
of approximately 30 seconds before closing down and resetting, ready for any further triggering input. If a trigger is continuously present (e.g. door left open), the alarm will repeat for a maximum of eight 30 second cycles
before excluding the triggering sensor for the remainder of the armed period.
To silence the siren, press once the central, disarm button on the transmitter key. If necessary, press a
second time to disarm the alarm. Note that if the vehicle battery has been disabled, it will not be possible to
interrupt the siren until completion of the sequence.
Alarm Tell Tale Summary
Brief flash every 3 secs;
Brief flash every 1.5 secs;
Tell tale on;
Tell tale off;
Immobilised, alarm armed.
Immobilised, alarm disarmed, ignition off.
Immobilised, alarm disarmed, ignition on.
Mobilised, alarm disarmed, ready to start.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Turning Off the Interior Movement Sensor
A microwave sensor mounted behind the centre console, will detect substantial physical movement within
the cockpit, and trigger the alarm.
If an animal is to be left in the vehicle, or if for any other reason it is desired to exclude the interior movement sensor, press once the transmitter logo button in the normal way to set the alarm, and then press a second
time (within 2 seconds) to exclude the interior movement sensor. A single beep will be heard as confirmation.
The sensor will automatically re-activate next time the alarm is armed.
Opening the Tailgate
To open the tailgate, press twice the end button on the transmitter key; the latch will release and allow
the tailgate to be opened, assisted by pressurised struts. Boot lamps will switch on automatically whenever
the tailgate is open.
With the ignition switched on, warning of an open or not fully latched tailgate is provided on the right hand
screen in the instrument panel via the vehicle silhouette graphic.
To close the tailgate, ensure that no persons or objects will be trapped before pulling down the panel and
pressing firmly over the latch to assure its complete engagement. Guard against inadvertently locking the
transmitter key in the boot.
Manual Activation of Siren
If, for personal security reasons, it is desired to manually activate the siren at any time when the ignition
is off, hold pressed the end button on the transmitter key for 3 seconds. The wailing siren will sound, and the
hazard lamps flash for a period of 30 seconds. To stop the siren, press once any of the transmitter buttons.
Manual siren activation will not affect the alarm system status.
Transmitter Key Battery Replacement
The transmitter fobs will normally operate within a range of 5 metres from the car, but this may be reduced
by the presence of other radio signals in the vicinity.
The transmitters are powered by a long life 3V Lithium battery, type CR2025, readily available from electrical outlets, which with normal use should last for 3 years. To ensure continuity of operation, it is recommended
to renew the batteries every 12 months:
- Using a small screwdriver, prise the
transmitter fob from the key blade carrier utilising the slot provided on the back of the case.
Transmitter fob
- At the end face of the fob, prise the
retaining tang inwards whilst withdrawing the
Carrier retaining tang
battery carriage from the fob.
- Remove the old battery and wait for 10
Key blade
seconds before inserting a new battery, with
+ve sign lowermost, and holding the battery
Type CR2025
only by its periphery.
battery
- Slide the battery carriage back into the
fob, pressing firmly to engage the clip, and
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
then clip back onto the key blade.
REPLACEMENT
- The transmitter should now operate
normally.
oh102c
Emergency Disarming/Mobilising
If the key transmitter is damaged or fails to function, and a spare key is not available, the alarm system’s
unique sPecific Identification Number (PIN) may be used to disarm the alarm provided that access is available to the cabin:
Turn on the ignition. The alarm tell tale will light.
If the alarm is armed, accessing the cabin, or turning on the ignition will trigger the alarm until completion
of this emergency process.
Within 10 seconds, turn the ignition off; the tell tale will begin to flash.
After a number of flashes corresponding to the first digit of the PIN, turn on the ignition. Note that the first
flash may not be of full duration (but is still to be counted) dependent on the waveform position at time of
ignition switch off. Note that 10 flashes correspond to a zero digit.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
-
-
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Turn off the ignition and after a number of flashes corresponding to the second digit of the PIN, turn on
the ignition. Repeat this process until all 5 digits have been completed. If, at any stage of the process, a
number is entered incorrectly, the system will immediately revert to the start, so that the whole PIN must
be re-entered.
If the PIN is entered correctly, the alarm will now be overridden and the engine mobilised. However, automatic immobilisation will still occur after an ignition off time of 40 seconds, requiring a repeat of the above
procedure to mobilise. Note that automatic re-arming of the alarm and automatic door locking cannot
occur until a working transmitter is used to operate the alarm.
Programming Additional Transmitters
Two transmitter fobs are provided with the new car. If one transmitter is lost or damaged, a replacement
should be obtained immediately, and programmed to the car alarm controller using the alarm system’s unique
sPecific Identification Number (PIN). A maximum of 6 transmitters may be programmed to the car, any thereafter
overwriting the first to have been programmed.
With the engine immobilised (tell tale flashes briefly once per second), turn on the ignition.
Enter the PIN as detailed in the emergency disarming process above, followed by the additional two digits
1, 1.
The tell tale will flash rapidly for one second, then turn off.
Within 8 seconds, press any button on the transmitter to be programmed. The tell tale will then pulse
rapidly and the siren will beep.
Within 10 seconds press any button on the next transmitter to be programmed (if applicable), and repeat
this process for all remaining transmitters.
When all transmitters have been programmed, wait for 10 seconds, or turn off the ignition.
To disable a lost or stolen transmitter from the system, use the above procedure to programme 6 transmitters, if necessary repeatedly reprogramming the same transmitter if less than 6 programmed transmitters
are to be used.
Disconnecting the Car Battery
In order to prevent the alarm being triggered, before disconnecting the vehicle battery, ensure that the
alarm is disarmed.
Trigger Report Back and Feature Selection
A facility is provided to identify the source of an alarm triggering event (trigger report back), as well as
allowing certain features of the system to be selected or de-selected. The same procedure described above
to input a PIN is used, but in this case to input the programming code '123'; the tell tale will then flash rapidly
for 1 second, then remain lit. Commencing within 10 seconds, continue this procedure to input the two digits
of the feature code, after which the tell tale will flash rapidly for 1 second then beep once or twice to indicate
the new status of that feature; one for 'ON', twice for 'OFF'. Selection will alternate each time that feature code
is entered. Note that within 10 seconds, a second feature code (or repeat) may be selected from this point by
entering only the 2-digit code. To exit programme mode, simply wait for 10 seconds.
Feature
Revert to defaults
Trigger report back
Unlock with ignition
Lock with ignition
Selective door unlock
Audible tones*
Lock with auto re-arm
Door open audible warning
Code
123 00
123 11
123 33
123 34
123 41
123 61
123 87
123 88
Default
1 Beep
2 Beeps
see below
OFF
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
* When selected, a single beep will sound when the alarm is armed, and a double beep when disarmed. To
silence for a single activation, press briefly the transmitter auxiliary (3rd) button prior to pressing the arm or
disarm button.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Trigger report back: After the code 12311 has been entered, the tell tale flashes out a code(s) to indicate the
source of the alarm trigger:
No. of flashes Triggering sensor
1 Microwave movement sensor
2 Door, bonnet or boot lid
3 Ignition energisation
4 Manual siren activation
Quick Test
To facilitate testing of the alarm system, the unit can be placed into a 'Quick Test' mode by arming the
alarm with one transmitter key, and disarming with another. In this mode, the system will shorten the siren time
to 2 seconds, the immobiliser arm time to 5 seconds, and the settling time to zero. To exit this mode, simply
wait for 2 minutes without any further inputs.
Note that in Quick Test mode, any movement detected by the microwave sensor will trigger only the tell
tale and not the siren. The 2 minute timer will not be extended.
Location of Alarm Components
The alarm system components are located as follows:
Electronic Controller/Immobiliser: Mounted on the top face of the scuttle beam at passenger's extreme
end. Accessible after removal of the fascia dash panel.
Siren Unit: Mounted on the underside of the front subframe LH longeron, ahead of the lower wishbone
forward pivot. Accessible after removal of the front undertray.
Microwave sensor: Mounted behind the centre console.
Door Sensor: Switch incorporated into each door latch mechanism.
Tailgate Sensor: Incorporated into the latch mechanism.
MR.2 - CENTRAL DOOR LOCKING
The central door locking (CDL) operates on the driver’s and passenger’s doors in conjunction with the
security alarm system.
To open the doors from outside:
To unlock the doors from outside, press the central, unlock button on the transmitter key. The first press
will unlock just the driver’s door. Press a second time to unlock the passenger’s door.
When the door is opened, a fully closed window will drop slightly, preparatory to easing its subsequent
closing, and the interior and footwell will be illuminated. If the driver’s door is opened whilst the ignition is off
but the key is in position, or if the exterior lights are switched on, an audible warning will sound.
On shutting the door, the window will close automatically unless already open by request, and the footwell
illumination will be extinguished. The interior lamp will remain lit for 2 minutes, or until the ignition is switched
on.
Interior Door Lock Switch
If it is desired to lock the doors from inside the car, for example to deter highjack attempts, press the door
lock switch in the cluster inboard of the steering column, with ignition on or off. Both doors will be locked and
the switch will light up as a reminder.
Alternatively, each door can be locked individually by depressing the button at the rear end of each door
sill, but this action will not activate the lock switch illumination.
Dynamic (drive away) Locking
This selectable feature will automatically lock the doors when road speed first exceeds 10 mph (15 km/h).
The doors will remain locked until either the interior door lock switch is pressed, or each door is unlocked manually by lifting the door sill button.
To select Dynamic Locking, turn on the ignition and hold the interior door locking switch pressed for at
least 5 seconds, until a single beep is heard as confirmation. The feature will remain selected throughout
further ignition cycles until the switch is again pressed for 5 seconds and a double beep is heard, confirming
de-selection.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Note that the lighting up of the interior door locking switch provides a visual indication of the door lock
status (locked when lit).
WARNING: Whether locked using the locking switch, sill buttons or ‘drive away locking’ feature, the
interior release handles will be disabled. Before opening, the door must first be unlocked by pressing
the interior lock switch, or lifting the door sill button.
To open the doors from inside:
To open the door from inside, first unlock if necessary by pressing the interior lock switch, or lifting the door
sill button, and then pulling the door release handle located towards the front of the door.
On opening the door, a fully closed window will drop slightly to aid subsequent door closing, and the interior
and footwell lamps will light. If the driver’s door is opened when the ignition is off but the key is in position, or
if the exterior lamps are on, an audible warning will sound.
After shutting the door, the window will close automatically (unless already open by request), and the
interior lamps will be extinguished after a 2 minute delay.
To lock both doors, press once the raised logo button on the transmitter key.
Locking The Doors Mechanically
In the event of a discharged vehicle battery, or an inoperative transmitter key, the right hand door may
be locked by pressing down the door sill button, and holding the exterior handle raised as the door is closed.
The left hand door may be locked in a similar manner, or alternatively, may by locked by using the key in the
exterior lock barrel; insert the key, turn fully clockwise, return to the vertical and withdraw. To unlock, insert the
key in the lock, turn fully counterclockwise, return to the vertical and withdraw.
Note:
Locking the doors mechanically will not arm the alarm system.
When locking both doors by pressing down the sill buttons, be aware of the potential for inadvertently
locking the keys in the vehicle.
Inertia Switch
The safety inertia switch is designed to operate on impact, typified by vehicle collision, to switch off the fuel
pump, and thus minimise any fire hazard. The central door locking will also be triggered to unlock the doors.
The inertia switch is mounted on the backstay at the left hand side of the engine bay, ahead of the airbox,
and is reset by pressing the rubber diaphragm button on the top of the unit.
CDL Component Location
A CDL actuator is mounted on a plate integral with the latch mechanism with which it interacts via a rotary
link. A CDL control module is mounted on the passenger end of the scuttle beam, at the top of the cabin side
vertical face, and is accessible after removal of the fascia lower panel.
MR.3 - ELECTRIC WINDOWS
The switches for the electric window operation are mounted in the door trim panel armrests, a single
switch for the passenger and one for each door for the driver. The switches are operative with the ignition key
at position l or ll, at which time the icon in the switch will be illuminated.
To lower a window, press down the appropriate switch; if held for more than a second, the window will
automatically lower fully. Lift the switch to raise the window (no one-touch raising).
To ease door closure, and optimise the sealing of the frameless door glass against the weatherstrips, a
fully raised window will automatically drop a small distance when the door is opened (preparatory to closing),
and rise again after the door is shut.
Note: If the battery supply is interrupted, the one touch down and auto drop features will not function. There
will be an increased risk of damage to the door window seals until:
each window is fully raised and the switch held for 2 seconds (a click will be heard).
each window is fully lowered and the switch held for 2 seconds ( a click will be heard).
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
The electric window lift mechanism uses an electric motor and winder drum driving a steel cable around top
and bottom guide pulleys to a lift block. The window glass is fixed to the lift block which is guided by a vertical
rail. Fuses C9 and C10 protect the window lift motors, and C33 the control switches. The door harnesses are
routed to the scuttle area via a grommet in the 'A' post area ahead of the door hinge post.
MR.4 - DOOR MIRRORS
-
Rear view mirrors are fitted on both driver’s and passenger’s doors, and include the following features:
Electric adjustment of mirror glass;
Mirror glass heaters;
Optional electric fold flat facility;
Mirror adjustment: The mirror control switch is located in the driver’s door armrest, ahead of the door window
switches, and comprises a combined rotary selector switch and joystick. To adjust the mirror, turn the ignition key to position l or ll, select the right or left hand mirror by turning the knob to the appropriate arrow, then
use the knob as a joystick to move the mirror plane in any of four directions. Note that the mirror glasses are
convex to provide a wider field of vision, but by so doing, make objects seem smaller and farther away than
when viewed through a flat glass. Take care when judging distances and approach speeds until familiarity
has been gained.
Fold flat (if fitted): If necessary, to reduce obstruction when parked, both mirrors may be folded flat against the
doors; turn the ignition key to position l or ll, select the central ‘fold’ rotary position on the joystick, and hold the
joystick rearwards until both mirrors have stopped moving. To unfold, hold the joystick forwards until mirror
movement stops. The field of vision setting will be retained.
Mirror heating: Heating elements in the mirror glasses are energised in conjunction with that of the heated
rear screen. The switch is located in the heater control panel, and will light up amber when the heater circuits
are operating, but due to the high current demand, this function requires the engine to be running. The circuits
will turn off after the switch is pressed a second time, or the ignition is switched off, or automatically after a ten
minute period has elapsed.
Component Location
A 'mini' relay for the heater circuit is mounted in the front fuse/relay station. Mirror control switch fuse is
C33, HRS/mirror heater switch fuse C28, heater relay input fuse MC6, relay output to mirrors fuse C31.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Blank page
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
MR.5 - SWITCHES & INSTRUMENTS - DRIVER'S INFORMATION
ll
lll
0
0
l
lll
0
l
Column unlocked;
Key insert/remove; accessories
audio
Ignition; services
ll
Ignition Switch/Steering Lock
The switch/lock is located on the right
hand side of the steering column. With the
key out of the switch, the steering column is
locked, and the following electrical circuits will
function:
- Locking and alarm system.
- Horns.
- Hazard warning lamps.
- Sidelamps and headlamps.
- Fuel filler flap release.
- Interior lamps.
- Automatic operation of cooling fans and
re-circ. pump.
- Glovebox latch.
- Boot auxiliary power socket.
Engine
cranking
IGNITION
SWITCH
ohe23
With the key inserted into the switch at position ‘0’, the audio system and glovebox lamp are functional.
To unlock the steering, turn the key clockwise to the ‘l’ position. If the key is reluctant to turn, wriggle the
steering wheel to ease the load on the steering lock. At this ‘accessories’ position, the following electrical
circuits will function in addition to those above:
Power windows.
Windscreen wiper and washer.
Interior fan.
Door mirror adjustment and fold.
Cabin auxiliary power socket.
Turn further clockwise to the ‘ignition’ position to activate all remaining electrical systems (note that some
circuits require the engine to be running).
Turning further clockwise to ‘III’ against spring pressure will operate the starter motor. As soon as the engine starts, allow the key to return to position ‘II’. For the correct starting procedure, see the later chapter
‘Starting Procedure & Running In’. To stop the engine, turn the key back to ‘I’.
Note that in order not to compromise engine starting, all electrical functions operative at position ‘l’, will
drop out whilst the engine is being cranked.
To remove the key, turn fully counterclockwise to ‘0’ and withdraw. The steering column lock will be acti
vated when the key is withdrawn but may not engage until the steering is turned and the mechanism is
aligned.
NOTICE: DO NOT leave the ignition switched on for long periods without the engine running. Although the
engine ignition system itself draws no current when the engine is stopped, a battery drain will occur through
other circuits even when auxiliary equipment is not being used.
WARNING:
•
Do not push or tow the car unless the key is first used to unlock the column and is then left in the
lock. Withdrawing the key will cause the steering to lock.
•
Never remove the key from the ignition switch or turn off the ignition while the car is moving.
Withdrawing the key will cause the steering to lock and may cause an accident resulting in serious
injury or death.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
TELL TALE LAMPS
Tell tale lamps are incorporated into the
instrument panel to provide important information about various vehicle systems.
Section MR
High engine speed
Security
LOTUS
OFF
TELL TALE LAMPS
ohe3
Bulb Check
In order to check that the warning systems are functional, all operative tell tale lamps will light for a few
seconds each time the ignition is switched on - refer to the text below for details of this feature relating to particular lamps. If the lamp does not light as specified, it is possible that the warning circuit or instrument assembly
may be at fault; see your dealer without delay, and be aware that there may be no warning of a malfunction
with that feature.
Turn Tell Tale
(green)
A left turn tell tale is incorporated into the upper face of the tachometer, and a right turn tell tale in the
speedo face. A bulb check will light the lamps for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
When the left hand or right hand turn indicators are operating, the appropriate green tell tale will flash in
unison together with an audible tone. If the tell tale fails to light, or flashes at an unusual or irregular rate, check
the operation of the turn indicator lamps immediately.
SUTOL
LOTUS
High RPM Tell Tales
(red)
Three red tell tale rings are incorporated into the tachometer face to warn that maximum engine speed is
being approached. No bulb test function applies.
Maximum engine speed is governed for both the continuous and transient (during acceleration) states,
and are detailed in the later section ‘Tachometer’.
LOTUS
As the rate of rpm increase is potentially greater in the lower gears, the tell tale trigger points are tailored
to accommodate the reaction time available. As maximum rpm is approached, the tell tales will light in the
following left to right sequence:
- one red light;
- two red lights;
- three rapidly flashing lights with an audible warning.
When exploiting maximum acceleration, gearchange upshifts should be made immediately the three
flashing lights appear.
OFF
FFO
OFF
NOTICE:
A graduated engine speed limit is imposed on a cold engine to reduce possible damage and wear from a
delinquent driving style.
Using maximum rpm and the above tell tale facility should be restricted to occasions when maximum acceleration is required. Overuse will compromise powertrain service life.
The engine is not protected from overspeeding caused by erroneous or premature downchanging. Such
misuse could result in catastrophic failure, not covered by the vehicle warranty.
High Beam Tell Tale
(blue)
This lamp glows blue whenever the headlamp high beams are operating. A bulb check will light the lamp
for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
OFF
Security Alarm Tell Tale
(red)
LOTUS
For details of the vehicle security alarm and its tell tale, see sub-section MR.1
LOTUS
OFF
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Page 11
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Rear Foglamp Tell Tale
(amber)
This lamp glows amber whenever the rear fog lamp is operating (see ‘Rear Fog Lamp Switch’). A bulb
check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
Passenger Airbag Off Switch
LOTUS
OFF
(amber)
This amber tell tale will light with ignition on, whenever the passenger airbag has been disabled by the
key operated switch at the passenger end of the fascia. A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds
following ignition switch on.
Tyre Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
(amber)
If the car is so equipped,
with ignition on, this amber tell tale, together with an audible alert, warns of low
LOTUS
pressure in one or more tyres. Stop the car as soon as it is safe so to do, and take appropriate action. A bulb
check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
OFF
LOTUS
Scheduled Service Tell Tale
(amber)
The Engine Control Module (ECM) on the Evora is also used to manage various related electrical systems,
and is able to detect certain types of fault, which may or may not be apparent to the driver. If such a fault is
detected, which has no detrimental effect on exhaust emissions (see MIL below), this amber tell tale will light
LOTUS
for the first 30 seconds after turning on the ignition. Interrogate using the Lotus TechCentre.
A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
OFF
OFF
Engine Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(amber)
The engine Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) is provided to warn the driver that the engine management
system has detected a fault which
may result in increased noxious emissions from the exhaust. In order to
LOTUS
minimise emissions and potential engine damage, various operational limitations may automatically be applied.
A circuit check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
i)
If the MIL lights continuously whilst driving, immediately reduce speed and adopt a moderate driving style.
Seek dealer advice without delay and avoid all unnecessary journeys.
ii) If the MIL flashes, an engine misfire has been detected which is likely to cause overheat damage to the
catalytic converters. Slow down immediately and be prepared to stop.
- If the MIL then stops flashing, and is lit continuously, proceed with caution and seek dealer advice.
- If the MIL continues to flash, stop the car as soon as it is safe so to do, and switch off the engine. Seek
dealer advice.
OFF
NOTICE: Continuing to drive the car with a flashing MIL may cause overheat damage to the catalytic converters, possible engine damage, increased emissions, and impaired fuel economy and driveability.
In order to comply with emissions regulations, data regarding activation of the MIL is recorded in the engine
electronic controller, and may be downloaded by Lotus dealers using the TechCentre.
Low Fuel Level Tell Tale
(amber)
LOTUS
A circuit check will
light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on. Thereafter, this amber
tell tale will light, with ignition on, when approximately 5 litres of fuel remain. Refuel at the next opportunity.
OFF
LOTUS
Low Washer Fluid Level Tell Tale
(amber)
This amber tell tale is provided to warn of low fluid level in the reservoir serving the windscreen and headlamp powerwash jets. A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on, but if the
LOTUS
lamp then remains lit, or lights after washer use, refill
the reservoir with a suitable fluid at the first opportunity.
OFF
OFF
Cruise Control Tell Tale
(amber)
If the car is so equipped, this amber tell tale indicates when the cruise control is enabled. For full details
of this system, see later. A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
LOTUS
Traction Control Off Tell Tale
(amber)
This amber tell tale reminds the driver that the traction control has been manually switched off. Lotus
OFF
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Traction Control should aways be active when driving on public roads in normal conditions. To re-activate LTC,
press momentarily the LTC off switch and check that the tell tale is extinguished. For LTC details, see later.
A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
LOTUS
OFF
Traction Control Tell Tale
(amber)
This amber tell tale will flicker whenever the Traction Control system is triggered to indicate to the driver
that the tractive limit is being broached.
A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on, but if the tell tale lights
constantly, a fault has been detected, and traction control will not be enabled.
LOTUS
OFF
LOTUS
ABS Tell Tale
(amber)
A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on, but if the lamp then remains
lit, or comes on whilst driving, a fault in the anti-lock brake system is indicated. The base brake system will
continue to operate normally, but without the anti-lock feature. Heavy braking, or braking on slippery surfaces
may cause one or more wheels to lock and result in reduced steering response and possible loss of control.
The car may continue to be driven with appropriate care and anticipation, but should be checked and
repaired at the earliest opportunity.
OFF
LOTUS
Sport Tell Tale
(amber)
This tell tale will light up amber to indicate that ‘Sport’ mode has been selected, delivering increased throttle
response and a reduced level of traction control. This selection will default off when the ignition is next turned
on. A bulb check will light the lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on.
LOTUS
OFF
OFF
Brake Tell Tale
(red)
A circuit check will light this lamp for about 3 seconds following ignition switch on. The tell tale will then
remain lit if the parking brake is applied. Check that the tell tale is extinguished when the parking brake is released, as driving the car with the brake not fully disengaged will cause overheat damage to the rear brakes.
With the parking brake released, if the tell tale should light at any time after the 3 second check period,
stop the car immediately, as the circuit has detected a dangerously low level of brake fluid in the master cylinder
reservoir, possibly caused by a hydraulic leak in one of the separate front or rear brake circuits. In the event
of a leak there is a danger that air may enter the hydraulic system and cause spongy operation and extended
pedal travel. The divided brake circuit should ensure that emergency braking remains, but the car should not
be driven until the fault has been identified and rectified.
Note that in order to inhibit false warnings of low fluid level due to surge effects, this circuit incorporates
a 10 second delay, requiring that the signal be present for a minimum of this period.
Oil Pressure Tell Tale
(red)
This red tell tale warns of low engine oil pressure. The lamp will be lit whenever the ignition is on and the
engine is stopped, but should go out as soon as the engine is started. If the lamp fails to go out after engine
start up, or comes on when the engine is running, stop the engine immediately and do not restart until the cause
has been investigated and rectified.
WARNING: Continuing to run the engine with the oil tell tale lit could cause major engine damage or
seizure, resulting in loss of car control and a crash. You or others could be killed or seriously injured.
Battery Charging Tell Tale
(red)
This red tell tale will light whenever the ignition is on and the engine is stopped. If it lights any time when
the engine is running, it indicates that the battery is not being charged, which may be due to a broken auxiliary
drive belt, or an electrical fault.
Stop the car as soon as safely possible and turn off the engine. The auxiliary belt also drives the engine
water pump, without which function the engine will overheat very quickly. If it can be determined that the
auxiliary belt and water pump are functioning correctly, it may be possible in favourable daylight conditions,
to drive a short distance to a repair facility, but do not, under any circumstances, allow the battery to become
completely discharged by continuing to drive, as this may result in engine damage and the car being stranded
in a dangerous position.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Seat Belt Tell Tale
(red)
As a reminder to fasten the seat belts, the seat belt tell tale in the instrument cluster will flash red for about
six seconds following ignition switch on, accompanied, if the driver’s belt is not fastened, by an intermittent
audible tone. Thereafter, if the driver’s belt remains unfastened, the lamp will light continuously, but if vehicle
speed should exceed 15 mph (20 km/h) the lamp will flash, accompanied by a beeping tone for a period of two
minutes, unless curtailed by a speed reduction below 10 mph (15 km/h) before this time.
Airbag Tell Tale
(red)
The airbag safety system, including the pre-tensioning seat belts, has a self-diagnostic feature which lights
the red tell tale if a fault is detected. As a bulb check, the tell tale will light for about six seconds following ignition switch on, and then go out, but if the lamp remains lit, or comes on at any other time, a fault in the airbag
system is indicated, which should be rectified without delay by your Lotus dealer.
INSTRUMENTS
Speedometer
This analogue display uses an illuminated pointer to indicate road speed in either mph or km/h dependent
on market. Each time the ignition is switched on, a re-setting routine will be performed with the pointer sweeping to full scale and back to zero. The scale backlighting and pointer will be illuminated whenever the ignition
or sidelamps circuits are active.
Note that a digital speed display in alternative units (mph or km/h) is available in the information panel
menu (see later).
Tachometer
This analogue display uses an illuminated pointer to indicate engine speed in revolutions per minute. The
engine management system graduates the maximum engine speed allowed during the warming up phase, and
once normal running temperature has been reached, limits continuous engine speed to 6,600 rpm (or 7,000
rpm in Sport mode). During maximum acceleration through the lower gears, very short bursts up to 6,800 rpm
are allowed (or 7,200 rpm in Sport mode).
Each time the ignition is switched on, a re-setting routine will be performed with the pointer sweeping
to full scale and back to zero. The scale backlighting and pointer will be illuminated whenever the ignition or
sidelamps circuits are active.
Three red tell tale rings are incorporated into the tachometer face to warn that maximum engine speed is
being approached, but as the rate of rpm increase is potentially greater in the lower gears, the tell tale trigger
points are tailored to accommodate the reaction time available. The tell tales will light in the following left to
right sequence:
one red light;
two red lights;
three rapidly flashing lights with an audible warning.
When exploiting maximum acceleration, gear upshifts should be made immediately the three flashing
lights appear.
NOTICE:
•
The use of wide throttle openings and/or high rpm before normal running temperature has been reached
should be avoided. A graduated engine speed limit is imposed on a cold engine to reduce possible damage and wear from a delinquent driving style.
•
Do not run the engine continuously at its maximum speed.
•
The engine is not protected from overspeeding caused by erroneous or premature downchanging, the
consequences of which could be catastrophic failure not covered by the vehicle warranty.
•
Use of maximum rpm and the above tell tale facility should be restricted to occasions when maximum
acceleration is required. Overuse will compromise powertrain service life.
Odometer
A vehicle total distance travelled indicator, in miles or kilometers, dependent on market, is displayed at
the centre top of the instrument panel whenever the ignition key is inserted. See later for the trip distance
function.
Page 14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Fuel Level Display
An indication of the level of fuel in the tank is displayed, with ignition on, in the form of a vertical bar graph
in the instrument panel left hand screen. The solid bar within the outline, represents the proportion of fuel
remaining in the tank.
When only 5 litres remains, an amber tell tale in the instrument panel will light. Refuel at the next opportunity.
The total usable fuel capacity is 60 litres (13 imp.gal), but for re-fuelling purposes, from the time the low
fuel tell tale is triggered, approximately 50 litres can be accommodated. Note that from the point of low fuel tell
tale activation to the gauge reading empty, is around 5 litres. The remaining balance of 5 litres should be treated
only as an emergency contingent, the use of which may entail intermittent fuel starvation and potential engine
damage. In such a situation, driving style should be modified to minimise engine load and cornering forces.
If maximum engine or handling performance is to be exploited, or severe gradients tackled, a high fuel
level should be maintained to ensure the greatest safety margin of fuel supply.
Ambient temperature
Time clock
Selective
display
Fuel
level
LH SCREEN
ohe33
NOTICE: Do not allow the tank to run completely dry, as this could damage the catalytic converters and fuel
pump. Any such consequence would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Ambient Air Temperature Display
The outside air temperature is shown on the instrument panel left hand screen whenever the ignition is
switched on, with units displayed in degrees Centigrade or Fahrenheit dependent on market. The sensor is
mounted by a grommet into the RH side of the engine radiator air intake duct.
If the temperature drops to 4°C (39°F) or below, the display will flash for ten seconds, accompanied by a
single audible chime to alert the driver to potentially hazardous road conditions. Note that optimum accuracy
will be obtained when the car is moving.
To change the displayed units between Centrigrade and Fahrenheit, see ‘Information Switch’ below.
Time Clock
A digital 24-hour time clock is displayed in the instrument panel left hand screen whenever the ignition
key is inserted.
To adjust the clock, see ‘Information Switch’ below:
Information Switch
A button is mounted on the end of the left hand column stalk, and has different functionality with ignition
on and off. With the ignition key inserted, but ignition OFF, the button operates as follows:
Time clock adjustment
Press the info. button for more than one second, until the hour display flashes.
Press momentarily the info. button to advance the figure by one hour and repeat as necessary. Alternatively,
a rapid double press will automatically scroll the display; press again to stop the scrolling at the desired
figure.
Press the info. button for more than one second until the seconds display flashes. Repeat the above
adjustment procedure.
Press the info. button for more than one second to enter the next mode:
Page 15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Ambient temperature units
Current temperature display units will now be displayed. To change from °C to °F, or vice-versa, press
momentarily the info. button.
To retain the displayed units, press the info. button for more than one second to enter the next mode:
Tyre pressure units (if TPMS is fitted)
Current tyre pressure units will now be displayed. To change from bar to psi, or vice-versa, press monentarily the info. button.
To retain the displayed units, press the info. button for more than one second to exit the adjustment
mode.
With the ignition ON, the info. button operates the trip functions as follows:
Trip Recorder
The instrument panel left hand screen allows a menu of trip functions to be displayed, selected by the ‘info’
switch on the end of the steering column left hand stalk. When the ignition is turned ON, the panel will display
the trip distance since the last reset, in either miles or kilometres, dependent on market.
A single momentary press of the info. button will scroll to the next function in the following sequence:
Trip distance.
Range; Driving distance available on current fuel level, based on average fuel consumption since reset.
Average fuel consumption; In mpg or km/l dependent on market. This display will be blank for the first 5
minutes of driving time since reset, to allow data to stabilise.
Road speed; Displayed digitally in alternative units (mph or km/h) to those of the analogue instrument.
Trip distance.
The Trip Distance, Range, and Average Fuel Consumption can all be reset, by selecting that function and
then pressing the info. switch for more than one second until the display zeroes.
Coolant Temperature Display
An indication of the engine coolant temperature is displayed, with ignition on, in the form of a vertical bar
graph in the instrument panel right hand screen. To optimise display space, the shown scale commences at
60°C (140°F), and finishes at 120°C (250°F).
Door open indication
Engine
temperature
Tyre
pressure
Pressure
units
RH SCREEN
ohe34
The running temperature will fluctuate a certain amount as the operating conditions change, and during
periods of idling or in heavy traffic, the temperature may rise to over 100°C (212°F), with the cooling fans switching on at half speed at approximately 98°C (208°F), and full speed at approximately 103°C (217°F). In order
to prompt closer monitoring by the driver of temperatures over 110°C (230°F), the temperature icon will flash
and be accompanied by the message ‘Engine too hot’ displayed above the car silhouette.
The pressurised cooling system has a boiling point of over 120°C (250°F), and if the temperature approaches this level, the car should be stopped and the engine allowed to idle for a few minutes whilst the
temperature is monitored. If the temperature continues to rise, there is a danger of engine damage; switch off
and seek qualified assistance.
NOTICE: After a heavy snowfall, ensure that the radiator cooling outlet grille in the front body is cleared of
snow before driving the car, or overheating may result.
Page 16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Tyre Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
On cars so equipped, a sensor incorporated into each of the tyre valves, monitors the air pressure inside
the tyre, and supplies an onboard control module with this data by radio transmission. As soon as the car has
been driven a short distance, tyre pressure readings will be displayed against the corresponding wheels on
the vehicle silhouette in the instrument cluster right hand screen. If any pressure should fall below 75% of the
recommended value, an alert message is sent to the instrument panel, causing the tyre pressure tell tale
to light up amber, and the corresponding pressure on the silhouette to flash.
If this warning should occur, stop the car as soon as it is safe so to do, and examine the affected tyre. If
there is no visible damage and a tyre pump is available, correct the pressure to that stated in the Technical
Data section of this handbook, and proceed with caution to a tyre dealer for professional inspection and advice.
Note that the tell tale will automatically be extinguished when the correct pressure is restored. If the tyre is
punctured, or no inflation equipment is available, consider using the emergency tyre inflator aerosol (see page
128), but observe the associated WARNINGS and be aware that the TPMS sensor in the tyre will be disabled
by the sealing fluid, and must subsequently be renewed.
The TPMS incorporates self-malfunction recognition, and if a fault is detected, the low tyre pressure tell
tale will flash for one minute and then remain constantly lit, this sequence being repeated for subsequent ignition
cycles; the system may not be able to detect or signal low tyre pressure. See your dealer without delay.
Be sure to advise any tyre fitters or service technicians that TPMS is fitted, and that any replacement tyre
valves include the correct pressure sensors. If a fault is indicated after wheel or tyre replacement, it is likely
that a sensor has been incorrectly fitted or damaged. If a tyre valve is renewed, or is moved to a different wheel
position, the TPMS will automatically identify the new configuration.
Note that the pressure sensors are powered by integral batteries, with an average service life of 10 years.
It is recommended to renew all pressure sensors at this time interval.
Door/Tailgate Open Display
The instrument cluster right hand screen includes a plan view silhouette of the car, which will graphically
show when either door is open, or indicate an open tailgate by flashing the corresponding area. This situation
will endure until the panel is fully latched.
Lighting Switches
Lighting functions are controlled by a vertical row of three push button switches mounted in the fascia
outboard of the steering column. Each switch is pressed once to switch on, and pressed a second time to
switch off. Each switch button incorporates a function symbol which is backlit red with the sidelamps and ignition switched on, and which lights up brightly when the circuit is active.
Sidelamp Switch
The topmost outboard switch functions with or without the ignition, and switches on the sidelamps and
some switch illumination. To help locate the switch in the dark, when the ignition is on, the button symbol will
be backlit red, changing to brightly lit green when the circuit is activated.
Note that the headlamps must be off before the sidelamps can be switched off.
Headlamp Switch
The second switch down functions with or without ignition, and switches on the headlamps together with
the sidelamps and some switch illumination. The switch button symbol is backlit red with the sidelamps on,
and lights up green to indicate when the circuit is active. The steering column lever switch (see later) is used
to select main or dip beam.
A second momentary press will switch off the headlamps, but leave on the sidelamps. To switch off both
the side and headlamps, hold the switch pressed for more than one second.
Homesafe
The Homesafe feature keeps the headlamps lit for a 30 second period after locking/arming the alarm, in
order to light the departure route. To activate Homesafe;
leave the headlamps switched on;
withdraw the ignition key;
use the transmitter to lock/arm the alarm.
The master lighting switch will flash during the 30 second period to indicate that Homesafe is operating.
Page 17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
‘Lights On’ Warning
If the lights are on when the ignition is switched off, a ‘lights on’ audible warning will sound when the
driver’s door is opened.
Rear Fog Lamp Switch (where fitted)
The lowermost outboard switch controls the single rear fog lamp, which will operate only when both the
ignition and the headlamps are active. The switch button symbol is backlit red with the sidelamps on, and lights
up amber to indicate when the circuit is active
Note that the switch will default to 'off' whenever the headlamps or ignition are switched off, such that the
switch must again be pressed when fog lamp operation is required.
In some territories, rear fog lamps may be used legally only in conditions of ‘seriously reduced visibility’.
Be aware that indiscriminate or forgetful use of the rear fog lamp can cause distraction and discomfort to following traffic.
Reversing Lamp, Parking Aids and Reversing Camera
With the ignition switched on, selection of reverse gear will cause:
The reversing lamp to light.
If fitted, the parking aid system will sound an audible acknowledgement, and then search for objects at
bumper height within the detection zone of about 1.5 m (5 ft) around the rear of the car. When within this
range, an intermittent beeping will be heard, which increases in frequency as the distance is reduced,
becoming a continuous tone at around 300 mm (1 ft). Be aware that the sensitivity of the system will vary
according to the size, position and material/density of an object.
If fitted, the reversing camera will switch on and display an image on the audio set screen, if and when
the set is manually switched on. Note that in order to cover the whole width of the car, the view will be
distorted from a conventional image.
Take time to familiarise yourself with the image displayed, the parking aid beeping frequency, and the
actual distance being detected before fully utilising these systems.
Hazard Warning Lamps Switch
The hazard warning switch button is located inboard of the audio set, and is backlit red when the sidelamps are switched on. The switch is enabled at all times, and when pressed, causes simultaneous flashing of
all the exterior turn lamps. In addition, the switch button graphic will flash, and an accompanying audible tone
will sound. Press the button a second time to switch off.
Instrument and Switch Illumination
The fascia mounted push button switches are backlit red whenever the sidelamps and ignition are switched
on. The sidelamps switch itself is backlit with the ignition on. Most switches will light up brightly when that
circuit is activated. The brightness of both the backlighting and active states is dimmed with the sidelights on,
in order to prevent distraction in the dark. Similarly, the red displays in the instrument panel side screens are
dimmed when the vehicle lights are on.
The speedometer and tachometer illumination is provided by white LEDs, with the pointers coloured red.
The lighting level of these instruments and that of the heating/ventilation control panel, may be adjusted by a
switch button inboard of the steering column:
To set the nightime level, switch on the sidelamps and press and hold the panel illumination button; the
brightness will progressively increase. Release the button at the required level.
The next press of the button will progressively decrease the brightness. Release at the required level.
To set the daytime level, repeat the above procedure with the sidelamps switched off.
Page 18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Steering Column Lever Switches
Lever switches are provided on the steering column, one on the left for headlamp functions, and one on
the right for windscreen wiping and washing.
Right turn
Info button
).&/
ohe2
ohe2
Fast wipe
Intermittent Slow wipe
interval
Intermittent wipe
).&/
2
3
4
5
Left turn
Flash
LH STALK
Dip/Beam change
2
Wash
3
4
5
Flick wipe
RH STALK
Turn Indicators/Headlamp Flash/Dipswitch
Turn Indicators: The turn indicators operate only with the ignition switched on. Move the lever down to indicate
a left hand turn, and up for a right turn. The switch will be cancelled when the steering wheel is returned to the
straight ahead position.
For convenience, when signalling a lane change, lightly pressing the switch up or down will allow its return
under spring action. Pressing the switch for less than a second will trigger three flashes of the indicators.
Headlamps: The left hand lever switch is operated by pulling the left hand lever switch towards the steering
wheel, to one of two spring loaded positions, and then releasing.
Headlamp Flash: To flash the headlamp main beams with or without ignition, pull the lever switch to the first
position; the beams will light until the lever is released.
Dip/Main Beam Switching: When the headlamp switch is pressed (see page 64), the headlamps will switch on
in either dip or main beam mode according to the last made selection. To change from one to the other, pull
the lever fully towards the steering wheel to the second spring loaded position, and then release. Each such
action will cause alternate selection of main and dip beams. Note that with ignition on, the main beam tell tale
in the instrument panel will indicate the current status.
Info Button: Momentarily pressing the ‘Info’ button on the end of the stalk will scroll through a menu of trip
functions (see above).
Windscreen Wiper & Washer Control
The right hand lever switch is enabled at ignition key positions I and II, and is operated as follows:
Wiper functions
To ‘flick’ wipe the screen, press the lever switch downwards against spring pressure and release. The
wiper will sweep the screen once at slow speed. Holding the lever downwards will activate further slow
sweeps until released.
For intermittent wipe, push the lever up to the first position, and select the wipe interval by rotating the
numbered collar to one of its six positions, the wipe frequency increasing at higher numbers.
For slow speed continuous wipe, move the lever upwards to the second position.
For fast speed continuous wipe, push fully upwards to the third position.
Note: In very cold weather, before attempting to use the wiper, ensure that the blade is not frozen to the screen
(use windscreen de-icer fluid), or damage to the blade or circuit fuse may be caused.
Windscreen washer functions
For short wash/wipe, a momentary press of the button on the end of the stalk will trigger the washer pump
and a single sweep of the wiper.
For a longer wash/wipe, press the end button for longer than one second to operate the washer, and to
trigger 3 sweeps of the wiper.
Page 19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Headlamp Powerwash
With ignition and headlamps on, the headlamp powerwash will be activated for a short burst at the first,
and every subsequent fifth request of the screen wash switch. Cycling of either the ignition or headlamp switch
will reset this timing.
The powerwash jets are contained in a sliding module which normally sits flush with the surface of the
headlamp cover. When activated, a stepper motor with combined pump, operates to lift the module proud of the
headlamp to expose the jets and deploy a pair of high pressure water streams to the lamp cover. The module
then retracts. Note that this function shares the water reservoir used for the windscreen washers.
Note:
The combined washer reservoir has a low fluid level sensor which will activate a tell tale in the instrument
cluster.
The windscreen washer jets have heating elements which are active whenever the ignition is on.
Horn
To sound the twin tone horns, which are operative at all times, press the centre pad on the steering
wheel.
PASSENGER
AIRBAG
SWITCH
(RHD shown)
On
/
&&
Passenger Airbag Defeat (PAB) Switch
If a rearward facing child seat is to be
used in the front passenger seat of the Evora,
it is essential to switch off the passenger airbag. If an accident should occur and trigger
airbag inflation, the back of the seat could
be subjected to a force sufficient to seriously
injure or kill the child.
A PAB switch is located at the end of
the passenger fascia, accessible only with
the door open, and is operated using the mechanical ignition key; insert the key and turn
clockwise to the ‘OFF’ position, and withdraw
the key. With the ignition switched on, a tell
tale lamp in the instrument panel will light up
amber as a reminder that the passenger airbag
has been disabled. To reinstate airbag operation, insert the key in the PAB switch and turn
counterclockwise.
Off
/.
ohe29
Interior Lighting
The main interior lamp is located centrally in the roof and incorporates a three position rocker switch:
-
Forward end depressed; Lamp is switched off (‘0’).
Rear end depressed; Lamp is switched on with or without ignition (‘I’).
NOTICE: To guard against flattening the battery, ensure that the lamp is not switched on when leaving
the car.
Switch central; This is the normal, courtesy position (door symbol).
A ‘mood lighting’ strip crossing the fascia and extending along both door trim panels, is controlled in conjunction with the main interior lamp. Each front footwell also houses a separate lamp to aid ingress.
With the interior lamp switch set to the courtesy position; when the transmitter key button is pressed to
unlock the doors, the interior lamp and mood lamps will fade on for a maximum period of 2 minutes. If a door
is opened, the footwell lamp will also light. On closing the door, the footwell lamp will be extinguished, but the
interior and mood lighting will abide for 2 minutes or until the ignition is switched on.
Similar logic will apply when opening the door to exit the vehicle, with the lighting being extinguished when
the doors are locked using the transmitter, or after a period of 2 minutes.
Page 20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Inertia Switch
The safety inertia switch is designed to operate on impact, typified by vehicle collision, to switch off the fuel
pump, and thus minimise any fire hazard. The central door locking will also be triggered to unlock the doors.
The inertia switch is mounted on the backstay at the left hand side of the engine bay, ahead of the airbox,
and is reset by pressing the rubber diaphragm button on the top of the unit.
Lotus Traction Control
Lotus Traction Control (LTC) is a software programme integrated within the engine management and
ABS electronic control units (ECUs) and uses inputs from the wheel speed sensors to determine if wheelspin
is occurring. If an excessive degree of wheelspin is detected, LTC will modulate fuel injector delivery, throttle
opening and rear brake application, in order to control engine power output and spinning wheel inertia, until
grip is restored. This feature can improve vehicle stability in some extreme conditions of use, especially where
variable or differential side/side surface grip prevails, or when maximum vehicle performance is being exploited.
Refer also to 'EDL' (see below).
If the traction control tell tale in the instrument panel is seen to flicker, this is an indication that the LTC
has been triggered and electronic intervention is taking place; the tractive limit has been reached and driving
style should be modified accordingly.
WARNING: The enhanced vehicle control that this feature provides should not induce any relaxation
of caution or vigilance by the driver. Physical limits of cornering and braking still apply, and excessive speed may result in loss of control and an accident. The driver is at all times responsible for the
judgement of appropriate speed.
Traction Control ‘Off’ Button: In certain unusual circumstances, such as loose surfaces, deep snow or when
‘rocking’ the vehicle free from mud, it may be desirable temporarily to switch off the LTC. An LTC ‘off’ button
is provided in the fascia, outboard of the steering column, and is operative only with the ignition on.
To switch off LTC, hold the button pressed for one second, until the button surround lights up in conjunction with the amber ‘LTC off’ tell tale in the instrument panel.
WARNING:
•
Lotus Traction Control should always be active when driving on the public highway in normal
conditions.
•
If the system is switched off when driving off-highway, be aware of the consequent change in
vehicle behaviour and modify driving style accordingly.
To re-activate LTC, briefly press the button a second time and check that the tell tale goes out. Irrespective
of the system status when the ignition is turned off, LTC will automatically be activated next time the ignition
is switched on.
If the on-board diagnostic system detects a fault with the LTC, the tell tale will be lit continuously; see your
dealer without delay.
Sport Mode (if fitted)
In order to cater for the preferences of some sport oriented drivers, a Sport Mode selector button is provided
to deliver quicker throttle response, increased wheel slippage thresholds, no throttle reduction on detection of
understeer, and a maximum continuous engine speed raised from 6,600 to 7,000 rpm. Note that switching off
the Lotus Traction Control (see above) in conjunction with selection of Sport Mode, will retain the Sport features,
but without any power induced wheelslip intervention. In all cases, anti-lock braking will be retained.
WARNING: Be aware that selecting Sport Mode and/or LTC OFF, will alter the handling characteristics
of the car. Drivers should excercise caution until familiarity has been gained in a controlled safe environment.
The Sport Mode switch is located in the fascia panel outboard of the steering column. To switch on Sport
Mode, turn on the ignition, and hold the button pressed for one second until the button surround lights up
amber, accompanied by the amber ‘SPORT’ tell tale in the instrument panel. In order to prevent unintentional
acceleration if the button is pressed whilst driving, in these circumstances, the button surround will flash in
acknowledgement, but Sport Mode will not be activated until the throttle pedal has been fully released.
Page 21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Briefly pressing the button a second time will switch off Sport Mode as soon as the throttle pedal is fully
released.
Note that Sport Mode will default to ‘off’ at the next ignition cycle.
Cruise Control
The cruise control system is operated by
four switches mounted on the steering wheel
spokes.
On/off/cancel (lower left).
Resume (upper left).
Set/raise speed setting (upper right).
Reduce speed setting (lower right).
The three operational states of cruise
control are:
Off.
Enabled (but inactive).
Active.
Set/raise
speed
Resume
Icon
only
On/off/
cancel Reduce
speed
LO
T US
CRUISE
CONTROLS
ohe12
To enable cruise control: The system will always default to ‘off’ whenever the ignition is turned off. To enable
cruise control, turn on the ignition, and press the on/off switch; the tell tale in the instrument panel will light to
confirm that the system is enabled (although no speed has yet been set). Alternatively, this operation may be
combined with that for activation, by pressing the on button followed by the set button (see below).
To activate cruise control: Drive the car to the desired cruising speed and press the set button. The accelerator
may now be released, but the set speed will be maintained (road gradient and winds permitting). The accelerator may be used to increase speed temporarily without affecting the setting.
Note; The system cannot be activated below 20 mph (32 km/h) or above 125 mph (200 km/h).
Deactivation: Cruise control will be deactivated when any of the following actions occur:
The brake pedal is depressed;
The clutch pedal is depressed.
The on/off/cancel button is pressed.
In any of these cases, normal manual speed control will be restored, but the system will remain enabled.
Resume: To resume cruise, press the resume switch. The vehicle speed will automatically adjust to the cruise
setting.
Changing the cruise setting: Whilst cruise is active, the speed setting can be adjusted by holding down the ‘+’
or ‘-’ buttons to accelerate or slow the car to the desired new speed. On release of the button, that speed will
then be set. Alternatively, a single short press of either button will increase or decrease the setting by 1 mph
(1.5 km/h).
If the system is not active, the car can be driven to the desired speed, and the set button pressed.
To disable cruise control: To switch off the system, with cruise inactive, press the on/off switch; the tell tale
lamp will be extinguished.
Page 22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
MR.6 - COMPONENT LOCATION & FUSE RATINGS
Main Fusebox
The main fuse and relay boxes are located at the front of the passenger footwell, protected by a removable
panel secured by a quarter turn fastener at each top corner, and a location channel on the floor. Forty slots
are provided for mini fuses which are numbered, and coloured according to their amperage rating, and may be
pulled out from their slots using the fuse extractor tool clipped to the fusebox. Six maxi fuses protecting major
circuits are also provided, along with six single contact change over micro relays and two 50A power relays.
Maxi fuses
Relays
Mini fuses
Slot
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
C11
C12
C13
C14
C15
C16
C17
C18
C19
C20
Rate Circuit
10A Horn
5A Battery services
5A Alarm B+
20A Rad fan relay 1
20A Rad fan relay 3
10A Radio B+
5A Key-in relay
2A Ignition switch
15A
Driver’s window
15A Pass. window
7.5A Hazard & Turn
3A Interior lighting
20A Int. control mod.
-
5A LH sidelamps
5A RH sidelamps
15A LH headlamp
15A RH headlamp
15A Main beam
3A Rear foglamp
Slot
C21
C22
C23
C24
C25
C26
C27
C28
C29
C30
C31
C32
C33
C34
C35
C36
C37
C38
C39
C40
Rate Circuit
3A Ign. services
5A ABS
3A Homelink
3A Brake lamps
15A HL powerwash
5A Alarm ignition
5A HVAC ignition
5A Washer jets
5A SRS unit
3A Heated mirrors
5A Washer pump
5A Mirror/window sw.
20A Wiper motor
20A Interior fan
10A Cabin pwr. socket
-
Slot Rate Circuit
MC1 40A
MC2 40A
MC3 40A
MC4 40A
MC5 25A
MC6 25A
Battery positive
B+, ignition
Accessories
ABS B+
ABS B+
HRS
Page 23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Front Relay Blocks
Mounted on the front fusebox panel, is a block of relays, the layout of which is inverted for opposite drive
hands:
RHD LHD
Integrated Control Module
Also mounted on the front fusebox panel is the integrated control module (ICM) which is used to perform
switching and control functions for many of the circuits. The module uses 4 harness connector blocks designated
A,B,C,D, with all connection details identified on the relevant circuit diagram, and summarised below:
13
1
8
A
1
6
1
11
1
B C D
26
Page 24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
14
16
9
12
7
22
12
m268
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Key to ICM Diagram
Pin
Description
Pin
Description
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14
A15
A16
A17
A18
A19
A20
A21
A22
A23
A24
A25
A26
Supply for indicator relays
Left indicators output
Fog switch input
Headlamp powerwash output
A.c. recirc. control output
Supply for recirc. & powerwash control
Horn output
Supply for horn & foglamps
Supply for indicator current sense
Right indicators output
Battery ground
LED lighting option input
Left indicator switch input
Right indicator switch input
Intermittent variable input
DRL option input
Battery ground
Fog lights output
Indicators supply after current sensing
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
C11
C12
Main beam flash power input
Int. fan fast input
Fog switch illum. input
Drive away locking output
Sidelights switch illum. output
HRS output
Recirc. switch illum. output
A.c. request output
Diagnostic comms. KW2000
B1
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
Main beam flash input
Recirc. switch input
Hazard switch input
Wiper int. input
Washer monitor input
HRW switch input
A.c. request switch input
B8
B9
B10
B11
B12
B13
B14
B15
B16
Driver door switch input
CDL switch illumination
CDL switch monitor
Lock status input
Unlock status input
Passenger door switch input
Headlamp switch input
Sidelamps switch input
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
D15
D16
D17
D18
D19
D20
D21
D22
ICM main supply & main lighting
HRS switch illumination
Ignition switch input
Headlamp relay output
Hazard switch illumination
Hazard active illumination
A.c. switch illumination
Headlamps switch illum. output
Door open output
Sidelights output
Main beam solenoid output
Int. fan speed input
Horn switch output
Eng. man. rpm input
Wiper park input
Wiper relay control output
Auto demist input
Indicators fault monitor input
-
Page 25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Rear Fusebox
Fuses and relays for the engine bay and rear mounted systems are contained in a fusebox mounted in the
cabin, behind the left hand rear quarter trim panel. For access, use a coin to release the quarter turn fastener
on the lower edge of the removable panel, and unhook the top edge. Twenty slots are provided for mini fuses
which are numbered, and coloured according to their amperage rating, and may be pulled out from their slots
using the fuse extractor tool clipped to the fusebox. Two maxi fuses protecting major circuits are also provided,
along with four single contact change over micro relays, and two power relays.
Relays
Mini fuses
Maxi fuses
ohe25
Slot Rate Circuit
Slot Rate Circuit
Slot
R1 10A
R2 7.5A
R3 10A
R4 2A
R5 R6 -
R7 5A
R8 7.5A
R9 5A
R10
5A
R11
R12
R13
R14
R15
R16
R17
R18
R19
R20
MR1 30A
MR2 30A
ECU, fan relay 3
Injectors
Ignition coils
Re-circ. pump
ECU ignition
Engine solenoids
O2 heaters
Alternator ign.
Fuse colours
2A - Black
3A - Violet
4A - Pink
5A - Orange
7.5A - Brown
10A - Red
Page 26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
7.5A
3A
3A
10A
20A
5A
10A
5A
15A - Light blue
20A - Yellow
25A - Clear
A.c. compressor
Rev lamp, camera
Boot lamps
Boot pwr. socket
Amplifier
Fuel filler flap
Fuel pump
Alternator B+
Rate Circuit
Crank & main rly.
Busbar R17-R20
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Component Location
Other electrical components may be found as follows:
CDL module; passenger side of scuttle beam vertical face.
Alarm components; see sub-section MR.1.
Horns; one beneath the front end of each front longeron, aligned with apertures in the air intake duct.
Accessible after removal of front undertray.
Ambient air temperature sensor; mounted in RH side of the air intake duct, clipped to the undertray pylon.
Accessible after removal of front undertray.
Audio speaker cross-over units; one on each end of the scuttle vertical rear face.
Forward crash sensor; one on the outboard face of each front subframe longeron, towards the front. Accessible after removal of the front undertray.
Engine management components; see section EMR.
TPMS module; in boot, on back of LH wheelarch.
Reversing camera module; in boot, on LHS of rear transom.
MR.7 - AUDIO EQUIPMENT
Operating instructions for the unit fitted are contained in a separate booklet supplied by the equipment
manufacturer. The audio set will operate with the ignition key inserted, and in any of its positions, including
the ‘0’ lock position.
On cars fitted with a 2-DIN audio system and 175mm display screen, the following features are also included:
AM/FM radio;
CD audio;
DVD video, operable only with the parking brake engaged;
i-pod to i-pod video interaction/control;
MP3 player;
Satellite navigation;
Integrated microphone for Bluetooth phone operation;
When set is switched on, automatic display from reversing camera when reverse gear is engaged.
Note that the screen should be cleaned occasionally with a lint free, spectacle polishing cloth.
Note
•
The ‘satnav’ system includes a road network safety camera database, which may be activated at the
owner’s request when the system is set up. If using the vehicle in territories where such a feature is illegal,
it is the owner’s responsibility to ensure that the system is de-activated.
•
Note that the quality of radio reception will vary according to audio equipment fitted and local area signal
strength.
Speakers: A main speaker is fitted into each of the door trim panels, and a high frequency ‘tweeter’ incorporated
into each end of the dash fascia panel. In addition, some cars are fitted with a single sub-woofer, low freqency
speaker in the right hand rear quarter trim panel.
Door speakers - Alpine LUK-SB01B (4-speaker base spec.):
145mm aperture, 63mm depth
Door speakers - Alpine LUK-SB02T: (4/5-speaker high spec.):
145mm aperture, 63mm depth
Sub-woofer - Alpine SWE 843 (5-speaker high spec.):
183mm aperture, 111mm depth
Tweeters - Alpine LUK-ST01:
42mm aperture, 12mm depth
Security: Some audio sets feature a removable front panel; For details, refer to the set manufacturer’s litera
ture.
Page 27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
MR.8 - BATTERY, BATTERY CABLES & EARTHING POINTS
Battery
WARNING: POISON/DANGER ‑ CAUSES SEVERE BURNS ‑ KEEP OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN.
Contains sulphuric acid ‑ avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing. If in contact with skin or eyes; flush
with copious amounts of water. Remove contaminated clothing. Seek immediate medical attention. If
ingested; seek immediate medical attention . Do not induce vomiting or give fluids to drink.
Batteries produce explosive gases. Keep sparks, flames and cigarettes away. Ventilate when charging
or using in enclosed space. Always shield eyes when working near batteries.
Battery Access
The 72 Ah VARTA BLUE dynamic battery is located at the left hand front of the rear luggage compartment,
protected by a plastic cover. No routine inspection or topping up of the electrolyte is required, but at intervals
specified in the Maintenance Schedule, the battery terminals should be checked for security and condition,
and protected with petroleum jelly.
To remove the battery, release the three
Check battery terminal symbols;
thumbscrews and remove the plastic cover.
Orientation may
Release the two screws and remove the
differ Positive
retaining clamp from the base of the battery.
terminal
Withdraw the battery sufficiently to allow the
Negative
cables to be disconnected (see below).
terminal
When lifting out the battery, be aware
of the considerable weight, and take all apRetaining
propriate precautions to safeguard personal
clamp
health.
plate
Refit the battery, with its terminals to
BATTERY ACCESS (cover removed)
the rear, by reversing the above procedure.
Remember to push on the breather pipe (if
applicable).
ohe46
Disconnecting the Battery
If the battery is to be disconnected, the following precautions should be taken:
i)
If the vehicle is fitted with security coded audio equipment, check that the code is available for entering
after battery reconnection.
ii) Wait for at least ten seconds after switching off the ignition to allow the engine management system to
adjust the setting of some components ready for re‑starting.
iii) Ensure that all electrical loads (e.g. lights) are switched off.
iiv) Check that the security alarm is disarmed. If the battery is disconnected when armed, the alarm will be
triggered.
v) Disconnect the negative (earth; black; ‘‑’) battery cable first, and re‑connect last. If the battery positive
terminal is inadvertently earthed (e.g. when using a spanner) whilst the negative terminal is still connected,
the resultant short circuit with heavy sparking and current flow could cause serious burns.
Battery Reconnection
i)
Check again that all electrical loads are switched off.
ii) Connect the positive battery cable first, followed by the negative (earth) cable.
iii) Be aware that the vehicle security alarm may be triggered by the action of battery re-connection. Have
the alarm transmitter key ready to disarm the alarm (see ‘Vehicle Security Alarm’).
iv) After reconnection, a change in the engine performance characteristics may be noted for a period whilst
the computer controlled engine management system ‘re‑learns’ some of its settings.
v) If necessary, enter the security code into audio equipment.
Battery Charging
Under conditions of normal daily use, it should not be necessary to use external battery charging equipment. In a low usage regime, however, it is important to maintain the charge state of the battery using a trickle
charger, or an automatic battery management conditioner such as that available through Lotus After Sales.
Page 28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Starting difficulties may be encountered after an unattended period of 3 weeks. A battery conditioner is able to
continuously monitor battery charge state and switch on and off automatically in order to maintain the battery
in a fully charged condition without danger of damage through overcharging.
If the battery becomes discharged to the extent that the car cannot be started, the recommended course
of action is to fit a substitute battery whilst the original battery is trickle charged. If, in an emergency, the car
has to be ‘jump’ started, the subsequent conditions of car use may not allow for sufficient alternator charging of
the battery to achieve a fully charged state. The battery should be trickle charged by external means until 12.8
volts is recorded, which process may take 24 hours or longer. Putting the battery into service at a lower state
of charge will reduce the time period for which the car can be parked without subsequent starting concerns. A
battery left in a fully discharged state for a prolonged period, may not be recoverable to its original condition.
Unless using an automatic battery management charger, the battery should be removed from the car for
recharging, to a well ventilated area to avoid a build up of fumes in the luggage compartment and to prevent
damage to the car's electrical system. Observe the safety precautions listed above when removing the battery and take care to avoid sharp knocks or shocks, keeping the battery as upright as possible. Beware of the
considerable weight of a battery, and take necessary precautions against personal injury.
The recommended bench charge rate is 4 amps. When the battery is fully charged (12.8 volts), allow it
to stand for an hour before refitting into the battery well and reconnecting the leads - see above.
Quiescent Drain
With a fully charged battery, a car with no aftermarket electrical equipment fitted, all electrics switched
off, and the alarm system either armed or disarmed, will have a quiescent current drain of between 27 - 32 mA
dependent on audio and sat. nav. options. Under normal conditions, this should allow a park period of over
four weeks before starting difficulties may be encountered.
If current drain is found to significantly exceed specification, the cause must be established by isolating
components (e.g. at fusebox) and rectifying faults as necessary.
Battery Cables
Two red cables are connected to the battery positive post. One leads to the solenoid on the starter motor.
A second cable leads to the positive post fixed to the back of the cabin bulhead in the LHR wheelarch area,
and includes an 'in-line' 150A fuse. This post is linked via a cable routed through the LH sill area to the front
mounted positive post on the top of the passenger side scuttle, and from here to the main fusebox/relay panel
at the front of the passenger footwell.
A braided earth cable connects the negative battery terminal to the chassis rear earth point, on the inside
face of the LH siderail, at the LHF of the engine bay, accessible from beneath. Two further cables link this point
to the transmission casing, and to the rear fusebox and ECU mounting bracket at the LHR of the cabin.
WARNING: Before disconnecting a live feed cable from either post, first disconnect the earth cable from
the battery. Be aware of the danger of short circuits and sparks caused by a live feed cable contacting
the chassis or other metal components.
The rear positive post is mounted on a bracket which also secures the left hand end of the evaporative
emissions canister, and is accessible with the wheelarch liner and/or rear clamshell removed. Special care
should be taken to prevent sparks in this area. When re-connecting the rear positive post, note that two spacers A075W4020Z should first be fitted onto each stud, before each pair of cables is assembled back to back,
with the battery and front fusebox cables on the front stud, and the alternator and rear fusebox cables on the
rear stud. Tighten the M8 retaining nuts to 16 Nm.
MR.9 - WIPER MECHANISM
The windscreen wiper mechanism comprises a uni-directional motor with an external rotary link, a connecting rod, and a pair of actuating links which join the connecting rod to the arms of the wiper spindle. This
mechanism provides the wiper with a motion which is slowed at each end of its travel in order to ease the
inertia loads during direction changes, to the benefit of refinement and durability. The motor and wheelbox are
mounted on a single pressed steel bracket which is bolted to the underside of the windscreen frame.
Page 29
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
To remove the wiper mechanism:
1. Remove the front clamshell (see sub-section BV.4).
2.
Remove the wiper arm.
3. Remove the 4 retaining screws, and withdraw the windscreen gutter with drain tubes.
4. Unplug the harness connector from the wiper motor. Release the 4 cap head screws around the wiper
spindle that secure the mounting bracket to the windscreen frame, and the single screw at the motor end
of the bracket. Withdraw the wiper mechanism.
5.
Re-assemble in the reverse order to removal, torque tightening the bracket bolts to 20 Nm.
Note that no service parts are offered for the wiper mechanism. Excessive wear in any part of the mechanism, or motor is rectified by renewal of the complete assembly.
MR.10 - HARNESS ROUTING
The main harness runs from the main fusebox/relay station at the front of the passenger footwell, up to
the center underside of the scuttle, across to the passenger side and through to the top of the scuttle. Then it
runs across the full width of the scuttle to supply all the fascia components and to each of the separate door
harnesses. At the centre of the front bulkhead, a branch of the main harness penetrates the bulkhead and divides along each side to supply the HVAC functions, ABS, lighting and other front mounted electrical equipment.
From the same junction at the front bulkhead, a further branch runs down the centre of the cockpit, beneath
the gearchange mounting channel to supply the fuel pump, with branches also running to each side behind
the seat mounting front cross-member and back to each rear quarter area. The RH branch supplies the roof
harness near the 'B' post area and continues through the rear bulkhead to supply the tailgate and rear lighting
harnesses. The LH branch connects to the engine management ECU and engine harness, then continues
through the bulkhead to supply the parking sensors and TPMS.
Main harness Roof harness
Tailgate harness
Rear
harness
Main fusebox/
relay station Door Rear fusebox
harness relay station
Engine harness
Page 30
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
pl1701eg
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
MR.11 - HEADLAMP ASSEMBLIES
Xenon Headlamp Assemblies
The Lotus Evora is available with High Intensity Discharge (HID)/Xenon headlamp assemblies, the light
sources of which utilise a plasma discharge arc between two electrodes to provide a blue-white light for optimal
illumination of the roadway. Each headlamp unit uses a D1S electronic igniter/burner unit (equivalent to the
bulb), mounted in a specially coated alloy reflector, ahead of which is fixed a glass aspheric lens on an alloy
carrier. A shielded high tension harness connects the burner unit to a voltage ballast unit mounted in the base
of the headlamp housing. The ballast unit is supplied with battery voltage and outputs around 20,000 volts (up
to 80,000 during the start up phase) to the burner, although the power consumption is only 35 Watts.
A bottom pivoted flap is used to mask the upper part of the light beam (i.e. lower part in front of the lamp,
prior to beam inversion by the aspheric lens), and allow a single light source to provide both main and dip
beams. The flap is sprung and counterweighted in order to default to the vertical, masking, position, and is
swung down by a solenoid fixed to the side of the reflector unit, when main beam is selected. Also contained
within each headlamp housing is a 10 LED sidelamp, positioned outboard of the headlamp, and an 8 amber
LED turn lamp at the front of the housing, fronted by a clear diffuser.
Due to the increased light production of the gas discharge headlamps, and the increased potential for dirt
on the lamp cover causing dazzle from refraction, a powerful headlamp washer is fitted. A dedicated high pressure pump is fitted into the windscreen washer bottle, and supplies a powerwash module incorporated into the
outer side of each headlamp unit, normally lying flush with the headlamp cover. When the windscreen washer
control is operated, the headlamp washer pump is also activated for 2 seconds, the pressure from which causes
the telescopic washer module to extend about 20 mm above the headlamp cover and deploy two conical sprays
of fluid from a pair of high flow jets. The module then returns under spring action to its flush position.
Note that certain atmospheric conditions may result in some condensation inside the lamp unit. This
should have no significant effect on lamp performance and is no cause for concern.
Headlamp Servicing
The only serviceable parts of the Xenon headlamp unit are:
D1S burner unit
Voltage ballast unit
Powerwash module
High tension cable
WARNING:
The high voltages produced by the headlamp ballast unit could cause injurious electric shocks. Ensure
the battery is disconnected before servicing the headlamp assembly.
To replace the burner unit, first disconnect the battery to protect from potentially injurious shocks. Remove
the access grommet in the wheelarch liner, and pull off the protective boot from the back of the headlamp housing. Release the spring wire clip and withdraw the burner sufficiently to allow the H.T. cable to be unplugged.
Note that touching the glass envelope by hand is likely to lead to premature failure. If necessary, the envelope
should be cleaned using white spirit and a paper tissue.
Other serviceable parts may be replaced after removing the headlamp housing from the car.
Halogen Bulb Headlamp Assemblies
The Evora is also available with halogen bulb headlamp assemblies, which share the same housing and
features of the Xenon units, but are replace the HID headlamp equipment with a simpler H4 halogen bulb.
Headlamp Housing Removal
Each headlamp is secured to the front subframe longeron via front and rear mounting brackets. To remove
a headlamp housing:
1. Remove the front roadwheel and wheelarch liner;
2.
Disconnect the wiring harness and washer tubing;
3.
Release the two screws securing the headlamp front mounting bracket to the subframe, and the two fixings
securing the headlamp rear bracket to the bumper support bracket. Withdraw the headlamp assembly.
Page 31
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
4.
When re-fitting, ensure the front clamshell is first fitted and optimised for position before adjusting the
headlamp mounting to obtain a satisfactory fit of the lamp in the aperture.
5.
Re-connect the harness and washer tubing and check headlamp beam alignment.
Headlamp Beam Alignment
1. Using beam setting equipment compatible with local regulations, position the machine between 300 and
700mm in front of the LH headlamp, and parallel with the two headlamp units using the sight bar or similar
device dependent on the machine design, to ensure cross car match. Use the guides provided on the
machine to ensure the correct height and lateral setting.
2.
Switch on the headlamp dip beams and check the lateral beam alignment. The ‘knee point’ of the beam
cut off line must lie within a tolerance of 2% to the passenger side, and 0%. Check the vertical alignment
of the dip beam which must lie within a tolerance of -0.5% and -2%.
3.
If adjustment is required, turn the steering to full lock to facilitate removal of the four screws retaining the
access cover in the wheelarch liner.
4.
Each headlamp assembly features two adjustment screws, one for vertical, and one for horizontal aim. To
adjust the beam laterally, turn the inboard adjuster screw. Turn clockwise to adjust the beam to the right.
Optimum setting is 0%. To adjust the beam vertically, turn the outboard adjuster screw. Turn clockwise
to raise the beam. Optimum setting is -1.2%. Re-check lateral alignment.
5.
Repeat for the opposite lamp.
6.
Re-fit the access covert in the wheelarch liner.
mr.12 - bulb replacement
Headlamp Units
Halogen Headlamps (if fitted)
On cars fitted with halogen headlamp assemblies, the lamps are fitted in the same housings as used for
the HID headlamps: Remove the access cover in the wheelarch liner, and pull off the protective boot from
the back of the headlamp housing. Pull the harness plug off the bulb, release the spring wire retaining clip,
and withdraw the bulb. Note that touching the glass envelope by hand is likely to lead to premature failure. If
necessary, the envelope should be cleaned using white spirit and a paper tissue.
HID Xenon Headlamps (if fitted)
Each HID headlamp unit uses a D1S electronic igniter/burner unit (equivalent to the bulb), mounted in a
specially coated alloy reflector, with a ballast unit to output around 20,000 volts to the burner.
WARNING: The high voltages produced by the headlamp ballast unit could cause injurious electric
shocks. Ensure the battery is disconnected before servicing a headlamp assembly.
1.
Disconnect the battery to protect from potentially injurious shocks. Remove the access cover in the
wheelarch liner, and pull off the protective boot from the back of the headlamp housing.
2.
Release the spring wire clip and withdraw the burner sufficiently to allow the H.T. cable to be unplugged.
Note that touching the glass envelope by hand is likely to lead to premature failure. If necessary, the
envelope should be cleaned using white spirit and a paper tissue.
3.
After refitting, verify lamp operation and check that the protective boot is correctly fitted onto the lamp body
before replacing the wheelarch liner grommet.
Front Turn Indicator & Sidelamp Bulbs
The front turn lamps and sidelamps are provided by light emitting diodes (LEDs) and are incorporated into
Page 32
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
the headlamp assemblies. These lamps are designed for long life and are serviceable only by replacement of
the complete headlamp unit.
Rear Lamp Cluster Bulbs
The outboard lamp cluster contains the tail, brake and turn indicator functions, and is configured as follows:
Annulus; tail and brake lamps.
Centre; turn indicator lamp.
The tail and brake lamps are provided by a ring of light emitting diodes (LEDs), and are serviceable only
by complete lamp cluster replacement. Each turn indicator lamp uses a filament type GE921 capless bulb
retained in a bayonet type holder. From inside the boot, turn the bulb holder anti-clockwise to release from the
lamp body, and withdraw the bulb.
Rear Fog and Reverse Lamps
A secondary lamp is mounted inboard of each rear lamp cluster, to provide a rear fog lamp on the driver’s
side, and a reversing lamp on the passenger side. Both these lamps are sealed units containing a ring of
LEDs, which are serviceable only by replacement of the complete lamp. Note that this process requires the
rear bumper to be removed (see sub-section BV.7).
Centre High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
The CHMSL, mounted to the underside of the rear aerofoil, uses a string of light emitting diodes (LEDs)
for optimum visibility. The lamp is a sealed unit with no replaceable bulbs, and may be replaced complete, after
releasing the two retaining screws and unplugging the harness connector.
Side Repeater Lamps
The side repeater lamps are mounted in the front clamshell behind each wheelarch, and use durable light
emitting diodes (LEDs). The lamps are servicable only by complete replacement, the lamp being secured by
an adhesive gasket.
Licence Plate Lamps
To replace a bulb in a rear licence plate lamp, first remove the two screws securing the lamp to the body,
and withdraw sufficiently to allow access to the festoon bulb.
Interior Lamp
To withdraw the interior lamp from the roof trim panel, first ease one end of the lamp from its aperture.
Withdraw the lamp sufficiently to allow access to the festoon bulb, if necessary, unplugging the harness connector.
mr13 - instrument panel
1.
The instrument panel is mounted on the Fascia Dash Panel, but may be removed separately:
Remove the instrument cowl top access panel by lifting the forward end free from its Griplock strips, and
unhook the rearward end.
2.
Unplug the harness connectors from the instrument panel. Release the two screws securing the top of the
instrument panel to the cowl flange, and the two screws securing the back face of the unit to the support
plate.
3.
From within the coin pocket outboard of the steering column, remove the blanking sticker and release the
switch panel fixing screw. Carefully prise the outboard switch panel out with its two Tower clips. Unplug
the switch harness connector.
4.
Carefully prise out the inboard switch panel with its four Tower clips and unplug the switch harness connectors.
5.
Release the two screws securing the instrument panel to the fascia, and withdraw the unit.
Page 33
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
MR.14 - CIRCUIT DIAGRAMS
Circuit
Sheet
Battery Supply
Accessory Key In
Accessory Supply
Ignition Supply
Charging System
CAN Network
Diagnostic Link Connector
Grounding Structure
Cranking
Alarm & Immobiliser
Central Locking
Fuel Filler Flap & Glovebox Solenoids
EMS Power & Ground
EMS Fuel Injection
EMS Ignition Coils
EMS TMAF & Knock Sensors
EMS Cam & Crank Sensors & Various Solenoids
EMS Coolant Sensing & Fan Contol
EMS Throttle Actuation
EMS Fuel Pump & Fuel level Sensing
EMS O2 Sensors
EMS Cruise Control
Sidelamps
Switch Illumination
Headlamps (Xenon)
Headlamps (Halogen)
Rear Fog Lamps
Direction Indicators & Hazard Lamps
Brake Lamps
Reverse Lamps & Reversing Camera/Sensors
Interior Lighting - LHD
Interior Lighting - RHD
Airbags
Anti-Lock Brakes, Traction Control & Sport Mode
Instrument Cluster
HVAC System Part 1
HVAC System Part 2
HVAC System Part 3
Wash Wipe System. Power Wash & Heated Jets
Window Lift with Active Glass (LHD)
Window Lift with Active Glass (RHD)
Tyre Pressure Monitoring
Electric Mirrors & Heated Rear Screen (LHD)
Electric Mirrors & Heated Rear Screen (RHD)
ICE Base
ICE Tech Pack
ICE - Japanese
Horns & Power Sockets
Homelink
Page 34
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Page
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
B1
B2
B3
B4
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
C8
C9
C10
D1A
D1B
D2A
D2B
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7 A
D7B
E1
E2
E3
E4A
E4B
E4C
E5
E6A
E6B
E7
E8A
E8B
E9A
E9B
E9D
E10
E11
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 35
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 36
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 37
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 38
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 39
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 40
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 41
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 42
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 43
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 44
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 45
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 46
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 47
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 48
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 49
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 50
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 51
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 52
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 53
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 54
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 55
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 56
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 57
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 58
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 59
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 60
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 61
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 62
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 63
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 64
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 65
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 66
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 67
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 68
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 69
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 70
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 71
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 72
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 73
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 74
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 75
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 76
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 77
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 78
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 79
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 80
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 81
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Page 82
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section MR
Lotus Service Notes
Section MR
Page 83
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
MAINTENANCE & LUBRICATION
SECTION OK
Page
Recommended Lubricants
2
Maintenance Schedule
Pre-Delivery Inspection
4
Pre-Delivery Paint Mark Up
9
Licence Plate Fitment
10
7
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS
Engine
In order to ensure the longevity and reliability of the vehicle, it is most important that only the specified
lubricants are used. It is an entirely false economy to try to save money by using lower quality oils, which
may break down before the next change interval and provide inadequate protection before the end of the term.
High oil consumption may also result.
For topping up purposes during the running-in period prior to the First After Sales Service, the recommended lubricant is Havoline Ultra 5W/40 semi-synthetic. If this is unavailable, a top quality semi-synthetic
5W/30 or 5W/40 oil should be used.
At the First After Sales Service and completion of the running-in period, a fully synthetic oil should then
be used throughout the life of the vehicle. A top quality fully synthetic 5W/40, such as 'Havoline Synthetic' is
suitable for all climatic conditions likely to be encountered, and provides ease of cranking, smooth cold running
and fuel economy at low temperatures, in combination with good wear protection at elevated temperatures and
at high engine speeds. Note that no oil additives are approved by Lotus.
Viscosity: ambient above -20°C
Quality standard
Capacity: refill inc. filter:
dry - no heat exchanger
dry - with heat exchanger
Difference between high & low dipstick marks
Oil change interval
SAE 5W/40
API SL/CF; ACEA A3/B3-04
6.1 litre
6.8 litre
7.1 litre
1.0 litre
Refer to Maintenance Schedule
Transmission (gearbox & final drive)
Viscosity
Quality standard
Approved product
Capacity
Oil change interval
SAE 75W/80
API GL-4
Havoline Multigear MTF 75W-80 (semi-synthetic)
2.3 litre
Refer to Maintenance Schedule
Brake & Clutch System
Type
Specification
Capacity - inc. brake and clutch systems
Fluid change interval
Non-mineral (non-petroleum) hydraulic fluid
DOT 4
580 cc
24 months
Power Steering System (PAS)
Fluid type:
Specification:
Capacity:
Fluid change interval:
PAS or Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Dexron III
1.5 litres
Not routine
Engine Coolant Additive
Approved product
Type
Colour
Quantity reqd. @ 50% concentration
Coolant change interval
Havoline XLC
Ethylene glycol antifreeze with OAT corrosion inhibitors
Orange
8.5 litres
4 years
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
'Severe Service’ Conditions
Certain operating conditions can cause rapid degradation of the oil quality, either by the accumulation
of dirt particles, or by the absorption of water from condensation. If any of the ‘severe service’ conditions described below apply, it is recommended that the oil and filter be changed twice as frequently as is listed in the
Maintenance Schedule.
•
Driving in dusty areas (e.g. on unmetalled roads); Change the oil and filter as soon as possible after driving in a dust storm.
•
Stop/start driving with frequent short trips where the engine rarely warms up thoroughly (especially in cold
weather/climates); and/or frequent or prolonged idling.
•
Track use, with repeated high rpm, wide throttle openings and high oil temperatures. In these circumstances,
individual judgement must be made regarding appropriate servicing. Note that use of the car off road or in
a competitive manner, including timed runs or laps, will invalidate warranty and require appropriate levels
of expert car preparation and servicing.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE - Evora (Non-USA)
LSL537
Job no.: ........................ Owner's name: .....…………....................... Vehicle: ..............………...………..
Vehicle registration no.: ......………................... V.I.N.: ......………................................................…
Recorded mileage: ........………...…….………… Mileage at last service.: ..............………………
Today's date: ………………..………...…………… Date of last service: ………………………
EXPLANATORY NOTES:
Required Maintenance
In order to maintain warranty validation and help ensure proper safety, emissions performance and
dependability of the vehicle, Lotus Cars Ltd. requires that the vehicle be serviced in accordance with this
schedule. Under normal usage conditions, a routine maintenance service should be performed at the first
occurring of 9,000 miles (15,000 km) or 12 months from the previous service. The approved service period
extends to 500 miles (800 km) before/after or one monthbefore/after the stipulated distance/time. Any
necessary repairs should be completed without delay.
A cross ( X ) in the following table indicates an operation to be performed. The corresponding box should be
ticked when the operation has been satisfactorily performed, or the X circled if extra work and time is required.
The approval of the customer should be obtained before any extra work is undertaken, details of which should
be recorded in the space provided at the end of the schedule.
'Inspect' means assess condition and test for correct operation. Extra time is required to adjust or repair advise customer beforehand if necessary.
'Check' means test and adjust/fill or tighten as necessary. Labour time is included.
Special Operating Conditions
If the car is subjected to one of the following 'special operating conditions', additional servicing is required:
- Regular use on unpaved or dusty roads (1,2)
- Use in mountainous areas with severe or prolonged brake usage (3)
- Frequent short trips with cold engine (esp. in cold weather/climates); and/or frequent or prolonged idling (1)
- Occasional hard use, with repeated high rpm, wide throttle openings and high oil temperatures (1,3,4)
- Competition, or track use - not endorsed by Lotus and voiding the Warranty (5)
Additional servicing:
1. Oil & filter change @ 4,500 m (7,500 km) intervals.
2. Inspect air cleaner @ 9,000 m (15,000 km) intervals, or as required.
3. Inspect brake pads & discs @ 4,500 m (7,500 km) intervals, or as required.
4. Thorough safety check including wheels, tyres, suspension, steering and brake systems.
5. The Evora is intended for use as a road going passenger vehicle. IT IS NOT DESIGNED OR INTENDED
FOR USE OFF ROAD, INCLUDING ON CLOSED CIRCUIT TRACKS OR FOR USE IN A COMPETITIVE
MANNER, INCLUDING TIMED LAPS OR RUNS. ANY SUCH USE WILL INVALIDATE THE NEW VEHICLE
WARRANTY. If an owner elects to use the Evora on a closed circuit track or in a competitive manner, the
severity of operating conditions demands that appropriate levels of expert car preparation, servicing (over and
above that specified in the Maintenance Schedule) and vigilance will be required, including careful inspection of
all safety critical components both before and after any track or competition session.
After Sales Service
To be performed within 1,000 - 1,500 miles (1,500 - 2,500 km) or 12 months of vehicle sale, whichever first
occurs.
If carried out by the selling dealer, there is no charge to the vehicle owner for the labour content of the After
Sales Service. Only for materials used will a charge be made. To maintain warranty validation, an Engine
History Report print out from the Lotus TechCentre must be submitted to the Warranty Department.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Op.
No.
1
2
2a
3
4
5
5a
6
6a
7
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
17a
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
Lotus Service Notes
Operation Description
Fit protective covers to seats, footwells, steering wheel and rear
body
Lubrication
Renew engine oil and filter - normal conditions
Renew engine oil and filter - special conditions
Inspect engine & transmission for oil leaks
Renew manual transmission oil
Engine
Inspect air cleaner element - normal conditions
Inspect air cleaner element - dusty conditions
Renew air cleaner element - normal conditions
Renew air cleaner element - dusty conditions
Renew spark plugs
Inspect auxiliary drive belt condition
Inspect integrity of fuel system
Inspect for fault codes & ECU programme level
Print Engine History & Performance reports and return to Lotus
Cooling System
Inspect water radiator & pipework for damage or leaks. Clean
radiator finning
Check coolant level
Renew coolant
Braking System
Inspect parking brake adjustment
Inspect brake pad thickness & disc condition - normal cndts.
Inspect brake pad thickness & disc condition - special cndts.
Inspect brake hoses, pipes & hydraulic units
Check brake fluid level
Renew brake/clutch fluid
Steering & Suspension
Check security and condition of front & rear suspension
Inspect dampers for leaks and performance
Inspect front and rear wheel bearings for play
Inspect condition of drive shaft gaiters
Inspect steering ball joints and gaiters
Inspect free play at steering wheel
Wheels & Tyres
Inspect tyre condition & set pressures
Electrical
Check battery & terminals for security & condition
Inspect operation of all lights
Body
Inspect operation & adjustment of hinges and latches, manual
door locks
Inspect operation & condition of seat belts
Inspect wiper operation & top up windscreen washer reservoir
Renew pollen filter
Renew alarm transmitter batteries (check with customer)
Section OK
After
Sales
X
Service Type
9,000m
Other
(15,000km)
Intervals
or 12 months
X
X
4,500m (7,500km)/6 mth
X
X
36,000m (60,000km)/4 yr
X
X
As required
36,000m (60,000km)/4 yr
As required
54,000m (90,000km)
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
4yrs
X
X
4,500m (7,500km)
X
X
X
18,000m (30,000km)/2 yr
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
18,000m (30,000km)/2 yr
1 yr
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
Road Test Performance
Engine performance ...........................…..................
Tailpipe CO ...........................................................
Clutch operation ......................................................
Gearbox operation ................................................
Brake performance ...................................................
Steering performance ...........................................
Driveline & suspension noise/vibration .......................
Wheel balance ......................................................
General comments ……………………………………………………………………………………………………
...........................................................................................................……………………….............
…………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………..
Additional Work Performed or Required
…………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………..
…………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………..
…………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………
………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………......
Work completed by ............................................… Owner's Maintenance Booklet stamped: …………
Recommended Service Times
After Sales Service: 1.9 hr
Regular Service:
2.8 hr
Op. 2a:
0.6 hr
Op.4:
0.4 hr
Op.5a:
0.1 hr
Op.6a:
0.7 hr
Op.7:
0.6 hr
Op.15:
1.0 hr
Op.17a:
0.1 hr
Op.20:
0.6 hr
Op.33:
0.1 hr
Op.34:
0.1 hr
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Dealer Stamp:
Date:
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
PRE-DELIVERY INSPECTION
LSL345E
MODEL
COLOUR
VIN
SCC _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _
9
OPERATION DESCRIPTION
Fit protective covers to seats, footwells & steering wheel.
Engine Bay
Check engine, transmission & PAS oil levels.
Check coolant fill level.
Start Engine
Inspect engine & transmission for oil leaks.
Inspect cooling system for leaks.
Fill fuel tank and inspect entire fuel system for leaks.
Use Lotus TechCentre to check for stored codes.
Wheels & Tyres
Check cold tyre pressures.
Check torque of wheel bolts.
Check tyreweld canister is fitted in rear luggage compartment.
Electrical
Check security of battery terminals and voltage. Below 12.4V recharge. Below 11.7V replace*.
Inspect operation of alarm system, CDL & fuel flap release.
Inspect operation of all exterior & interior lamps.
Inspect operation of horn & hazard switch.
Inspect wiper operation at all speeds & park position.
Inspect screen washer & powerwash operation, jet alignment & reservoir level.
Inspect operation of all instrumentsl, mirror adjustment & fold.
Inspect operation of heater / air conditioning & blower fan.
Inspect operation of audio equipment & set time clock (if applicable).
Body
Check brake / clutch fluid level.
Inspect operation of doors, door locks & tailgate release (incl. Evora cable).
Inspect operation of electric window lift mechanism.
Inspect fit of hard & soft top roofs.
Inspect seat adjustment latching & operation of front & rear seatbelts.
Inspect interior trim for damage & cleanliness.
Inspect all paint work for damage (Elise LSL407a; Exige LSL409a; Europa LSL514; Evora LSL544).
Check presence of toolkit & literature pack.
Fit number plates and tax disc holder.
Complete Warranty Literature
Check presence of vehicle handbook, audio booklet & other documentation.
Complete pages 2, 3, 4a & 4c in "Maintenance Record" booklet.
Cut out pages 4a & 4c for return to Lotus Cars Warranty Department.
Copy alarm installation certificate, PIN & key details (inc. locking wheel bolts). Originals to customer.
U.K.: Complete Lotus Roadside Assistance card (expiry date 2 years from reg. date).
* Battery claims will not be accepted unless correct trickle charging has been maintained.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
Road Test Performance Check - Add comments as necessary
Engine performance:
Brake performance:
Clutch operation:
Gearbox operation:
Steering performance:
Check wheel balance:
Driveline/suspension noise/vibration:
General Comments
Additional Work Required
Additional Work Completed by:
Valet
Undertake complete vehicle valet.
Notes - The PDI is subject to the following conditions:
Dealer stamp:
a) It is the responsibility of the supplying dealer to ensure that
the car is delivered to the customer in the best possible condition.
b) All costs incurred during the inspection process are the responsibility of the dealer.
c) Failure to return a signed copy of this inspection to Lotus
Cars Ltd. by the dealer, may result in warranty claims on
the particular car being rejected.
Pre-Delivery Inspection Completed by:
Date:
ONCE COMPLETED, SEND ORIGINAL COPY OF PDI FORM, OWNER'S HANDBOOK MAINTENANCE RECORD
PAGES "P.D.I & REGISTRATION OF SALE", AND NEW CAR HANDOVER CHECKLIST (LSL486) TO:
WARRANTY DEPARTMENT,
LOTUS CARS LTD.
POTASH LANE,
HETHEL,
NORFOLK,
NR14 8EZ,
ENGLAND
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
PRE-DELIVERY PAINT MARK UP - EVORA
VIN
COLOUR
OWNER
DATE OF PDI
lsl544
PAINT DEFECT CODE
B
C
D
F
G
H
K
M
BLISTERING
CHIPS
DISTORTION
FLAKING
GEL CRAZING
PIN HOLES
SINKAGE
MAT CREASES
N
O
P
R
S
T
U
V
SHADING
OVERSPRAY
PRE-RELEASES
RUN
SCRATCHES
THIN PAINT
DIRT UNDER PAINT
VOIDS
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section OK
Licence Plate Fitment
Front
The mounting plinth for the front licence plate is screw fixed to the front clamshell, and is slightly curved in
plan. Typically, the plate is secured using double sided tape in conjunction with two fixing screws with suitable
blind fix nuts (e.g. Rawlnuts). The plate should be aligned with the bottom edge of the plinth to reduce potential
damage from grounding or kerbs, whilst providing the minimum restriction to radiator airflow.
Rear
The rear licence plate should be mounted on the surface of the rear transom recess using double sided
tape and/or fixing screws at the dealer's/customer's discretion. Ensure that any holes drilled through the body
are suitably weather sealed.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
AIR CONDITIONING, HEATING & VENTILATION
SECTION PN
Sub-Section Page
General Description
PN.1
3
Heater/A.C. Airflow Overview
PN.2
5
Cooling Fans & Re-circulation Pump
PN.3
9
Refrigerant Handling
PN.4
10
Refrigerant Pipework Precautions
PN.5
10
Refrigerant Oil
PN.6
12
Compressor
PN.7
12
Condenser
PN.8
14
Receiver-Drier
PN.9
15
Heater/Evaporator/Fan (HVAC) Unit
PN.10
15
Air Distribution Unit (ADU)
PN.11
16
Refrigerant Pipes
PN.12
17
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Heater Circuit
Heater matrix
Heater
Thermostat return rail
housing
Header
Coolant outlet
tank
housing
Air bleed
screws
Outlet
from head
Re-circulation pump
Pipe runs
through LH sill
p116
Refrigerant Circuit
Expansion valve
Receiver drier
Condenser
High pressure
vapour line
Evaporator
Low pressure
vapour line
Compressor
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
p115
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
PN.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The heating, ventilation and air conditioning (HVAC) main unit comprises a plastic casing secured to the
front face of the main chassis tub, housing the fan blower, a.c. evaporator and heater matrix, with a fresh air
inlet adaptor on its top face, a re-circulation intake port on the rear face, and an outlet to the air distribution
chamber on the top rear of the unit.
Heater Circuit
The heating system uses engine coolant to provide a heat source transferred to the interior airstream via
a heat exchanger matrix mounted within the HVAC unit. Hot coolant is directed from an offtake on the engine
outlet housing at the rear of the cylinder head, via a re-circulation pump (see below), into pipework running
through the LH sill, and connecting to the heater matrix. The outlet from the matrix connects to return pipwork
routed alongside the supply line to the LH end of the heater return rail. This rail runs down the 'V' of the cylinder block, alongside the by-pass pipe, and connects to the engine side of the thermostat housing at the front
of the engine.
In conditions of 'heat soak', after stopping a hot engine, the electric re-circulation pump mounted in the
heater supply line at the LH side of the engine bay, is energised under engine ECU control, to pump coolant
around the heater circuit and limit the potential for localised boiling within the cylinder head.
Air Conditioning - Basic Principles
The air conditioning unit uses a variable displacement compressor system with a thermostatic expansion
valve to provide refrigerated air to the vehicle interior. The system comprises:
a closed circuit containing refrigerant R134a;
a variable displacement compressor mounted on the front side of the engine, driven by multi-vee belt from
the front end of the crankshaft via an electromagnetic clutch;
a condenser fixed to the front of the engine cooling radiator, between the front subframe longerons and
tilted forwards at 45°;
an evaporator unit (cooler) contained within the HVAC housing ahead of the cabin footwell bulkhead;
a thermostatic expansion valve fitted at the inlet connection to the evaporator;
a refrigerant receiver-drier unit mounted on the outside of the front subframe RH longeron, ahead of the
RH front wheel.
Closed Circuit
The closed refrigerant circuit should not be opened unless absolutely necessary, and only then using
appropriate refrigerant recovery equipment. Never allow the refrigerant to vent to atmosphere. Refer to subsection PN.5. Failure to observe these precautions may result in personal injury.
The discharge hose from the engine driven compressor connects to a rigid aluminium pipe at the RH
side of the engine bay, with the junction supported on an vibration isolator plate. The high pressure discharge
pipe is routed through the RH body sill via foam support blocks clamped to the outside of the chassis main
siderail. At the rear of the RHF wheelarch, the pipe rises to another junction plate secured to the outside of
the subframe longeron, where it connects to the condenser supply pipe/hose assembly which runs over the
wheelarch area to the RH side of the condenser, to which it connects on the topside. The condenser outlet
union is sited alongside the inlet union, and supplies a rigid aluminium pipe running to the receiver-drier unit
mounted ahead of the RHF wheelarch. From here, another pipe, incorporating the trinary switch, connects to
the expansion valve mounted on the evaporator inlet pipe at the RH side of the HVAC unit. Refrigerant leaving
the evaporator passes through the expansion valve into a pipe/hose assembly which connects to a sill pipe
and then continues to run in parallel to the supply line back to the compressor.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Compressor
The variable displacement compressor is mounted on the front side of the engine, and is driven by the
multi-rib auxiliary belt. The compressor operates to discharge refrigerant vapour at high pressure and temperature into the condenser and is lubricated by a quantity of special refrigerant oil, most of which is retained
in the compressor, with the remainder being circulated with the refrigerant. The compressor contains a ring of
cylinders with axes parallel to the compressor drive shaft, and whose pistons are driven up and down the bores
by a rotating 'swash plate', the angle of which, in relation to the drive shaft, is variable. With a small swash plate
angle, a short piston stroke is produced for a low refrigerant flow; a high swash plate angle results in greater
piston stroke for a higher flow of refrigerant. The angle of the swashplate is determined by the pressure differential between that on top of the pistons, and that within the housing, applying a force to the underside of
the pistons, in conjunction with a coil spring around the drive shaft.
This differential is controlled by a solenoid valve under ECU control, using pulse width modulation. When
the valve is open, the output from the cylinders is bled off to the compressor housing to result in no pressure
differential. The angle of the swashplate is then determined by the coil spring which pushes the plate to a
near neutral position to provide minimal flow. As the valve is progressively closed, the pressure differential
increases, with the pressure on top of the pistons pushing the swashplate to a greater angle, and producing
an increased refrigerant flow.
The engine ECU is programmed to minimise refrigerant flow until an a.c. request is made, thus allowing
the compressor to be run at all times in the interests of system lubrication, and the reduction of inactivity damage.
To safeguard the drive system in the event of compressor seizure, an electromagnetic clutch in the pulley
hub is used to disengage the drive as signalled by a sensor in the compressor nose. The clutch will also be
disengaged by the ECU if a loss of refrigerant is detected by the trinary switch (see below).
Hot refrigerant vapour from the compressor is fed via flexible hoses and alloy pipwork routed through the
body RH sill, to the front mounted condenser.
Condenser
The aluminium condenser is a 'parallel flow' heat exchanger, configured with side mounted collector tanks
interconnected by 40 oval shaped, horizontal tubes, all provided with generous finning. The unit is fixed to the
front of the engine cooling radiator, sited between the longerons of the front subframe, and angled forwards at
45°. The hot vapour received from the compressor, is admitted into the top section of the RH condenser tank,
and flows through 32 tubes to the LH tank before returning to the lower section of the RH tank via the bottom
8 tubes. In so doing, heat is released to the surrounding air via the condenser finning, with airflow boosted by
two electric fans mounted on top of the engine radiator, and ram air flow caused by vehicle movement.
A union at the bottom of the RH tank directs the condensed, liquid refrigerant into pipework connecting
with the receiver-drier.
Receiver-Drier
The receiver-drier unit is fitted into the refrigerant line between the condenser and evaporator expansion
valve, and houses a screen sack filled with desiccant to absorb traces of moisture and other contaminants from
the refrigerant. The unit is mounted on the outside of the subframe RH longeron, ahead of the RHF wheel.
A trinary switch fitted into the pipe between the receiver-drier and expansion valve supplies a pressure
signal to the engine ECU, which then allows system operation only within a pressure range of 2 to 32 bar in
order to prevent system damage from too high a pressure, or from compressor oil starvation damage caused
by too low a pressure. This data is also used by the ECU to engage the two condenser fans at half speed at
pressures over 17.5 bar (see also sub-section KJ.5).
Expansion Valve
The expansion valve block is fitted into the high and low pressure pipes at the evaporator connection, and
provides a variable restriction to the flow of high pressure liquid into the evaporator, such that the consequent
pressure drop causes a change of state to a low pressure, low temperature atomised liquid.
By sensing the temperature and pressure of refrigerant leaving the evaporator, the expansion acts to
modulate the flow of refrigerant into the unit to optimise the cooling performance.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Evaporator
The evaporator is a 'serpentine' type heat exchanger mounted within the HVAC unit. The low pressure liquid
refrigerant flowing into the evaporator via the expansion valve, begins to boil (evaporate) and in so doing, draws
the necessary heat for this process from the airstream passing across the evaporator finning. This airstream is
consequently cooled, and is directed through the various outlet vents to the passenger compartment.
When the a.c. switch is pressed by the driver, and other parameters allow it (i.e. ignition on, blower fan
speed selected, a.c. system pressurised, ambient temperature above 3°C), the a.c. circuit is activated and refrigerant flow established. A thermostat, using a thermistor positioned against the outlet side of the evaporator
finning, monitors the temperature of the refrigerated air and signals the ECU to regulate refrigerant flow in order
to provide an output air temperature just above that at which ice may form on the evaporator.
The inlet and outlet pipes connect to the evaporator via the expansion valve block, into which they are
sealed using 'O' rings and a clamp plate. The inlet is supplied from the receiver-drier, and the outlet feeds into
pipework routed through the body RH sill, to the compressor.
Ventilation
Air in the cabin is exhausted via an outlet vent at the left hand side of the rear bulkhead, and another at
the bottom right hand corner of the bulkhead. Ducting from each of these vents connects to the rear luggage
compartment, from which air escapes to atmosphere through two one-way flap valves fitted in the rear transom
and concealed by the rear bumper.
PN.2 - HEATER/A.C. AIRFLOW OVERVIEW
The HVAC unit comprises left and right hand plastic mouldings sandwiched together and containing a
pair of blower fans supplied from two intake sources, an a.c. evaporator, a heater matrix, and two electrically
controlled flaps; one for the fresh air intake and one for the heater matrix.
Outlet to face level vents
Outlet to screen vents
Air distribution unit
Outlet adaptor
Pollen filter
Duct to
passenger
footwell
Distribution
drum actuator
Fan housing
Intake adaptor
Fixing to chassis
bulkhead
Fixing to subframe Refrigerant connections
crossmember
Temperature flap actuator
Fixing bracket to subframe
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
p118
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Ambient air collected from the top of the intake duct, ahead of the engine radiator, is fed via an insulated
fibreform duct to a pollen filter mounted at the intake to the HVAC unit, within which the airflow is divided towards
the inner and outer sides of the two blower fans. Air enters the fan drums axially and is centrifuged outwards to
be directed into the evaporator chamber. A second intake duct collects air from the cabin interior via a central
aperture in the footwell toeboard, from which the air flows through a duct formed in the lower section of the
HVAC unit and into the fan chamber in a similar manner to the ambient flow. Electrical resistors used in the fan
speed circuitry are cooled by the incoming airflow stream. The fresh air intake may be closed off at the driver's
request by an electrically operated flap at the top of the unit, which closes or fully opens the ambient air intake.
The re-circulation intake is open at all times.
All air exiting the fan chamber is directed through the evaporator, whether or not a.c. is selected, and is then
divided between routes flowing either past, or through the heater matrix by an electrically operated air blender
flap, the position of which is determined by the temperature selector knob. Blended air then leaves the top rear
of the HVAC unit and enters the Air Distribution Unit (ADU) which passes beneath the base of the windscreen
and is secured to the top of the footwells. A part cylindrical rotary mask on a horizontal axis, controls the airflow
exiting the ADU into a top mounted port for the windscreen vents, an adjacent port for the face level vents, and,
via a port in each end plate of the mask, to outlets supplying a duct in the top of the passenger footwell, and
through the inboard side of the pedal box. The rotation of the mask is driven by a stepper motor (common with
the air intake and air blender actuators) mounted on the left hand side of the ADU.
Interior Climate Controls
The interior climate control panel is located on the centre console and consists of three rotary control
knobs, for air distribution, temperature and fan speed, and four button switches, for air conditioning, demist,
air re-circulation and heated rear screen. When the sidelamps are switched on, the rotary control graphics are
backlit white and red/blue by an electro-luminescent panel, with red lit pips in the knobs to indicate their position.
The button switches are backlit red with ignition or sidelamps switched on, and will light up brightly (HRS and
demist in amber) when activated. Press the switch a second time to switch off. Climate control functionality
requires the ignition to be on, and for refrigeration and heat production, the engine needs to be running.
Distribution Control
This rotary control is positioned at the top of the HVAC panel and allows a choice of air distribution from
the various outlet vents. There are 5 designated positions with corresponding symbols, although there is a
progressive transition from each airflow mode to the next, allowing a preferred balance to be attained.
Face level vents
To face level vent
ducting in underside
of fascia top panel
Air distribution unit
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Airflow from
HVAC unit
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Face level vents & footwells
To face level vent
ducting in underside
of fascia top panel
To footwell vents
Airflow from
HVAC unit
Footwell vents
Airflow from
HVAC unit
To footwell vents
Footwells & windscreen
To windscreen vent ducting
in underside of fascia top panel
Airflow from
HVAC unit
To footwell vents
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Windscreen
Section PN
To windscreen vent ducting
in underside of fascia top panel
Airflow from
HVAC unit
Temperature Control
The rotary temperature control actuates the air blender flap, which dictates the proportion of the airflow
which is directed through the heater matrix. With the control knob fully clockwise at the coldest position, the
heater matrix is fully shut off. As the control is turned counterclockwise, the flap is moved to allow some airflow
through the heater matrix, until at the fully hot position, all airflow is directed through the matrix for maximum
heating.
Interior Fan
The lowermost of the rotary controls, allows the selection of 4 speeds for the interior fan, and functions
with the key at the accessory or ignition positions. Turned fully clockwise, the fan is switched off. Turning the
knob counterclockwise through 4 detent positions provides increasing fan speed and airflow delivery. Note that
the air conditioning will not function until a fan speed is manually selected.
Re-circulation Switch
This switch functions with the key at the accessory or ignition positions, and will maintain its status throughout ignition cycles.
The re-circulation port in the footwell toe-board is open at all times, such that the greater proportion of air
drawn into the fan chamber, via a duct incorporated into the bottom of the HVAC housing, is always from the
cabin interior. The fresh air intake on the top of the unit is controlled by a stepper motor and flap valve, and is
normally open to provide approximately 30% fresh airflow. To close the intake and prevent fumes being drawn
into the cabin, or to provide the quickest response to temperature change requests, the fresh air intake may
be closed off by pressing the re-circ. switch, to result in 100% re-circulation. This option should, however, be
used sparingly to avoid stuffiness in the cockpit.
Air Conditioning Switch
The engine must be running for the a.c. to operate. This switch signals the engine ECU with an air conditioning request, and will maintain its status throughout ignition cycles. The ECU determines whether the running
conditions allow for compressor activation. Conditions which will inhibit a.c. include:
near full throttle demand;
excessive coolant temperature;
any fault codes set;
low refrigerant pressure.
When appropriate, the ECU will activate the a.c. by applying a duty cycle to the compressor solenoid valve,
thus generating a swash plate angle and initiating refrigerant flow.
Demist Switch
In order to allow a single touch selection of demist/defrost settings, a dedicated switch is provided. The
switch is operative only with ignition on, and will default off at the next ignition cycle. When activated:
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
-
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
The interior fan will operate at full speed;
All airflow will be directed to the windscreen;
Air conditioning will be switched on (may be overridden by manual de-selection).
Note that an appropriate temperature setting must be selected manually.
Heated Rear Screen
Due to the heavy current demand, this switch will operate only when the engine is running. Under this
condition, the HRS and door mirror heating elements will be activated for a period of 10 minutes before automatically switching off. The switch and heating cycle will default off next time the ignition is turned on.
Pollen Filter
Mounted at the air intake to the HVAC unit, is a folded paper element pollen filter which should be renewed
at intervals specified in the Maintenance Schedule. An access panel beneath the front body hatch is provided
to allow filter replacement by simply pulling out the old element and pressing in the new.
Engine Bay Ventilation
Various intake and outlet vents are provided in the rear body to allow ventilation and cooling of the engine
bay.
Intake vents ahead of the rear wheelarches provide ambient air for the engine air intake, and for engine
bay cooling.
Outlet grilles around the top of the tailgate panel exhaust hot air from around the catalytic converter at the
front of the engine bay.
An outlet grille at the base of the tailgate glass, and to either side, exhaust hot air from around the catalytic
converter at the rear of the engine bay.
Engine bay front cooling
Hot air
from around
exhaust
system
Engine air intake Hot air from front of engine bay
ohe31
PN.3 - COOLING FANS & RE-CIRCULATION PUMP
The two cooling fans are fitted on the top side of the radiator/condenser package, and the coolant recirculation pump is mounted at the LH side of the engine bay, beneath the air cleaner. Both the fans and pump
are controlled by the engine management ECU using data provided by the engine coolant temperature sensor
and the a.c. trinary switch mounted in the refrigerant line between receiver-drier and evaporator.
Cooling Fans
The cooling fans are switched as a pair, and will operate at half speed (connected in series) when coolant temperature reaches 98°C on rise (94°C with a.c. on), and switch off at 96°C on fall (92°C with a.c. on). If
coolant temperature rises to 105°C (96°C with a.c. on), the fans will switch to full speed (connected in parallel),
reverting to half speed on fall at 98°C (94°C with a.c. on).
Note that the temperatures displayed on the instrument panel may differ from the programmed values
described above due to instrument damping lag.
The fans are also activated by signals received from the trinary switch; the fans will run at low speed for
pressures between 13 - 18 bar, and at high speed for pressures over 18 bar.
Certain types of ECU detected engine fault will also cause the fans to be activated as an engine protection
measure. If the ECU receives a coolant temperature sensor signal voltage outside of the acceptable range, a
default setting equating to 60°C will be substituted, and the cooling fans will run at half speed.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Re-circulation Pump
A coolant re-circulation electric pump is mounted beneath the air cleaner, and is plumbed into the heater
supply line. When energised, the pump circulates coolant through the heater system, drawing coolant from the
back of the cylinder head, and pumping it through the heater matrix and back to the engine.
Heat Soak
After ignition switch off, the ECU remains live for a minimum period of 1 minute for coolant temperatures
below 75°C (at time of switch off), extending progressively to a maximum period of 10 minutes for temperatures
over 90°C. If, during this period, the coolant temperature exceeds 110°C, the re-circ. pump will be activated
and will run for a maximum period of 6 minutes, or until the coolant temperature falls to 50°C.
If, during the ECU live period the coolant temperature rises to 120°C, the cooling fans will run at slow speed
in addition to the re-circ. pump, for a maximum period of 2 minutes, or until the temperature falls to 70°C.
PN.4 - REFRIGERANT HANDLING
The system is charged with 0.625 kg of refrigerant HFC R134a, and the following precautions MUST
ALWAYS BE OBSERVED.
1. On no account should refrigerant ever be discharged to atmosphere - use a refrigerant recovery/recycling
station in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.
2.
Standard R134a 'quick fit' connectors are provided in the compressor suction and discharge pipes at the
right hand front of the engine bay;
- the low pressure vapour line port is fitted in the pipe between the evaporator and compressor.
- the high pressure liquid line port is fitted in the pipe between the compressor and condenser.
3.
Heavy concentrations of refrigerant vapour can produce toxic gas if exposed to a naked flame. The gas
can also attack metal.
4.
Refrigerant drums must never be left open - always ensure the caps are securely fitted.
5.
Never transport drums of refrigerant in the passenger compartment of a car.
6.
Never expose refrigerant drums to high temperature.
7.
Never weld or use a steam cleaner in close proximity to any part of the air conditioning system.
8.
Never expose the eyes to vapourised or liquid refrigerant - ALWAYS wear safety goggles and gloves when
handling refrigerant.
PN.5 - REFRIGERANT PIPEWORK PRECAUTIONS
The following precautions must be observed when carrying out any work on the refrigerant pipework:
Before disconnecting any refrigerant pipework, the refrigerant must first be recovered using suitable equipment
connected to the service valves located at the rear of the right hand front wheelarch, behind the wheelarch liner.
Ensure that the equipment is suitable for R134a.
1.
All replacement components and flexible end connections are sealed when new, and should only be
opened IMMEDIATELY PRIOR TO FITTING, AND AT ROOM TEMPERATURE, to prevent condensation
of any moisture which may enter when the sealing is removed.
2.
Pipes, flexible end connections and components, must be capped immediately they are opened to prevent
the ingress of moisture and/or dirt.
3.
The receiver-drier should be the LAST component to be connected, to ensure optimum dehydration and
maximum moisture protection of the system.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Refrigerant Pipework Fixing Torques
Key
Description
Qty
Thread
M8
Pitch
Torque
1
Compressor to engine
4
25 Nm
2
A.C. hoses to compressor
2
M6
3
Sill pipe to comp. hose, high pressure
1
3/4 - 16 UNF
1.6
25-30 Nm
4
Sill pipe to comp. hose, low pressure
1
1 1/16 - 14 UNS
1.8
35-40 Nm
5
Sill pipe to condenser pipe
1
3/4 - 16 UNF
1.6
25-30 Nm
6
Receiver-drier connections
2
5/8 - 18 UNF
1.4
25-30 Nm
7
Evaporator pipe to receiver-drier
1
5/8 - 18 UNF
1.4
20-25 Nm
8
Trinary switch to pipe
1
3/8 - 24 UNF
9 Nm
10-13 Nm
9
Clamp plate, pipes to cond & exp valve
1
M6
1.0
9 Nm
10
Clamp plate, expansion valve to evap
1
M5
0.8
6 Nm
11
Evaporator to sill pipe
1
1 1/16 - 14 UNS
1.8
35-40 Nm
# Use refrigeration oil only, smear on “O” rings and threads prior to assembly
(Gloves should be worn when handling refrigeration oil - see data sheet)
Refrigerant Pipework 'O' Rings
Key
Diameter
Part Number
A Suction line to compressor. Condenser connections
Description
16 mm
A120P6002H
B High pressure line to compressor
13 mm
A120P6001H
C Suction pipe to sill pipe and expansion valve
19 mm
A082P6081F
D High pressure line to sill pipe
12 mm
A082P6079F
E Receiver-drier connections and expansion valve inlet
9 mm
A082P6078F
A
E6
p115
9
C11
E
C D5
10
9
E
C
D3
B1
A2
Page 11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
C4
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
4.
All joints should be coated with refrigeration oil before making any connections, to aid seating.
5.
Great care must be taken to prevent damage to the pipe fittings and connections, since due to the high
pressures involved, a leak can be caused by the slightest imperfection. Always use two spanners of the
correct size when releasing or tightening any pipe joint so that the fixed part of the union may be prevented
from twisting and damaging the component. This is especially important with the aluminium condenser.
6.
All pipes and hoses must be free from any kinking. The efficiency of the system can be impaired by a
single kink, or restriction. Flexible hoses should not be bent to a radius which is less than ten times the
diameter of the hose.
PN.6 - REFRIGERANT OIL
The internal working parts of the compressor are lubricated by refrigerant oil. This is a special type of oil
which has an affinity with the refrigerant, such that a proportion of the oil circulates with the refrigerant, around
the whole system. Under normal operating conditions, the oil never needs changing or replenishing, and if
the correct procedure for system depressurisation and re-charging is followed, minimal oil will be lost from the
system during these operations. If, however, the system suffers a major leak or sudden de-pressurisation, most
of the oil held in suspension will be lost as the refrigerant escapes, necessitating the addition of a specified
quantity of oil to the compressor on re-assembly (see section PN.7).
If a refrigeration component is to be replaced, the removed item will contain a certain amount of oil, and
a corresponding amount of new oil must be added to the system on re-assembly:
Condenser; 30 cm³
Evaporator; 30 cm³
Any major pipe or hose; 10 cm³
Receiver-drier; 30 cm³
Approved Oils
Use only Denso ND-OIL 8 low viscosity (ISO46) PAG oil or equivalent (Sanden SP10; Four Seasons 59007).
Refrigerant oil absorbs water and should not be exposed to the atmosphere for any longer than is strictly
necessary to perform the operation. Never return decanted oil back into the storage container.
PN.7 - COMPRESSOR
The a.c. compressor is mounted at the left hand front of the crankcase, and is driven from the crankshaft,
together with the alternator, PAS pump and water pump, by a multi-rib, serpentine, synthetic belt. A maintenance
free belt tensioner takes the form of an idler pulley mounted on a sprung eccentric hub, which mechanism
applies pressure to the smooth, back side of the belt between the crankshaft and water pump, and provides a
generous belt wrap around the crankshaft pulley.
The belt itself should be inspected for condition at each service interval, and if it exhibits any evidence of
physical damage, cracking, fraying, perishing, abrasion, contamination or any other deterioration, it should be
replaced. In the case of oil or coolant contamination, the cause must be identified and rectified, and each of
the pulleys must be thoroughly degreased before the new belt is fitted.
Compressor Removal
1. Remove the RHF wheelarch liner and recover the refrigerant using equipment connected to the service
ports at the rear of the wheelarch.
2.
Remove the driver's seat and cabin rear bulkhead trim. Remove the bulkhead access panel.
3.
Remove the RHR wheel and wheelarch liner. Using a hexagonal 14mm socket applied to the auxiliary
belt tensioner bolt, relieve the tension on the auxiliary drive belt by turning counterclockwise, and insert a
5 mm locking pin in the hole provided in the tensioner hub.
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
4.
Release the clamp plate securing each of the pipes to the compressor and immediately cap the pipes and
compressor ports to prevent ingress of dirt and moisture. Secure the two pipe/hoses aside.
5.
Disconnect the two compressor electrical harness plugs.
6
Remove the four bolts securing the compressor to the engine, disengage the drive belt and withdraw the
unit through the bulkhead aperture. Retain the compressor for oil quantity measurement if a new unit is
to be fitted.
Illustration TBA
Oil Quantity Adjustment Prior to Compressor Refitment
Refitting Existing Compressor
i)
If the existing compressor is to be refitted after normal refrigerant recovery has been performed, a quantity
of oil equivalent to that recovered must be added to that already held in the compressor.
ii) If the system has suffered a rapid discharge, caused for example by accident damage, most of the refrigerant oil will have been lost. Drain the remaining oil from the compressor by removing the drain plug
and rotating the clutch plate. Add 150 cm³ of new refrigerant oil (see above) to the compressor before
refitment.
Fitting New Compressor
New compressors are sealed and pressurised with nitrogen gas. The sealing caps should be removed
only immediately prior to compressor fitment, at which time the gas pressure should be heard to escape
as a cap is slowly released. New compressors are supplied with an oil fill of 150 cm³.
iii) If normal refrigerant recovery has been performed, the new compressor oil should be drained off, and the
required oil quantity in the new compressor calculated and added:
- Drain and measure the oil quantity in the OLD compressor by removing the drain plug and rotating the
clutch plate. Quantity = X cm³
- Oil quantity to be added to new compressor = X + 10 cm³
iv) If the system has suffered a rapid discharge, caused for example by accident damage, most of the refrigerant oil will have been lost. In this case, fit the new compressor as supplied with its 150 cm³ oil charge.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
Compressor Fitment
1. Fit the compressor to the engine and secure with the three M8 bolts; Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lbf.ft).
2.
Using new 'O' rings lubricated with mineral refrigerant oil, fit the two refrigerant pipes to the compressor
and tighten each clamp plate screw to 8 Nm.
3.
Connect the compressor clutch harness.
4.
Fit the auxiliary belt around the pulleys ensuring correct engagement of the ribs. Apply a counterclockwise
torque to the auxiliary belt tensioner and remove the locking pin.
5.
Recharge the system with R134a refrigerant.
PN.8 - CONDENSER
The a.c. condenser, engine cooling radiator and cooling fans (in front to back order), are secured together
as a package and mounted between the front subframe longerons leaning forwards at an angle of 45°. The
package is flexibly mounted via grommets and spigots off the engine radiator, with the condenser rigidly fixed
to the front of the radiator by 4 setscrews. The inlet pipe to the top section of the divided RH tank and the outlet
pipe from the lower section of the RH tank extend to a joint plate accessible from above.
Removal of the condenser from below is possible without disturbing the engine radiator, and is facilitated
by removal of the front clamshell, but is also possible with this panel in situ, using access provided by the
headlamp apertures.
To Remove Condenser
1. Remove the RHF wheelarch liner and recover the refrigerant using equipment connected to the service
ports at the rear of the wheelarch.
3.
Remove the front undertray and both headlamp assemblies (see sub-section BV.4).
4.
Remove the radiator air intake duct lower section:
- Release the headlamp powerwash hose from its 'P' clips
- Remove both horns
- Release the ambient temperature sensor from the RH side
- Remove the 2 fixings securing the condenser to the radiator lower mounting brackets
- Remove the 2 edge clips at each side securing the lower duct to the upper duct, and withdraw the
lower section.
5.
From the RH headlamp aperture, release the clamp plate securing the refrigerant pipes connection.
6.
From each headlamp aperture, release the screw securing the top of the condenser to the radiator
bracket.
7.
At each side, release the single screw securing the bottom of the condenser to the radiator bracket, and
withdraw the condenser.
8.
Refit in reverse order to removal.
- If a new condenser is fitted, add 30 cm³ of approved refrigerant oil to the system.
- Use new 'O' rings on the pipe connections, and lubricate with refrigerant oil.
- Recharge the system with 0.625 kg of R134a.
Page 14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
PN.9 - RECEIVER-DRIER
If the system has been open to atmosphere for any length of time, e.g. following accident damage or a
burst hose or damaged component, the receiver-drier unit must be renewed, and should be the last component
to be fitted, and uncapped only immediately prior to connection and recharging.
The receiver-drier is clamped to a mounting bracket fixed to the outside face of the front subframe RH
longeron, ahead of the front wheel, and is accessible from beneath with the front undertray removed. If the
receiver-drier is to be replaced, the refrigerant must first be recovered using suitable equipment connected to
the service ports at the rear of the RHF wheelarch.
- Cap all pipes and ports immediately after disconnection to prevent the ingress of dirt and moisture.
- When reconnecting the pipes, use new 'O' rings coated in an approved refrigerant oil, and tighten to
25 - 30 Nm.
- If a new receiver-drier is fitted, add 30 cm³ of approved refrigerant oil to the system.
- Recharge the system with 0.625 kg of R134a.
PN.10 - HEATER/EVAPORATOR/FAN (HVAC) UNIT
The HVAC unit comprises left and right hand plastic mouldings sandwiched together and containing a
pair of blower fans supplied from two intake sources, an a.c. evaporator, a heater matrix, and two electrically
controlled flaps; one for the fresh air intake and one for the heater matrix. The complete HVAC unit is mounted
between the chassis front bulkhead and subframe cross-member, with the steering rack beneath, and the
radiator air outlet duct ahead.
To Remove HVAC Unit
1. Remove the front undertray, front clamshell, radiator air outlet ducts and HVAC air inlet duct.
2.
Remove the wiper motor mechanism from the windscreen surround.
3.
Recover the refrigerant.
4.
Remove the HVAC pollen filter intake moulding.
5.
Unplug the fan harness connector block, and disconnect the heater flap and air inlet flap actuators.
6.
Release the a.c. pipes clamp plate from the expansion valve, release the outlet pipe 'P' clip and secure
the pipe aside, with both pipe and expansion valve port capped. Remove the pipe between receiver-drier
and expansion valve, and cap all pipe ends and ports.
7.
Remove the subframe crossmember. Remove:
- 2 bolts securing the top of the HVAC unit to the subframe crossmember;
- 2 bolts each side to top of longerons;
- 2 Torx head screws each side to top of longerons;
- 4 bolts each side securing the crossmember wall to the inboard side of the longeron;
- 3 bolts securing lower edge of wall to subframe lower crossmember.
Withdraw the crossmember/wall assembly.
8.
From beneath, release the single bolt securing the HVAC unit to the chassis bulkhead, and the two bolts
joining the fan housing bracket to the lower crossmember bracket.
9.
Withdraw the HVAC unit.
The expansion valve is fitted onto the evaporator inlet and outlet pipes, and its removal requires disassembly of the HVAC unit. Determine the availability of the valve before embarking on such a task.
Page 15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Outlet to compresser
Section PN
Inlet from receiver-drier
M6 clamp screw
'O' ring seal
Top clamp plate
M5 clamp screw (x2)
Expansion valve body
Lower clamp plate
(tapped)
'O' ring seal
Evaporator outlet pipe
Evaporator inlet pipe
p71
Refit the HVAC unit in reverse order to removal:
- If a new evaporator is fitted, add 30 cm³ of approved refrigerant oil to the system.
- Use new 'O' rings on the pipe connections, and lubricate with refrigerant oil.
- Recharge the system with 0.625 kg of R134a.
PN.11 - AIR DISTRIBUTION UNIT (ADU)
The airflow distribution unit is mounted on top of the chassis scuttle, sandwiched between the underside of
the fascia top/demist duct and the chassis. The unit comprises several plastic mouldings bonded and rivetted
together to contain the rotary distribution drum which controls the airflow to the windscreen, face level vents,
and footwells. The stepper motor for the drum is mounted on the left hand side of the unit.
To Remove the Air Distribution Unit
1. Remove the main fascia panel (see sub-section VE.8).
2.
Remove the footwell duct between the side of the ADU and the passenger side scuttle aperture, by prising
away from its double sided tape.
3.
Remove the 2 bolts securing the ADU integral rear bracket to the scuttle.
4.
From within the footwell, release the single bolt within the scuttle top central reinforcement channel.
5.
Withdraw the ADU and disconnect the drum actuator harness plug.
Page 16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section PN
PN.12 - REFRIGERANT PIPES
The main feed and return (high pressure liquid and low pressure suction) lines between the compressor,
condenser and expansion valve, take the form of aluminium pipes clamped along the outside of the chassis
RH siderail, such that removal of the body side panel is required for access to the pipes. Replacement of the
pipes is unlikely to be necessary other than as a result of accident damage, in which case the body sill will be
replaced in accordance with Service Notes sub-section BS.9.
Page 17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section QJ
CLUTCH
SECTION QJ
Sub-Section
Page
General Description
QJ.1
3
Clutch Pedal
QJ.2
3
Hydraulic Release System
QJ.3
3
Clutch Assembly
QJ.4
5
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Illustration TBA
GENERAL LAYOUT
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section QJ
Lotus Service Notes
Section QJ
QJ.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Lotus Evora uses a CMS C500 cast iron flywheel bolted to the rear end of the engine crankshaft,
secured with 8 bolts and located by a dowel pin. Sandwiched between the flywheel and crankshaft is a steel
plate carrying the starter ring gear, and also secured to the periphery of the flywheel with 6 screws.
The driving surfaces of the clutch assembly comprise the rear face of the flywheel, and a corresponding
surface on a pressure plate carried by the spring diaphragm clutch cover which is bolted to the periphery of the
flywheel. The driven element, constitutes a single, dry, double sided friction plate, splined to the gearbox input
shaft, and sandwiched between the flywheel and pressure plate. The diaphragm spring between the clutch
cover and pressure plate serves to clamp the friction plate between the pressure plate and flywheel and provide
the drive connection between engine and gearbox. The gearbox input shaft, on which the friction plate is free
to slide axially, is 'overhung' from the gearbox, with no spigot bearing in the rear end of the crankshaft.
The hydraulic clutch release mechanism uses a master cylinder fixed to the pedal box and operated by
the clutch pedal, and a slave cylinder bolted to the left hand side of the clutch housing operating a release fork
pivoted on a ball pin inside the housing to apply an axial thrust to the release bearing. The release bearing surrounds the gearbox input shaft and transmits the thrust via a ball bearing race to the inner ends of the diaphragm
spring. This action releases the clamping action of the spring outer rim, serving to disengage the drive.
No routine adjustment of the clutch or release mechanism is required. The clutch slave cylinder is self
adjusting, with the 'rest' position of the piston dependent on the thickness, or degree of wear, of the friction
plate. As wear of the friction plate takes place, and its thickness is reduced, the slave cylinder piston is pushed
progressively further back on the return stroke with a corresponding rise in the reservoir fluid level.
QJ.2 - CLUTCH PEDAL
The clutch pedal is fabricated from steel plate, and features synthetic 'top hat' bushes for maintenance free
articulation on the steel pivot shaft, and a serrated alloy footpad. A hollow steel pivot shaft serving the brake
and clutch pedals is bolted to a steel mounting plate, itself bolted to the inside of the pedal box.
The clutch pedal is equipped with an overcentre assist coil spring linkage, in order to reduce the pedal
effort required to maintain full disengagement. A potentiometer is also fitted in order to provide data for Cruise
Control operation, and for the start inhibit function on Canadian market cars.
The master cylinder pushrod is captive in the end of the master cylinder, and uses an integral clevis to
connect to the pedal and control the pedal up position as the master cylinder 'tops' out. A downstop buffer is
provided on the pedal box flange.
QJ.3 - HYDRAULIC RELEASE SYSTEM
Master Cylinder
The clutch master cylinder is mounted on the pedal box, and is accessible with the front clamshell removed. The cylinder is not equipped with its own fluid reservoir, but instead is linked via hose to the adjacent
brake fluid reservoir. There is no provision for any servicing of the master cylinder, and if found to be faulty,
the unit should be replaced.
WARNING
Do not attempt to bleed the clutch hydraulic system when the catalytic converter is hot - spilled
hydraulic fluid could initiate a fire. Wait until the engine and converter is cool to the touch.
To replace the master cylinder:
Remove the front clamshell (see sub-section BV.6).
Clean the master cylinder and surrounding area with methylated spirit. Do not use petrol or paraffin.
Take all necessary precautions to guard against contamination of painted surfaces with brake fluid.
Disconnect and immediately plug and cap the hose connection to the fluid reservoir, and the output pipe
connection.
From inside the footwell, remove the clevis pin connecting the pushrod to the pedal. Remove the two
bolts securing the cylinder to the pedal box and withdraw the cylinder from above.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section QJ
Illustration TBA
-
To refit, reverse the removal procedure. Tighten the outlet pipe connection to 20 - 24 Nm, and the cylinder to pedal box fixings to 28 Nm. Bleed the hydraulic system of air, using the bleed nipple provided on
the slave cylinder.
Slave Cylinder
The slave cylinder is secured to the left hand side of the clutch housing by two M8 fixings into tapped holes.
The cylinder is protected from radiated heat from the front catalytic converter by an aluminium heat shield, part
of which may be bent back to allow improved access to the slave cylinder bleed nipple.
WARNING
Do not attempt to bleed the clutch hydraulic system when the catalytic converter is hot - spilled
hydraulic fluid could initiate a fire. Wait until the engine and converter is cool to the touch.
To remove the cylinder, first disconnect the pipe union and immediately seal the open end of the pipe and
the cylinder port. Release the two fixing bolts and withdraw the cylinder. If necessary, remover the cylinder
end protective rubber boot and pushrod, and use compressed air in the hydraulic port to expel the piston assembly.
To re-assemble, coat the seals with lithium soap base glycol grease before inserting into the cylinder,
and then fitting the pushrod and boot. Secure with the two M8 bolts tightened to 12 Nm (9 lbf.ft), connect the
hydraulic line (15 Nm {11 lbf.ft}), and bleed the system of air, tightening the bleed nipple to 5 Nm (45 lbf.in).
Finally, ensure that the heat shield is returned to its original shape in order adequately to protect the slave
cylinder and hydraulic line.
Hydraulic Pipe
A 2-part rigid steel pipe is used to convey the hydraulic fluid from the master cylinder to the left hand front
corner of the engine bay. The pipe is routed down the LH 'A' post to run along the outside of the chassis LH
main siderail, within the composite sill member, and is supported, together with other pipes and hoses in foam
blocks. A flexible hose is used to connect the rear end of the chassis pipe to a short rigid pipe on the transmission, which connects to the slave cylinder.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section QJ
QJ.4 - CLUTCH ASSEMBLY
The clutch assembly comprises the friction plate, clutch cover assembly (pressure plate/diaphragm spring/
cover) and release bearing. For access to the clutch assembly, the complete power unit must first be removed
from the chassis (see sub-section EJ.5).
To separate the transmission from the engine, see sub-section FL.5.
The clutch cover is secured to the flywheel by 6 x M8 bolts and located by 3 dowels. Unless the cover
is to be renewed, first match mark the cover to the flywheel before gradually loosening the 6 bolts in an even
pattern, to release the clamp load without distorting the clutch cover. Finally, remove the bolts and withdraw
the cover from the flywheel dowels making provision to capture the friction plate which will also be released.
Inspection & Replacement
1.
Clutch cover: Check the surface of the pressure plate for excessive scoring or discolouration through
overheating. Check the fingers of the diaphragm spring for excessive wear at the release bearing contact
surface and for even height. If the cover is accidentally dropped, the setting or balance of the assembly
could be disturbed; replacement of the cover is recommended.
On re-assembly, use a universal type of centralising mandrel to position the centre plate (ensuring it is
the correct way round - refer to markings) whilst the clutch cover is fitted. Apply a suitable thread locking
compound to the cover fixing bolts before locating the cover on the flywheel dowels and progressively
tightening the bolts in a diagonal sequence to avoid distorting the cover. Torque to 20 Nm.
2.
Friction plate: Check the cush drive springs for breakage or cracking of the hub. Examine the condition
of the friction material for signs of oil contamination, scorching, or any other damage. Measure the depth
of material on both sides of the plate from the friction surface to the head of the rivets;
Minimum service depth = 0.3 mm.
If any of the above inspections are failed, or if addressing symptoms of clutch judder, renew the friction
plate.
3.
Release bearing & fork: Unclip the release bearing from the fork, and check the bearing for discernible
play, noise or rough feeling, and renew if there is any doubt. Check the arm for undue wear on any of the
contact surfaces and for cracks. Check the release fork pivot ball.
4.
Flywheel: Check the friction surface of the flywheel for excessive scoring or discolouration through overheating. Using a dial test indicator, measure the axial run-out at the centre of the flywheel friction surface.
Maximum runout: 0.15 mm.
If necessary, renew the flywheel:
- Lock the flywheel ring gear and progressively release the eight bolts securing the flywheel to the crankshaft and withdraw, noting the loose spacer ring between the ring gear plate and the crankshaft flange.
- If necessary, release the six bolts securing the ring gear to the front of the flywheel. When re-fitting,
ensure that the ring gear plate swages face towards the flywheel. Use an appropriate alignment mandrel
to ensure concentricity of the ring gear to the flywheel before tightening the 6 securing bolts to 30 Nm.
- When re-mounting the assembly to the crankshaft, ensure the spacer ring is fitted between the ring gear
and crankshaft, with the dimple on the spacer locating in the crankshaft flange dowel hole.
- Ensure scrupulous cleanliness of all mating surfaces before locating the flywheel onto the crankshaft
and fitting the 8 bolts to which Permabond A130 (A912E7033) has been applied to the threads.
- Progressively tighten the bolts in a diagonal sequence, locking the ring gear before finally torque tightening to 65 Nm.
Re-assembly
Apply sparing quantities of Molybdenum Disulphide (MoS2) grease to the contact points of the release
fork fingers, pivot socket, and pushrod socket. Also apply sparingly to the input shaft splines, or use the special
grease provided with a new friction plate. Fit the fork through the housing aperture and grommet, locate on the
pivot ball, slide the release bearing over the input shaft and clip to the release fork arms.
Fit the transmission assembly to the engine (see sub-section FL.5), and refit the power unit (sub-section
EJ.5).
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section TDT
TECHNICAL DATA - ENGINE
SECTION TDT
Page
General ...............................................................................................................
Cylinder Block .....................................................................................................
Cylinder Head ......................................................................................................
Valves & Springs .................................................................................................
Camshafts ...........................................................................................................
Pistons ................................................................................................................
Crankshaft ...........................................................................................................
Oil Pump .............................................................................................................
Coolant Thermostat ............................................................................................
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
4
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section TDT
General
Type designation 2GR-FE
Configuration V6
Capacity 3456 cm³ (210.9 in3)
Bore 94.0 mm (3.70 in3)
Stroke 83.0 mm (3.27 in3)
Valve configuration 4 VPC in pentroof chamber
Camshaft configuration DOHC per bank
Camshaft drive Single chain drive to both inlet camshafts.
Secondary chain linking each inlet camshaft
to its neighbouring exhaust camshaft.
All 4 camshafts use hydraulically activated
variable timing sprocket hubs under ECU
control
Valve operation Finger followers with hydraulic pivot posts
Siamese ports
Compression ratio 10.8:1
Compression pressure - new minimum 1,400 kPa (14 kgf/cm2, 199 psi)
- service minimum 980 kPa (10.0 kgf/cm2, 142 psi)
- cyl/cyl max. variance 100 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 15 psi)
Firing order 1,2.3,4,5,6
Spark plugs Denso FK20HR11 (Iridium)
Spark plug gap 1.0 - 1.1 mm (0.040 - 0.045 in)
Engine management Lotus T4e controller
Ignition system Direct ignition using individual plug top coils
Fuel system Port injection.
Sychronous and non-synchronous operation
Hot wire airflow sensor
Fuel requirement Minimum 95 RON
Intake system Single throttle valve
2 stage intake tract length
Maximum continuous engine speed - std 6,600 rpm
- Sport mode 7,000 rpm
Maximum transient engine speed - std 6,800 rpm
- Sport mode 7,200 rpm
Normal warm idle speed - a.c. off 640 rpm
- a.c. on 690 rpm
Net power (ECE 85) 206 kW @ 6,400 rpm
Net torque (ECE 85) 350 Nm @ 4,600 rpm
Exhaust emissions (ECE 83.05) - CO 0.169 g/km
- HC 0.049 g/km
- NOx 0.016 g/km
- HC + NOx 0.065 g/km
- CO2
- Urban 293 g/km
- Extra urban 154 g/km
- Combined 205 g/km
cylinder block
Material Aluminium alloy with 'cast in' cast iron
cylinder liners
Configuration 60°V, right hand bank offset 36.6mm forward
RH bank; cylinders 1,2,3 from front
LH bank; cylinders 4,5,6 from front
Bore diameter - std 94.000 to 94.012 mm (3.7008 to 3.7013 in.)
- service limit 94.200 mm (3.7087 in.)
Deck face flatness tolerance 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section TDT
cylinder head
Material Aluminium alloy
Head face flatness tolerance 0.10 mm (0.004 in.)
Manifold face flatness tolerance 0.10 mm (0.004 in.)
Valve guide bore in head - std 10.285 to 10.306 mm (0.4049 to 0.4057 in.)
- 05mm o/s 10.335 to 10.356 mm (0.4069 to 0.4077 in.)
Valve guide standout - inlet 9.1 to 9.9 mm (0.36 to 0.39 in.)
- exhaust 9.3 to 9.7 mm (0.3661 to 0.3819 in.)
Maximum oil clearance - inlet 0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
- exhaust 0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
valves & springs
Valve stem diameter - inlet
- exhaust
Overall length - inlet - std
- min
- exhaust - std
- min
Valve seat contact width - inlet
- exhaust
Valve head margin (thickness between head face and 45° face)
- std
- minimum
Valve spring free length
camshafts
Endfloat
Maximum oil clearance
- std
- service limit
- front journal
- except front
5.470 to 5.485 mm (0.2154 to 0.2159 in.)
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2151 to 0.2157 in.)
5.465 to 5.480 mm (0.2151 to 0.2157 in.)
105.35 mm (4.1476 in.)
110.40 mm (4.3464 in.)
109.90 mm (4.3268 in.)
1.1 to 1.5 mm (0.043 to 0.059 in.)
1.2 to 1.6 mm (0.047 to 0.063 in.)
1.00 mm (0.040 in.)
0.50 mm (0.020 in.)
45.46 mm (1.790 in.)
0.08 to 0.13 mm (0.0031 to 0.0051 in.)
0.15 mm (0.006 in.)
0.15 mm (0.006 in.)
0.09 mm (0.0035 in.)
pistons
Diameter 10mm below pin centreline - std
- miniumum
Bore oil clearance - std
- service limit
Gudgeon pin oil clearance - std
- service limit
93.960 to 93.980 mm (3.6992 to 3.6999 in.)
93.830 mm (3.6941 in.)
0.020 to 0.052 mm (0.0007 to 0.0020 in.)
0.060 mm (0.0024 in.)
0.001 to 0.007 mm (0.00004 to 0.0003 in.)
0.015 mm (0.0006 in.)
crankshaft
Main journal diameter
Main journal max. runout
Main journal maximum taper and out-of-round
Crankpin diameter
Crankpin maximum taper and out-of-round
60.988 to 61.00 mm (2.4011 to 2.4016 in.)
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
52.992 to 53.000 mm (2.0863 to 2.0866 in.)
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
oil pump
Rotor tip clearance
Annulus to housing clearance
Rotor/annulus side clearance
Hot oil pressure
0.060 to 0.160 mm (0.0024 to 0.0063 in.)
0.16 mm (0.0063 in.)
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
0.325 mm (0.0128 in.)
0.030 to 0.090 mm (0.0012 to 0.0035 in.)
0.090 mm (0.0035 in.)
80 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.6 psi)
380 kPa (3.9 kgf/cm2, 55.5 psi)
- std
- service limit
- std
- service limit
- std
- service limit
- idle
- 6,000 rpm
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
coolant thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift at 95°C
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section TDT
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
10 mm
Lotus Service Notes
Section TDU
TECHNICAL DATA - VEHICLE
SECTION TDU
Page
Dimensions ........................................................................................................
Capacities ..........................................................................................................
Wheels & Tyres ...................................................................................................
Front Suspension .................................................................................................
Rear Suspension .................................................................................................
Electrical .............................................................................................................
Transmission .......................................................................................................
Clutch ..................................................................................................................
Brakes .................................................................................................................
Steering ...............................................................................................................
Fuel Consumption ...............................................................................................
2
2
2
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section TDU
DIMENSIONS
Overall length
Overall width - excl. mirrors
- incl. mirrors
Overall height (unladen)
Wheelbase
Track - front
- rear
Ground clearance (mid-laden)
Front overhang
Rear overhang
Approach angle
Departure angle
Unladen weight - total
- front
- rear
Max. weight - total
- front
- rear
Trailer towing
4350 mm
1848 mm
1972 mm (approx.)
1229 mm
2575 mm
1564 mm
1557 mm
125 mm
1000 mm
776 mm
11.5°
22°
1382 kg ) inc. full
526 kg ) fuel tank
856 kg )
1782 kg > incl.
659 kg > occupants
1123 kg > & luggage
Not permissible
CAPACITIES
Engine oil - dry - with heat exchanger
- w/o heat exchanger
- refill inc. filter, with/w/o heat exchanger
High/low dipstick mark difference
Transmission oil
Brake system hydraulic fluid
Clutch system hydraulic fluid
Fuel tank
Coolant
Refrigerant
7.1 litre
6.8 litre
6.1 litre
1.0 litre
2.3 litre
450 cc
130 cc
60 litre
17 litre
0.625 kg
WHEELS & TYRES
Tyres (normal use)
Type
Size - front
- rear
Pressure (cold) - front
- rear
Pirelli P-Zero
225/40 ZR18
255/35 ZR19 96Y
2.3 bar (33.5 psi)
2.5 bar (36 psi)
Winter Tyres
Type
Size - front
- rear
Pressure (cold) - front
- rear
Tyre studding
Tyre chains
Yokohama W.drive V902 'LTS'
215/40 R18
245/35 R19
2.3 bar (33 lb/in²)
2.5 bar (36 lb/in²)
Not permitted
RUD-matic DISC snow chains (Lotus part number
A132G6004F), fitted only on the rear, and only
on the approved winter tyres.
Wheels
Type - std
- optional
Cast alloy, 10 spokes in pairs, 5-bolt fixing
Silver or grey painted
Forged alloy, 10 radial spokes, 5-bolt fixing
Silver or grey painted
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Size - front
- rear
Inset - front
- rear
Wheel bolt torque
Section TDU
8.0J x 18H2
9.5J x 19H2
+ 52 mm
+ 69 mm
105 Nm (77 lbf.ft)
FRONT SUSPENSION
Type Independent. Upper and lower lightweight forged
alloy wishbones; co-axial coil spring/telescopic
damper unit; tubular anti-roll bar
Geometry
Mid-laden ride height (2 x 75 kg occupants + full fuel tank)
- set car to this height before measuring geometry: - front 125 mm below front end of chassis siderail
- rear 147 mm below rear end of chassis siderail
Castor - optimum + 5.2°
- tolerance range + 5.0° to + 5.5°; max. side/side 0.3°
Camber - optimum - 0.3°
- tolerance range - 0.5° to - 0.2°; max. side/side 0.2°
Alignment - optimum Zero
- tolerance range 0.5 mm toe-out, to 0.5mm toe-in overall
Steering axis inclination 9.4° nominal
REAR SUSPENSION
Type Independent. Upper and lower lightweight forged
alloy wishbones; co-axial coil spring/telescopic
damper unit; tubular anti-roll bar
Geometry
Mid-laden ride height (2 x 75 kg occupants + full fuel tank)
- set car to this height before measuring geometry: - front 125 mm below front end of chassis siderail
- rear 147 mm below rear end of chassis siderail
Camber - optimum - 1.6°
- tolerance range - 1.8° to - 1.5°; max. side/side 0.2°
Alignment - optimum 1.5 mm toe-in each side
- tolerance range 1.4 to 1.8 mm toe-in each side
max. side/side 0.3 mm
Thrust angle - optimum Zero
- tolerance 0.05°
ELECTRICAL
Light Bulbs
Headlamps
Rear turn indicators
Licence plate lamps
Interior lamp
Wattage
35
21
5
5
Type
D1S electronic igniter/burner unit
P21W
C5W
W5W
Note that other lamps are likely to be long life LED type, serviced only by lamp replacement.
System voltage/polarity
Alternator
Battery (service replacement) - type
- rating
12V negative earth
100A
Varta L3B (T6)
72 Ah
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
TRANSMISSION
Designation
Differential
Section TDU
6 speed manual type EA60
Open bevel gear
Gear ratio table ('opt' refers to alternative ratio set)
Gear
Internal ratio
Final drive
1
3.54
3.78
5.6
9.1
2
1.91
3.78
10.4
16.7
3
1.22
3.78
3 opt
4
1.41
0.86
5
1.09
0.79
6
0.97
0.64
6 opt
Rev
0.86
3.83
14.1
22.8
37.2
18.2
29.4
3.24
3.24
km/h/1000rpm
26.3
23.1
3.78
3.24
5 opt
16.3
3.78
3.78
4 opt
mph/1000rpm
29.4
47.3
23.9
36.3
3.24
38.5
58.4
27
43.5
3.24
CLUTCH
Type
Friction plate diameter
Friction plate clamped thickness - new
Damper springs
Hub material
Clamp load - new
Single dry plate. Diaphragm spring cover.
Hydraulic release, self adjusting
228 mm
8.0 mm
4 off
Sintered steel
8350N
BRAKES
Brake discs
Disc dimensions - front
- rear
Callipers
Piston size - front
- rear
Operation
Parking brake
Cast iron, curved vane ventilated, cross-drilled
Rear discs incorporate parking drums
350 x 32 mm
332 x 26 mm. 185 mm drum
A.P. Racing, aluminium alloy body, 4 pistons in
opposed pairs. Common casting front/rear
Leading; 38.1 mm. Trailing; 41.3 mm
Leading; 38.2 mm. Trailing; 36.0 mm
Tandem master cylinder with dual diaphragm
vacuum servo and Bosch Anti-lock system
Cable operated drum brakes incorporated into rear
discs
STEERING
Type
Turns, lock to lock
Gear ratio
Power assisted rack and pinion
2.86
47mm rack movement/steering wheel revolution
FUEL CONSUMPTION
1999/100/EC
12.4 l/100km
6.5 l/100km
8.7 l/100km
- urban
- extra urban
- combined
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
INTERIOR TRIM
SECTION VE
Sub-Section
Page
General Description
VE.1
3
Door Trim Panel
VE.2
3
Door Trim Panel Components
VE.3
4
Door Sill Trim Panel
VE.4
4
Lower 'A' Post Trim Panel
VE.5
5
Centre Console
VE.6
5
Fascia Dash Panel
VE.7
5
Fascia Lower Panels
VE.8
6
Main Fascia Panel
VE.9
6
Steering Column Shroud
VE.10
6
Windscreen Pillar Trim Panels
VE.11
7
Rear Quarter Panels
VE.12
7
Rear Seat Backrest or Bulkhead Pad
VE.13
7
Rear Window Surround
VE.14
8
Roof Lining
VE.15
8
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Column
shrouds
Outboard
switch
panel
Inboard switch
panel
Fascia dash
panel
Fascia top panel
Infill panel
Fascia panel
lower right
Fascia end
closing panel
Airbag cover
pl1405
Lotus Service Notes
Fascia panel
lower centre
Steering column
infill panel
Instrument cowl
top access cover
FASCIA STRUCTURE
Section VE
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
VE.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Interior trim panels on the Evora are manufactured by one of three processes;
1.
Structural Reaction Injection Moulding (SRIM); using a polyurethane resin and glass reinforcement.
Panels include:
- Door trim panels;
- Lower 'A' post trim panels;
- Door sill trim panels;
- Rear quarter trim panels;
- Rear bulkhead trim panel;
- Centre console;
- Fascia panel lower centre;
- Fascia panel lower left hand and right hand;
- Fascia dash panel.
2.
Polyurethane Foam;
Panels include:
- Fascia top panel;
- Passenger airbag cover;
- Driver's side fascia infill panel;
- Glovebox lid;
- Steering column cover.
3.
Reaction Transfer Compression (RTC) moulding; using a polypropylene glass reinforced moulding to which
is bonded a Nylon polypropylene fabric with a foam backing (visible surface) and a polypropylene foam
lining (reverse side).
Panels include:
- Roof liner;
- 'B' post upper trim panels;
- 'A' pillar trim panels.
VE.2 - Door trim panel
Release handle escutcheon
Door trim panel
Trim feature strip
Pull handle
Door pocket
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
v22
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
The door trim panel is secured to the door shell by the door pull handle fixings, five screws along the bottom shutface, a single screw at the top front corner, and three location pegs along the top edge. Note that the
door speaker grille is fixed to the door panel, but the speaker itself is mounted to the door shell.
To remove/refit door trim panel
1. Prise out the window and mirror switches and unplug the harness connector.
2.
Remove the door front top corner closing panel:
- Prise out the two fir tree fasteners.
- Remove the two screws in the flange of the air duct connector.
Remove the single fixing screw securing the panel to the door shell.
3.
Prise out the finisher plate from the door pull handle (4 spring clips), and remove the two fixings securing
the handle and trim panel to the door.
4.
Remove the five screws in the underside of the door securing the panel. Pull out the bottom of the door
panel and lift the top edge location pegs from their slots in the door shell. Unhook the door release cable
from the handle, and disconnect the door harness from the window/mirror switchgear and mood lighting
strip.
Refit in reverse order to removal.
VE.3 - door trim panel components
Face level vent/release handle escutcheon
1. The face level vent itself may be pulled out of the escutcheon with the door panel in situ.
2.
To remove the escutcheon, the door panel must be removed. Then from behind the panel, remove the
blanking sticker on the air duct moulding to access the two screws securing the front of the escutcheon,
and release another pair of screws in the door release handle bracket.
Door release handle
To remove the door release handle, remove the door trim panel and from behind the panel, release the
four fixing screws.
Trim feature strip & mood lighting
The feature strip is secured by two fixings in the front shut face, two in the rear shut face and three screws
along its length, all accessed from behind the panel. The mood lighting strip is secured to the door trim panel
with double sided tape.
Door pocket
The door pocket comprises inner and outer parts both secured to the door trim panel from behind by 10
screws.
VE.4 - Door sill trim panel
The door sill trim panel is secured to the chassis side rail by two 'fir tree' buttons located at the rear lower
edge. Prise out the buttons, and lift the rear of the panel to release the 'grip-lok' strips. Unhook the front end
tongues from the lower 'A' post trim panel.
If necessary, remove the harness protection cover from the rear of the sill by prising out the 'fir tree' buttons on the lower edge, and pulling the panel from its double sided tape.
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
VE.5 - Lower 'A' post Trim panel
1.
Remove the door sill trim panel (see VE.3).
2.
Release the three screws securing the bottom edge to the chassis side rail, and the single screw at the
outboard top corner to the scuttle beam.
3.
Pull the panel from the 'grip-lok' strips on the footwell side wall.
VE.6 - centre console
The centre console, which is constructed from separate right and left hand sides, and a top panel, extends
from the base of the fascia to the rear seats/stowage compartment, and surrounds the gear and parking brake
levers. To remove the console:
1. Remove the parking brake lever sleeve after loosening the retaining grub screw.
2.
Prise the Lotus badge from the gear lever knob, release the screw and withdraw the knob.
3.
Release the armrest from its hinge by removing the two fixings beneath its rear end.
4.
Remove the HVAC panel from the console by careful prising to release the 5 Tower-clip fasteners. Unplug the harness connectors, and lift the panel until the gaiter top clip can be released, and the panel fully
withdrawn.
5.
Release the two screws at the back of the gear lever aperture securing the park brake lever surround,
unhook the rear end and withdraw the panel and gaiter over the lever.
6.
Remove 3 screws within the front aperture securing the console top panel, and pull the rear part of the
panel upwards to withdraw the two Tower clips.
7.
Remove the 4 screws securing the top surfaces of the console sides together. Remove the 3 screws
securing each of the side's lower rear flanges to the floor channel. Pull away the front end of each side
panel to release the two spring steel clips.
ve.7 - Fascia Dash panel
The fascia dash panel reaches across the full width of the fascia and includes the instrument cowl/surround.
The panel also mounts the instrument pack, switch panels and mood lighting strip. To remove the panel:
1. Remove the closing panel from each end of the fascia by prising out the two fir tree fasteners, and pulling
the panel from its Griplock strips. At each end, release the two screws securing the dash panel to the
fascia.
2.
Remove the instrument cowl top access panel by lifting the forward end free from its Griplock strips, and
unhook the rearward end. Unplug the harness connectors from the instrument panel.
3.
From within the coin pocket outboard of the steering column, remove the blanking sticker and release the
switch panel fixing screw. Carefully prise the outboard switch panel out with its two Tower clips. Unplug
the switch harness connector.
4.
Carefully prise out the inboard switch panel with its four Tower clips and unplug the switch harness connectors.
5.
Release the four screws round the underside of the instrument panel (not the screws securing the instrument panel itself), fixing the dash panel to the fascia.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
6.
Open the glovebox, and from within, release the 4 hex. head screws securing the fascia panel finisher to
the glovebox wall.
7.
Withdraw the dash panel, and unplug the harness connectors to the mood lighting strip and glovebox
light.
VE.8 - Fascia Lower panels
The fascia lower panels comprise left, right and centre panels, plus the passsenger's glovebox and driver's
colum infill panel, all of these linking the underside of the main fascia to the chassis scuttle beam. These panels
should be removed before removal of the main fascia panel.
1.
Driver's side fascia lower panel: Swing down the column infill panel by pulling the top edges to release
the Griplock fastener strips. Remove the single screw securing the panel to the scuttle beam and the two
screws to the underside of the fascia. Withdraw the panel from the location pin.
2.
Passenger's side fascia lower panel: Open the glovebox fully by releasing the check cord and damper
cord. Remove the single screw securing the panel to the scuttle beam and the two screws to the underside
of the fascia.
3.
Withdraw the column infill panel or glovebox from the location pin.
4.
Central fascia lower panel: First remove the centre console (see section VE.5).
Remove the two screws securing the centre fascia lower panel to the scuttle beam, and the two screws
to the underside of the main fascia panel.
ve.9 - Main Fascia panel
The main fascia panel extends from the base of the windscreen to the scuttle beam, carries the dash
panel and passenger airbag, and incorporates ducting to the demist vents. To remove the main fascia panel:
1.
Remove the fascia dash panel (see VE.6).
2.
Remove the fascia lower panels (see VE.7).
3.
Unplug the passenger airbag connectors.
4.
Remove the two screws securing the fascia to the rear face of the scuttle beam, beneath the passenger's
airbag.
5.
At each end, remove the single screw securing the fascia to the support bracket on the scuttle beam.
6.
Draw the main fascia panel rearwards to disengage the three front edge spigot pins from their location
holes in the windscreen frame.
ve.10 - steering column shroud
The steering column shroud consists of upper and lower mouldings. The upper section is clipped to the
lower, and should be prised off before releasing the tree screws securing the lower section to the steering
column.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
VE.11 - Windscreen pillar trim panels
Each windscreen pillar trim panel is retained by a single 'fir tree' button at its lower end, and by 3 captive
'fir trees' along its length.
VE.12 - rear quarter panels
Rear window surround
Rear quarter
trim panel
assembly
Harness
cover
Access
cover
pl1511
First remove the rear seat cushion or shelf, rear seat backrest or bulkhead insulation, and the rear window
surround. Then:
To allow the seat belt to be fed through the slot in the quarter panel, the door sill trim and harness cover
must first be removed (see VE.3). Release the belt anchor rail from the sill and slide off the belt. Release
the belt upper anchorage from the 'B' post.
Pull off the rear section of the door weatherstrip.
Release the two screws from the base of the panel, and the two at the upper rear edge.
Pull the panel from its two spring clips around the window, and feed the seat belt through the panel aperture.
VE.13 - rear seat backrest or bulkhead pad
On 2+2 cars, the rear seat backrest is secured by a screw behind each backrest top insert pad, two screws
at the bottom edge and Velcro patches. To remove the seat:
Remove the rear seat cushion by pulling free from its Velcro fastening.
Remove both backrest top insert pads by pushing upwards to release the spring clips. Release each of
the single screw fixings thus revealed.
Remove the two screws at the bottom edge of the backrest, and pull the panel free from its Velcro fastening.
On 2+0 cars, the insulating pad on the rear bulkhead is retained by Velco pads.
Page 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section VE
VE.14 - rear window surround
The rear window surround is secured by four spring clips. Pull the panel forwards to remove.
VE.15 - roof lining
The roof lining is retained by the sun visor brackets, the 'B' post upper trims, and two screws at the rear
edge. To remove the roof lining panel:
Pull the rear window surround from its 4 spring clips and remove the two screws at the rear edge of the
roof lining.
Release the seat belt upper anchorage from the 'B' pillar, and remove the 'B' post upper trim.
Prise out the 'fir tree' button from the base of each windscreen pillar trim, and pull each trim panel from its
three spring clips.
Remove the three screws securing each of the sun visors and visor clips to the roof.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
AIRBAG SYSTEM
SECTION WF
Sub-Section Page
General Description
WF.1
3
Airbag Tell Tale
WF.2
3
Data Link Connector
WF.3
4
Trouble Codes
WF.4
4
Lotus TechCentre
WF.5
4
Safety Precautions, Shipping, Storage & Disposal
WF.6
5
Theory of Operation
WF.7
7
Sensor & Diagnostic Module (SDM)
WF.8
9
Driver Airbag Module
WF.9
10
Rotary Connector
WF.10
11
Passenger Airbag Module
WF.11
12
Seat Belt Pre-tensioners
WF.12
13
Page 1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Illustration to follow
Page 2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Section WF
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
WF.1 - GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Lotus Evora is equipped with dual stage airbags for both the driver and front seat passenger, in conjunction with pyrotechnic seat belt pre-tensioners for both front seat occupants. The airbag Supplementary
Restraint System (SRS) is supplemental to the seat belts, and does not render the seat belts redundant. Seat
belts have proven to be the single most effective safety device, and should be worn at all times by both driver
and passenger, no matter how short the journey. Properly worn seat belts also ensure that the seat occupant
is in the best position for full effectiveness of the airbag.
WARNING: Airbags inflate with great force, in a fraction of a second, and if a vehicle occupant is too close
to the airbag (less than 250 mm) or incorrectly positioned, they could be killed or seriously injured.
The SRS is designed to operate when the vehicle is involved in a frontal, or near frontal collision, and the
impact (rate of deceleration) as detected by any one of three vehicle mounted sensors, is sufficient to warrant
airbag and seat belt tensioning protection to both front seat occupants. The 55 litre airbag for the driver is housed
in the centre of the steering wheel, with a 100 litre bag for the passenger housed within the fascia. Three 'G'
sensors are mounted in the vehicle to detect the rate of deceleration in a collision, and if the signal from any
one of these should exceed a threshold value, the first stage of airbag inflation will be initiated. This will cause
the airbags to inflate at a rate calculated to provide appropriate protection, whilst minimising the potential for
airbag induced injury, especially where an occupant is not positioned optimally at the triggering moment. If a
higher rate of deceleration is detected, indicating a more severe impact, the second stage inflator modules will
be triggered to more rapidly inflate the airbags. In either case, both bags inflate in a fraction of a second to
form a cushion for the driver's and passenger's upper bodies. The bags then deflate very rapidly to minimise
any obstruction to the driver. Note that in order to protect against the danger of an unprogrammed firing of the
second stage after a first stage airbag deployment, with the potential to cause injury to the vehicle occupant or
carer, any first stage firing is followed almost immediately by triggering of the second stage, too late to affect
the speed of airbag inflation, but ensuring that the airbag is then 'dead' and in a stable condition.
Initiated at the same time as the airbags is a pyrotechnic device on each front seat belt reel assembly,
which uses rapid gas generation and a train of balls in a track to apply a tightening force to the belt reel and
remove any slack from the belt. The force sustained by the belt and its user during the event, is then controlled
by a torsion bar within the belt reel to limit the deceleration force to which the occupant is subjected.
Note that the SRS will deploy only in moderate to severe frontal and near frontal collisions, and is not
designed to be triggered in rollover, rear or low speed frontal collisions, or in some types of side impacts.
The system incorporates a self-diagnostic facility, which continuously monitors the SRS electrical circuits
for faults, and if necessary, lights a tell tale lamp in the instrument cluster. Most components of the SRS will
require replacement after an airbag deployment.
Passenger Airbag Defeat (PAB) Switch
If a rearward facing child seat is to be used in the front passenger seat of the Evora, it is essential to switch
off the passenger airbag. If an accident should occur and trigger airbag inflation, the back of the seat could be
subjected to a force sufficient to seriously injure or kill the child.
A PAB switch is located at the end of the passenger fascia, and is operated using the mechanical ignition
key; insert the key and turn clockwise to the ‘OFF’ position, and withdraw the key. With the ignition switched
on, a tell tale lamp in the instrument panel will light up red as a reminder that the passenger airbag has been
disabled. To reinstate airbag operation, insert the key in the PAB switch and turn counterclockwise.
WF.2 - AIRBAG TELL TALE
The airbag safety system, including the pre-tensioning seat belts, has a self-diagnostic feature which
lights the red tell tale and sounds an audible alert if a fault is detected. As a circuit check, the tell tale will light
for about six seconds following ignition switch on, and then go out. If the lamp remains lit, or comes on at any
other time, a fault in the airbag system is indicated, which should be rectified without delay.
WARNING: If the airbag tell tale is lit, the airbags may not inflate correctly in a crash, or may inflate
without warning; or the pre-tensioning seat belts may not perform correctly. The SRS should be interrogated using the Lotus TechCentre and diagnosed and rectified without delay.
Page 3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
WF.3 - DATA LINK CONNECTOR (DLC)
In order to provide for communication
with the SRS Sensing and Diagnostic Module
(SDM), the Lotus TechCentre may be plugged
into the special 16 terminal harness connector socket, known as a Data Link Connector,
located beneath the driver's side fascia at the
outboard side of the footwell. Communication
with engine management and anti-lock brakes
is also available via this connector.
Illustration to follow
WF.4 - TROUBLE CODES
All the time the ignition is switched on, the Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) continuously monitors
the resistance of various parts of the SRS electrical circuit, and compares these values with pre-programmed
tolerance bands to enable it to recognise 'faults' in the system and light the airbag tell tale lamp in the instrument cluster. If such a fault is detected, the SDM stores a 'Trouble Code' for that particular type of fault in its
memory.
i). Current (Present) Codes - Faults that are currently being detected. Current codes are stored in the SDM
Random Access Memory (RAM), which will be cleared if the vehicle battery is disconnected.
ii). History (Not present) Codes - All faults detected since the last time faults were cleared from the memory
using the Lotus TechCentre. History codes are stored in the SDM Electronically Erasable Programmable
Read Only Memory (EEPROM) and are not cleared if the battery is disconnected.
Vehicle crash data is also stored in coded form in the SDM and is not erasable. New SDMs are supplied
only against V.I.N. and on exchange with the old unit.
WF.5 - LOTUS TECHCENTRE
CAN BUS Diagnostics
Controller Area Network (CAN) is an electronic standard to allow high speed communication between modules
and controllers, via a serial data BUS. The BUS is a circuit linking the modules to the controller, consisting of
a pair of cables, twisted together to reduce electromagnetic interference, and carrying a square wave voltage
signal corresponding to '0's and '1's, coded in such a way as to identify and prioritise the individual messages.
On the Evora, CAN based systems include; engine management system, instrument pack, tyre pressure monitoring and ABS/Traction Control/ESP.
A CAN compliant on-board diagnostic system is accessible via a 'stand alone' lap top PC loaded with 'Lotus
TechCentre' software to allow the CAN based serial data to be read. A Vehicle Communication Device (VCD;
T000T1476F) is used to connect the vehicle's Data Link Connector (DLC) to the laptop Lotus Techcentre. Engine programming, live data display, diagnostics of engine, ABS and airbag systems, and service tell tale lamp
resetting are all carried out via the Lotus TechCentre.
The minimum specification of the laptop computer for installation of the Lotus Techcentre software is as
follows:
Processer 1.70 Ghz;
1 GB RAM;
40 GB HDD;
CDRW DVD ROM;
WIN XP PRO;
USB interface;
Ethernet or Wireless LAN
Page 4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
Note that this laptop should be dedicated totally to the Lotus Techcentre, with no other software installed.
WF.6 - SAFETY PRECAUTIONS, SHIPPING, STORAGE & DISPOSAL
WARNING: The SDM can maintain sufficient voltage to cause an airbag deployment for up to 20 seconds
after the battery has been disconnected. Before working on the airbag system, or in close proximity to
an airbag, first take the following precautions to temporarily disable the airbag system:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Turn off the ignition.
Before disconnecting the battery, use the Lotus TechCentre to read any stored trouble codes.
Disconnect the negative (earth) lead from the battery and tape back to ensure that no contact with the
battery negative terminal can be made.
Wait for 30 seconds.
If working on or near the steering wheel, first unclip the top part of the column shroud, then remove the
lower part after releasing the three retaining screws.
Locate and unplug the airbag harness from the rotary connector. Note that the connector socket is fitted
with 'shorting bars' which automatically interconnect the high and low terminals of the airbag to prevent
unschedules deployment caused by a voltage differential.
When service work has been completed, reconnect the harness plug secured with its locking feature, and
reconnect the battery. Ensure the airbag tell tale lights for a few seconds with ignition and then goes out.
Storage
Airbag modules and SDMs should not be stored at temperatures above 176°F (80°C).
Airbag modules and SDMs should not be stored in damp conditions.
Do not store airbag module or SDM boxes more than two high.
Always store and handle airbag modules and SDMs in an upright position. Never store SDMs upside
down.
Sensor & Diagnostic Module (SDM) & Forward Crash Sensors
The SDM and forward crash sensors are calibrated specifically to the Evora, and are mounted in a
dedicated manner in specific positions. Never use SRS components from any other vehicle, or modify their
mounting to the Evora.
WARNING:
•
Handle the SDM with great care. Never strike or jar the SDM as this could cause airbag deployment
and result in personal injury or improper operation of the SRS.
•
All module and mounting bracket bolts must be correctly installed and tightened to assure proper
security and operation.
•
Never power up the SRS when the SDM is not properly mounted and secured, since the SDM is
easily triggered when not attached, and could result in deployment causing personal injury.
•
Do not use or attempt to repair a damaged SDM.
Inflator Module
Live (Undeployed) Inflator Modules: Special care is necessary when handling and storing a live (undeployed)
inflator module. In the unlikely event of accidental deployment, violent movement of the inflator module could
result in personal injury.
WARNING:
•
When carrying a live inflator module, make sure the bag and trim cover are pointed away from you.
In case of an accidental deployment, the bag will then deploy with minimal chance of injury.
•
When placing a live inflator module on a bench or other surface, always face the bag and trim cover
upwards, away from the surface. This is necessary so that a free space is provided to allow the
air bag to expand in the unlikely event of accidental deployment. Otherwise, personal injury may
result.
•
Never carry the inflator module by the wires or connector on the underside of the module.
Page 5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
•
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
Do not use or attempt to repair a damaged inflator module, and NEVER apply any electrical power
to the module except as specified in the diagnostic procedures.
Inflator Module Shipping Procedures for Live (Undeployed) Inflator Modules
The transportation of uninstalled inflator modules is regulated by the Hazardous Materials Regulations
of the U.S. Dept, of Transportation (DOT) and most state governments. Special procedures are required for
transportation. Lotus recommends that the dealers and repair shops check with the hazardous material section
of their respective state police authority for applicable shipping requirements.
For all shipments on public roads, the DOT has classified the uninstalled inflator module as a flammable
solid under a special exemption process. It should always be shipped and stored in the approved cardboard
container in which it is purchased. The container should be marked with “Flammable Solid , n.o.s., UN1325,
DOT-E8236” and labelled with the specified red and white flammable solid label. Each shipping location must
have a copy of the exemption on file. A shipping paper (e.g., a customer receipt) must accompany each shipment and identify the module as “Flammable Solid, n.o.s., UN1325, DOT-E8236”. Transportation, storage and
handling of the module should be in accordance with the exemption and the requirements for a DOT flammable
solid. Do not expose the module to heat, open flame, impact, friction, or electrical charge.
Inflator Module Scrapping Procedures
WARNING: Failure to follow proper SRS inflator module disposal procedures can result in airbag deployment which may cause personal injury. Undeployed inflator modules must not be disposed of through
normal refuse channels. The undeployed inflator module contains substances that can cause severe
illness or personal injury if the sealed container is damaged during disposal. Disposal in any manner
inconsistent with proper procedures may be a violation of federal, state and/or local laws.
Reference should be made to the local State authority for the correct disposal procedures for deployed
inflator modules.
Vehicle Scrapping Procedures
Some vehicles equipped with SRS that have live (undeployed) inflator modules may have to be scrapped
because they have completed their useful life, or have been severely damaged in a non-deployment type accident. The following procedure should be followed when scrapping a vehicle with an undeployed module.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Follow the safety procedure detailed in sub-section WF.6 to turn off the ignition, disconnect the battery
and unplug the inflator module harness.
Follow the procedure detailed in sub-section WF.11 to gain access to the passenger airbag module.
At the driver's airbag harness alongside the steering column, cut the harness side of the SRS wiring approx. 75 to 150 mm from the yellow connector.
Splice 2 wires at least 6 metres long to the red/blue and the red/green coloured cables in this connector
block.
Reconnect the yellow 4-way connector block now equipped with 2 x 6 m long cables.
Check that the inflator module is secured to the steering wheel.
Remove all loose objects from the front seat.
Ensure no one is in the vehicle.
Stretch wires away from car to their full length.
Apply 12 volts across the wires to deploy the air bag.
Do not touch the inflator module area for 20 minutes due to the heat generated during deployment.
Wear gloves and safety glasses to handle the deployed air bag. Wash your hands with mild soap and
water afterwards.
Repeat steps 3 to 12 for the passenger airbag, splicing the 6 m cables into the two wires connecting the
SDM to the airbag.
Page 6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
Deployed Inflator Modules
WARNING: Safety precautions must be observed when handling a deployed inflator module. After deployment, the air bag surface may contain a white packing powder used to ease deployment. Always
wear gloves and safety glasses when handling a deployed inflator module, and wash your hands with
a mild soap and water afterwards.
Inspections Required After an Accident
All SRS system components, including harnesses and brackets, must be inspected after an accident. If
any are damaged or bent, they must be replaced even if a deployment did not occur. If the SRS was deployed,
the following components MUST be renewed even if there is no visible damage to the parts:
•
Driver airbag module;
•
Passenger airbag module;
•
Sensor & Diagnostic Module (SDM);
•
Driver and passenger pyrotechnic seat belt assemblies;
•
Rotary connector;
•
Passenger airbag mounting brackets (if passenger airbag was deployed);
•
Main fascia panel (if passenger airbag was deployed);
Inspect the steering column for damage or telescoping (see Section HG) and column mounting brackets
for damage. Inspect the front subframe longerons, and the mounting of the two forward crash sensors for damage or distortion. Inspect the chassis scuttle beam in the area of the passenger airbag mounting brackets for
damage or distortion. Inspect the SRS wiring harness and connectors for damage or any signs of overheating.
Inspect both front seat shells, and all seat mounting brackets and runners. Check all seat belt mountings and
brackets for damage or distortion.
Do not attempt to repair the steering column or chassis or any of the above mentioned components.
Service only by replacement.
WARNING: Proper operation of the SRS system requires that any repairs to the vehicle structure return
it to its original production configuration. Deployment, or any visible damage to the SRS components
and/or their respective mounting brackets requires replacement, not repair.
WF.7 - THEORY OF OPERATION
•
•
•
•
•
•
The key components of the Supplementary Restraint System (SRS) are the following:
Sensor & Diagnostic Module (SDM);
Forward crash sensors;
Driver airbag module;
Passenger airbag module;
Rotary connector;
Seat belt pre-tensioners.
Sensor & Diagnostic Module (SDM);
The SDM is the main electronic control unit (ECU) of the SRS, and incorporates an accelerometer to detect rates of forward deceleration in conjuction with two forward crash sensors. When data from these sensors
meets collision recognition criteria over a certain threshold, the SDM triggers as a single set, the driver and front
passenger airbags in either stage one or stage two mode, and both front seat belt pre-tensioners. Additional
functions are to maintain an electrical energy reserve in case of vehicle battery power interruption during the
accident, operation of a dash mounted tell tale lamp, and an electronic diagnostic and event recording facility
accessible via a workshop scanner tool.
The unit is mounted in an alloy box bolted to the centre underside of the chassis scuttle beam, accessible
from the footwells.
•
The following functionality is provided by the SDM;
Sensing of frontal impact crash events and vehicle specific discrimination between airbag non-deployment
and stage one or stage two deployment-requiring events as well as activation of the front seat belt prePage 7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
•
•
•
•
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
tensioners.
In case of a required deployment, timely switching of the activation current for the deployment loops.
Detection of electrical system faults which may influence the readiness of the system to deploy, or increase
the probability of an inadvertent deployment by:
- continuous electrical monitoring of all deployment circuits (without any effect on the readiness of the
system);
- continuous monitoring of the supply voltage and the lamp circuitry (dependent on lamp driver activation
status);
- SDM self test;
- activation of a tell tale lamp in case of a detected system fault.
Fault storage and 'Crashrecording' within EEPROM ('crashrecording': recording of system parameters
{e.g. fault status in deployment events}).
Diagnostic communication using an ISO9141 protocol.
Frontal Impact Sensing and Deployment
The SDM and the two forward crash sensors contain accelerometers which provide a nearly linear proportional electrical representation of the acceleration experienced by the vehicle along the longitudinal axis. This
signal is amplified and filtered to reduce unwanted electronic noise and to compensate for offset drifts. The
filtered signal is then digitized to provide an input for evaluation by the crash algorithm. As soon as the crash
algorithm detects that pre-defined thresholds have been exceeded, the SDM activates both airbags in either
stage 1 or stage 2 mode, and both front seat belt pre-tensioners.
To enhance system reliability under normal driving conditions, an additional electromechanical 'safing'
sensor is included within the SDM to ensure that the SRS is armed only when significant deceleration occurs.
In order to protect against undesired deployments in case of severe EMI, humidity or accelerometer fault, the
deceleration condition monitoring by the safing sensor occurs in addition to, and independent of, the crash
algorithm.
Note that neither the seat belt pre-tensioners nor the airbags will be activated by the SDM as long as the
diagnostic mode is active.
Fault Display
The following conditions lead to a fault display in the form of continuous illumination of the airbag tell
tale:
•
One or more trouble codes requiring tell tale lamp activation in the 'historic' and 'present' condition are
stored in the SDM's EEPROM.
•
One or more trouble codes requiring tell tale lamp activation in the 'present' condition only are stored in
the SDM's EEPROM, the condition of which is, or has been, 'present' in the current operating cycle. For
all faults requiring four consecutive incidents for a trouble code to be set, the 'present' condition and fault
display will be activated already after two consecutive events if the related trouble code has already been
stored in a previous operating cycle.
•
Faults concerning the voltage supply (overvoltage/undervoltage) will lead to tell tale activation only until
the regular voltage range has been reached again (turn-off delay max. 5s after return from undervoltage
and max. 20s after return from overvoltage). There are no related trouble codes.
•
The airbag tell tale will not be activated due to SRS warning lamp related faults.
•
The tell tale will be activated immediately after entering the diagnostic mode, or on deployment of the
SRS.
Excluding the exceptions stated above, it is not possible to switch off the tell tale other than by resetting
the fault codes stored in the EEPROM. This is not possible after an airbag deployment - the SDM must be
renewed.
The following delays apply for the detection and display of faults. The delays apply from the extinguishing
of the tell tale, following the ignition switch on bulb check period:
1 to 5 secs - for external deployment circuit faults and overvoltage supply.
12 to 20 secs - for undervoltage supply.
up to 15 secs - for SDM internal faults.
Page 8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
•
•
•
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
The tell tale will be activated without SDM intervention in the following situations:
the minimum voltage of 8.0 V has not been exceeded after switching on the ignition.
the energy reserve (in SDM) has run low, which may be caused by supply voltages below 7.8 V.
the watchdog has interfered.
A trouble code readout using tell tale blink codes is not implemented.
Power Supply & Grounding
The nominal supply voltage of +12 volts is derived from terminal 5 when the ignition is switched on. The
SDM internal ground (terminal 7) must be securely connected to the vehicle chassis ground. To provide redundant grounding, the SDM housing is internally connected to the ground connector pin.
Supply Voltage Range
The SDM is designed to operate within the following voltage ranges:
System fault detection, SDM self test: min. 8.0 V; max. 16.0 V
Below 10.0 V system readiness may be delayed by 3 s.
Below 9.0 V system readiness may be delayed by 10 s.
System fault detection and SDM self test are reduced as long as an undervoltage condition is detected, which
could already apply for supply voltages below 10.5 V.
Activation of airbags: min. 8.0 V; max. 16.0 V.
Activation of seat belt pre-tensioners: min. 10.0 V; max. 16.0 V.
Energy Reserve
Energy reserve capacitors within the SDM are provided to allow SRS deployment if the vehicle battery
power supply is interrupted during the time of vehicle impact. The capacitors provide full support of the acceleration sensing and airbag initiation capability for a minimum of 150 ms after a loss of external power supply,
provided that before the loss, the SDM had been supplied with:
at least 10.0 V for at least 10 s; or
at least 9.0 V for at least 13 s; or
at least 8.0 V for at least 20 s.
The capacitors will be discharged down to a point where no initiation of airbags is possible within a max.
of 20 s after removal of the power supply.
WF.8 - SENSOR & DIAGNOSTIC MODULE (SDM)
To Replace SDM
WARNING: The SDM must be replaced after SRS deployment. Do not attempt to repair or reuse.
The SDM is mounted in an alloy box bolted to the centre underside of the scuttle beam.
1.
Follow the safety procedure detailed in sub-section WF.6 to turn off the ignition, disconnect the battery
and unplug the rotary connector.
2.
From the footwells, release the 8 setscrews securing the SDM mounting box to the scuttle. Release the
three screws securing the SDM to the box and unplug the two harness connectors.
Refitment of the SDM is a reversal of the removal procedure, torque tightening the fixing screws for SDM
and mounting box to 9 Nm.
Page 9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
WF.9 - DRIVER AIRBAG MODULE
WARNING: Safety precautions must be observed when handling a deployed airbag. After deployment,
the airbag surface may contain a white packing powder used to ease deployment. Always wear gloves
and safety glasses when handling a deployed inflator module, and wash your hands with a mild soap
and water afterwards.
The driver's airbag (or inflator module) is housed in the hub of the steering wheel, beneath a moulded trim
cover designed to hinge open in the event of deployment. The module comprises:
an inflatable fabric bag;
an inflator (canister of gas generating material)
an initiator (or 'squib')
The complete module also serves as a horn operating pad, such that pressing anywhere on the steering
wheel centre trim will operate the horns. The module is spring mounted to a baseplate secured to the steering
wheel hub, the baseplate carrying 4 earthed electrical contacts which correspond with 4 opposing contacts
supplied with 12 volts and mounted on the module itself. Closing any of the contacts will ground the circuit
and sound the horns.
When the vehicle suffers a forward deceleration of sufficient magnitude to close both the safing sensor
and the integrated accelerometer within the SDM or one of the two forward crash sensors, current flows through
the stage 1 or stage 2 deployment loop of both the driver and passenger airbag module initiators and ignites
the gas generating material. Each bag inflates in a fraction of a second, the driver's bag bursting open the
steering wheel centre trim cover, and then deflates via vents in the bag, with the whole cycle taking less than
one second. The airbag is designed for a single deployment, and must then be renewed.
In order to help prevent unwanted deployment of the driver's airbag when servicing the steering column
or other SRS components, a shorting bar is incorporated into each of the two connector sockets on the rotary
connector (one connector for each airbag stage). The shorting bar operates when the connector is unplugged,
to short across the feed and return connections to the airbag. Thus, if a positive feed, or earth is inadvertently
applied to the connector terminals, both sides of the inflator module will be subject to the same electrical potential, and no deployment will occur. The same feature is included in the airbag module connector sockets.
To replace driver's airbag
WARNING: The following procedures must be followed in the order listed to temporarily disable the
airbag system whilst working in the immediate vicinity of an airbag. Failure to follow this procedure
could cause unintended airbag deployment, resulting in personal injury and unnecessary airbag system repairs.
1.
Follow the safety procedure detailed in sub-section WF.6 to turn off the ignition, disconnect the battery
and unplug the rotary connector.
2.
On the reverse side of the steering wheel, release the two Torx head screws, accessible via holes in the
plastic shroud around the steering wheel hub. Withdraw the airbag module and disconnect the two airbag
harness connectors and the two horn leads.
WARNING: When carrying a live airbag module, make sure the bag and trim cover are pointed away
from you. In case of an accidental deployment, the bag will then deploy with minimal chance of injury.
When placing a live airbag module on a bench or other surface, always face the bag and trim cover
upwards, away from the surface. This is necessary so that a free space is provided to allow the airbag
to expand in the unlikely event of accidental deployment.
3.
If a driver's airbag is deployed, refer to steering sub-section HI.5 to determine whether the steering column
telescoping mechanism has been activated, and if necessary, renew the column assembly.
4.
Mate the two harnesss connectors to the new airbag module sockets, matching the colour coding, and
connect the two horn leads. Locate the module into the steering wheel and retain with the two Torx head
retaining screws, tightening to 7 Nm.
Page 10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
5.
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
When all service work is complete, connect the harness plugs to the rotary connector sockets and refit
the column shrouds. Reconnect the battery, turn on the ignition and check that the airbag tell tale lights
for a few seconds and then goes out.
WF.10 - ROTARY CONNECTOR
WARNING: The rotary connector MUST be replaced after SRS deployment even if there is no visible
damage.
The rotary connector is a device which fits between the steering wheel and column, and allows the steering
wheel to turn whilst maintaining electrical continuity to the airbag module and horn buttons. The assembly consists of an annular housing fitted over the top end of the steering column, and containing a coil of wires providing
feed and return circuits for the first and second stage airbag initiators, horn buttons and cruise controls.
The steering column side of the device is fitted with a connector block into which is plugged a branch of
the main vehicle harness. The steering wheel side of the device has a divided connector block for the cruise
control jump harness, and the airbag/horn jump harness. The coil housing is constructed in two parts, with the
outer part fixed to the outer (stationary) column, and the inner part keyed to the steering wheel. The two parts
of the coil housing slide inside of each other in such a way as to allow the steering wheel to be rotated through
its full travel, lock to lock, whilst maintaining an unbroken feed to each of the circuits in the steering wheel hub,
via the continuous wires in the coils.
In order to help prevent unwanted deployment of the air bag when servicing the steering column or other
SIR components, a shorting bar is incorporated into the rotary connector column side connector socket. This
shorting bar operates when the connector is unplugged, to short across the feed and return connections to the
inflator module. Thus, if a positive feed, or earth is inadvertently applied to the connector terminals, both sides
of the inflator module will be subject to the same potential, and no deployment will occur.
When servicing the rotary connector, it is most important that the correct orientation of the connector is
maintained on refitment, or the connector will run out of travel and be broken.
To replace the rotary connector
1. Remove the airbag module from the steering wheel (see sub-section WF.8).
2.
Disconnect the cruise control harness plug.
3.
Ensure the wheels are pointing straight ahead, match mark the wheel to the column, and remove the
steering wheel retaining bolt. Note that the wheel is located on a steep angle hexagonal taper on the
column.
CAUTION: If excessive force is applied to either the steering wheel or column, the break-out inserts securing the column to the fascia bracket may be disturbed, necessitating replacement of
the complete column. If necessary, use an appropriate puller.
4.
Unplug the harness from the two column lever switches and unclip each switch from the carrier.
5.
Unplug the harness from the column side of the rotary connector, unclip the carrier from the outer column,
and slide the the rotary connector from the steering column.
6.
Refit in reverse order to removal, but before fitting the steering wheel, it is essential to centralise the rotary
connector, or the unit will be broken when lock is applied. Turn the connector fully clockwise until it tightens,
and then turn back just over two turns until the red marker appears in the square window. Note that this
instruction is printed on the rotary connector. Ensure the road wheels are pointing straight ahead and fit
the steering wheel with the match marks aligned. Tighten the steering wheel retaining bolt to 50 Nm.
When fitting the jump harness for the cruise controls, ensure the cable is routed through the channel
provided in the steering wheel carrier.
7.
After re-assembly, check that the airbag tell tale lights for a few seconds with ignition, and then goes
out.
Page 11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
WF.11 - PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE
WARNING: Safety precautions must be observed when handling a deployed airbag. After deployment,
the airbag surface may contain a white packing powder used to ease deployment. Always wear gloves
and safety glasses when handling a deployed inflator module, and wash your hands with a mild soap
and water afterwards.
The passenger's airbag (or inflator module) is mounted on the underside of the main fascia panel and
also braced to the rear face of the chassis scuttle beam. An airbag 'door' in the top surface of the fascia, is
designed to break open under the force of airbag deployment, and, hinging at its front end, direct the inflating
bag into the area of optimum effectiveness.
The passenger's airbag (or inflator module) comprises:
an inflatable fabric bag;
an inflator (canister of gas generating material)
an initiator (or 'squib')
When the vehicle suffers a forward deceleration which closes the safing sensor, and the signal from the
SDM accelerometer or either of the two forward sensors indicates that the severity is sufficient to require airbag
deployment, current flows through the stage 1 or stage 2 deployment loop of both the driver and passenger
airbag module initiators and ignites the gas generating material. Each bag inflates in a fraction of a second, the
passenger's bag bursting open the fascia airbag door, and then deflates via vents in the bag, with the whole cycle
taking less than one second. The airbag is designed for a single deployment, and must then be renewed.
To replace passenger airbag
WARNING: The following procedures must be followed in the order listed to temporarily disable the
airbag system whilst working in the immediate vicinity of an airbag. Failure to follow this procedure
could cause unintended airbag deployment, resulting in personal injury and unnecessary airbag system repairs.
i). Turn off the ignition.
ii). Before disconnecting the battery, use the Lotus TechCentre to read any stored trouble codes.
iii). Disconnect the negative (earth) lead from the battery and tape back to ensure that no contact with the
battery negative terminal can be made.
iv). Wait for at least 30 seconds to allow the SDM capacitors to discharge.
v). Open the glovebox, release the tether and damper cords, and lower the glovebox fully.
vi). Remove the glovebox back panel; remove the two screws into the underside of the fascia panel, and prise
out the four 'fir tree' fasteners. Disconnect the glovebox lamp.
vii). Access is now available to unplug the airbag harness yellow connector.
1.
Replacement of the passenger airbag requires that the main fascia panel be removed - refer to sub-section
VE.8.
2.
Release the four fixings securing the airbag module to the underside of the fascia.
WARNING: When carrying a live airbag module, make sure the top surface of the module is pointed
away from you. In case of an accidental deployment, the bag will then deploy with minimal chance of
injury. When placing a live airbag module on a bench or other surface, always arrange for the deployment face to be uppermost. This is necessary so that a free space is provided to allow the airbag to
expand in the unlikely event of accidental deployment.
3.
If an airbag deployment has occurred, the chassis scuttle beam and main fascia panel must be carefully
examined for damage or distortion and replaced if necessary. The airbag door will always need replacing.
Page 12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
WARNING: Proper operation of the SRS system requires that the vehicle structure remains in its original production configuration. Any damage to the SRS components and/or their respective mounting
brackets, including the chassis, requires replacement, not repair.
4.
Fit the airbag module to the fascia panel and tighten the four M6 nuts to 10 Nm.
5.
Fit a new airbag door to the fascia panel and tighten the two M6 nuts to 10 Nm. Ensure the 2 plastic barb
clips are correctly engaged.
6.
Refit the fascia panels (see section VE) and plug in the passenger airbag harness connector.
7.
When all service work is complete, check that the airbag tell tale lights for a few seconds with ignition, and
then goes out.
WF.12 - SEAT BELT PRE-TENSIONERS
WARNING:
•
Failure to comply with the instructions, safety standards and operating procedures as described
in this section, may cause vehicle damage and/or personal injury.
•
Both driver and passenger front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after SRS deployment. Do
not attempt to repair or reuse.
Device Operation
Initiated at the same time as the airbags, is a pyrotechnic device on each front seat belt reel assembly to
apply a tightening force to the belt reel and remove any slack from the belt. The force sustained by the belt and
its user during the event, is then controlled by a torsion bar within the belt reel to limit the deceleration force to
which the occupant is subjected. When airbag/pre-tensioner triggering conditions apply, the SDM signals ignition of a gas generator on each front seat belt assembly, the pressure from which forces a train of balls around
a tubular track to apply a retraction force to the belt reel.
Page 13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
The belt pre-tensioning mechanism is designed to operate only once, such that both front belt assemblies
should be renewed after airbag/seat belt pre-tensioner deployment. Activation of the pyrotechnic mechanism
is indicated by the belt reel being locked, and allowing neither extraction nor retraction of the belt.
To replace front seat belt assembly
Each front seat belt reel assembly is secured to the seat belt mounting frame/roof hoop by a single bolt,
with an orientation tag on the belt reel engaging with a slot in the mounting plate.
WARNING: Before removing or refitting a pyrotechnic seat belt assembly, the ignition key should be
withdrawn, and the battery leads disconnected from both positive and negative terminals, and isolated
to ensure that accidental contact cannot occur.
1.
Remove the rear quarter trim panel (refer to sub-section VE.11).
2.
Unplug the vehicle harness from the belt tensioner initiator, and release the belt reel assembly retaining
bolt.
3.
Refit in reverse order to removal, tightening the belt reel securing bolt to 33 Nm.
4.
When all service work is complete, check that the airbag tell tale lights for a few seconds with ignition, and
then goes out.
Safety Standard
The pre-tensioning function is energised via pyrotechnic materials, therefore manipulation, handling and
storage MUST be performed to the specified procedures as described to avoid any occurrence of injury to the
operator or damage to the pre-tensioning unit.
In normal conditions, the pre-tensioner assembly can only be activated through the action of the electric
ignition control during impact. During the activation phase of the pyrotechnic charge, small gas quantities are
developed. The main constituent of the gases is Nitrogen:
Note! This gas is not toxic.
The pre-tensioner assemblies must be protected against exposure;
To temperatures over 90°C (195°F) at contact with surfaces
90°C during 106 hrs.
From sparks and naked flames.
WARNING: If exposed to temperatures in excess of 140°C, self-ignition of the pyrotechnic charge of
the gas generator may occur. Exposure to temperatures in excess of 165°C, self-ignition of the pyrotechnic charge will occur.
Also, if exposed to temperatures between 90°C (285°F) and 165°C (330°F), deterioration of the pyrotechnic charge ignition is possible. The consequences of this could be failure to activate at prescribed levels.
The pre-tensioner must be protected against stresses, shocks and dropping. Pre-tensioners that have been
subjected to such treatment must be discarded and returned to the supplier with accompanying paperwork
describing the reasons for return.
Never store pre-tensioner assemblies with other flammable or combustible materials. Gas generators
MUST be prevented from coming into contact with acid, water, grease and heavy metals: Contact with these
substances may cause toxic or dangerous gases, or explosive mixtures.
Any residual fuel of the gas generator, not burned during ignition, is slightly flammable. The unit, therefore,
must never be disassembled, damaged or the parts manipulated. Any advertising or demonstrations of the
pre-tensioner assembly should only be carried out using inert pre-tensioners (without the pyrotechnic charge).
The base of the pre-tensioner must be painted green, with visible and indelible wording, stating ‘Inert Assembly’. It must incorporate the KSS logo, signed with indelible ink by the person responsible for the supply of the
product.
WARNING: Never disassemble the pre-tensioner or any of it’s components!
Page 14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Lotus Service Notes
Section WF
Transportation of belt with pre-tensioner
Transport on road vehicles should be carried out with the assemblies stored in the luggage compartment.
Never transport in the passenger compartment. Never transport the pre-tensioner manually or holding it by the
webbing: this can result in damage to the assembly.
Storage of belt with pre-tensioner
Belts with pre-tensioning elements should be stored in containers or boxes that can be locked with a key,
and ventilated. They MUST be stored in an area free from flames and heat sources. On completion of work,
or during work break periods, pre-tensioner belts should be returned to the storage container and locked with
a key.
Disposal of belts with pre-tensioner
Charged pre-tensioners to be scrapped and not fitted to a car must be activated. This should be carried
out only by the belt manufacturers, or specialised workshops.
Vehicle disposal
Charged pre-tensioners fitted to a vehicle MUST be removed before the vehicle is dismantled for scrapping. If the pre-tensioner is not activated during an accident, the device must be considered as still to be in a
'charged' condition.
General safety instructions/dangers for health
When handling activated pre-tensioners, use safety glasses and vinylic or nitrylic protection gloves.
After handling a loaded pre-tensioner, wash hands with soap and water.
There is no danger of exposure to propellants in the sealed system. The propellant mix is in a solid state,
therefore no inhalation is possible, even if the gas generator cartridge is broken.
Avoid skin contact and do not ingest the propellant.
First aid
Ingestion: Help the person vomit if conscious. Call a physician.
Skin contact: Wash immediately with soap and water. Call a physician.
Eyes: Wash the eyes immediately with running water for a minimum of 10 minutes. Call a physician.
Inhalation: Take the person immediately to fresh air. Call a physician.
General notice
Storage, transport, dismantling and/or recycling of the pre-tensioner shall be carried out according to the
legal and local regulations, taking account also of directives for masonry, fire fighting, transport, environmental
protection and the safety and health of all staff.
WARNING: The seat belt pre-tensioner devices fitted on the Lotus Evora are designed and calibrated
specifically for this particular model. Pre-tensioners must not be adapted, re-used or installed on any
other vehicle - they must only be fitted to the prescribed vehicle with specific homologation continuity.
Any attempt to re-use, adapt or install pre-tensioners on a different vehicle can cause severe or fatal
injuries to the occupants during normal operation as well as the result of an accident.
Page 15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine